Intel MPX bound violation handling
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2662 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2663 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2664 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2665 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2666 information on convenience variables.
2667
2668 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2669 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2670 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2671 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2672 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2673 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2674
2675 @table @code
2676 @kindex add-inferior
2677 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2678 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2679 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2680 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2681 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2682 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2683
2684 @kindex clone-inferior
2685 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2686 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2687 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2688 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2689 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2690
2691 @smallexample
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2695 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2696 Added inferior 2.
2697 1 inferiors added.
2698 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2699 Num Description Executable
2700 2 <null> helloworld
2701 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2702 @end smallexample
2703
2704 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2705
2706 @kindex remove-inferiors
2707 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2708 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2709 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2710 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2711
2712 @end table
2713
2714 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2715 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2716 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2717 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2721 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2723 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2724 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2725 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2726
2727 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2730 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2731 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2732 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2736 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2737 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2738 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2739
2740
2741 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2742 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex set print inferior-events
2746 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2747 @item set print inferior-events
2748 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2749 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2750 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2751 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2752 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2753 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2754
2755 @kindex show print inferior-events
2756 @item show print inferior-events
2757 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2758 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2759 @end table
2760
2761 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2762 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2763 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2764
2765
2766 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2767 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2768 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2769 info program-spaces}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2773 @item maint info program-spaces
2774 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2775 @value{GDBN}.
2776
2777 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2778
2779 @enumerate
2780 @item
2781 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2782
2783 @item
2784 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2785 the @code{file} command.
2786
2787 @end enumerate
2788
2789 @noindent
2790 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2791 indicates the current program space.
2792
2793 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2794 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2795 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2796
2797 @smallexample
2798 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2799 Id Executable
2800 * 1 hello
2801 2 goodbye
2802 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2803 @end smallexample
2804
2805 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2806 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2807 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2808 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2809 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2813 Id Executable
2814 * 1 vfork-test
2815 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2819 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2820 @end table
2821
2822 @node Threads
2823 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2824
2825 @cindex threads of execution
2826 @cindex multiple threads
2827 @cindex switching threads
2828 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2829 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2830 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2831 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2832 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2833 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2834 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2835
2836 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2837 programs:
2838
2839 @itemize @bullet
2840 @item automatic notification of new threads
2841 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2842 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2843 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2844 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2845 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2846 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2847 messages on thread start and exit.
2848 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2849 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2850 isn't compatible with the program.
2851 @end itemize
2852
2853 @cindex focus of debugging
2854 @cindex current thread
2855 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2856 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2857 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2858 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2859 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2860
2861 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2862 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2863 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2864 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2865 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2866 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2867 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2868 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2869 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2870 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2871
2872 @smallexample
2873 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2874 @end smallexample
2875
2876 @noindent
2877 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2878 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2879 further qualifier.
2880
2881 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2882 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2883 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2884 @c program?
2885 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2886 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2887 @c threads ab initio?
2888
2889 @anchor{thread numbers}
2890 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2891 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2892 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2893 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2894 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2895 between threads of different inferiors.
2896
2897 @cindex qualified thread ID
2898 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2899 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2900 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2901 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2902 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2903 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2904 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2905 inferior.
2906
2907 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2908 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2909 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2910 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2911
2912 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2913 @cindex thread ID lists
2914 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2915 argument. A list element can be:
2916
2917 @enumerate
2918 @item
2919 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2920 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2921 @samp{1}.
2922
2923 @item
2924 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2925 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2926 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2927
2928 @item
2929 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2930 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2931 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2932 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2933 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2934
2935 @end enumerate
2936
2937 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2938 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2939 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2940 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2941 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2942 7.1}.
2943
2944
2945 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2946 @cindex global thread number
2947 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2948 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2949 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2950 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2951 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2952 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2953
2954 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2955 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2956 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2957
2958 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2959 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2960 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2961 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2962 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2963 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2964 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2965 general information on convenience variables.
2966
2967 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2968 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2969 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2970
2971 @smallexample
2972 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2973 @end smallexample
2974
2975 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2976
2977 @smallexample
2978 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2979 @end smallexample
2980
2981 @table @code
2982 @kindex info threads
2983 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2984
2985 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2986 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2987 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2988 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2989
2990 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2991
2992 @enumerate
2993 @item
2994 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2995
2996 @item
2997 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
2998 option was specified
2999
3000 @item
3001 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3002
3003 @item
3004 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3005 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3006 program itself.
3007
3008 @item
3009 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3010 @end enumerate
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3014 indicates the current thread.
3015
3016 For example,
3017 @end table
3018 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3019
3020 @smallexample
3021 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3022 Id Target Id Frame
3023 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3024 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3025 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3026 at threadtest.c:68
3027 @end smallexample
3028
3029 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3030 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3031 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3032
3033 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3034 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3038 Id GId Target Id Frame
3039 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3040 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3041 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3042 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3046 Solaris-specific command:
3047
3048 @table @code
3049 @item maint info sol-threads
3050 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3051 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3052 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3053 @end table
3054
3055 @table @code
3056 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3057 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3058 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3059 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3060 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3061 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3062
3063 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3064 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3065
3066 @smallexample
3067 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3068 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3069 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3070 8 printf ("hello\n");
3071 @end smallexample
3072
3073 @noindent
3074 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3075 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3076 threads.
3077
3078 @kindex thread apply
3079 @cindex apply command to several threads
3080 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3081 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3082 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3083 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3084 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3085 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3086 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3087 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3088
3089
3090 @kindex thread name
3091 @cindex name a thread
3092 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3093 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3094 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3095 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3096
3097 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3098 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3099 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3100 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3101 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3102
3103 @kindex thread find
3104 @cindex search for a thread
3105 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3106 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3107 matches the supplied regular expression.
3108
3109 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3110 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3111 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3112 is the LWP id.
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3116 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3117 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3120 @end smallexample
3121
3122 @kindex set print thread-events
3123 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3124 @item set print thread-events
3125 @itemx set print thread-events on
3126 @itemx set print thread-events off
3127 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3128 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3129 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3130 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3131 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3132
3133 @kindex show print thread-events
3134 @item show print thread-events
3135 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3136 have started and exited.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3140 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3141 programs with multiple threads.
3142
3143 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3144 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3145
3146 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3149 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3150 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3151 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3152 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3153 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3154 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3155 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3156 macro.
3157
3158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3159 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3160 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3161 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3162 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3163 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3164
3165 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3166 refers to the default system directories that are
3167 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3168 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3169 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3170
3171 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3172 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3173 was loaded in the inferior process.
3174
3175 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3176 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3177 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3178 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3179 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3180 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3181 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3182
3183 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3184 only on some platforms.
3185
3186 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3187 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3188 Display current libthread_db search path.
3189
3190 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3191 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3192 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3193 @item set debug libthread-db
3194 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3195 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3196 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 @node Forks
3200 @section Debugging Forks
3201
3202 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3203 @cindex multiple processes
3204 @cindex processes, multiple
3205 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3206 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3207 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3208 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3209 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3210 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3211 will cause it to terminate.
3212
3213 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3214 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3215 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3216 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3217 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3218 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3219 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3220 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3221 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3222 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3223
3224 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3225 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3226 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3227 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3228
3229 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3230 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3231 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3232
3233 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3234 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3235
3236 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3237 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3238
3239 @table @code
3240 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3241 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3242 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3243 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3244 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3245
3246 @table @code
3247 @item parent
3248 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3249 unimpeded. This is the default.
3250
3251 @item child
3252 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3253 unimpeded.
3254
3255 @end table
3256
3257 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3258 @item show follow-fork-mode
3259 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3260 @end table
3261
3262 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3263 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3264 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3265
3266 @table @code
3267 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3268 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3269 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3270 retain debugger control over them both.
3271
3272 @table @code
3273 @item on
3274 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3275 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3276 independently. This is the default.
3277
3278 @item off
3279 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3280 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3281 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3282 is held suspended.
3283
3284 @end table
3285
3286 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3287 @item show detach-on-fork
3288 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3289 @end table
3290
3291 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3292 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3293 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3294 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3295 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3296 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3297
3298 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3299 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3300 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3301 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3302 and Programs}.
3303
3304 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3305 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3306 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3307 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3308 the child process's @code{main}.
3309
3310 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3311 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3312
3313 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3314 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3315 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3316 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3317 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3318 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3319 command.
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3323 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3324
3325 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3326 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3327
3328 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3329
3330 @table @code
3331 @item new
3332 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3333 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3334 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3335 original inferior.
3336
3337 For example:
3338
3339 @smallexample
3340 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3341 (gdb) info inferior
3342 Id Description Executable
3343 * 1 <null> prog1
3344 (@value{GDBP}) run
3345 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3346 Program exited normally.
3347 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3348 Id Description Executable
3349 1 <null> prog1
3350 * 2 <null> prog2
3351 @end smallexample
3352
3353 @item same
3354 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3355 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3356 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3357 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3358 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3359
3360 For example:
3361
3362 @smallexample
3363 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3364 Id Description Executable
3365 * 1 <null> prog1
3366 (@value{GDBP}) run
3367 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3368 Program exited normally.
3369 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3370 Id Description Executable
3371 * 1 <null> prog2
3372 @end smallexample
3373
3374 @end table
3375 @end table
3376
3377 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3378 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3379
3380 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3381 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3382 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3383
3384 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3385 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3386
3387 @cindex checkpoint
3388 @cindex restart
3389 @cindex bookmark
3390 @cindex snapshot of a process
3391 @cindex rewind program state
3392
3393 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3394 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3395 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3396 later.
3397
3398 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3399 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3400 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3401 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3402 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3403
3404 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3405 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3406 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3407 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3408 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3409 start again from there.
3410
3411 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3412 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3413
3414 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3415
3416 @table @code
3417 @kindex checkpoint
3418 @item checkpoint
3419 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3420 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3421 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3422
3423 @kindex info checkpoints
3424 @item info checkpoints
3425 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3426 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3427 listed:
3428
3429 @table @code
3430 @item Checkpoint ID
3431 @item Process ID
3432 @item Code Address
3433 @item Source line, or label
3434 @end table
3435
3436 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3437 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3438 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3439 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3440 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3441 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3442 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3443
3444 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3445 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3446 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3447 the debugger.
3448
3449 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3450 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3451 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3452
3453 @end table
3454
3455 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3456 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3457 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3458 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3459 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3460 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3461 previously read data can be read again.
3462
3463 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3464 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3465 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3466 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3467 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3468 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3469
3470 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3471 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3472 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3473 different execution path this time.
3474
3475 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3476 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3477 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3478 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3479 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3480 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3481 potentially pose a problem.
3482
3483 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3484
3485 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3486 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3487 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3488 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3489 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3490 next.
3491
3492 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3493 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3494 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3495 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3496 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3497
3498 @node Stopping
3499 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3500
3501 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3502 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3503 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3504
3505 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3506 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3507 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3508 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3509 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3510 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3511 explicitly request this information at any time.
3512
3513 @table @code
3514 @kindex info program
3515 @item info program
3516 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3517 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3518 @end table
3519
3520 @menu
3521 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3522 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3523 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3524 Skipping over functions and files
3525 * Signals:: Signals
3526 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3527 @end menu
3528
3529 @node Breakpoints
3530 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3531
3532 @cindex breakpoints
3533 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3534 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3535 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3536 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3537 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3538 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3539 program.
3540
3541 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3542 the executable is run.
3543
3544 @cindex watchpoints
3545 @cindex data breakpoints
3546 @cindex memory tracing
3547 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3548 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3549 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3550 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3551 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3552 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3553 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3554 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3555 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3556 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3557 same commands.
3558
3559 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3560 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3561 Automatic Display}.
3562
3563 @cindex catchpoints
3564 @cindex breakpoint on events
3565 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3566 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3567 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3568 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3569 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3570 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3571 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3572
3573 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3574 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3575 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3576 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3577 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3578 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3579 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3580 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3581 enable it again.
3582
3583 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3584 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3585 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3586 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3587 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3588 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3589 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3590
3591 @menu
3592 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3593 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3594 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3595 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3596 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3597 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3598 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3599 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3600 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3601 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3602 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3603 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3604 @end menu
3605
3606 @node Set Breaks
3607 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3608
3609 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3610 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3611 @c
3612 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3613
3614 @kindex break
3615 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3616 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3617 @cindex latest breakpoint
3618 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3619 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3620 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3621 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3622 convenience variables.
3623
3624 @table @code
3625 @item break @var{location}
3626 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3627 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3628 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3629 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3630 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3631
3632 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3633 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3634 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3635 that situation.
3636
3637 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3638 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3639 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3640
3641 @item break
3642 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3643 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3644 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3645 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3646 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3647 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3648 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3649 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3650 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3651 inside loops.
3652
3653 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3654 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3655 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3656 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3657 existed when your program stopped.
3658
3659 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3660 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3661 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3662 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3663 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3664 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3665 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3666
3667 @kindex tbreak
3668 @item tbreak @var{args}
3669 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3670 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3671 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3672 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3673
3674 @kindex hbreak
3675 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3676 @item hbreak @var{args}
3677 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3678 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3679 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3680 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3681 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3682 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3683 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3684 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3685 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3686 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3687 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3688 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3689 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3690 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3691 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3692 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3693 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3694 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3695
3696 @kindex thbreak
3697 @item thbreak @var{args}
3698 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3699 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3700 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3701 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3702 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3703 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3704 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3705 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3706
3707 @kindex rbreak
3708 @cindex regular expression
3709 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3710 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3711 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3712 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3713 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3714 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3715 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3716 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3717 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3718
3719 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3720 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3721 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3722 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3723 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3724 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3725
3726 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3727 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3728 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3729 classes.
3730
3731 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3732 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3733 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3734
3735 @smallexample
3736 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3737 @end smallexample
3738
3739 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3740 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3741 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3742 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3743 every function in a given file:
3744
3745 @smallexample
3746 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3747 @end smallexample
3748
3749 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3750 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3751
3752 @kindex info breakpoints
3753 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3754 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3755 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3756 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3757 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3758 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3759 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3760
3761 @table @emph
3762 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3763 @item Type
3764 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3765 @item Disposition
3766 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3767 @item Enabled or Disabled
3768 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3769 that are not enabled.
3770 @item Address
3771 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3772 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3773 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3774 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3775 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3776 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3777 @item What
3778 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3779 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3780 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3781 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3782 @end table
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3786 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3787 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3788 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3789 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3790 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3791
3792 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3793 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3794 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3795 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3796
3797 @noindent
3798 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3799 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3800 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3801 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3802 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3803
3804 @noindent
3805 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3806 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3807 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3808 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3809 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3810 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3811
3812 @noindent
3813 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3814 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3815
3816 @end table
3817
3818 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3819 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3820 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3821 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3822
3823 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3824 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3825 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3826 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3827
3828 @itemize @bullet
3829 @item
3830 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3831
3832 @item
3833 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3834 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3835
3836 @item
3837 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3838 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3839
3840 @item
3841 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3842 several places where that function is inlined.
3843 @end itemize
3844
3845 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3846 the relevant locations.
3847
3848 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3849 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3850 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3851 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3852 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3853 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3854 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3855
3856 For example:
3857
3858 @smallexample
3859 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3860 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3861 stop only if i==1
3862 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3863 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3864 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3865 @end smallexample
3866
3867 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3868 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3869 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3870 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3871 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3872 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3873 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3874 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3875 that belong to that breakpoint.
3876
3877 @cindex pending breakpoints
3878 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3879 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3880 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3881 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3882 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3883 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3884 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3885 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3886 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3887 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3888 is not yet resolved.
3889
3890 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3891 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3892 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3893 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3894 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3895 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3896
3897 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3898 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3899 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3900 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3901
3902 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3903 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3904 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3905
3906 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3907 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3908 address specification to an address:
3909
3910 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3911 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3912 @table @code
3913 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3914 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3915 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3916
3917 @item set breakpoint pending on
3918 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3919 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3920
3921 @item set breakpoint pending off
3922 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3923 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3924 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3925
3926 @item show breakpoint pending
3927 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3928 @end table
3929
3930 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3931 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3932 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3933
3934 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3935 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3936 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3937 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3938 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3939 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3940 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3941 breakpoints.
3942
3943 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3944
3945 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3946 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3947 @table @code
3948 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3949 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3950 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3951 breakpoint must be used.
3952
3953 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3954 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3955 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3956 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3957 @end table
3958
3959 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3960 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3961 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3962 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3963 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3964 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3965 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3966 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3967 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3968
3969 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3970 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3971 @table @code
3972 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3973 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3974 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3975 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3976
3977 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3978 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3979 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3980 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3981 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3982 @end table
3983
3984 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3985 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3986 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3987
3988 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3989 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3990
3991 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3992
3993 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3994 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3995 @table @code
3996 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3997 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3998 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3999 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4000 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4001
4002 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4003 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4004 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4005 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4006 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4007 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4008 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4009 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4010 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4011 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4012 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4013 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4014 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4015
4016 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4017 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4018 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4019 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4020 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4021 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4022 @end table
4023
4024
4025 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4026 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4027 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4028 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4029 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4030 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4031 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4032 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4033
4034
4035 @node Set Watchpoints
4036 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4037
4038 @cindex setting watchpoints
4039 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4040 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4041 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4042 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4043 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4044
4045 @itemize @bullet
4046 @item
4047 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4048
4049 @item
4050 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4051 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4052 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4053
4054 @item
4055 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4056 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4057 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4058 @end itemize
4059
4060 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4061 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4062 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4063 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4064 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4065 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4066 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4067 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4068 the expression changes.
4069
4070 @cindex software watchpoints
4071 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4072 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4073 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4074 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4075 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4076 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4077 culprit.)
4078
4079 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4080 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4081 slow down the running of your program.
4082
4083 @table @code
4084 @kindex watch
4085 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4086 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4087 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4088 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4089 to watch the value of a single variable:
4090
4091 @smallexample
4092 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4093 @end smallexample
4094
4095 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4096 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4097 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4098 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4099 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4100 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4101
4102 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4103 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4104 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4105 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4106 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4107 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4108 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4109 error.
4110
4111 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4112 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4113 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4114 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4115 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4116 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4117 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4118 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4119 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4120 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4121 Examples:
4122
4123 @smallexample
4124 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4125 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4126 @end smallexample
4127
4128 @kindex rwatch
4129 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4130 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4131 by the program.
4132
4133 @kindex awatch
4134 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4135 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4136 or written into by the program.
4137
4138 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4139 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4140 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4141 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4142 @end table
4143
4144 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4145 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4146 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4147 a never-changing value:
4148
4149 @smallexample
4150 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4151 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4152 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4153 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4154 @end smallexample
4155
4156 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4157 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4158 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4159 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4160 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4161 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4162
4163 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4164 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4165 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4166 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4167 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4168 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4169 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4170 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4171
4172 @table @code
4173 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4174 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4175 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4176
4177 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4178 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4179 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4180 @end table
4181
4182 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4183 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4184 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4185
4186 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4187
4188 @smallexample
4189 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4190 @end smallexample
4191
4192 @noindent
4193 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4194
4195 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4196 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4197 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4198 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4199 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4200 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4201 will print a message like this:
4202
4203 @smallexample
4204 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4205 @end smallexample
4206
4207 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4208 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4209 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4210 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4211 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4212 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4213 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4214 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4215
4216 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4217 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4218 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4219 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4220 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4221 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4222
4223 @smallexample
4224 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4225 @end smallexample
4226
4227 @noindent
4228 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4229
4230 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4231 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4232 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4233 expression with separately allocated resources.
4234
4235 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4236 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4237 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4238
4239 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4240 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4241 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4242 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4243 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4244 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4245 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4246 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4247 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4248
4249 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4250 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4251 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4252 watched expression from every thread.
4253
4254 @quotation
4255 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4256 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4257 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4258 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4259 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4260 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4261 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4262 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4263 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4264 @end quotation
4265
4266 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4267
4268 @node Set Catchpoints
4269 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4270 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4271 @cindex exception handlers
4272 @cindex event handling
4273
4274 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4275 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4276 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @kindex catch
4280 @item catch @var{event}
4281 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4282
4283 @table @code
4284 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4285 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4286 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4287 @kindex catch throw
4288 @kindex catch rethrow
4289 @kindex catch catch
4290 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4291 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4292
4293 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4294 regular expression will be caught.
4295
4296 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4297 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4298 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4299 exception being thrown.
4300
4301 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4302 @value{GDBN}:
4303
4304 @itemize @bullet
4305 @item
4306 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4307 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4308 supported.
4309
4310 @item
4311 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4312 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4313 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4314 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4315 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4316 built.
4317
4318 @item
4319 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4320 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4321
4322 @item
4323 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4324 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4325 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4326 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4327
4328 @item
4329 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4330 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4331 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4332 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4333 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4334 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4335 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4336 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4337 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4338
4339 @item
4340 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4341
4342 @item
4343 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4344 @end itemize
4345
4346 @item exception
4347 @kindex catch exception
4348 @cindex Ada exception catching
4349 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4350 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4351 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4352 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4353 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4354
4355 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4356 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4357 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4358 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4359 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4360 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4361 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4362 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4363
4364 @item exception unhandled
4365 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4366 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4367
4368 @item assert
4369 @kindex catch assert
4370 A failed Ada assertion.
4371
4372 @item exec
4373 @kindex catch exec
4374 @cindex break on fork/exec
4375 A call to @code{exec}.
4376
4377 @item syscall
4378 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4379 @kindex catch syscall
4380 @cindex break on a system call.
4381 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4382 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4383 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4384 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4385 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4386 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4387 will be caught.
4388
4389 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4390 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4391 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4392 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4393
4394 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4395 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4396 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4397 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4398
4399 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4400 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4401 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4402 available choices.
4403
4404 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4405 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4406 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4407 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4408 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4409 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4410 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4411 behind the OS upgrades).
4412
4413 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4414 arguments to it:
4415
4416 @smallexample
4417 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4418 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4419 (@value{GDBP}) r
4420 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4421
4422 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4423 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4424 (@value{GDBP}) c
4425 Continuing.
4426
4427 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4428 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4429 (@value{GDBP})
4430 @end smallexample
4431
4432 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4436 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4437 (@value{GDBP}) r
4438 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4439
4440 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4441 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4442 (@value{GDBP}) c
4443 Continuing.
4444
4445 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4446 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4447 (@value{GDBP})
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4451 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4452 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4453
4454 @smallexample
4455 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4456 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4457 (@value{GDBP}) r
4458 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4459
4460 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4461 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4462 (@value{GDBP}) c
4463 Continuing.
4464
4465 Program exited normally.
4466 (@value{GDBP})
4467 @end smallexample
4468
4469 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4470 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4471 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4472 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4473
4474 @smallexample
4475 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4476 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4477 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4478 (@value{GDBP})
4479 @end smallexample
4480
4481 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4482 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4483 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4484 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4485 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4486 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4487
4488 @smallexample
4489 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4490 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4491 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4492 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4493 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4494 (@value{GDBP})
4495 @end smallexample
4496
4497 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4498
4499 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4500 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4504 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4505 @end smallexample
4506
4507 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4508
4509 @item fork
4510 @kindex catch fork
4511 A call to @code{fork}.
4512
4513 @item vfork
4514 @kindex catch vfork
4515 A call to @code{vfork}.
4516
4517 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4518 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4519 @kindex catch load
4520 @kindex catch unload
4521 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4522 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4523 matches one of the affected libraries.
4524
4525 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4526 @kindex catch signal
4527 The delivery of a signal.
4528
4529 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4530 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4531 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4532
4533 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4534 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4535 signal names.
4536
4537 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4538 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4539 will be caught.
4540
4541 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4542 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4543 catchpoint.
4544
4545 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4546 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4547 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4548 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4549 commands.
4550
4551 @end table
4552
4553 @item tcatch @var{event}
4554 @kindex tcatch
4555 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4556 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4557
4558 @end table
4559
4560 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4561
4562
4563 @node Delete Breaks
4564 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4565
4566 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4567 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4568 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4569 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4570 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4571 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4572
4573 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4574 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4575 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4576 their breakpoint numbers.
4577
4578 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4579 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4580 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4581
4582 @table @code
4583 @kindex clear
4584 @item clear
4585 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4586 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4587 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4588 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4589
4590 @item clear @var{location}
4591 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4592 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4593 most useful ones are listed below:
4594
4595 @table @code
4596 @item clear @var{function}
4597 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4598 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4599
4600 @item clear @var{linenum}
4601 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4602 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4603 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4604 @end table
4605
4606 @cindex delete breakpoints
4607 @kindex delete
4608 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4609 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4610 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4611 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4612 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4613 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4614 @end table
4615
4616 @node Disabling
4617 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4618
4619 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4620 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4621 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4622 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4623 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4624
4625 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4626 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4627 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4628 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4629 do not know which numbers to use.
4630
4631 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4632 affects all of its locations.
4633
4634 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4635 different states of enablement:
4636
4637 @itemize @bullet
4638 @item
4639 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4640 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4641 @item
4642 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4643 @item
4644 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4645 disabled.
4646 @item
4647 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4648 N times, then becomes disabled.
4649 @item
4650 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4651 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4652 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4653 @end itemize
4654
4655 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4656 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4657
4658 @table @code
4659 @kindex disable
4660 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4661 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4662 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4663 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4664 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4665 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4666 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4667
4668 @kindex enable
4669 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4670 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4671 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4672
4673 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4674 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4675 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4676
4677 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4678 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4679 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4680 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4681 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4682 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4683 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4684
4685 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4686 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4687 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4688 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4692 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4693 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4694 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4695 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4696 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4697 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4698 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4699 Stepping}.)
4700
4701 @node Conditions
4702 @subsection Break Conditions
4703 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4704 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4705
4706 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4707 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4708 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4709 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4710 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4711 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4712 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4713 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4714
4715 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4716 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4717 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4718 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4719 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4720
4721 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4722 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4723 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4724 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4725 one.
4726
4727 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4728 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4729 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4730 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4731 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4732 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4733 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4734 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4735 conditions for the
4736 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4737 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4738
4739 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4740 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4741 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4742 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4743 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4744 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4745
4746 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4747 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4748 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4749 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4750 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4751
4752 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4753 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4754 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4755 with the @code{condition} command.
4756
4757 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4758 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4759 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4760 catchpoint.
4761
4762 @table @code
4763 @kindex condition
4764 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4765 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4766 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4767 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4768 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4769 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4770 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4771 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4772 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4773 prints an error message:
4774
4775 @smallexample
4776 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4777 @end smallexample
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 @value{GDBN} does
4781 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4782 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4783 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4784
4785 @item condition @var{bnum}
4786 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4787 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4788 @end table
4789
4790 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4791 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4792 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4793 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4794 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4795 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4796 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4797 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4798 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4799 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4800 your program reaches it.
4801
4802 @table @code
4803 @kindex ignore
4804 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4805 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4806 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4807 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4808 takes no action.
4809
4810 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4811 a count of zero.
4812
4813 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4814 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4815 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4816 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4817
4818 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4819 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4820 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4821
4822 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4823 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4824 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4825 Variables}.
4826 @end table
4827
4828 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4829
4830
4831 @node Break Commands
4832 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4833
4834 @cindex breakpoint commands
4835 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4836 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4837 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4838 enable other breakpoints.
4839
4840 @table @code
4841 @kindex commands
4842 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4843 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4844 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4845 @itemx end
4846 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4847 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4848 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4849
4850 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4851 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4852
4853 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4854 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4855 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4856 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4857 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4858 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4859 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4860 Expressions}).
4861 @end table
4862
4863 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4864 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4865
4866 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4867 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4868 that resumes execution.
4869
4870 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4871 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4872 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4873 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4874 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4875
4876 @kindex silent
4877 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4878 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4879 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4880 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4881 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4882 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4883
4884 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4885 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4886 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4887
4888 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4889 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4890
4891 @smallexample
4892 break foo if x>0
4893 commands
4894 silent
4895 printf "x is %d\n",x
4896 cont
4897 end
4898 @end smallexample
4899
4900 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4901 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4902 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4903 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4904 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4905 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4906 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4907
4908 @smallexample
4909 break 403
4910 commands
4911 silent
4912 set x = y + 4
4913 cont
4914 end
4915 @end smallexample
4916
4917 @node Dynamic Printf
4918 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4919
4920 @cindex dynamic printf
4921 @cindex dprintf
4922 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4923 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4924 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4925 having to recompile it.
4926
4927 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4928 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4929 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4930 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4931 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4932 redirects to files and so forth.
4933
4934 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4935 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4936 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4937 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4938 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4939 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4940 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4941
4942 @table @code
4943 @kindex dprintf
4944 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4945 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4946 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4947 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4948
4949 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4950 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4951 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4952 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4953 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4954 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4955
4956 @item gdb
4957 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4958 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4959
4960 @item call
4961 @kindex dprintf-style call
4962 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4963 @code{printf}).
4964
4965 @item agent
4966 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4967 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4968 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4969 support running commands on the target.
4970
4971 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4972 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4973 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4974 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4975 command.
4976
4977 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4978 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4979 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4980 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4981 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4982 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4983
4984 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4985 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4986 you could do the following:
4987
4988 @example
4989 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4990 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4991 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4992 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4993 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4994 (gdb) info break
4995 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4996 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4997 continue
4998 (gdb)
4999 @end example
5000
5001 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5002 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5003 the variable settings.
5004
5005 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5006 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5007 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5008 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5009 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5010 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5011
5012 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5013 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5014 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5015
5016 @end table
5017
5018 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5019 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5020 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5021 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5022 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5023 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5024
5025 @node Save Breakpoints
5026 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5027
5028 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5029 breakpoints}} command.
5030
5031 @table @code
5032 @kindex save breakpoints
5033 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5034 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5035 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5036 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5037 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5038 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5039 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5040 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5041 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5042 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5043 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5044 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5045 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5046 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5047 that can no longer be recreated.
5048 @end table
5049
5050 @node Static Probe Points
5051 @subsection Static Probe Points
5052
5053 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5054 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5055 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5056 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5057 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5058
5059 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5060 ELF-compatible systems:
5061
5062 @itemize @bullet
5063
5064 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5065 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5066 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5067 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5068 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5069 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5070 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5071 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5072
5073 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5074 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5075 C@t{++} languages.
5076 @end itemize
5077
5078 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5079 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5080 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5081 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5082 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5083 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5084 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5085 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5086 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5087
5088 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5089 probes}, with optional arguments:
5090
5091 @table @code
5092 @kindex info probes
5093 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5094 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5095 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5096 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5097
5098 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5099 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5100 probes from all providers are listed.
5101
5102 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5103 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5104 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5105
5106 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5107 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5108 given, all object files are considered.
5109
5110 @item info probes all
5111 List the available static probes, from all types.
5112 @end table
5113
5114 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5115 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5116 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5117 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5118 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5119
5120 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5121 commands, with optional arguments:
5122
5123 @table @code
5124 @kindex enable probes
5125 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5126 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5127 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5128 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5129
5130 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5131 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5132 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5133
5134 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5135 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5136 given, all object files are considered.
5137
5138 @kindex disable probes
5139 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5140 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5141 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5142 @end table
5143
5144 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5145 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5146 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5147 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5148 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5149 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5150 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5151 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5152 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5153 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5154 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5155 at the current probe point.
5156
5157 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5158 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5159 an error message.
5160
5161
5162 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5163 @node Error in Breakpoints
5164 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5165
5166 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5167 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5168
5169 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5170 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5171 @smallexample
5172 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5173 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5174 @end smallexample
5175
5176 @noindent
5177 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5178 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5179 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5180
5181 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5182 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5183
5184 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5185 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5186 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5187
5188 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5189 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5190 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5191 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5192
5193 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5194 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5195 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5196 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5197 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5198 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5199 first in the bundle.
5200
5201 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5202 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5203 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5204 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5205 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5206 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5207 is hit.
5208
5209 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5210 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5211
5212 @smallexample
5213 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5214 @end smallexample
5215
5216 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5217 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5218 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5219 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5220 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5221 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5222 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5223 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5224
5225 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5226 adjusted breakpoints:
5227
5228 @smallexample
5229 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5230 to 0x00010410.
5231 @end smallexample
5232
5233 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5234 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5235 frequently than expected.
5236
5237 @node Continuing and Stepping
5238 @section Continuing and Stepping
5239
5240 @cindex stepping
5241 @cindex continuing
5242 @cindex resuming execution
5243 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5244 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5245 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5246 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5247 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5248 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5249 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5250 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5251 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5252 handlers}).)
5253
5254 @table @code
5255 @kindex continue
5256 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5257 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5258 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5259 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5260 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5261 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5262 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5263 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5264 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5265 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5266
5267 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5268 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5269 @code{continue} is ignored.
5270
5271 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5272 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5273 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5274 @code{continue}.
5275 @end table
5276
5277 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5278 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5279 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5280 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5281
5282 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5283 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5284 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5285 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5286 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5287 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5288
5289 @table @code
5290 @kindex step
5291 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5292 @item step
5293 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5294 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5295 abbreviated @code{s}.
5296
5297 @quotation
5298 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5299 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5300 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5301 @c distinction here.
5302 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5303 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5304 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5305 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5306 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5307 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5308 below.
5309 @end quotation
5310
5311 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5312 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5313 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5314 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5315 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5316 called within the line.
5317
5318 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5319 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5320 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5321 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5322 was any debugging information about the routine.
5323
5324 @item step @var{count}
5325 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5326 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5327 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5328
5329 @kindex next
5330 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5331 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5332 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5333 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5334 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5335 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5336 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5337 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5338
5339 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5340
5341
5342 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5343 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5344 @c
5345 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5346 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5347 @c function are executed without stopping.
5348
5349 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5350 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5351 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5352
5353 @kindex set step-mode
5354 @item set step-mode
5355 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5356 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5357 @itemx set step-mode on
5358 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5359 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5360 information rather than stepping over it.
5361
5362 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5363 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5364 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5365
5366 @item set step-mode off
5367 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5368 debug information. This is the default.
5369
5370 @item show step-mode
5371 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5372 source line debug information.
5373
5374 @kindex finish
5375 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5376 @item finish
5377 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5378 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5379 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5380
5381 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5382 ,Returning from a Function}).
5383
5384 @kindex until
5385 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5386 @cindex run until specified location
5387 @item until
5388 @itemx u
5389 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5390 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5391 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5392 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5393 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5394 than the address of the jump.
5395
5396 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5397 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5398 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5399 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5400 through the next iteration.
5401
5402 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5403 stack frame.
5404
5405 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5406 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5407 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5408 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5409 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5410
5411 @smallexample
5412 (@value{GDBP}) f
5413 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5414 206 expand_input();
5415 (@value{GDBP}) until
5416 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5417 @end smallexample
5418
5419 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5420 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5421 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5422 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5423 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5424 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5425 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5426
5427 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5428 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5429 argument.
5430
5431 @item until @var{location}
5432 @itemx u @var{location}
5433 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5434 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5435 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5436 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5437 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5438 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5439 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5440 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5441 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5442 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5443 invocations have returned.
5444
5445 @smallexample
5446 94 int factorial (int value)
5447 95 @{
5448 96 if (value > 1) @{
5449 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5450 98 @}
5451 99 return (value);
5452 100 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455
5456 @kindex advance @var{location}
5457 @item advance @var{location}
5458 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5459 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5460 @ref{Specify Location}.
5461 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5462 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5463 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5464 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5465
5466
5467 @kindex stepi
5468 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5469 @item stepi
5470 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5471 @itemx si
5472 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5473
5474 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5475 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5476 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5477 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5478
5479 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5480
5481 @need 750
5482 @kindex nexti
5483 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5484 @item nexti
5485 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5486 @itemx ni
5487 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5488 proceed until the function returns.
5489
5490 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5491
5492 @end table
5493
5494 @anchor{range stepping}
5495 @cindex range stepping
5496 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5497 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5498 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5499 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5500 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5501 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5502 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5503 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5504 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5505 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5506 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5507 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5508 if necessary:
5509
5510 @table @code
5511 @kindex set range-stepping
5512 @kindex show range-stepping
5513 @item set range-stepping
5514 @itemx show range-stepping
5515 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5516
5517 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5518 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5519 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5520 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5521 default is @code{on}.
5522
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5526 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5527 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5528
5529 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5530 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5531 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5532
5533 For example, consider the following C function:
5534
5535 @smallexample
5536 101 int func()
5537 102 @{
5538 103 foo(boring());
5539 104 bar(boring());
5540 105 @}
5541 @end smallexample
5542
5543 @noindent
5544 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5545 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5546 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5547 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5548
5549 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5550 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5551 is called from many places.
5552
5553 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5554 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5555 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5556 @code{foo}.
5557
5558 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5559 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5560
5561 @table @code
5562 @kindex skip function
5563 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5564 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5565 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5566 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5567 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5568
5569 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5570 will be skipped.
5571
5572 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5573 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5574
5575 @kindex skip file
5576 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5577 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5578 will be skipped over when stepping.
5579
5580 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5581 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5582 @end table
5583
5584 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5585 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5586
5587 @table @code
5588 @kindex info skip
5589 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5590 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5591 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5592 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5593
5594 @table @emph
5595 @item Identifier
5596 A number identifying this skip.
5597 @item Type
5598 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5599 @item Enabled or Disabled
5600 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5601 @item Address
5602 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5603 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5604 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5605 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5606 address here.
5607 @item What
5608 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5609 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5610 where it is defined.
5611 @end table
5612
5613 @kindex skip delete
5614 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5615 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5616 skips.
5617
5618 @kindex skip enable
5619 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5620 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5621 skips.
5622
5623 @kindex skip disable
5624 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5625 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5626 skips.
5627
5628 @end table
5629
5630 @node Signals
5631 @section Signals
5632 @cindex signals
5633
5634 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5635 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5636 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5637 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5638 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5639 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5640 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5641 requested an alarm).
5642
5643 @cindex fatal signals
5644 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5645 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5646 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5647 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5648 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5649 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5650
5651 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5652 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5653 signal.
5654
5655 @cindex handling signals
5656 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5657 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5658 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5659 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5660 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5661
5662 @table @code
5663 @kindex info signals
5664 @kindex info handle
5665 @item info signals
5666 @itemx info handle
5667 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5668 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5669 the defined types of signals.
5670
5671 @item info signals @var{sig}
5672 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5673
5674 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5675
5676 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5677 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5678 for details about this command.
5679
5680 @kindex handle
5681 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5682 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5683 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5684 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5685 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5686 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5687 say what change to make.
5688 @end table
5689
5690 @c @group
5691 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5692 Their full names are:
5693
5694 @table @code
5695 @item nostop
5696 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5697 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5698
5699 @item stop
5700 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5701 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5702
5703 @item print
5704 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5705
5706 @item noprint
5707 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5708 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5709
5710 @item pass
5711 @itemx noignore
5712 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5713 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5714 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5715
5716 @item nopass
5717 @itemx ignore
5718 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5719 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5720 @end table
5721 @c @end group
5722
5723 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5724 program until you
5725 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5726 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5727 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5728 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5729 program sees that signal when you continue.
5730
5731 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5732 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5733 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5734 erroneous signals.
5735
5736 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5737 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5738 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5739 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5740 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5741 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5742 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5743 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5744 Program a Signal}.
5745
5746 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5747 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5748
5749 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5750 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5751 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5752 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5753 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5754 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5755 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5756 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5757 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5758 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5759 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5760 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5761 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5762
5763 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5764
5765 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5766 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5767 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5768 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5769
5770 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5771 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5772 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5773 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5774
5775 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5776 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5777
5778 @smallexample
5779 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5780 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5781 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5782 (@value{GDBP}) c
5783 Continuing.
5784
5785 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5786 main () sigusr1.c:28
5787 28 p = 0;
5788 (@value{GDBP}) si
5789 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5790 9 @{
5791 @end smallexample
5792
5793 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5794 program to receive the signal first:
5795
5796 @smallexample
5797 (@value{GDBP}) n
5798 28 p = 0;
5799 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5800 (@value{GDBP}) si
5801 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5802 9 @{
5803 (@value{GDBP})
5804 @end smallexample
5805
5806 @cindex extra signal information
5807 @anchor{extra signal information}
5808
5809 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5810 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5811 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5812 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5813 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5814 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5815 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5816 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5817 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5818 system header.
5819
5820 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5821 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5822
5823 @smallexample
5824 @group
5825 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5826 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5827 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5828 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5829 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5830 type = struct @{
5831 int si_signo;
5832 int si_errno;
5833 int si_code;
5834 union @{
5835 int _pad[28];
5836 struct @{...@} _kill;
5837 struct @{...@} _timer;
5838 struct @{...@} _rt;
5839 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5840 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5841 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5842 @} _sifields;
5843 @}
5844 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5845 type = struct @{
5846 void *si_addr;
5847 @}
5848 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5849 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5850 @end group
5851 @end smallexample
5852
5853 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5854
5855 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5856 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5857 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5858 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5859 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5860 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5861 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5862 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5863 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5864 information is displayed.
5865
5866 The usual output of a segfault is:
5867 @smallexample
5868 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5869 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5870 68 value = *(p + len);
5871 @end smallexample
5872
5873 While a bound violation is presented as:
5874 @smallexample
5875 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5876 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5877 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5878 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5879 68 value = *(p + len);
5880 @end smallexample
5881
5882 @node Thread Stops
5883 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5884
5885 @cindex stopped threads
5886 @cindex threads, stopped
5887
5888 @cindex continuing threads
5889 @cindex threads, continuing
5890
5891 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5892 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5893 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5894 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5895 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5896 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5897 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5898 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5899 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5900
5901 @menu
5902 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5903 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5904 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5905 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5906 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5907 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5908 @end menu
5909
5910 @node All-Stop Mode
5911 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5912
5913 @cindex all-stop mode
5914
5915 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5916 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5917 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5918 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5919 underfoot.
5920
5921 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5922 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5923 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5924
5925 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5926 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5927 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5928 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5929 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5930 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5931 stops.
5932
5933 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5934 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5935 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5936 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5937
5938 @cindex automatic thread selection
5939 @cindex switching threads automatically
5940 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5941 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5942 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5943 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5944 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5945 thread.
5946
5947 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5948 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5949
5950 @table @code
5951 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5952 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5953 @cindex lock scheduler
5954 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
5955 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5956 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
5957 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
5958 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
5959 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
5960 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
5961 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5962 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
5963 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
5964 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
5965 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
5966 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
5967 @code{on} in replay mode.
5968
5969 @item show scheduler-locking
5970 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5971 @end table
5972
5973 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5974 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5975 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5976 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5977 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5978 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5979 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5980 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5981 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5982 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5983 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5984 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5985 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5986 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5987
5988 @table @code
5989 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5990 @item set schedule-multiple
5991 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5992 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5993 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5994 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5995 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5996 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5997
5998 @item show schedule-multiple
5999 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6000 multiple processes.
6001 @end table
6002
6003 @node Non-Stop Mode
6004 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6005
6006 @cindex non-stop mode
6007
6008 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6009 @c with more details.
6010
6011 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6012 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6013 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6014 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6015 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6016 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6017
6018 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6019 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6020 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6021 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6022 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6023 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6024 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6025 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6026 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6027 independently and simultaneously.
6028
6029 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6030 or attach to your program:
6031
6032 @smallexample
6033 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6034 set pagination off
6035
6036 # Finally, turn it on!
6037 set non-stop on
6038 @end smallexample
6039
6040 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6041
6042 @table @code
6043 @kindex set non-stop
6044 @item set non-stop on
6045 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6046 @item set non-stop off
6047 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6048 @kindex show non-stop
6049 @item show non-stop
6050 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6051 @end table
6052
6053 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6054 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6055 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6056 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6057 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6058 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6059 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6060 default.
6061
6062 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6063 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6064 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6065
6066 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6067 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6068 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6069 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6070 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6071
6072 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6073 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6074 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6075 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6076 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6077
6078 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6079
6080 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6081 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6082 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6083 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6084 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6085 previously current thread.
6086
6087 @node Background Execution
6088 @subsection Background Execution
6089
6090 @cindex foreground execution
6091 @cindex background execution
6092 @cindex asynchronous execution
6093 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6094
6095 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6096 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6097 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6098 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6099 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6100 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6101
6102 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6103 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6104
6105 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6106 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6107 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6108 are:
6109
6110 @table @code
6111 @kindex run&
6112 @item run
6113 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6114
6115 @item attach
6116 @kindex attach&
6117 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6118
6119 @item step
6120 @kindex step&
6121 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6122
6123 @item stepi
6124 @kindex stepi&
6125 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6126
6127 @item next
6128 @kindex next&
6129 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6130
6131 @item nexti
6132 @kindex nexti&
6133 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6134
6135 @item continue
6136 @kindex continue&
6137 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6138
6139 @item finish
6140 @kindex finish&
6141 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6142
6143 @item until
6144 @kindex until&
6145 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6146
6147 @end table
6148
6149 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6150 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6151 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6152 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6153 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6154 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6155
6156 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6157 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6158
6159 @table @code
6160 @kindex interrupt
6161 @item interrupt
6162 @itemx interrupt -a
6163
6164 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6165 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6166 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6167 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6168 @end table
6169
6170 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6171 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6172
6173 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6174 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6175 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6176
6177 @table @code
6178 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6179 @cindex thread breakpoints
6180 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6181 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6182 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6183 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6184 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6185 specify some source line.
6186
6187 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6188 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6189 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6190 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6191 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6192
6193 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6194 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6195 program.
6196
6197 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6198 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6199 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6200
6201 @smallexample
6202 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6203 @end smallexample
6204
6205 @end table
6206
6207 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6208 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6209 thread list. For example:
6210
6211 @smallexample
6212 (@value{GDBP}) c
6213 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6214 @end smallexample
6215
6216 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6217 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6218 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6219 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6220 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6221 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6222 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6223 command.
6224
6225 @node Interrupted System Calls
6226 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6227
6228 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6229 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6230 @cindex premature return from system calls
6231 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6232 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6233 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6234 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6235 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6236 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6237 stop execution.
6238
6239 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6240 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6241 style anyways.
6242
6243 For example, do not write code like this:
6244
6245 @smallexample
6246 sleep (10);
6247 @end smallexample
6248
6249 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6250 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6251
6252 Instead, write this:
6253
6254 @smallexample
6255 int unslept = 10;
6256 while (unslept > 0)
6257 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6258 @end smallexample
6259
6260 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6261 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6262 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6263 @value{GDBN}.
6264
6265 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6266 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6267 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6268 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6269
6270 @node Observer Mode
6271 @subsection Observer Mode
6272
6273 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6274 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6275 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6276 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6277 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6278
6279 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6280 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6281 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6282 mode.
6283
6284 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6285 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6286 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6287 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6288 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6289
6290 @table @code
6291
6292 @kindex observer
6293 @item set observer on
6294 @itemx set observer off
6295 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6296 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6297 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6298 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6299
6300 @item show observer
6301 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6302
6303 @kindex may-write-registers
6304 @item set may-write-registers on
6305 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6306 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6307 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6308 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6309
6310 @item show may-write-registers
6311 Show the current permission to write registers.
6312
6313 @kindex may-write-memory
6314 @item set may-write-memory on
6315 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6316 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6317 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6318 defaults to @code{on}.
6319
6320 @item show may-write-memory
6321 Show the current permission to write memory.
6322
6323 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6324 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6325 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6326 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6327 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6328 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6329
6330 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6331 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6332
6333 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6334 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6335 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6336 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6337 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6338 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6339 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6340
6341 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6342 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6343
6344 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6345 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6346 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6347 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6348 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6349 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6350 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6351
6352 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6353 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6354
6355 @kindex may-interrupt
6356 @item set may-interrupt on
6357 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6358 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6359 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6360 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6361 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6362
6363 @item show may-interrupt
6364 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6365
6366 @end table
6367
6368 @node Reverse Execution
6369 @chapter Running programs backward
6370 @cindex reverse execution
6371 @cindex running programs backward
6372
6373 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6374 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6375 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6376 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6377
6378 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6379 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6380 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6381 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6382 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6383 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6384
6385 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6386 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6387 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6388 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6389 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6390 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6391 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6392 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6393 prior values@footnote{
6394 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6395 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6396 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6397
6398 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6399 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6400 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6401 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6402 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6403 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6404 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6405 }.
6406
6407 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6408 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6409
6410 @table @code
6411 @kindex reverse-continue
6412 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6413 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6414 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6415 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6416 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6417 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6418 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6419
6420 @kindex reverse-step
6421 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6422 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6423 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6424 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6425
6426 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6427 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6428 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6429 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6430 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6431 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6432
6433 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6434 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6435
6436 @kindex reverse-stepi
6437 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6438 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6439 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6440 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6441 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6442 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6443 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6444
6445 @kindex reverse-next
6446 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6447 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6448 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6449 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6450 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6451 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6452 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6453 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6454 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6455 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6456
6457 @kindex reverse-nexti
6458 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6459 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6460 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6461 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6462 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6463 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6464 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6465 frame) is reached.
6466
6467 @kindex reverse-finish
6468 @item reverse-finish
6469 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6470 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6471 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6472 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6473
6474 @kindex set exec-direction
6475 @item set exec-direction
6476 Set the direction of target execution.
6477 @item set exec-direction reverse
6478 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6479 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6480 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6481 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6482 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6483 @item set exec-direction forward
6484 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6485 This is the default.
6486 @end table
6487
6488
6489 @node Process Record and Replay
6490 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6491 @cindex process record and replay
6492 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6493
6494 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6495 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6496 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6497
6498 @cindex replay mode
6499 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6500 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6501 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6502 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6503 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6504 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6505 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6506 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6507 execution log.
6508
6509 @cindex record mode
6510 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6511 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6512 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6513 for future replay.
6514
6515 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6516 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6517 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6518 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6519 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6520 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6521
6522 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6523 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6524 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6525 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6526
6527 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6528 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6529
6530 @table @code
6531 @kindex target record
6532 @kindex target record-full
6533 @kindex target record-btrace
6534 @kindex record
6535 @kindex record full
6536 @kindex record btrace
6537 @kindex record btrace bts
6538 @kindex record btrace pt
6539 @kindex record bts
6540 @kindex record pt
6541 @kindex rec
6542 @kindex rec full
6543 @kindex rec btrace
6544 @kindex rec btrace bts
6545 @kindex rec btrace pt
6546 @kindex rec bts
6547 @kindex rec pt
6548 @item record @var{method}
6549 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6550 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6551 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6552 recording methods are available:
6553
6554 @table @code
6555 @item full
6556 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6557 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6558 execution.
6559
6560 @item btrace @var{format}
6561 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6562 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6563 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6564 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6565 execution.
6566
6567 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6568 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6569 formats are available:
6570
6571 @table @code
6572 @item bts
6573 @cindex branch trace store
6574 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6575 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6576 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6577
6578 @item pt
6579 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6580 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6581 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6582 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6583
6584 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6585 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6586 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6587
6588 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6589 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6590 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6591 buffer-size with care.
6592 @end table
6593
6594 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6595 @end table
6596
6597 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6598 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6599 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6600 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6601
6602 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6603 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6604 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6605 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6606 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6607
6608 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6609 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6610 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6611 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6612 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6613 does not support these two modes.
6614
6615 @kindex record stop
6616 @kindex rec s
6617 @item record stop
6618 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6619 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6620 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6621
6622 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6623 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6624 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6625 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6626 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6627
6628 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6629 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6630 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6631 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6632 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6633
6634 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6635 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6636
6637 @kindex record goto
6638 @item record goto
6639 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6640 ways to specify the location to go to:
6641
6642 @table @code
6643 @item record goto begin
6644 @itemx record goto start
6645 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6646
6647 @item record goto end
6648 Go to the end of the execution log.
6649
6650 @item record goto @var{n}
6651 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6652 @end table
6653
6654 @kindex record save
6655 @item record save @var{filename}
6656 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6657 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6658 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6659
6660 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6661
6662 @kindex record restore
6663 @item record restore @var{filename}
6664 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6665 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6666
6667 @kindex set record full
6668 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6669 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6670 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6671 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6672
6673 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6674 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6675 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6676 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6677 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6678 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6679 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6680 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6681
6682 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6683 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6684 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6685
6686 @kindex show record full
6687 @item show record full insn-number-max
6688 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6689 recording method.
6690
6691 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6692 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6693 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6694 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6695 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6696 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6697 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6698 oldest one to be deleted.
6699
6700 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6701 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6702
6703 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6704 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6705
6706 @item set record full memory-query
6707 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6708 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6709 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6710 case.
6711
6712 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6713 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6714 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6715 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6716 results.
6717
6718 @item show record full memory-query
6719 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6720
6721 @kindex set record btrace
6722 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6723 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6724 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6725 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6726 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6727 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6728 You can use the following command for that:
6729
6730 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6731 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6732 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6733 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6734 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6735 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6736 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6737 position.
6738
6739 @kindex show record btrace
6740 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6741 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6742
6743 @kindex set record btrace bts
6744 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6745 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6746 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6747 format. Default is 64KB.
6748
6749 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6750 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6751 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6752 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6753 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6754 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6755 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6756
6757 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6758 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6759
6760 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6761 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6762
6763 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6764 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6765 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6766
6767 @kindex set record btrace pt
6768 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6769 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6770 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6771 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6772
6773 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6774 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6775 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6776 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6777 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6778 actual buffer size for each thread.
6779
6780 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6781 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6782
6783 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6784 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6785
6786 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6787 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6788 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6789
6790 @kindex info record
6791 @item info record
6792 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6793 method:
6794
6795 @table @code
6796 @item full
6797 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6798 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6799
6800 @itemize @bullet
6801 @item
6802 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6803 @item
6804 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6805 @item
6806 Highest recorded instruction number.
6807 @item
6808 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6809 @item
6810 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6811 @item
6812 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6813 @end itemize
6814
6815 @item btrace
6816 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6817
6818 @itemize @bullet
6819 @item
6820 Recording format.
6821 @item
6822 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6823 @item
6824 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6825 instructions.
6826 @item
6827 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6828 @end itemize
6829
6830 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6831 @itemize @bullet
6832 @item
6833 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6834 @end itemize
6835
6836 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6837 @itemize @bullet
6838 @item
6839 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6840 @end itemize
6841 @end table
6842
6843 @kindex record delete
6844 @kindex rec del
6845 @item record delete
6846 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6847 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6848 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6849 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6850
6851 @kindex record instruction-history
6852 @kindex rec instruction-history
6853 @item record instruction-history
6854 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6855 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6856 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6857 are printed in execution order.
6858
6859 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6860 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6861 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6862
6863 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6864 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6865 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6866 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6867 @code{/p} modifier.
6868
6869 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6870 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6871 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6872
6873 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6874 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6875
6876 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6877 disassemble:
6878
6879 @table @code
6880 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6881 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6882 @var{insn}.
6883
6884 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6885 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6886 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6887 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6888 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6889 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6890
6891 @item record instruction-history
6892 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6893
6894 @item record instruction-history -
6895 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6896
6897 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6898 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6899 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6900 number @var{end} is included.
6901 @end table
6902
6903 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6904
6905 @kindex set record
6906 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6907 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6908 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6909 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6910 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6911
6912 @kindex show record
6913 @item show record instruction-history-size
6914 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6915 instruction-history} command.
6916
6917 @kindex record function-call-history
6918 @kindex rec function-call-history
6919 @item record function-call-history
6920 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6921 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6922 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6923 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6924 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6925 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6926 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6927 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6928 given together.
6929
6930 @smallexample
6931 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6932 1 void foo (void)
6933 2 @{
6934 3 @}
6935 4
6936 5 void bar (void)
6937 6 @{
6938 7 ...
6939 8 foo ();
6940 9 ...
6941 10 @}
6942 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6943 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6944 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6945 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6946 @end smallexample
6947
6948 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6949 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6950 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6951 to print:
6952
6953 @table @code
6954 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6955 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6956
6957 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6958 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6959 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6960 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6961 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6962
6963 @item record function-call-history
6964 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6965
6966 @item record function-call-history -
6967 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6968
6969 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6970 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6971 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6972 @end table
6973
6974 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6975
6976 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6977 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6978 Define how many lines to print in the
6979 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6980 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6981
6982 @item show record function-call-history-size
6983 Show how many lines to print in the
6984 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6985 @end table
6986
6987
6988 @node Stack
6989 @chapter Examining the Stack
6990
6991 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6992 stopped and how it got there.
6993
6994 @cindex call stack
6995 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6996 is generated.
6997 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6998 the arguments of the call,
6999 and the local variables of the function being called.
7000 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7001 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7002 stack}.
7003
7004 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7005 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7006
7007 @cindex selected frame
7008 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7009 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7010 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7011 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7012 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7013 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7014
7015 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7016 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7017 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7018
7019 @menu
7020 * Frames:: Stack frames
7021 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7022 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7023 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7024 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7025
7026 @end menu
7027
7028 @node Frames
7029 @section Stack Frames
7030
7031 @cindex frame, definition
7032 @cindex stack frame
7033 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7034 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7035 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7036 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7037 which the function is executing.
7038
7039 @cindex initial frame
7040 @cindex outermost frame
7041 @cindex innermost frame
7042 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7043 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7044 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7045 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7046 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7047 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7048 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7049 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7050
7051 @cindex frame pointer
7052 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7053 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7054 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7055 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7056 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7057 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7058
7059 @cindex frame number
7060 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7061 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7062 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7063 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7064 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7065
7066 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7067 @c underflow problems.
7068 @cindex frameless execution
7069 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7070 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7071 @smallexample
7072 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7073 @end smallexample
7074 generates functions without a frame.)
7075 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7076 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7077 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7078 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7079 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7080 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7081 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7082
7083 @node Backtrace
7084 @section Backtraces
7085
7086 @cindex traceback
7087 @cindex call stack traces
7088 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7089 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7090 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7091 stack.
7092
7093 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7094 @table @code
7095 @kindex backtrace
7096 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7097 @item backtrace
7098 @itemx bt
7099 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7100 frames in the stack.
7101
7102 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7103 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7104
7105 @item backtrace @var{n}
7106 @itemx bt @var{n}
7107 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7108
7109 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7110 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7111 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7112
7113 @item backtrace full
7114 @itemx bt full
7115 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7116 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7117 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7118 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7119
7120 @item backtrace no-filters
7121 @itemx bt no-filters
7122 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7123 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7124 @itemx bt no-filters full
7125 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7126 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7127 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7128 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7129 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7130 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7131 support.
7132 @end table
7133
7134 @kindex where
7135 @kindex info stack
7136 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7137 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7138
7139 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7140 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7141 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7142 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7143 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7144 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7145 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7146 multi-threaded program.
7147
7148 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7149 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7150 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7151 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7152 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7153 line number.
7154
7155 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7156 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7157
7158 @smallexample
7159 @group
7160 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7161 at builtin.c:993
7162 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7163 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7164 at macro.c:71
7165 (More stack frames follow...)
7166 @end group
7167 @end smallexample
7168
7169 @noindent
7170 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7171 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7172 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7173
7174 @noindent
7175 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7176 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7177 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7178 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7179 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7180
7181 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7182 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7183 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7184 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7185 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7186 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7187 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7188 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7189 such a backtrace might look like:
7190
7191 @smallexample
7192 @group
7193 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7194 at builtin.c:993
7195 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7196 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7197 at macro.c:71
7198 (More stack frames follow...)
7199 @end group
7200 @end smallexample
7201
7202 @noindent
7203 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7204 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7205
7206 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7207 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7208 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7209
7210 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7211 @cindex program entry point
7212 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7213 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7214 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7215 @code{main}@footnote{
7216 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7217 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7218 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7219 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7220 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7221 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7222
7223 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7224 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7225
7226 @table @code
7227 @item set backtrace past-main
7228 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7229 @kindex set backtrace
7230 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7231
7232 @item set backtrace past-main off
7233 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7234 default.
7235
7236 @item show backtrace past-main
7237 @kindex show backtrace
7238 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7239
7240 @item set backtrace past-entry
7241 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7242 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7243 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7244 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7245
7246 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7247 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7248 application. This is the default.
7249
7250 @item show backtrace past-entry
7251 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7252
7253 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7254 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7255 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7256 @cindex backtrace limit
7257 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7258 or zero means unlimited levels.
7259
7260 @item show backtrace limit
7261 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7262 @end table
7263
7264 You can control how file names are displayed.
7265
7266 @table @code
7267 @item set filename-display
7268 @itemx set filename-display relative
7269 @cindex filename-display
7270 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7271
7272 @item set filename-display basename
7273 Display only basename of a filename.
7274
7275 @item set filename-display absolute
7276 Display an absolute filename.
7277
7278 @item show filename-display
7279 Show the current way to display filenames.
7280 @end table
7281
7282 @node Selection
7283 @section Selecting a Frame
7284
7285 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7286 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7287 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7288 of the stack frame just selected.
7289
7290 @table @code
7291 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7292 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7293 @item frame @var{n}
7294 @itemx f @var{n}
7295 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7296 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7297 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7298 @code{main}.
7299
7300 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7301 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7302 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7303 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7304 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7305 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7306 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7307 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7308
7309 @kindex up
7310 @item up @var{n}
7311 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7312 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7313 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7314
7315 @kindex down
7316 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7317 @item down @var{n}
7318 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7319 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7320 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7321 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7322 @end table
7323
7324 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7325 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7326 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7327 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7328
7329 @need 1000
7330 For example:
7331
7332 @smallexample
7333 @group
7334 (@value{GDBP}) up
7335 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7336 at env.c:10
7337 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7338 @end group
7339 @end smallexample
7340
7341 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7342 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7343 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7344 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7345 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7346 for details.
7347
7348 @table @code
7349 @kindex select-frame
7350 @item select-frame
7351 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7352 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7353 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7354 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7355
7356 @kindex down-silently
7357 @kindex up-silently
7358 @item up-silently @var{n}
7359 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7360 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7361 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7362 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7363 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7364 distracting.
7365 @end table
7366
7367 @node Frame Info
7368 @section Information About a Frame
7369
7370 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7371 stack frame.
7372
7373 @table @code
7374 @item frame
7375 @itemx f
7376 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7377 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7378 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7379 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7380 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7381
7382 @kindex info frame
7383 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7384 @item info frame
7385 @itemx info f
7386 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7387 including:
7388
7389 @itemize @bullet
7390 @item
7391 the address of the frame
7392 @item
7393 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7394 @item
7395 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7396 @item
7397 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7398 @item
7399 the address of the frame's arguments
7400 @item
7401 the address of the frame's local variables
7402 @item
7403 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7404 @item
7405 which registers were saved in the frame
7406 @end itemize
7407
7408 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7409 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7410 the usual conventions.
7411
7412 @item info frame @var{addr}
7413 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7414 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7415 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7416 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7417 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7418 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7419
7420 @kindex info args
7421 @item info args
7422 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7423
7424 @item info locals
7425 @kindex info locals
7426 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7427 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7428 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7429
7430 @end table
7431
7432 @node Frame Filter Management
7433 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7434 @cindex managing frame filters
7435
7436 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7437 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7438
7439 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7440 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7441
7442 @table @code
7443 @kindex info frame-filter
7444 @item info frame-filter
7445 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7446 their name, priority and enabled status.
7447
7448 @kindex disable frame-filter
7449 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7450 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7451 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7452 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7453 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7454 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7455 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7456 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7457 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7458 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7459 may be enabled again later.
7460
7461 @kindex enable frame-filter
7462 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7463 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7464 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7465 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7466 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7467 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7468 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7469 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7470 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7471
7472 Example:
7473
7474 @smallexample
7475 (gdb) info frame-filter
7476
7477 global frame-filters:
7478 Priority Enabled Name
7479 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7480 100 Yes Reverse
7481
7482 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7483 Priority Enabled Name
7484 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7485
7486 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7487 Priority Enabled Name
7488 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7489
7490 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7491 (gdb) info frame-filter
7492
7493 global frame-filters:
7494 Priority Enabled Name
7495 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7496 100 Yes Reverse
7497
7498 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7499 Priority Enabled Name
7500 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7501
7502 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7503 Priority Enabled Name
7504 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7505
7506 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7507 (gdb) info frame-filter
7508
7509 global frame-filters:
7510 Priority Enabled Name
7511 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7512 100 Yes Reverse
7513
7514 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7515 Priority Enabled Name
7516 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7517
7518 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7519 Priority Enabled Name
7520 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7521 @end smallexample
7522
7523 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7524 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7525 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7526 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7527 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7528 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7529 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7530
7531 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7532 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7533 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7534 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7535 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7536 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7537 dictionary resides.
7538
7539 Example:
7540
7541 @smallexample
7542 (gdb) info frame-filter
7543
7544 global frame-filters:
7545 Priority Enabled Name
7546 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7547 100 Yes Reverse
7548
7549 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7550 Priority Enabled Name
7551 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7552
7553 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7554 Priority Enabled Name
7555 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7556
7557 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7558 (gdb) info frame-filter
7559
7560 global frame-filters:
7561 Priority Enabled Name
7562 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7563 50 Yes Reverse
7564
7565 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7566 Priority Enabled Name
7567 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7568
7569 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7570 Priority Enabled Name
7571 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7572 @end smallexample
7573 @end table
7574
7575 @node Source
7576 @chapter Examining Source Files
7577
7578 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7579 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7580 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7581 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7582 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7583 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7584 source files by explicit command.
7585
7586 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7587 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7588 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7589
7590 @menu
7591 * List:: Printing source lines
7592 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7593 * Edit:: Editing source files
7594 * Search:: Searching source files
7595 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7596 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7597 @end menu
7598
7599 @node List
7600 @section Printing Source Lines
7601
7602 @kindex list
7603 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7604 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7605 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7606 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7607 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7608
7609 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7610
7611 @table @code
7612 @item list @var{linenum}
7613 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7614 current source file.
7615
7616 @item list @var{function}
7617 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7618 @var{function}.
7619
7620 @item list
7621 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7622 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7623 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7624 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7625 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7626
7627 @item list -
7628 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7629 @end table
7630
7631 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7632 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7633 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7634
7635 @table @code
7636 @kindex set listsize
7637 @item set listsize @var{count}
7638 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7639 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7640 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7641 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7642
7643 @kindex show listsize
7644 @item show listsize
7645 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7646 @end table
7647
7648 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7649 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7650 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7651 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7652 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7653
7654 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7655 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7656 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7657 to specify some source line.
7658
7659 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7660
7661 @table @code
7662 @item list @var{location}
7663 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7664
7665 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7666 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7667 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7668 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7669 the same source file as the first location.
7670
7671 @item list ,@var{last}
7672 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7673
7674 @item list @var{first},
7675 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7676
7677 @item list +
7678 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7679
7680 @item list -
7681 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7682
7683 @item list
7684 As described in the preceding table.
7685 @end table
7686
7687 @node Specify Location
7688 @section Specifying a Location
7689 @cindex specifying location
7690 @cindex location
7691 @cindex source location
7692
7693 @menu
7694 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7695 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7696 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7697 @end menu
7698
7699 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7700 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7701 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7702 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7703 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7704
7705 @node Linespec Locations
7706 @subsection Linespec Locations
7707 @cindex linespec locations
7708
7709 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7710 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7711 specifying a linespec:
7712
7713 @table @code
7714 @item @var{linenum}
7715 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7716
7717 @item -@var{offset}
7718 @itemx +@var{offset}
7719 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7720 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7721 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7722 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7723 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7724 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7725 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7726 linespec.
7727
7728 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7729 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7730 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7731 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7732 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7733 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7734 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7735
7736 @item @var{function}
7737 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7738 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7739
7740 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7741 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7742
7743 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7744 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7745 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7746 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7747 functions in different source files.
7748
7749 @item @var{label}
7750 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7751 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7752 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7753 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7754
7755 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7756 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7757 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7758 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7759 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7760 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7761
7762 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7763 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7764 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7765 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7766 each one of those probes.
7767 @end table
7768
7769 @node Explicit Locations
7770 @subsection Explicit Locations
7771 @cindex explicit locations
7772
7773 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7774 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7775
7776 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7777 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7778 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7779 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7780 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7781
7782 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7783 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7784 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7785 the symbol table to know.
7786
7787 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7788 following table:
7789
7790 @table @code
7791 @item -source @var{filename}
7792 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7793 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7794 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7795 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7796 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7797
7798 @item -function @var{function}
7799 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7800 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7801 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7802 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7803
7804 @item -label @var{label}
7805 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7806 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7807 selected stack frame.
7808
7809 @item -line @var{number}
7810 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7811 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7812 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7813 relative to the current line.
7814 @end table
7815
7816 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7817 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7818
7819 @node Address Locations
7820 @subsection Address Locations
7821 @cindex address locations
7822
7823 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7824 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7825
7826 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7827 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7828 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7829 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7830 source files.
7831
7832 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7833 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7834 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7835 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7836 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7837 of @var{address}:
7838
7839 @table @code
7840 @item @var{expression}
7841 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7842
7843 @item @var{funcaddr}
7844 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7845 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7846 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7847 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7848 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7849 (although the Pascal form also works).
7850
7851 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7852 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7853
7854 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7855 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7856 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7857 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7858 functions with identical names in different source files.
7859 @end table
7860
7861 @node Edit
7862 @section Editing Source Files
7863 @cindex editing source files
7864
7865 @kindex edit
7866 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7867 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7868 The editing program of your choice
7869 is invoked with the current line set to
7870 the active line in the program.
7871 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7872 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7873
7874 @table @code
7875 @item edit @var{location}
7876 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7877 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7878 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7879 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7880 command most commonly used:
7881
7882 @table @code
7883 @item edit @var{number}
7884 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7885
7886 @item edit @var{function}
7887 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7888 @end table
7889
7890 @end table
7891
7892 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7893 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7894 @footnote{
7895 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7896 following command-line syntax:
7897 @smallexample
7898 ex +@var{number} file
7899 @end smallexample
7900 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7901 the file where to start editing.}.
7902 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7903 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7904 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7905 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7906 @smallexample
7907 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7908 export EDITOR
7909 gdb @dots{}
7910 @end smallexample
7911 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7912 @smallexample
7913 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7914 gdb @dots{}
7915 @end smallexample
7916
7917 @node Search
7918 @section Searching Source Files
7919 @cindex searching source files
7920
7921 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7922 regular expression.
7923
7924 @table @code
7925 @kindex search
7926 @kindex forward-search
7927 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7928 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7929 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7930 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7931 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7932 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7933 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7934 @code{fo}.
7935
7936 @kindex reverse-search
7937 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7938 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7939 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7940 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7941 this command as @code{rev}.
7942 @end table
7943
7944 @node Source Path
7945 @section Specifying Source Directories
7946
7947 @cindex source path
7948 @cindex directories for source files
7949 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7950 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7951 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7952 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7953 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7954 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7955 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7956
7957 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7958 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7959 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7960 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7961 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7962 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7963 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7964 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7965 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7966 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7967 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7968
7969 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7970 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7971 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7972 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7973 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7974 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7975
7976 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7977 source files.
7978
7979 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7980 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7981 each line is in the file.
7982
7983 @kindex directory
7984 @kindex dir
7985 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7986 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7987 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7988
7989 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7990 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7991
7992 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7993 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7994 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7995 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7996 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7997 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7998 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7999 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8000 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8001 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8002 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8003 name to look up the sources.
8004
8005 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8006 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8007 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8008 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8009 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8010 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8011 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8012 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8013
8014 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8015 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8016 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8017 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8018 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8019 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8020 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8021
8022 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8023 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8024 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8025 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8026 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8027 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8028 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8029 command.
8030
8031 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8032 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8033 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8034 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8035 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8036 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8037 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8038
8039 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8040 @cindex default source path substitution
8041 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8042 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8043 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8044 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8045 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8046 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8047 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8048 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8049 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8050 together.
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8054 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8055 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8056 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8057 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8058 part of absolute file names) or
8059 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8060 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8061
8062 @kindex cdir
8063 @kindex cwd
8064 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8065 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8066 @cindex compilation directory
8067 @cindex current directory
8068 @cindex working directory
8069 @cindex directory, current
8070 @cindex directory, compilation
8071 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8072 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8073 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8074 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8075 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8076 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8077
8078 @item directory
8079 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8080
8081 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8082 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8083
8084 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8085 @kindex set directories
8086 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8087 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8088
8089 @item show directories
8090 @kindex show directories
8091 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8092
8093 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8094 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8095 @kindex set substitute-path
8096 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8097 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8098 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8099
8100 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8101 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8102
8103 @smallexample
8104 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8105 @end smallexample
8106
8107 @noindent
8108 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8109 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8110 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8111
8112 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8113 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8114 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8115 the substitution.
8116
8117 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8118
8119 @smallexample
8120 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8121 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8122 @end smallexample
8123
8124 @noindent
8125 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8126 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8127 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8128 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8129
8130
8131 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8132 @kindex unset substitute-path
8133 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8134 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8135 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8136
8137 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8138
8139 @item show substitute-path [path]
8140 @kindex show substitute-path
8141 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8142 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8143
8144 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8145 rules.
8146
8147 @end table
8148
8149 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8150 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8151 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8152
8153 @enumerate
8154 @item
8155 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8156
8157 @item
8158 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8159 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8160 directories in one command.
8161 @end enumerate
8162
8163 @node Machine Code
8164 @section Source and Machine Code
8165 @cindex source line and its code address
8166
8167 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8168 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8169 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8170 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8171 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8172 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8173 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8174 well as hex.
8175
8176 @table @code
8177 @kindex info line
8178 @item info line @var{location}
8179 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8180 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8181 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8182 @end table
8183
8184 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8185 the object code for the first line of function
8186 @code{m4_changequote}:
8187
8188 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8189 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8190 @smallexample
8191 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8192 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8193 @end smallexample
8194
8195 @noindent
8196 @cindex code address and its source line
8197 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8198 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8199 @smallexample
8200 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8201 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8202 @end smallexample
8203
8204 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8205 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8206 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8207 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8208 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8209 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8210 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8211 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8212 Variables}).
8213
8214 @table @code
8215 @kindex disassemble
8216 @cindex assembly instructions
8217 @cindex instructions, assembly
8218 @cindex machine instructions
8219 @cindex listing machine instructions
8220 @item disassemble
8221 @itemx disassemble /m
8222 @itemx disassemble /s
8223 @itemx disassemble /r
8224 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8225 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8226 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8227 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8228 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8229 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8230 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8231 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8232 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8233 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8234
8235 @table @code
8236 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8237 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8238 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8239 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8240 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8241 @end table
8242
8243 @noindent
8244 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8245 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8246
8247 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8248 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8249
8250 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8251 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8252 @end table
8253
8254 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8255 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8256
8257 @smallexample
8258 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8259 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8260 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8261 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8262 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8263 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8264 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8265 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8266 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8267 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8268 End of assembler dump.
8269 @end smallexample
8270
8271 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8272 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8273 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8274
8275 @smallexample
8276 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8277 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8278 5 @{
8279 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8280 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8281 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8282 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8283 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8284
8285 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8286 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8287 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8288
8289 7 return 0;
8290 8 @}
8291 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8292 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8293 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8294
8295 End of assembler dump.
8296 @end smallexample
8297
8298 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8299 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8300 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8301 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8302 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8303 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8304 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8305 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8306 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8307
8308 @file{foo.h}:
8309
8310 @smallexample
8311 int
8312 foo (int a)
8313 @{
8314 if (a < 0)
8315 return a * 2;
8316 if (a == 0)
8317 return 1;
8318 return a + 10;
8319 @}
8320 @end smallexample
8321
8322 @file{foo.c}:
8323
8324 @smallexample
8325 #include "foo.h"
8326 volatile int x, y;
8327 int
8328 main ()
8329 @{
8330 x = foo (y);
8331 return 0;
8332 @}
8333 @end smallexample
8334
8335 @smallexample
8336 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8337 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8338 5 @{
8339
8340 6 x = foo (y);
8341 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8342 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8343
8344 7 return 0;
8345 8 @}
8346 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8347 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8348 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8349 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8350
8351 End of assembler dump.
8352 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8353 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8354 foo.c:
8355 5 @{
8356 6 x = foo (y);
8357 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8358
8359 foo.h:
8360 4 if (a < 0)
8361 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8362 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8363
8364 6 if (a == 0)
8365 7 return 1;
8366 8 return a + 10;
8367 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8368 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8369 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8370 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8371
8372 foo.c:
8373 6 x = foo (y);
8374 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8375
8376 7 return 0;
8377 8 @}
8378 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8379 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8380
8381 foo.h:
8382 5 return a * 2;
8383 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8384 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8385 End of assembler dump.
8386 @end smallexample
8387
8388 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8389
8390 @smallexample
8391 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8392 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8393 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8394 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8395 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8396 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8397 End of assembler dump.
8398 @end smallexample
8399
8400 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8401 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8402 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8403 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8404
8405 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8406 mnemonics or other syntax.
8407
8408 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8409 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8410 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8411 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8412 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8413
8414 @table @code
8415 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8416 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8417 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8418 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8419 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8420 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8421
8422 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8423 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8424 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8425 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8426
8427 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8428 @item show disassembly-flavor
8429 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8430 @end table
8431
8432 @table @code
8433 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8434 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8435 @item set disassemble-next-line
8436 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8437 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8438 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8439 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8440 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8441 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8442 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8443 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8444 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8445 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8446 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8447 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8448 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8449 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8450 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8451 instruction.
8452 @end table
8453
8454
8455 @node Data
8456 @chapter Examining Data
8457
8458 @cindex printing data
8459 @cindex examining data
8460 @kindex print
8461 @kindex inspect
8462 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8463 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8464 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8465 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8466 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8467 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8468
8469 @table @code
8470 @item print @var{expr}
8471 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8472 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8473 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8474 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8475 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8476 Formats}.
8477
8478 @item print
8479 @itemx print /@var{f}
8480 @cindex reprint the last value
8481 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8482 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8483 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8484 @end table
8485
8486 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8487 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8488 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8489
8490 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8491 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8492 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8493 Table}.
8494
8495 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8496 @kindex explore
8497 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8498 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8499 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8500 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8501 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8502 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8503 embedded in the higher level data types.
8504
8505 @table @code
8506 @item explore @var{arg}
8507 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8508 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8509 @end table
8510
8511 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8512 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8513 C program as
8514
8515 @smallexample
8516 struct SimpleStruct
8517 @{
8518 int i;
8519 double d;
8520 @};
8521
8522 struct ComplexStruct
8523 @{
8524 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8525 int arr[10];
8526 @};
8527 @end smallexample
8528
8529 @noindent
8530 followed by variable declarations as
8531
8532 @smallexample
8533 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8534 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8535 @end smallexample
8536
8537 @noindent
8538 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8539 @code{explore} command as follows.
8540
8541 @smallexample
8542 (gdb) explore cs
8543 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8544 the following fields:
8545
8546 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8547 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8548
8549 Enter the field number of choice:
8550 @end smallexample
8551
8552 @noindent
8553 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8554 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8555 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8556 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8557 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8558 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8559 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8560 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8561
8562 @smallexample
8563 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8564 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8565 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8566 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8567
8568 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8569 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8570
8571 Press enter to return to parent value:
8572 @end smallexample
8573
8574 @noindent
8575 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8576 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8577 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8578 to explore.
8579
8580 @smallexample
8581 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8582 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8583
8584 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8585
8586 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8587
8588 Press enter to return to parent value:
8589 @end smallexample
8590
8591 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8592 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8593 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8594 level data structure).
8595
8596 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8597 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8598 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8599 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8600 same example as above, your can explore the type
8601 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8602 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8603
8604 @smallexample
8605 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8606 @end smallexample
8607
8608 @noindent
8609 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8610 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8611 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8612 example.
8613
8614 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8615 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8616 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8617 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8618 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8619
8620 @table @code
8621 @item explore value @var{expr}
8622 @cindex explore value
8623 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8624 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8625 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8626 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8627 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8628
8629 @item explore type @var{arg}
8630 @cindex explore type
8631 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8632 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8633 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8634 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8635 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8636 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8637 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8638 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8639 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8640 @end table
8641
8642 @menu
8643 * Expressions:: Expressions
8644 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8645 * Variables:: Program variables
8646 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8647 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8648 * Memory:: Examining memory
8649 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8650 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8651 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8652 * Value History:: Value history
8653 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8654 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8655 * Registers:: Registers
8656 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8657 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8658 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8659 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8660 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8661 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8662 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8663 character set than GDB does
8664 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8665 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8666 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8667 @end menu
8668
8669 @node Expressions
8670 @section Expressions
8671
8672 @cindex expressions
8673 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8674 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8675 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8676 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8677 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8678 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8679 @ref{Compilation}.
8680
8681 @cindex arrays in expressions
8682 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8683 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8684 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8685 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8686 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8687 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8688
8689 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8690 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8691 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8692 languages.
8693
8694 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8695 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8696
8697 @cindex casts, in expressions
8698 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8699 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8700 at that address in memory.
8701 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8702
8703 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8704 to programming languages:
8705
8706 @table @code
8707 @item @@
8708 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8709 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8710
8711 @item ::
8712 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8713 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8714
8715 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8716 @cindex type casting memory
8717 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8718 @cindex casts, to view memory
8719 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8720 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8721 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8722 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8723 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8724 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8725 @end table
8726
8727 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8728 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8729 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8730
8731 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8732 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8733 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8734 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8735 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8736 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8737 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8738
8739 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8740 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8741 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8742 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8743 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8744 as well.
8745
8746 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8747 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8748 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8749 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8750 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8751 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8752 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8753 choices.
8754
8755 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8756 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8757 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8758
8759 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8760 @smallexample
8761 @group
8762 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8763 [0] cancel
8764 [1] all
8765 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8766 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8767 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8768 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8769 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8770 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8771 > 2 4 6
8772 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8773 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8774 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8775 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8776 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8777 breakpoints.
8778 (@value{GDBP})
8779 @end group
8780 @end smallexample
8781
8782 @table @code
8783 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8784 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8785 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8786
8787 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8788 is ambiguous.
8789
8790 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8791 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8792 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8793 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8794 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8795 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8796 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8797 in the use of the menu.
8798
8799 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8800 when an ambiguity is detected.
8801
8802 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8803 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8804
8805 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8806 @item show multiple-symbols
8807 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8808 @end table
8809
8810 @node Variables
8811 @section Program Variables
8812
8813 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8814 in your program.
8815
8816 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8817 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8818
8819 @itemize @bullet
8820 @item
8821 global (or file-static)
8822 @end itemize
8823
8824 @noindent or
8825
8826 @itemize @bullet
8827 @item
8828 visible according to the scope rules of the
8829 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8830 @end itemize
8831
8832 @noindent This means that in the function
8833
8834 @smallexample
8835 foo (a)
8836 int a;
8837 @{
8838 bar (a);
8839 @{
8840 int b = test ();
8841 bar (b);
8842 @}
8843 @}
8844 @end smallexample
8845
8846 @noindent
8847 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8848 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8849 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8850 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8851
8852 @cindex variable name conflict
8853 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8854 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8855 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8856 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8857 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8858 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8859 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8860
8861 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8862 @ifnotinfo
8863 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8864 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8865 @end ifnotinfo
8866 @smallexample
8867 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8868 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8869 @end smallexample
8870
8871 @noindent
8872 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8873 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8874 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8875 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8876
8877 @smallexample
8878 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8879 @end smallexample
8880
8881 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8882 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8883 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8884 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8885 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8886
8887 @smallexample
8888 void
8889 foo (int a)
8890 @{
8891 if (a < 10)
8892 bar (a);
8893 else
8894 process (a); /* Stop here */
8895 @}
8896
8897 int
8898 bar (int a)
8899 @{
8900 foo (a + 5);
8901 @}
8902 @end smallexample
8903
8904 @noindent
8905 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8906 here is what you might see
8907 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8908
8909 @smallexample
8910 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8911 $1 = 10
8912 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8913 $2 = 5
8914 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8915 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8916 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8917 $3 = 5
8918 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8919 $4 = 0
8920 @end smallexample
8921
8922 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8923 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8924 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8925 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8926 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8927
8928 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8929 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8930 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8931 @code{some_global}.
8932
8933 @smallexample
8934 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8935 $1 = 23
8936 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8937 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8938 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8939 $2 = 27
8940 @end smallexample
8941
8942 @cindex wrong values
8943 @cindex variable values, wrong
8944 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8945 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8946 @quotation
8947 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8948 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8949 scope, and just before exit.
8950 @end quotation
8951 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8952 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8953 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8954 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8955 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8956 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8957 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8958 variable definitions may be gone.
8959
8960 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8961 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8962 when compiling.
8963
8964 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8965 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8966 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8967 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8968 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8969 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8970 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8971
8972 @smallexample
8973 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8974 @end smallexample
8975
8976 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8977 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8978 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8979 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8980 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8981
8982 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8983 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8984 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8985 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8986
8987 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8988 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8989 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8990 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8991 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8992
8993 @smallexample
8994 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8995 29 i++;
8996 (gdb) next
8997 30 e (i);
8998 (gdb) print i
8999 $1 = 31
9000 (gdb) print i@@entry
9001 $2 = 30
9002 @end smallexample
9003
9004 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9005 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9006 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9007 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9008 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9009 For program code
9010
9011 @smallexample
9012 char var0[] = "A";
9013 signed char var1[] = "A";
9014 @end smallexample
9015
9016 You get during debugging
9017 @smallexample
9018 (gdb) print var0
9019 $1 = "A"
9020 (gdb) print var1
9021 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9022 @end smallexample
9023
9024 @node Arrays
9025 @section Artificial Arrays
9026
9027 @cindex artificial array
9028 @cindex arrays
9029 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9030 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9031 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9032 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9033 program.
9034
9035 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9036 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9037 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9038 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9039 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9040 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9041 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9042 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9043 example. If a program says
9044
9045 @smallexample
9046 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9047 @end smallexample
9048
9049 @noindent
9050 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9051
9052 @smallexample
9053 p *array@@len
9054 @end smallexample
9055
9056 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9057 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9058 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9059 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9060 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9061
9062 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9063 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9064 The value need not be in memory:
9065 @smallexample
9066 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9067 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9068 @end smallexample
9069
9070 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9071 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9072 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9073 @smallexample
9074 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9075 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9076 @end smallexample
9077
9078 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9079 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9080 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9081 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9082 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9083 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9084 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9085 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9086 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9087 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 set $i = 0
9091 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9092 @key{RET}
9093 @key{RET}
9094 @dots{}
9095 @end smallexample
9096
9097 @node Output Formats
9098 @section Output Formats
9099
9100 @cindex formatted output
9101 @cindex output formats
9102 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9103 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9104 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9105 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9106 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9107
9108 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9109 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9110 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9111 letters supported are:
9112
9113 @table @code
9114 @item x
9115 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9116 hexadecimal.
9117
9118 @item d
9119 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9120
9121 @item u
9122 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9123
9124 @item o
9125 Print as integer in octal.
9126
9127 @item t
9128 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9129 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9130 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9131 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9132
9133 @item a
9134 @cindex unknown address, locating
9135 @cindex locate address
9136 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9137 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9138 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9139
9140 @smallexample
9141 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9142 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9143 @end smallexample
9144
9145 @noindent
9146 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9147 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9148
9149 @item c
9150 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9151 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9152 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9153 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9154
9155 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9156 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9157 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9158 data.
9159
9160 @item f
9161 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9162 using typical floating point syntax.
9163
9164 @item s
9165 @cindex printing strings
9166 @cindex printing byte arrays
9167 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9168 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9169 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9170 natural types.
9171
9172 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9173 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9174 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9175 array.
9176
9177 @item z
9178 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9179 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9180 to the size of the integer type.
9181
9182 @item r
9183 @cindex raw printing
9184 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9185 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9186 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9187 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9188 pretty-printer which might exist.
9189 @end table
9190
9191 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9192
9193 @smallexample
9194 p/x $pc
9195 @end smallexample
9196
9197 @noindent
9198 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9199 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9200
9201 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9202 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9203 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9204
9205 @node Memory
9206 @section Examining Memory
9207
9208 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9209 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9210
9211 @cindex examining memory
9212 @table @code
9213 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9214 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9215 @itemx x @var{addr}
9216 @itemx x
9217 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9218 @end table
9219
9220 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9221 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9222 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9223 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9224 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9225
9226 @table @r
9227 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9228 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9229 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
9230 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9231 @c 4.1.2.
9232
9233 @item @var{f}, the display format
9234 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9235 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9236 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9237 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9238 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9239
9240 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9241 The unit size is any of
9242
9243 @table @code
9244 @item b
9245 Bytes.
9246 @item h
9247 Halfwords (two bytes).
9248 @item w
9249 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9250 @item g
9251 Giant words (eight bytes).
9252 @end table
9253
9254 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9255 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9256 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9257 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9258 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9259 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9260 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9261 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9262 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9263 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9264 be altered.
9265
9266 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9267 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9268 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9269 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9270 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9271 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9272 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9273 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9274 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9275 a value from memory).
9276 @end table
9277
9278 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9279 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9280 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9281 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9282 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9283
9284 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9285 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9286 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9287 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9288 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9289
9290 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9291 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9292 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9293 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9294 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9295 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9296 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9297 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9298 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9299
9300 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9301 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9302 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9303 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9304 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9305 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9306 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9307
9308 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9309 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9310
9311 @smallexample
9312 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9313 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9314 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9315 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9316 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9317 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9318 @end smallexample
9319
9320 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9321 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9322 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9323 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9324 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9325 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9326 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9327 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9328 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9329
9330 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9331 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9332 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9333
9334 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9335 @cindex addressable memory unit
9336 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9337 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9338 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9339 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9340 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9341 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9342 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9343 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9344 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9345
9346 @cindex remote memory comparison
9347 @cindex target memory comparison
9348 @cindex verify remote memory image
9349 @cindex verify target memory image
9350 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9351 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9352 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9353 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9354 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9355 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9356
9357 @table @code
9358 @kindex compare-sections
9359 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9360 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9361 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9362 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9363 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9364 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9365
9366 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9367 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9368 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9369 @end table
9370
9371 @node Auto Display
9372 @section Automatic Display
9373 @cindex automatic display
9374 @cindex display of expressions
9375
9376 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9377 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9378 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9379 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9380 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9381 The automatic display looks like this:
9382
9383 @smallexample
9384 2: foo = 38
9385 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9386 @end smallexample
9387
9388 @noindent
9389 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9390 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9391 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9392 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9393 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9394 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9395
9396 @table @code
9397 @kindex display
9398 @item display @var{expr}
9399 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9400 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9401
9402 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9403
9404 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9405 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9406 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9407 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9408 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9409
9410 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9411 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9412 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9413 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9414 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9415 @end table
9416
9417 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9418 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9419 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9420
9421 @table @code
9422 @kindex delete display
9423 @kindex undisplay
9424 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9425 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9426 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9427 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9428 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9429 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9430 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9431
9432 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9433 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9434
9435 @kindex disable display
9436 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9437 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9438 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9439 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9440 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9441 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9442 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9443 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9444
9445 @kindex enable display
9446 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9447 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9448 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9449 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9450 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9451 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9452 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9453
9454 @item display
9455 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9456 done when your program stops.
9457
9458 @kindex info display
9459 @item info display
9460 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9461 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9462 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9463 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9464 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9465 @end table
9466
9467 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9468 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9469 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9470 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9471 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9472 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9473 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9474 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9475 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9476 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9477 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9478
9479 @node Print Settings
9480 @section Print Settings
9481
9482 @cindex format options
9483 @cindex print settings
9484 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9485 and symbols are printed.
9486
9487 @noindent
9488 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9489
9490 @table @code
9491 @kindex set print
9492 @item set print address
9493 @itemx set print address on
9494 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9495 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9496 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9497 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9498 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9499 @code{set print address on}:
9500
9501 @smallexample
9502 @group
9503 (@value{GDBP}) f
9504 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9505 at input.c:530
9506 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9507 @end group
9508 @end smallexample
9509
9510 @item set print address off
9511 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9512 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9513
9514 @smallexample
9515 @group
9516 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9517 (@value{GDBP}) f
9518 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9519 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9520 @end group
9521 @end smallexample
9522
9523 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9524 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9525 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9526 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9527
9528 @kindex show print
9529 @item show print address
9530 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9531 @end table
9532
9533 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9534 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9535 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9536 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9537 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9538 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9539 it prints a symbolic address:
9540
9541 @table @code
9542 @item set print symbol-filename on
9543 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9544 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9545 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9546 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9547
9548 @item set print symbol-filename off
9549 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9550 default.
9551
9552 @item show print symbol-filename
9553 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9554 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9555 @end table
9556
9557 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9558 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9559 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9560
9561 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9562 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9563
9564 @table @code
9565 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9566 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9567 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9568 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9569 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9570 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9571 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9572 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9573
9574 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9575 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9576 symbolic address.
9577 @end table
9578
9579 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9580 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9581 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9582 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9583 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9584 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9585 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9586 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9587
9588 @smallexample
9589 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9590 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9591 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9592 @end smallexample
9593
9594 @quotation
9595 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9596 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9597 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9598 @end quotation
9599
9600 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9601 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9602
9603 @table @code
9604 @item set print symbol on
9605 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9606 one exists.
9607
9608 @item set print symbol off
9609 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9610 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9611 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9612
9613 @item show print symbol
9614 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9615 address.
9616 @end table
9617
9618 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9619
9620 @table @code
9621 @item set print array
9622 @itemx set print array on
9623 @cindex pretty print arrays
9624 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9625 but uses more space. The default is off.
9626
9627 @item set print array off
9628 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9629
9630 @item show print array
9631 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9632 arrays.
9633
9634 @cindex print array indexes
9635 @item set print array-indexes
9636 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9637 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9638 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9639 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9640
9641 @item set print array-indexes off
9642 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9643
9644 @item show print array-indexes
9645 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9646 arrays.
9647
9648 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9649 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9650 @cindex number of array elements to print
9651 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9652 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9653 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9654 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9655 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9656 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9657 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9658 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9659
9660 @item show print elements
9661 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9662 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9663
9664 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9665 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9666 @cindex printing frame argument values
9667 @cindex print all frame argument values
9668 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9669 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9670 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9671 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9672 values are:
9673
9674 @table @code
9675 @item all
9676 The values of all arguments are printed.
9677
9678 @item scalars
9679 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9680 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9681 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9682 only scalar arguments are shown:
9683
9684 @smallexample
9685 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9686 at frame-args.c:23
9687 @end smallexample
9688
9689 @item none
9690 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9691 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9692
9693 @smallexample
9694 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9695 at frame-args.c:23
9696 @end smallexample
9697 @end table
9698
9699 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9700 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9701 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9702 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9703 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9704 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9705 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9706 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9707 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9708 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9709
9710 @item show print frame-arguments
9711 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9712
9713 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9714 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9715
9716 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9717 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9718 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9719 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9720 This is the default.
9721
9722 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9723 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9724
9725 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9726 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9727 @kindex set print entry-values
9728 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9729 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9730 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9731 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9732 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9733
9734 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9735 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9736 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9737 @code{no} setting.
9738
9739 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9740 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9741 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9742 this information.
9743
9744 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9745
9746 @table @code
9747 @item no
9748 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9749 point.
9750 @smallexample
9751 #0 equal (val=5)
9752 #0 different (val=6)
9753 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9754 #0 born (val=10)
9755 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9756 @end smallexample
9757
9758 @item only
9759 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9760 values are never printed.
9761 @smallexample
9762 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9763 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9764 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9765 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9766 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9767 @end smallexample
9768
9769 @item preferred
9770 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9771 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9772 value for such parameter.
9773 @smallexample
9774 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9775 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9776 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9777 #0 born (val=10)
9778 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9779 @end smallexample
9780
9781 @item if-needed
9782 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9783 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9784 parameter.
9785 @smallexample
9786 #0 equal (val=5)
9787 #0 different (val=6)
9788 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9789 #0 born (val=10)
9790 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9791 @end smallexample
9792
9793 @item both
9794 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9795 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9796 optimizations.
9797 @smallexample
9798 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9799 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9800 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9801 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9802 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9803 @end smallexample
9804
9805 @item compact
9806 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9807 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9808 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9809 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9810 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9811 @smallexample
9812 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9813 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9814 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9815 #0 born (val=10)
9816 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9817 @end smallexample
9818
9819 @item default
9820 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9821 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9822 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9823 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9824 @smallexample
9825 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9826 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9827 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9828 #0 born (val=10)
9829 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9830 @end smallexample
9831 @end table
9832
9833 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9834 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9835
9836 @item show print entry-values
9837 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9838 entry.
9839
9840 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9841 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9842 @cindex repeated array elements
9843 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9844 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9845 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9846 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9847 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9848 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9849 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9850 is 10.
9851
9852 @item show print repeats
9853 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9854 elements.
9855
9856 @item set print null-stop
9857 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9858 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9859 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9860 contain only short strings.
9861 The default is off.
9862
9863 @item show print null-stop
9864 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9865 @sc{null} character.
9866
9867 @item set print pretty on
9868 @cindex print structures in indented form
9869 @cindex indentation in structure display
9870 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9871 per line, like this:
9872
9873 @smallexample
9874 @group
9875 $1 = @{
9876 next = 0x0,
9877 flags = @{
9878 sweet = 1,
9879 sour = 1
9880 @},
9881 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9882 @}
9883 @end group
9884 @end smallexample
9885
9886 @item set print pretty off
9887 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9888
9889 @smallexample
9890 @group
9891 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9892 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9893 @end group
9894 @end smallexample
9895
9896 @noindent
9897 This is the default format.
9898
9899 @item show print pretty
9900 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9901
9902 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9903 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9904 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9905 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9906 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9907 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9908 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9909 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9910
9911 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9912 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9913 international character sets, and is the default.
9914
9915 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9916 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9917
9918 @item set print union on
9919 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9920 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9921 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9922
9923 @item set print union off
9924 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9925 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9926 instead.
9927
9928 @item show print union
9929 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9930 structures and other unions.
9931
9932 For example, given the declarations
9933
9934 @smallexample
9935 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9936 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9937 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9938 Bug_forms;
9939
9940 struct thing @{
9941 Species it;
9942 union @{
9943 Tree_forms tree;
9944 Bug_forms bug;
9945 @} form;
9946 @};
9947
9948 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9949 @end smallexample
9950
9951 @noindent
9952 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9953
9954 @smallexample
9955 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9956 @end smallexample
9957
9958 @noindent
9959 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9960
9961 @smallexample
9962 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @noindent
9966 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9967 and in Pascal.
9968 @end table
9969
9970 @need 1000
9971 @noindent
9972 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9973
9974 @table @code
9975 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9976 @item set print demangle
9977 @itemx set print demangle on
9978 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9979 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9980 linkage. The default is on.
9981
9982 @item show print demangle
9983 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9984
9985 @item set print asm-demangle
9986 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9987 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9988 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9989 The default is off.
9990
9991 @item show print asm-demangle
9992 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9993 or demangled form.
9994
9995 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9996 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9997 @kindex set demangle-style
9998 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9999 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10000 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10001
10002 @table @code
10003 @item auto
10004 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10005 This is the default.
10006
10007 @item gnu
10008 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10009
10010 @item hp
10011 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10012
10013 @item lucid
10014 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10015
10016 @item arm
10017 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10018 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10019 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10020 require further enhancement to permit that.
10021
10022 @end table
10023 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10024
10025 @item show demangle-style
10026 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10027
10028 @item set print object
10029 @itemx set print object on
10030 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10031 @cindex display derived types
10032 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10033 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10034 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10035 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10036 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10037 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10038 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10039
10040 @item set print object off
10041 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10042 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10043
10044 @item show print object
10045 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10046
10047 @item set print static-members
10048 @itemx set print static-members on
10049 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10050 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10051
10052 @item set print static-members off
10053 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10054
10055 @item show print static-members
10056 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10057
10058 @item set print pascal_static-members
10059 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10060 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10061 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10062 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10063
10064 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10065 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10066
10067 @item show print pascal_static-members
10068 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10069
10070 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10071 @item set print vtbl
10072 @itemx set print vtbl on
10073 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10074 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10075 @cindex VTBL display
10076 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10077 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10078 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10079
10080 @item set print vtbl off
10081 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10082
10083 @item show print vtbl
10084 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10085 @end table
10086
10087 @node Pretty Printing
10088 @section Pretty Printing
10089
10090 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10091 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10092 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10093
10094 @menu
10095 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10096 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10097 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10098 @end menu
10099
10100 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10101 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10102
10103 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10104 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10105 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10106
10107 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10108 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10109 pretty-printers with their names.
10110 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10111 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10112 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10113 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10114
10115 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10116 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10117 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10118 do anything special.
10119
10120 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10121
10122 @itemize @bullet
10123 @item
10124 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10125 all inferiors.
10126
10127 @item
10128 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10129 when debugging that program.
10130 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10131
10132 @item
10133 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10134 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10135 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10136 @end itemize
10137
10138 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10139 pretty-printers are selected,
10140
10141 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10142 for new types.
10143
10144 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10145 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10146
10147 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10148
10149 @smallexample
10150 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10151 $1 = @{
10152 static npos = 4294967295,
10153 _M_dataplus = @{
10154 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10155 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10156 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10157 @},
10158 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10159 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10160 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10161 @}
10162 @}
10163 @end smallexample
10164
10165 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10166
10167 @smallexample
10168 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10169 $2 = "abcd"
10170 @end smallexample
10171
10172 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10173 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10174 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10175
10176 @table @code
10177 @kindex info pretty-printer
10178 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10179 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10180 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10181
10182 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10183 whose pretty-printers to list.
10184 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10185 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10186 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10187 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10188 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10189
10190 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10191 to list.
10192
10193 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10194 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10195 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10196 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10197
10198 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10199 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10200 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10201 @end table
10202
10203 Example:
10204
10205 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10206 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10207 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10208 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10209
10210 @smallexample
10211 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10212 library1.so:
10213 foo
10214 library2.so:
10215 bar
10216 bar1
10217 bar2
10218 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10219 library2.so:
10220 bar
10221 bar1
10222 bar2
10223 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10224 1 printer disabled
10225 2 of 3 printers enabled
10226 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10227 library1.so:
10228 foo [disabled]
10229 library2.so:
10230 bar
10231 bar1
10232 bar2
10233 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10234 1 printer disabled
10235 1 of 3 printers enabled
10236 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10237 library1.so:
10238 foo [disabled]
10239 library2.so:
10240 bar
10241 bar1 [disabled]
10242 bar2
10243 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10244 1 printer disabled
10245 0 of 3 printers enabled
10246 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10247 library1.so:
10248 foo [disabled]
10249 library2.so:
10250 bar [disabled]
10251 bar1 [disabled]
10252 bar2
10253 @end smallexample
10254
10255 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10256 as can each individual subprinter.
10257
10258 @node Value History
10259 @section Value History
10260
10261 @cindex value history
10262 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10263 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10264 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10265 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10266 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10267 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10268 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10269 symbol table.
10270
10271 @cindex @code{$}
10272 @cindex @code{$$}
10273 @cindex history number
10274 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10275 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10276 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10277 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10278 history number.
10279
10280 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10281 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10282 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10283 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10284 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10285 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10286 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10287
10288 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10289 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10290
10291 @smallexample
10292 p *$
10293 @end smallexample
10294
10295 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10296 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10297
10298 @smallexample
10299 p *$.next
10300 @end smallexample
10301
10302 @noindent
10303 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10304 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10305
10306 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10307 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10308
10309 @smallexample
10310 print x
10311 set x=5
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 @noindent
10315 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10316 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10317
10318 @table @code
10319 @kindex show values
10320 @item show values
10321 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10322 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10323 values} does not change the history.
10324
10325 @item show values @var{n}
10326 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10327
10328 @item show values +
10329 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10330 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10331 @end table
10332
10333 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10334 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10335
10336 @node Convenience Vars
10337 @section Convenience Variables
10338
10339 @cindex convenience variables
10340 @cindex user-defined variables
10341 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10342 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10343 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10344 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10345 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10346
10347 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10348 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10349 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10350 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10351 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10352
10353 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10354 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10355 For example:
10356
10357 @smallexample
10358 set $foo = *object_ptr
10359 @end smallexample
10360
10361 @noindent
10362 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10363 @code{object_ptr}.
10364
10365 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10366 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10367 value with another assignment at any time.
10368
10369 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10370 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10371 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10372 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10373
10374 @table @code
10375 @kindex show convenience
10376 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10377 @item show convenience
10378 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10379 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10380 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10381
10382 @kindex init-if-undefined
10383 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10384 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10385 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10386 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10387 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10388 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10389 override default values used in a command script.
10390
10391 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10392 any side-effects do not occur.
10393 @end table
10394
10395 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10396 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10397 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10398
10399 @smallexample
10400 set $i = 0
10401 print bar[$i++]->contents
10402 @end smallexample
10403
10404 @noindent
10405 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10406
10407 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10408 values likely to be useful.
10409
10410 @table @code
10411 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10412 @item $_
10413 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10414 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10415 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10416 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10417 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10418 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10419 to the type of @code{$__}.
10420
10421 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10422 @item $__
10423 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10424 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10425 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10426
10427 @item $_exitcode
10428 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10429 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10430 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10431 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10432
10433 @item $_exitsignal
10434 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10435 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10436 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10437 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10438
10439 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10440 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10441 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10442 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10443 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10444
10445 @smallexample
10446 #include <signal.h>
10447
10448 int
10449 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10450 @{
10451 raise (SIGALRM);
10452 return 0;
10453 @}
10454 @end smallexample
10455
10456 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10457 or signalled would be:
10458
10459 @smallexample
10460 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10461 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10462 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10463 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10464 >echo The program has exited\n
10465 >else
10466 >echo The program has signalled\n
10467 >end
10468 >end
10469 (@value{GDBP}) run
10470 Starting program:
10471
10472 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10473 The program no longer exists.
10474 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10475 The program has signalled
10476 @end smallexample
10477
10478 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10479 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10480 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10481 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10482
10483 @smallexample
10484 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10485 The program has exited
10486 @end smallexample
10487
10488 @item $_exception
10489 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10490 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10491
10492 @item $_probe_argc
10493 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10494 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10495
10496 @item $_sdata
10497 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10498 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10499 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10500 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10501 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10502
10503 @item $_siginfo
10504 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10505 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10506 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10507 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10508 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10509
10510 @item $_tlb
10511 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10512 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10513 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10514 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10515 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10516 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10517
10518 @item $_inferior
10519 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10520 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10521
10522 @item $_thread
10523 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10524
10525 @item $_gthread
10526 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10527
10528 @end table
10529
10530 @node Convenience Funs
10531 @section Convenience Functions
10532
10533 @cindex convenience functions
10534 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10535 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10536 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10537 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10538 @value{GDBN}.
10539
10540 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10541 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10542
10543 @table @code
10544
10545 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10546 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10547 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10548 returns zero.
10549
10550 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10551 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10552 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10553 it is @code{void}:
10554
10555 @smallexample
10556 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10557 $1 = void
10558 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10559 $2 = 1
10560 (@value{GDBP}) run
10561 Starting program: ./a.out
10562 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10563 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10564 $3 = 0
10565 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10566 $4 = 0
10567 @end smallexample
10568
10569 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10570 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10571 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10572 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10573 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10574 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10575 anymore.
10576
10577 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10578 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10579
10580 @smallexample
10581 void
10582 foo (void)
10583 @{
10584 @}
10585 @end smallexample
10586
10587 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10588
10589 @smallexample
10590 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10591 $1 = void
10592 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10593 $2 = 1
10594 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10595 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10596 $3 = void
10597 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10598 $4 = 1
10599 @end smallexample
10600
10601 @end table
10602
10603 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10604 @code{Python} support.
10605
10606 @table @code
10607
10608 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10609 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10610 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10611 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10612 Otherwise it returns zero.
10613
10614 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10615 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10616 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10617 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10618 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10619 regular expression support.
10620
10621 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10622 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10623 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10624 Otherwise it returns zero.
10625
10626 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10627 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10628 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10629
10630 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10631 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10632 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10633 Otherwise it returns zero.
10634
10635 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10636 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10637 The default is 1.
10638
10639 Example:
10640
10641 @smallexample
10642 (gdb) backtrace
10643 #0 bottom_func ()
10644 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10645 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10646 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10647 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10648 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10649 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10650 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10651 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10652 $1 = 1
10653 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10654 $1 = 1
10655 @end smallexample
10656
10657 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10658 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10659 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10660 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10661
10662 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10663 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10664 The default is 1.
10665
10666 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10667 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10668 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10669 Otherwise it returns zero.
10670
10671 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10672 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10673 The default is 1.
10674
10675 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10676 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10677 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10678 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10679
10680 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10681 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10682 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10683 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10684
10685 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10686 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10687 The default is 1.
10688
10689 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10690 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10691 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10692 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10693
10694 @end table
10695
10696 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10697 convenience functions.
10698
10699 @table @code
10700 @item help function
10701 @kindex help function
10702 @cindex show all convenience functions
10703 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10704 @end table
10705
10706 @node Registers
10707 @section Registers
10708
10709 @cindex registers
10710 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10711 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10712 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10713 your machine.
10714
10715 @table @code
10716 @kindex info registers
10717 @item info registers
10718 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10719 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10720
10721 @kindex info all-registers
10722 @cindex floating point registers
10723 @item info all-registers
10724 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10725 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10726
10727 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10728 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10729 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10730 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10731 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10732 @end table
10733
10734 @anchor{standard registers}
10735 @cindex stack pointer register
10736 @cindex program counter register
10737 @cindex process status register
10738 @cindex frame pointer register
10739 @cindex standard registers
10740 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10741 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10742 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10743 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10744 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10745 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10746 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10747 you could print the program counter in hex with
10748
10749 @smallexample
10750 p/x $pc
10751 @end smallexample
10752
10753 @noindent
10754 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10755
10756 @smallexample
10757 x/i $pc
10758 @end smallexample
10759
10760 @noindent
10761 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10762 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10763 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10764 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10765 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10766 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10767 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10768
10769 @smallexample
10770 set $sp += 4
10771 @end smallexample
10772
10773 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10774 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10775 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10776 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10777 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10778 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10779 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10780
10781 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10782 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10783 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10784 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10785 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10786 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10787 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10788
10789 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10790 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10791 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10792 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10793 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10794 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10795 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10796 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10797 prints the data in both formats.
10798
10799 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10800 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10801 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10802 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10803 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10804 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10805 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10806
10807 @smallexample
10808 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10809 $1 = @{
10810 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10811 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10812 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10813 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10814 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10815 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10816 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10817 @}
10818 @end smallexample
10819
10820 @noindent
10821 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10822 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10823 value to a @code{struct} member:
10824
10825 @smallexample
10826 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10827 @end smallexample
10828
10829 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10830 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10831 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10832 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10833 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10834 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10835
10836 @cindex caller-saved registers
10837 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10838 @cindex volatile registers
10839 @cindex <not saved> values
10840 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10841 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10842 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10843 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10844 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10845 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10846 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10847 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10848 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10849 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10850 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10851 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10852 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10853 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10854 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10855 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10856 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10857 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10858 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10859 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10860 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10861 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10862 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10863
10864 @node Floating Point Hardware
10865 @section Floating Point Hardware
10866 @cindex floating point
10867
10868 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10869 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10870
10871 @table @code
10872 @kindex info float
10873 @item info float
10874 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10875 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10876 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10877 the ARM and x86 machines.
10878 @end table
10879
10880 @node Vector Unit
10881 @section Vector Unit
10882 @cindex vector unit
10883
10884 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10885 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10886
10887 @table @code
10888 @kindex info vector
10889 @item info vector
10890 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10891 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10892 @end table
10893
10894 @node OS Information
10895 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10896 @cindex OS information
10897
10898 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10899 you debug your program.
10900
10901 @cindex auxiliary vector
10902 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10903 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10904 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10905 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10906 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10907 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10908 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10909 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10910 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10911 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10912 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10913 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10914
10915 @table @code
10916 @kindex info auxv
10917 @item info auxv
10918 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10919 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10920 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10921 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10922 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10923 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10924 an unrecognized tag.
10925 @end table
10926
10927 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10928 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10929 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10930 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10931 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10932 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10933 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10934
10935 @table @code
10936 @kindex info os
10937 @item info os @var{infotype}
10938
10939 Display OS information of the requested type.
10940
10941 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10942
10943 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10944 @table @code
10945 @kindex info os cpus
10946 @item cpus
10947 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10948 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10949 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10950 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10951 kernel initialization.
10952
10953 @kindex info os files
10954 @item files
10955 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10956 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10957 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10958 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10959
10960 @kindex info os modules
10961 @item modules
10962 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10963 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10964 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10965 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10966 in memory.
10967
10968 @kindex info os msg
10969 @item msg
10970 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10971 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10972 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10973 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10974 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10975 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10976 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10977 the message queue was last changed.
10978
10979 @kindex info os processes
10980 @item processes
10981 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10982 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10983 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10984 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10985 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10986 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10987
10988 @kindex info os procgroups
10989 @item procgroups
10990 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10991 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10992 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10993 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10994 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10995 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10996 and the process group leader is listed first.
10997
10998 @kindex info os semaphores
10999 @item semaphores
11000 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11001 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11002 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11003 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11004 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11005
11006 @kindex info os shm
11007 @item shm
11008 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11009 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11010 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11011 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11012 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11013 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11014 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11015
11016 @kindex info os sockets
11017 @item sockets
11018 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11019 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11020 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11021 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11022 connection.
11023
11024 @kindex info os threads
11025 @item threads
11026 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11027 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11028 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11029 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11030 process is not listed.
11031 @end table
11032
11033 @item info os
11034 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11035 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11036 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11037 types, this command will report an error.
11038 @end table
11039
11040 @node Memory Region Attributes
11041 @section Memory Region Attributes
11042 @cindex memory region attributes
11043
11044 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11045 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11046 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11047 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11048 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11049 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11050 user can override the fetched regions.
11051
11052 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11053 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11054 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11055 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11056 all memory.
11057
11058 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11059 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11060
11061 @table @code
11062 @kindex mem
11063 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11064 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11065 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11066 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11067 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11068 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11069
11070 @item mem auto
11071 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11072 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11073
11074 @kindex delete mem
11075 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11076 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11077 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11078
11079 @kindex disable mem
11080 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11081 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11082 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11083 It may be enabled again later.
11084
11085 @kindex enable mem
11086 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11087 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11088
11089 @kindex info mem
11090 @item info mem
11091 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11092 for each region:
11093
11094 @table @emph
11095 @item Memory Region Number
11096 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11097 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11098 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11099
11100 @item Lo Address
11101 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11102
11103 @item Hi Address
11104 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11105
11106 @item Attributes
11107 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11108 @end table
11109 @end table
11110
11111
11112 @subsection Attributes
11113
11114 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11115 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11116 write accesses to a memory region.
11117
11118 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11119 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11120 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11121
11122 @table @code
11123 @item ro
11124 Memory is read only.
11125 @item wo
11126 Memory is write only.
11127 @item rw
11128 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11129 @end table
11130
11131 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11132 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11133 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11134 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11135 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11136
11137 @table @code
11138 @item 8
11139 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11140 @item 16
11141 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11142 @item 32
11143 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11144 @item 64
11145 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11146 @end table
11147
11148 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11149 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11150 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11151 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11152 @c
11153 @c @table @code
11154 @c @item hwbreak
11155 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11156 @c @item swbreak (default)
11157 @c @end table
11158
11159 @subsubsection Data Cache
11160 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11161 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11162 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11163 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11164 registers.
11165
11166 @table @code
11167 @item cache
11168 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11169 @item nocache
11170 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11171 @end table
11172
11173 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11174 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11175 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11176 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11177 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11178
11179 @table @code
11180 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11181 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11182 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11183 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11184 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11185 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11186 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11187 The default value is @code{on}.
11188 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11189 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11190 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11191 @end table
11192
11193
11194 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11195 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11196 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11197 @c
11198 @c @table @code
11199 @c @item verify
11200 @c @item noverify (default)
11201 @c @end table
11202
11203 @node Dump/Restore Files
11204 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11205 @cindex dump/restore files
11206 @cindex append data to a file
11207 @cindex dump data to a file
11208 @cindex restore data from a file
11209
11210 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11211 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11212 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11213 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11214 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11215 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11216 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11217
11218 @table @code
11219
11220 @kindex dump
11221 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11222 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11223 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11224 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11225
11226 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11227 @table @code
11228 @item binary
11229 Raw binary form.
11230 @item ihex
11231 Intel hex format.
11232 @item srec
11233 Motorola S-record format.
11234 @item tekhex
11235 Tektronix Hex format.
11236 @item verilog
11237 Verilog Hex format.
11238 @end table
11239
11240 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11241 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11242 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11243 form.
11244
11245 @kindex append
11246 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11247 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11248 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11249 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11250 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11251
11252 @kindex restore
11253 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11254 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11255 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11256 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11257 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11258
11259 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11260 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11261 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11262 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11263 from that location.
11264
11265 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11266 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11267 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11268 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11269
11270 @end table
11271
11272 @node Core File Generation
11273 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11274 @cindex dump core from inferior
11275
11276 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11277 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11278 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11279 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11280 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11281 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11282 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11283
11284 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11285 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11286 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11287
11288 @table @code
11289 @kindex gcore
11290 @kindex generate-core-file
11291 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11292 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11293 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11294 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11295 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11296 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11297
11298 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11299 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11300
11301 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11302 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11303 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11304
11305 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11306 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11307 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11308 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11309 Enable or disable the use of the file
11310 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11311 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11312 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11313 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11314
11315 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11316 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11317 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11318 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11319 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11320 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11321 about the bits that can be set in the
11322 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11323 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11324
11325 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11326 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11327 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11328 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11329 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11330 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11331 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11332 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11333 @end table
11334
11335 @node Character Sets
11336 @section Character Sets
11337 @cindex character sets
11338 @cindex charset
11339 @cindex translating between character sets
11340 @cindex host character set
11341 @cindex target character set
11342
11343 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11344 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11345 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11346 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11347 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11348 @dfn{target character set}.
11349
11350 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11351 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11352 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11353 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11354 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11355 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11356 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11357 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11358 character and string literals in expressions.
11359
11360 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11361 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11362 target-charset} command, described below.
11363
11364 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11365 support:
11366
11367 @table @code
11368 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11369 @kindex set target-charset
11370 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11371 list of supported target character sets, type
11372 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11373
11374 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11375 @kindex set host-charset
11376 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11377
11378 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11379 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11380 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11381 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11382 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11383
11384 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11385 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11386 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11387
11388 @item set charset @var{charset}
11389 @kindex set charset
11390 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11391 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11392 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11393 for both host and target.
11394
11395 @item show charset
11396 @kindex show charset
11397 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11398
11399 @item show host-charset
11400 @kindex show host-charset
11401 Show the name of the current host character set.
11402
11403 @item show target-charset
11404 @kindex show target-charset
11405 Show the name of the current target character set.
11406
11407 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11408 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11409 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11410 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11411 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11412 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11413
11414 @item show target-wide-charset
11415 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11416 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11417 @end table
11418
11419 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11420 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11421 @file{charset-test.c}:
11422
11423 @smallexample
11424 #include <stdio.h>
11425
11426 char ascii_hello[]
11427 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11428 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11429 char ibm1047_hello[]
11430 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11431 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11432
11433 main ()
11434 @{
11435 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11436 @}
11437 @end smallexample
11438
11439 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11440 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11441 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11442
11443 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11444
11445 @smallexample
11446 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11447 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11448 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11449 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11450 @dots{}
11451 (@value{GDBP})
11452 @end smallexample
11453
11454 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11455 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11456 strings:
11457
11458 @smallexample
11459 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11460 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11461 (@value{GDBP})
11462 @end smallexample
11463
11464 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11465 initial character set:
11466 @smallexample
11467 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11468 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11469 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11470 (@value{GDBP})
11471 @end smallexample
11472
11473 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11474 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11475 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11476 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11477 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11478
11479 @smallexample
11480 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11481 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11482 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11483 $2 = 72 'H'
11484 (@value{GDBP})
11485 @end smallexample
11486
11487 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11488 literals you use in expressions:
11489
11490 @smallexample
11491 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11492 $3 = 43 '+'
11493 (@value{GDBP})
11494 @end smallexample
11495
11496 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11497 character.
11498
11499 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11500 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11501 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11502
11503 @smallexample
11504 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11505 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11506 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11507 $5 = 200 '\310'
11508 (@value{GDBP})
11509 @end smallexample
11510
11511 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11512 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11513
11514 @smallexample
11515 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11516 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11517 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11518 @end smallexample
11519
11520 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11521 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11522 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11523 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11524 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11525
11526 @smallexample
11527 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11528 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11529 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11530 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11531 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11532 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11533 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11534 $7 = 72 '\110'
11535 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11536 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11537 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11538 $9 = 200 'H'
11539 (@value{GDBP})
11540 @end smallexample
11541
11542 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11543 string literals you use in expressions:
11544
11545 @smallexample
11546 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11547 $10 = 78 '+'
11548 (@value{GDBP})
11549 @end smallexample
11550
11551 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11552 character.
11553
11554 @node Caching Target Data
11555 @section Caching Data of Targets
11556 @cindex caching data of targets
11557
11558 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11559 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11560 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11561 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11562 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11563 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11564 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11565 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11566 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11567 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11568 is executing.
11569 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11570 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11571 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11572 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11573 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11574 in the code segment.
11575 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11576 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11577
11578 @table @code
11579 @kindex set remotecache
11580 @item set remotecache on
11581 @itemx set remotecache off
11582 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11583 with old scripts.
11584
11585 @kindex show remotecache
11586 @item show remotecache
11587 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11588
11589 @kindex set stack-cache
11590 @item set stack-cache on
11591 @itemx set stack-cache off
11592 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11593 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11594
11595 @kindex show stack-cache
11596 @item show stack-cache
11597 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11598
11599 @kindex set code-cache
11600 @item set code-cache on
11601 @itemx set code-cache off
11602 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11603 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11604 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11605
11606 @kindex show code-cache
11607 @item show code-cache
11608 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11609 accesses.
11610
11611 @kindex info dcache
11612 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11613 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11614 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11615 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11616 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11617 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11618
11619 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11620 printed in hex.
11621
11622 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11623 @cindex dcache size
11624 @kindex set dcache size
11625 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11626
11627 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11628 @cindex dcache line-size
11629 @kindex set dcache line-size
11630 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11631 Must be a power of 2.
11632
11633 @item show dcache size
11634 @kindex show dcache size
11635 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11636
11637 @item show dcache line-size
11638 @kindex show dcache line-size
11639 Show default size of dcache lines.
11640
11641 @end table
11642
11643 @node Searching Memory
11644 @section Search Memory
11645 @cindex searching memory
11646
11647 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11648 @code{find} command.
11649
11650 @table @code
11651 @kindex find
11652 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11653 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11654 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11655 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11656 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11657 @end table
11658
11659 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11660 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11661
11662 @table @r
11663 @item @var{s}, search query size
11664 The size of each search query value.
11665
11666 @table @code
11667 @item b
11668 bytes
11669 @item h
11670 halfwords (two bytes)
11671 @item w
11672 words (four bytes)
11673 @item g
11674 giant words (eight bytes)
11675 @end table
11676
11677 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11678 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11679 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11680
11681 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11682 value's type in the current language.
11683 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11684 pattern as a mixture of types.
11685 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11686 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11687 which is typically four bytes.
11688
11689 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11690 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11691 @end table
11692
11693 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11694 (@code{"}).
11695 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11696 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11697
11698 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11699 number of matches found.
11700
11701 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11702 @samp{$_}.
11703 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11704
11705 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11706
11707 @smallexample
11708 void
11709 hello ()
11710 @{
11711 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11712 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11713 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11714 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11715 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11716 @}
11717 @end smallexample
11718
11719 @noindent
11720 you get during debugging:
11721
11722 @smallexample
11723 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11724 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11725 1 pattern found
11726 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11727 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11728 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11729 2 patterns found
11730 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11731 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11732 1 pattern found
11733 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11734 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11735 1 pattern found
11736 (gdb) print $numfound
11737 $1 = 1
11738 (gdb) print $_
11739 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11740 @end smallexample
11741
11742 @node Value Sizes
11743 @section Value Sizes
11744
11745 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11746 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11747 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11748 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11749 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11750
11751 @table @code
11752 @kindex set max-value-size
11753 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11754 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11755 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11756 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11757 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11758
11759 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11760 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11761
11762 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11763 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11764 currently 16 bytes.
11765
11766 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11767 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11768 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11769 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11770 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11771 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11772 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11773 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11774
11775 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11776
11777 @kindex show max-value-size
11778 @item show max-value-size
11779 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11780 allocate for the contents of a value.
11781 @end table
11782
11783 @node Optimized Code
11784 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11785 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11786 @cindex debugging optimized code
11787
11788 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11789 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11790 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11791 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11792 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11793 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11794 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11795
11796 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11797 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11798 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11799 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11800
11801 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11802 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11803 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11804 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11805 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11806 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11807
11808 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11809 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11810 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11811 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11812 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11813
11814 @menu
11815 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11816 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11817 @end menu
11818
11819 @node Inline Functions
11820 @section Inline Functions
11821 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11822
11823 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11824 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11825 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11826 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11827 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11828 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11829 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11830 @code{info frame} command.
11831
11832 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11833 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11834 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11835 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11836 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11837 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11838 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11839 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11840 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11841 local variables in the caller.
11842
11843 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11844 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11845 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11846 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11847 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11848 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11849 instructions are executed.
11850
11851 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11852 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11853 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11854 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11855
11856 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11857 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11858
11859 @itemize @bullet
11860 @item
11861 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11862 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11863 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11864 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11865 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11866 or inside the inlined function instead.
11867
11868 @item
11869 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11870 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11871 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11872 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11873
11874 @end itemize
11875
11876 @node Tail Call Frames
11877 @section Tail Call Frames
11878 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11879
11880 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11881 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11882 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11883 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11884 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11885
11886 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11887 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11888 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11889 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11890 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11891 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11892 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11893
11894 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11895 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11896 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11897 this information.
11898
11899 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11900 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11901
11902 @smallexample
11903 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11904 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11905 (gdb) info frame
11906 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11907 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11908 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11909 source language c++.
11910 Arglist at unknown address.
11911 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11912 @end smallexample
11913
11914 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11915 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11916 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11917 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11918 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11919 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11920
11921 @table @code
11922 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11923 @item set debug entry-values
11924 @kindex set debug entry-values
11925 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11926 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11927 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11928 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11929 result.
11930
11931 @item show debug entry-values
11932 @kindex show debug entry-values
11933 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11934 values at function entry and tail calls.
11935 @end table
11936
11937 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11938 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11939 reference by variable @code{x}):
11940
11941 @smallexample
11942 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11943 void (*x) (void) = c;
11944 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11945 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11946 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11947
11948 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11949 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11950 a () at t.c:3
11951 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11952 (gdb) bt
11953 #0 a () at t.c:3
11954 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11955 @end smallexample
11956
11957 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11958
11959 @smallexample
11960 int i;
11961 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11962 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11963 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11964 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11965 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11966 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11967 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11968 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11969
11970 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11971 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11972 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11973 (gdb) bt
11974 #0 f () at t.c:2
11975 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11976 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11977 @end smallexample
11978
11979 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11980 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11981
11982 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11983 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11984 @set ARROW @click{}
11985 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11986 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11987 @end ifset
11988 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11989 @set ARROW ->
11990 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11991 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11992 @end ifclear
11993
11994 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11995 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11996 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11997
11998 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11999 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12000 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12001 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12002 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12003 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12004
12005 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12006 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12007 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12008 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12009 omitted.
12010
12011 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12012 entry may fail:
12013
12014 @smallexample
12015 int v;
12016 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12017 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12018 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12019 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12020 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12021 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12022
12023 (gdb) bt
12024 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12025 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
12026 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12027 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12028 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12029 @end smallexample
12030
12031 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12032 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12033 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12034 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12035 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12036
12037 @node Macros
12038 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12039
12040 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12041 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12042 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12043 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12044 where it was defined.
12045
12046 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12047 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12048 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12049 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12050
12051 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12052 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12053 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12054 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12055 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12056 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12057 see @ref{List}.
12058
12059 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12060 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12061 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12062
12063 @table @code
12064
12065 @kindex macro expand
12066 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12067 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12068 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12069 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12070 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12071 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12072 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12073 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12074 it can be any string of tokens.
12075
12076 @kindex macro exp1
12077 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12078 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12079 @cindex expand macro once
12080 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12081 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12082 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12083 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12084 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12085 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12086 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12087 can be any string of tokens.
12088
12089 @kindex info macro
12090 @cindex macro definition, showing
12091 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12092 @cindex macros, from debug info
12093 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12094 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12095 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12096 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12097 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12098 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12099
12100 @kindex info macros
12101 @item info macros @var{location}
12102 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12103 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12104 command-line where those definitions were established.
12105
12106 @kindex macro define
12107 @cindex user-defined macros
12108 @cindex defining macros interactively
12109 @cindex macros, user-defined
12110 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12111 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12112 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12113 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12114 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12115 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12116 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12117 @var{arglist}.
12118
12119 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12120 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12121 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12122 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12123 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12124
12125 @kindex macro undef
12126 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12127 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12128 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12129 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12130 in the program being debugged.
12131
12132 @kindex macro list
12133 @item macro list
12134 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12135 @end table
12136
12137 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12138 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12139 show our source files:
12140
12141 @smallexample
12142 $ cat sample.c
12143 #include <stdio.h>
12144 #include "sample.h"
12145
12146 #define M 42
12147 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12148
12149 main ()
12150 @{
12151 #define N 28
12152 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12153 #undef N
12154 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12155 #define N 1729
12156 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12157 @}
12158 $ cat sample.h
12159 #define Q <
12160 $
12161 @end smallexample
12162
12163 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12164 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12165 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12166 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12167 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12168 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12169 information.
12170
12171 @smallexample
12172 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12173 $
12174 @end smallexample
12175
12176 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12177
12178 @smallexample
12179 $ gdb -nw sample
12180 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12181 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12182 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12183 (@value{GDBP})
12184 @end smallexample
12185
12186 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12187 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12188 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12189
12190 @smallexample
12191 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12192 3
12193 4 #define M 42
12194 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12195 6
12196 7 main ()
12197 8 @{
12198 9 #define N 28
12199 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12200 11 #undef N
12201 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12202 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12203 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12204 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12205 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12206 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12207 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12208 #define Q <
12209 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12210 expands to: (42 + 1)
12211 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12212 expands to: once (M + 1)
12213 (@value{GDBP})
12214 @end smallexample
12215
12216 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12217 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12218 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12219 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12220
12221 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12222 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12223
12224 @smallexample
12225 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12226 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12227 (@value{GDBP}) run
12228 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12229
12230 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12231 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12232 (@value{GDBP})
12233 @end smallexample
12234
12235 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12236
12237 @smallexample
12238 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12239 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12240 #define N 28
12241 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12242 expands to: 28 < 42
12243 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12244 $1 = 1
12245 (@value{GDBP})
12246 @end smallexample
12247
12248 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12249 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12250 thereof) in force at each point:
12251
12252 @smallexample
12253 (@value{GDBP}) next
12254 Hello, world!
12255 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12256 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12257 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12258 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12259 (@value{GDBP}) next
12260 We're so creative.
12261 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12262 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12263 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12264 #define N 1729
12265 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12266 expands to: 1729 < 42
12267 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12268 $2 = 0
12269 (@value{GDBP})
12270 @end smallexample
12271
12272 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12273 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12274 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12275 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12276
12277 @smallexample
12278 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12279 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12280 -D__STDC__=1
12281 (@value{GDBP})
12282 @end smallexample
12283
12284
12285 @node Tracepoints
12286 @chapter Tracepoints
12287 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12288 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12289
12290 @cindex tracepoints
12291 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12292 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12293 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12294 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12295 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12296 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12297 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12298
12299 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12300 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12301 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12302 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12303 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12304 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12305 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12306 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12307 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12308 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12309 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12310
12311 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12312 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12313 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12314 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12315 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12316 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12317 Packets}.
12318
12319 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12320 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12321 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12322
12323 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12324
12325 @menu
12326 * Set Tracepoints::
12327 * Analyze Collected Data::
12328 * Tracepoint Variables::
12329 * Trace Files::
12330 @end menu
12331
12332 @node Set Tracepoints
12333 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12334
12335 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12336 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12337 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12338 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12339 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12340 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12341 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12342
12343 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12344 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12345 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12346 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12347 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12348 tracepoint was hit.
12349
12350 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12351 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12352 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12353 either.
12354
12355 @cindex fast tracepoints
12356 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12357 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12358 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12359
12360 @cindex static tracepoints
12361 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12362 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12363 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12364 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12365 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12366 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12367 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12368 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12369 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12370 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12371 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12372 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12373 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12374 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12375 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12376 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12377 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12378 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12379 static tracepoint marker.
12380
12381 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12382 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12383
12384 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12385 conditions and actions.
12386
12387 @menu
12388 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12389 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12390 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12391 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12392 * Trace State Variables::
12393 * Tracepoint Actions::
12394 * Listing Tracepoints::
12395 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12396 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12397 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12398 @end menu
12399
12400 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12401 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12402
12403 @table @code
12404 @cindex set tracepoint
12405 @kindex trace
12406 @item trace @var{location}
12407 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12408 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12409 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12410 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12411 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12412 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12413 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12414 in tracing}).
12415 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12416 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12417 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12418 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12419 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12420 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12421 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12422 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12423 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12424 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12425 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12426 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12427
12428 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12429
12430 @smallexample
12431 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12432
12433 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12434
12435 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12436
12437 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12438
12439 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12440 @end smallexample
12441
12442 @noindent
12443 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12444
12445 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12446 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12447 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12448 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12449 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12450 information on tracepoint conditions.
12451
12452 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12453 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12454 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12455 @kindex ftrace
12456 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12457 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12458 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12459 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12460 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12461 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12462 message.
12463
12464 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12465 @code{trace}.
12466
12467 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12468 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12469 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12470 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12471 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12472 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12473 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12474 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12475
12476 @example
12477 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12478 @end example
12479
12480 @noindent
12481 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12482 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12483
12484 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12485 @cindex set static tracepoint
12486 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12487 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12488 @kindex strace
12489 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12490 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12491 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12492 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12493 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12494
12495 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12496 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12497 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12498 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12499 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12500 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12501 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12502 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12503 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12504 tracing engine:
12505
12506 @smallexample
12507 main ()
12508 @{
12509 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12510 @}
12511 @end smallexample
12512
12513 @noindent
12514 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12515 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12516
12517 @smallexample
12518 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12519 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12520 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12521 Data: "str %s"
12522 [etc...]
12523 @end smallexample
12524
12525 @noindent
12526 so you may probe the marker above with:
12527
12528 @smallexample
12529 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12530 @end smallexample
12531
12532 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12533 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12534 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12535 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12536 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12537 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12538 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12539 the @samp{Data:} field.
12540
12541 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12542 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12543 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12544
12545 @vindex $tpnum
12546 @cindex last tracepoint number
12547 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12548 @cindex tracepoint number
12549 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12550 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12551
12552 @kindex delete tracepoint
12553 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12554 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12555 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12556 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12557 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12558
12559 Examples:
12560
12561 @smallexample
12562 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12563
12564 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12565 @end smallexample
12566
12567 @noindent
12568 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12569 @end table
12570
12571 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12572 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12573
12574 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12575
12576 @table @code
12577 @kindex disable tracepoint
12578 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12579 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12580 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12581 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12582 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12583 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12584 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12585 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12586 next trace experiment.
12587
12588 @kindex enable tracepoint
12589 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12590 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12591 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12592 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12593 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12594 next time a trace experiment is run.
12595 @end table
12596
12597 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12598 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12599
12600 @table @code
12601 @kindex passcount
12602 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12603 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12604 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12605 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12606 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12607 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12608 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12609 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12610 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12611 user.
12612
12613 Examples:
12614
12615 @smallexample
12616 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12617 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12618
12619 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12620 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12623 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12625 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12626 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12627 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12628 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12629 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12630 @end smallexample
12631 @end table
12632
12633 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12634 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12635 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12636 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12637
12638 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12639 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12640 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12641 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12642 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12643 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12644 is true.
12645
12646 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12647 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12648 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12649 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12650 just as with breakpoints.
12651
12652 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12653 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12654 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12655 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12656 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12657 accesses, and so forth.
12658
12659 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12660 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12661 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12662 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12663 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12664 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12665 search through.
12666
12667 @smallexample
12668 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12669 @end smallexample
12670
12671 @node Trace State Variables
12672 @subsection Trace State Variables
12673 @cindex trace state variables
12674
12675 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12676 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12677 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12678 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12679 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12680 integers.
12681
12682 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12683 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12684 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12685 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12686
12687 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12688 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12689 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12690 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12691 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12692 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12693 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12694 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12695 variable with the same name.
12696
12697 @table @code
12698
12699 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12700 @kindex tvariable
12701 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12702 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12703 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12704 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12705 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12706 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12707 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12708 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12709 value. The default initial value is 0.
12710
12711 @item info tvariables
12712 @kindex info tvariables
12713 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12714 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12715 currently running.
12716
12717 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12718 @kindex delete tvariable
12719 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12720 are specified.
12721
12722 @end table
12723
12724 @node Tracepoint Actions
12725 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12726
12727 @table @code
12728 @kindex actions
12729 @cindex tracepoint actions
12730 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12731 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12732 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12733 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12734 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12735 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12736 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12737 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12738 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12739 @code{while-stepping}.
12740
12741 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12742 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12743 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12744
12745 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12746 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12747 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12748
12749 @smallexample
12750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12751
12752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12753
12754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12755 @end smallexample
12756
12757 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12758 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12759 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12760 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12761 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12762 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12763 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12764 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12765
12766 @smallexample
12767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12769 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12770 > collect bar,baz
12771 > collect $regs
12772 > while-stepping 12
12773 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12774 > end
12775 end
12776 @end smallexample
12777
12778 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12779 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12780 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12781 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12782 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12783 special arguments are supported:
12784
12785 @table @code
12786 @item $regs
12787 Collect all registers.
12788
12789 @item $args
12790 Collect all function arguments.
12791
12792 @item $locals
12793 Collect all local variables.
12794
12795 @item $_ret
12796 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12797 of a backtrace.
12798
12799 @item $_probe_argc
12800 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12801 tracepoint is located.
12802 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12803
12804 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12805 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12806 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12807 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12808
12809 @item $_sdata
12810 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12811 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12812 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12813 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12814 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12815 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12816 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12817 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12818 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12819
12820 @smallexample
12821 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12822 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12823 @end smallexample
12824
12825 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12826 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12827 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12828 @value{GDBN}.
12829 @end table
12830
12831 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12832 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12833 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12834
12835 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12836 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12837 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12838 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12839 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12840 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12841 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12842 @samp{mystr}.
12843
12844 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12845 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12846
12847 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12848 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12849 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12850 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12851 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12852 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12853 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12854 action were used.
12855
12856 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12857 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12858 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12859 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12860 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12861 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12862
12863 @smallexample
12864 > while-stepping 12
12865 > collect $regs, myglobal
12866 > end
12867 >
12868 @end smallexample
12869
12870 @noindent
12871 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12872 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12873 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12874 @code{stepping}.
12875
12876 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12877 @kindex set default-collect
12878 @cindex default collection action
12879 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12880 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12881 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12882 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12883 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12884 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12885
12886 @item show default-collect
12887 @kindex show default-collect
12888 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12889 tracepoint hit.
12890
12891 @end table
12892
12893 @node Listing Tracepoints
12894 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12895
12896 @table @code
12897 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12898 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12899 @cindex information about tracepoints
12900 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12901 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12902 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12903 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12904 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12905 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12906
12907 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12908 tracing:
12909
12910 @itemize @bullet
12911 @item
12912 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12913
12914 @item
12915 the state about installed on target of each location
12916 @end itemize
12917
12918 @smallexample
12919 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12920 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12921 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12922 while-stepping 20
12923 collect globfoo, $regs
12924 end
12925 collect globfoo2
12926 end
12927 pass count 1200
12928 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12929 collect $eip
12930 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12931 installed on target
12932 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12933 installed on target
12934 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12935 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12936 not installed on target
12937 (@value{GDBP})
12938 @end smallexample
12939
12940 @noindent
12941 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12942 @end table
12943
12944 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12945 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12946
12947 @table @code
12948 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12949 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12950 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12951 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12952 program.
12953
12954 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12955
12956 @table @emph
12957 @item Count
12958 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12959 stable identifier.
12960 @item ID
12961 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12962 @item Enabled or Disabled
12963 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12964 that are not enabled.
12965 @item Address
12966 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12967 @item What
12968 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12969 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12970 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12971 will be left blank.
12972 @end table
12973
12974 @noindent
12975 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12976
12977 @table @emph
12978 @item Data
12979 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12980 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12981 marker call.
12982 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12983 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12984 @end table
12985
12986 @smallexample
12987 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12988 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12989 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12990 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12991 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12992 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12993 Data: str %s
12994 (@value{GDBP})
12995 @end smallexample
12996 @end table
12997
12998 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12999 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13000
13001 @table @code
13002 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13003 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13004 @cindex collected data discarded
13005 @item tstart
13006 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13007 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13008 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13009 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13010 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13011 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13012 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13013 information, and so forth.
13014
13015 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13016 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13017 @item tstop
13018 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13019 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13020 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13021 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13022 needs to be stopped quickly.
13023
13024 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13025 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13026 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13027
13028 @kindex tstatus
13029 @cindex status of trace data collection
13030 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13031 @item tstatus
13032 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13033 collection.
13034 @end table
13035
13036 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13037
13038 @smallexample
13039 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13040 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13041 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13042 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13043 > while-stepping 11
13044 > collect $regs
13045 > end
13046 > end
13047 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13048 [time passes @dots{}]
13049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13050 @end smallexample
13051
13052 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13053 @cindex disconnected tracing
13054 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13055 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13056 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13057 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13058 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13059 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13060 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13061 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13062
13063 @table @code
13064 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13065 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13066 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13067 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13068 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13069 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13070 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13071 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13072
13073 @item show disconnected-tracing
13074 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13075 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13076
13077 @end table
13078
13079 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13080 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13081 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13082 it will continue after reconnection.
13083
13084 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13085 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13086 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13087 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13088 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13089 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13090 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13091 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13092 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13093 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13094
13095 @cindex circular trace buffer
13096 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13097 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13098 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13099 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13100 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13101 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13102 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13103 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13104 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13105 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13106 the next run.
13107
13108 @table @code
13109 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13110 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13111 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13112 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13113 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13114 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13115 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13116
13117 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13118 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13119 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13120 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13121 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13122 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13123
13124 @end table
13125
13126 @table @code
13127 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13128 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13129 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13130 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13131 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13132 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13133 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13134 likes. This is also the default.
13135
13136 @item show trace-buffer-size
13137 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13138 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13139 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13140 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13141 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13142 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13143 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13144 @end table
13145
13146 @table @code
13147 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13148 @kindex set trace-user
13149
13150 @item show trace-user
13151 @kindex show trace-user
13152
13153 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13154 @kindex set trace-notes
13155 Set the trace run's notes.
13156
13157 @item show trace-notes
13158 @kindex show trace-notes
13159 Show the trace run's notes.
13160
13161 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13162 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13163 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13164 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13165 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13166
13167 @item show trace-stop-notes
13168 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13169 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13170
13171 @end table
13172
13173 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13174 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13175
13176 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13177 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13178 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13179 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13180 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13181 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13182 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13183 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13184 mentioned here.
13185
13186 @itemize @bullet
13187
13188 @item
13189 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13190 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13191 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13192 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13193 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13194 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13195 cannot be collected either.
13196
13197 @item
13198 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13199 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13200 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13201 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13202 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13203 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13204 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13205 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13206 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13207 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13208
13209 @item
13210 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13211 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13212 in a misleading way.
13213
13214 @item
13215 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13216 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13217 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13218 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13219 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13220 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13221 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13222 by @code{ptr}.
13223
13224 @item
13225 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13226 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13227 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13228 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13229 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13230 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13231 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13232 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13233 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13234 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13235 invalid address.
13236
13237 @item
13238 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13239 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13240 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13241 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13242 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13243 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13244 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13245 it to zero.
13246
13247 @end itemize
13248
13249 @node Analyze Collected Data
13250 @section Using the Collected Data
13251
13252 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13253 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13254 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13255 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13256 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13257 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13258 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13259 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13260 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13261 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13262 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13263 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13264 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13265 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13266 the buffer will fail.
13267
13268 @menu
13269 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13270 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13271 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13272 @end menu
13273
13274 @node tfind
13275 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13276
13277 @kindex tfind
13278 @cindex select trace snapshot
13279 @cindex find trace snapshot
13280 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13281 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13282 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13283 snapshot is selected.
13284
13285 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13286
13287 @table @code
13288 @item tfind start
13289 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13290 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13291
13292 @item tfind none
13293 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13294
13295 @item tfind end
13296 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13297
13298 @item tfind
13299 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
13300
13301 @item tfind -
13302 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13303 retracing earlier steps.
13304
13305 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13306 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13307 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13308 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13309 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13310
13311 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13312 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13313 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13314 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13315 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13316
13317 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13318 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13319 addresses (exclusive).
13320
13321 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13322 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13323 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13324
13325 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13326 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13327 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13328 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13329 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13330 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13331 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13332 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13333 @end table
13334
13335 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13336 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13337 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13338 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13339 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13340 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13341 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13342 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13343 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13344 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13345 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13346 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13347 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13348 tracepoint as the current one.
13349
13350 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13351 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13352 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13353 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13354 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13355
13356 @smallexample
13357 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13358 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13359 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13360 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13361 > tfind
13362 > end
13363
13364 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13365 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13366 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13367 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13368 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13369 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13370 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13371 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13372 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13373 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13374 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13375 @end smallexample
13376
13377 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13378 the buffer:
13379
13380 @smallexample
13381 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13382 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13383 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13384 > tfind line
13385 > end
13386
13387 Frame 0, X = 1
13388 Frame 7, X = 2
13389 Frame 13, X = 255
13390 @end smallexample
13391
13392 @node tdump
13393 @subsection @code{tdump}
13394 @kindex tdump
13395 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13396 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13397
13398 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13399 the current trace snapshot.
13400
13401 @smallexample
13402 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13403 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13404 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13405 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13406 > end
13407
13408 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13409
13410 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13411 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13412 at gdb_test.c:444
13413 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13414
13415 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13416 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13417 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13418 d1 0x18 24
13419 d2 0x80 128
13420 d3 0x33 51
13421 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13422 d5 0x22 34
13423 d6 0xe0 224
13424 d7 0x380035 3670069
13425 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13426 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13427 a2 0x100 256
13428 a3 0x322000 3284992
13429 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13430 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13431 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13432 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13433 ps 0x0 0
13434 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13435 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13436 fpstatus 0x0 0
13437 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13438 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13439 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13440 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13441 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13442 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13443 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13444 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13445 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13446
13447 (@value{GDBP})
13448 @end smallexample
13449
13450 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13451 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13452 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13453 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13454
13455 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13456 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13457 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13458 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13459 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13460 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13461 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13462 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13463 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13464 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13465
13466 @node save tracepoints
13467 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13468 @kindex save tracepoints
13469 @kindex save-tracepoints
13470 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13471
13472 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13473 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13474 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13475 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13476 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13477 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13478
13479 @node Tracepoint Variables
13480 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13481 @cindex tracepoint variables
13482 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13483
13484 @table @code
13485 @vindex $trace_frame
13486 @item (int) $trace_frame
13487 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13488 snapshot is selected.
13489
13490 @vindex $tracepoint
13491 @item (int) $tracepoint
13492 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13493
13494 @vindex $trace_line
13495 @item (int) $trace_line
13496 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13497
13498 @vindex $trace_file
13499 @item (char []) $trace_file
13500 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13501
13502 @vindex $trace_func
13503 @item (char []) $trace_func
13504 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13505 @end table
13506
13507 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13508 use @code{output} instead.
13509
13510 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13511 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13512 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13513 which are managed by the target.
13514
13515 @smallexample
13516 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13517
13518 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13519 > output $trace_file
13520 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13521 > tfind
13522 > end
13523 @end smallexample
13524
13525 @node Trace Files
13526 @section Using Trace Files
13527 @cindex trace files
13528
13529 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13530 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13531 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13532 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13533 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13534
13535 @table @code
13536
13537 @kindex tsave
13538 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13539 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13540 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13541 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13542 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13543 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13544 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13545 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13546 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13547 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13548 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13549 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13550 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13551 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13552 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13553
13554 @kindex target tfile
13555 @kindex tfile
13556 @kindex target ctf
13557 @kindex ctf
13558 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13559 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13560 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13561 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13562 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13563 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13564 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13565 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13566 the host.
13567
13568 @smallexample
13569 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13570 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13571 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13572 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13573 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13574 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13575 i = 0
13576 a = 0
13577 b = 1 '\001'
13578 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13579 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13580 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13581 $1 = 1
13582 @end smallexample
13583
13584 @end table
13585
13586 @node Overlays
13587 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13588 @cindex overlays
13589
13590 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13591 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13592 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13593 use overlays.
13594
13595 @menu
13596 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13597 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13598 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13599 mapped by asking the inferior.
13600 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13601 @end menu
13602
13603 @node How Overlays Work
13604 @section How Overlays Work
13605 @cindex mapped overlays
13606 @cindex unmapped overlays
13607 @cindex load address, overlay's
13608 @cindex mapped address
13609 @cindex overlay area
13610
13611 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13612 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13613 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13614 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13615 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13616
13617 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13618 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13619 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13620 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13621 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13622 largest overlay as well.
13623
13624 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13625 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13626 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13627 there.
13628
13629 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13630 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13631 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13632
13633 @smallexample
13634 @group
13635 Data Instruction Larger
13636 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13637 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13638 | | | | | |
13639 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13640 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13641 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13642 | and heap | | | | | |
13643 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13644 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13645 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13646 | | | | | |
13647 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13648 address | | | | | |
13649 | overlay | <-' | | |
13650 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13651 | | <---. | | load address
13652 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13653 | | | |
13654 +-----------+ | |
13655 +-----------+
13656 | |
13657 +-----------+
13658
13659 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13660 @end group
13661 @end smallexample
13662
13663 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13664 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13665 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13666 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13667 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13668 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13669 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13670 program and the overlay area.
13671
13672 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13673 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13674 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13675 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13676 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13677 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13678 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13679
13680 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13681 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13682 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13683
13684 @itemize @bullet
13685
13686 @item
13687 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13688 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13689 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13690 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13691
13692 @item
13693 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13694 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13695 your program's performance.
13696
13697 @item
13698 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13699 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13700 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13701 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13702 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13703 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13704 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13705
13706 @item
13707 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13708 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13709 instruction and data spaces.
13710
13711 @end itemize
13712
13713 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13714 improved in many ways:
13715
13716 @itemize @bullet
13717
13718 @item
13719 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13720 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13721 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13722 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13723 area in the usual way.
13724
13725 @item
13726 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13727 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13728
13729 @item
13730 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13731 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13732 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13733 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13734 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13735 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13736 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13737
13738 @end itemize
13739
13740
13741 @node Overlay Commands
13742 @section Overlay Commands
13743
13744 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13745 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13746 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13747 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13748 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13749 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13750
13751 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13752 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13753
13754 @table @code
13755 @item overlay off
13756 @kindex overlay
13757 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13758 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13759 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13760 overlay support is disabled.
13761
13762 @item overlay manual
13763 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13764 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13765 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13766 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13767 commands described below.
13768
13769 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13770 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13771 @cindex map an overlay
13772 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13773 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13774 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13775 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13776 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13777 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13778
13779 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13780 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13781 @cindex unmap an overlay
13782 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13783 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13784 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13785 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13786
13787 @item overlay auto
13788 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13789 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13790 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13791 Overlay Debugging}.
13792
13793 @item overlay load-target
13794 @itemx overlay load
13795 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13796 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13797 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13798 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13799 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13800 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13801
13802 @item overlay list-overlays
13803 @itemx overlay list
13804 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13805 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13806 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13807
13808 @end table
13809
13810 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13811 of the function the address falls in:
13812
13813 @smallexample
13814 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13815 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13816 @end smallexample
13817 @noindent
13818 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13819 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13820 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13821 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13822
13823 @smallexample
13824 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13825 No sections are mapped.
13826 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13827 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13828 @end smallexample
13829 @noindent
13830 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13831 name normally:
13832
13833 @smallexample
13834 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13835 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13836 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13837 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13838 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13839 @end smallexample
13840
13841 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13842 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13843 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13844 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13845 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13846
13847 @itemize @bullet
13848 @item
13849 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13850 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13851 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13852 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13853 @item
13854 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13855 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13856 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13857 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13858 breakpoints properly.
13859 @end itemize
13860
13861
13862 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13863 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13864 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13865
13866 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13867 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13868 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13869 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13870 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13871 current state of the overlays.
13872
13873 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13874 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13875
13876 @table @asis
13877
13878 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13879 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13880
13881 @smallexample
13882 struct
13883 @{
13884 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13885 unsigned long vma;
13886
13887 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13888 unsigned long size;
13889
13890 /* The overlay's load address. */
13891 unsigned long lma;
13892
13893 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13894 zero otherwise. */
13895 unsigned long mapped;
13896 @}
13897 @end smallexample
13898
13899 @item @code{_novlys}:
13900 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13901 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13902
13903 @end table
13904
13905 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13906 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13907 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13908 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13909 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13910 currently mapped.
13911
13912 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13913 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13914 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13915 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13916 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13917 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13918 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13919 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13920 are not being executed.
13921
13922 @node Overlay Sample Program
13923 @section Overlay Sample Program
13924 @cindex overlay example program
13925
13926 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13927 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13928 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13929 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13930 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13931 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13932 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13933
13934 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13935 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13936 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13937 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13938
13939 @table @file
13940 @item overlays.c
13941 The main program file.
13942 @item ovlymgr.c
13943 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13944 @item foo.c
13945 @itemx bar.c
13946 @itemx baz.c
13947 @itemx grbx.c
13948 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13949 @item d10v.ld
13950 @itemx m32r.ld
13951 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13952 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13953 @end table
13954
13955 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13956 cross-compiler like this:
13957
13958 @smallexample
13959 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13960 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13961 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13962 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13963 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13964 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13965 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13966 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13967 @end smallexample
13968
13969 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13970 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13971 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13972
13973
13974 @node Languages
13975 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13976 @cindex languages
13977
13978 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13979 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13980 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13981 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13982 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13983 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13984
13985 @cindex working language
13986 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13987 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13988 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13989 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13990 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13991 language}.
13992
13993 @menu
13994 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13995 * Show:: Displaying the language
13996 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13997 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13998 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13999 @end menu
14000
14001 @node Setting
14002 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14003
14004 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14005 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14006 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14007 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14008 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14009 are printed, etc.
14010
14011 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14012 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14013 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14014 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14015 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14016 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14017 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14018 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14019 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14020 Displaying the Language}.
14021
14022 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14023 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14024 another language. In that case, make the
14025 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14026 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14027 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14028
14029 @menu
14030 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14031 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14032 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14033 @end menu
14034
14035 @node Filenames
14036 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14037
14038 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14039 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14040
14041 @table @file
14042 @item .ada
14043 @itemx .ads
14044 @itemx .adb
14045 @itemx .a
14046 Ada source file.
14047
14048 @item .c
14049 C source file
14050
14051 @item .C
14052 @itemx .cc
14053 @itemx .cp
14054 @itemx .cpp
14055 @itemx .cxx
14056 @itemx .c++
14057 C@t{++} source file
14058
14059 @item .d
14060 D source file
14061
14062 @item .m
14063 Objective-C source file
14064
14065 @item .f
14066 @itemx .F
14067 Fortran source file
14068
14069 @item .mod
14070 Modula-2 source file
14071
14072 @item .s
14073 @itemx .S
14074 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14075 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14076 @end table
14077
14078 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14079 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14080
14081 @node Manually
14082 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14083
14084 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14085 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14086 your program.
14087
14088 @kindex set language
14089 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14090 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14091 a language, such as
14092 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14093 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14094
14095 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14096 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14097 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14098 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14099 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14100 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14101 command such as:
14102
14103 @smallexample
14104 print a = b + c
14105 @end smallexample
14106
14107 @noindent
14108 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14109 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14110 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14111 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14112
14113 @node Automatically
14114 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14115
14116 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14117 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14118 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14119 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14120 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14121 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14122 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14123 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14124 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14125
14126 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14127 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14128 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14129 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14130 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14131
14132 @node Show
14133 @section Displaying the Language
14134
14135 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14136 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14137
14138 @table @code
14139 @item show language
14140 @anchor{show language}
14141 @kindex show language
14142 Display the current working language. This is the
14143 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14144 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14145
14146 @item info frame
14147 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14148 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14149 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14150 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14151 information listed here.
14152
14153 @item info source
14154 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14155 Display the source language of this source file.
14156 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14157 information listed here.
14158 @end table
14159
14160 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14161 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14162 with a language explicitly:
14163
14164 @table @code
14165 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14166 @kindex set extension-language
14167 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14168 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14169
14170 @item info extensions
14171 @kindex info extensions
14172 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14173 @end table
14174
14175 @node Checks
14176 @section Type and Range Checking
14177
14178 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14179 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14180 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14181 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14182 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14183 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14184 errors when your program is running.
14185
14186 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14187 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14188 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14189 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14190
14191 @menu
14192 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14193 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14194 @end menu
14195
14196 @cindex type checking
14197 @cindex checks, type
14198 @node Type Checking
14199 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14200
14201 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14202 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14203 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14204 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14205
14206 @smallexample
14207 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14208
14209 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14210 $1 = 2
14211 @exdent but
14212 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14213 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14214 @end smallexample
14215
14216 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14217 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14218
14219 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14220 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14221 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14222 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14223 expressions like the second example above.
14224
14225 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14226 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14227 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14228 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14229 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14230 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14231
14232 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14233
14234 @kindex set check type
14235 @kindex show check type
14236 @table @code
14237 @item set check type on
14238 @itemx set check type off
14239 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14240 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14241 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14242
14243 @item show check type
14244 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14245 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14246 @end table
14247
14248 @cindex range checking
14249 @cindex checks, range
14250 @node Range Checking
14251 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14252
14253 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14254 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14255 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14256 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14257 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14258
14259 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14260 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14261 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14262 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14263
14264 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14265 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14266 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14267 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14268 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14269 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14270
14271 @smallexample
14272 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14273 @end smallexample
14274
14275 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14276 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14277 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14278
14279 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14280
14281 @kindex set check range
14282 @kindex show check range
14283 @table @code
14284 @item set check range auto
14285 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14286 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14287 each language.
14288
14289 @item set check range on
14290 @itemx set check range off
14291 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14292 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14293 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14294 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14295
14296 @item set check range warn
14297 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14298 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14299 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14300 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14301 systems).
14302
14303 @item show range
14304 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14305 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14306 @end table
14307
14308 @node Supported Languages
14309 @section Supported Languages
14310
14311 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14312 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14313 @c This is false ...
14314 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14315 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14316 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14317 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14318 language.
14319
14320 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14321 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14322 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14323 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14324 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14325 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14326 language reference or tutorial.
14327
14328 @menu
14329 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14330 * D:: D
14331 * Go:: Go
14332 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14333 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14334 * Fortran:: Fortran
14335 * Pascal:: Pascal
14336 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14337 * Ada:: Ada
14338 @end menu
14339
14340 @node C
14341 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14342
14343 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14344 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14345
14346 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14347 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14348 together.
14349
14350 @cindex C@t{++}
14351 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14352 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14353 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14354 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14355 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14356 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14357 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14358
14359 @menu
14360 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14361 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14362 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14363 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14364 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14365 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14366 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14367 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14368 @end menu
14369
14370 @node C Operators
14371 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14372
14373 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14374
14375 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14376 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14377 often defined on groups of types.
14378
14379 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14380
14381 @itemize @bullet
14382
14383 @item
14384 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14385 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14386
14387 @item
14388 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14389 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14390
14391 @item
14392 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14393
14394 @item
14395 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14396
14397 @end itemize
14398
14399 @noindent
14400 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14401 in order of increasing precedence:
14402
14403 @table @code
14404 @item ,
14405 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14406 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14407 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14408
14409 @item =
14410 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14411 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14412
14413 @item @var{op}=
14414 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14415 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14416 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14417 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14418 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14419
14420 @item ?:
14421 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14422 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14423 should be of an integral type.
14424
14425 @item ||
14426 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14427
14428 @item &&
14429 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14430
14431 @item |
14432 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14433
14434 @item ^
14435 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14436
14437 @item &
14438 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14439
14440 @item ==@r{, }!=
14441 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14442 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14443
14444 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14445 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14446 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14447 and non-zero for true.
14448
14449 @item <<@r{, }>>
14450 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14451
14452 @item @@
14453 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14454
14455 @item +@r{, }-
14456 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14457 pointer types.
14458
14459 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14460 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14461 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14462 integral types.
14463
14464 @item ++@r{, }--
14465 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14466 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14467 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14468 operation takes place.
14469
14470 @item *
14471 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14472 @code{++}.
14473
14474 @item &
14475 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14476
14477 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14478 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14479 to examine the address
14480 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14481 stored.
14482
14483 @item -
14484 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14485 precedence as @code{++}.
14486
14487 @item !
14488 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14489 @code{++}.
14490
14491 @item ~
14492 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14493 @code{++}.
14494
14495
14496 @item .@r{, }->
14497 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14498 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14499 pointer based on the stored type information.
14500 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14501
14502 @item .*@r{, }->*
14503 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14504
14505 @item []
14506 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14507 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14508
14509 @item ()
14510 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14511
14512 @item ::
14513 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14514 and @code{class} types.
14515
14516 @item ::
14517 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14518 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14519 above.
14520 @end table
14521
14522 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14523 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14524 predefined meaning.
14525
14526 @node C Constants
14527 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14528
14529 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14530
14531 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14532 following ways:
14533
14534 @itemize @bullet
14535 @item
14536 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14537 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14538 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14539 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14540 @code{long} value.
14541
14542 @item
14543 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14544 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14545 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14546 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14547 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14548 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14549 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14550 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14551 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14552 constant.
14553
14554 @item
14555 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14556 integral equivalents.
14557
14558 @item
14559 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14560 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14561 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14562 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14563 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14564 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14565 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14566 @samp{\n} for newline.
14567
14568 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14569 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14570 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14571 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14572
14573 @item
14574 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14575 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14576 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14577 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14578 characters.
14579
14580 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14581 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14582 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14583
14584 @item
14585 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14586 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14587
14588 @item
14589 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14590 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14591 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14592 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14593 @end itemize
14594
14595 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14596 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14597
14598 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14599 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14600
14601 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14602 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14603 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14604 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14605 @quotation
14606 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14607 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14608 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14609 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14610 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14611 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14612 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14613 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14614 @end quotation
14615
14616 @enumerate
14617
14618 @cindex member functions
14619 @item
14620 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14621
14622 @smallexample
14623 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14624 @end smallexample
14625
14626 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14627 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14628 @item
14629 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14630 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14631 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14632 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14633 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14634
14635 @cindex call overloaded functions
14636 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14637 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14638 @item
14639 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14640 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14641 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14642 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14643 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14644 default arguments.
14645
14646 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14647 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14648 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14649 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14650 number of function arguments.
14651
14652 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14653 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14654 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14655
14656 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14657 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14658 @smallexample
14659 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14660 @end smallexample
14661
14662 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14663 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14664
14665 @cindex reference declarations
14666 @item
14667 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14668 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14669 dereferenced.
14670
14671 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14672 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14673 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14674 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14675 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14676
14677 @item
14678 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14679 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14680 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14681 necessary, for example in an expression like
14682 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14683 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14684 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14685
14686 @item
14687 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14688 specification.
14689 @end enumerate
14690
14691 @node C Defaults
14692 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14693
14694 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14695
14696 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14697 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14698 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14699 selects the working language.
14700
14701 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14702 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14703 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14704 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14705 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14706 for further details.
14707
14708 @node C Checks
14709 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14710
14711 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14712
14713 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14714 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14715 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14716 constants to pointers.
14717
14718 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14719 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14720 that is not itself an array.
14721
14722 @node Debugging C
14723 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14724
14725 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14726 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14727 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14728 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14729
14730 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14731 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14732 ,Expressions}.
14733
14734 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14735 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14736
14737 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14738
14739 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14740 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14741
14742 @table @code
14743 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14744 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14745 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14746 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14747 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14748 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14749
14750 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14751 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14752 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14753 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14754 classes.
14755 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14756
14757 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14758 @item catch throw
14759 @itemx catch rethrow
14760 @itemx catch catch
14761 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14762 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14763
14764 @cindex inheritance
14765 @item ptype @var{typename}
14766 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14767 @var{typename}.
14768 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14769
14770 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14771 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14772 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14773 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14774 multiple inheritance is in use.
14775
14776 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14777 @item demangle @var{name}
14778 Demangle @var{name}.
14779 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14780
14781 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14782 @item set print demangle
14783 @itemx show print demangle
14784 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14785 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14786 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14787 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14788 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14789
14790 @item set print object
14791 @itemx show print object
14792 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14793 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14794
14795 @item set print vtbl
14796 @itemx show print vtbl
14797 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14798 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14799 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14800 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14801
14802 @kindex set overload-resolution
14803 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14804 @item set overload-resolution on
14805 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14806 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14807 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14808 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14809 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14810 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14811
14812 @item set overload-resolution off
14813 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14814 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14815 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14816 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14817 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14818 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14819 argument types.
14820
14821 @kindex show overload-resolution
14822 @item show overload-resolution
14823 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14824
14825 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14826 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14827 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14828 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14829 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14830 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14831 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14832 @end table
14833
14834 @node Decimal Floating Point
14835 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14836 @cindex decimal floating point format
14837
14838 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14839 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14840 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14841 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14842
14843 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14844 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14845 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14846 configured target.
14847
14848 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14849 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14850 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14851
14852 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14853 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14854 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14855
14856 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14857 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14858 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14859
14860 @node D
14861 @subsection D
14862
14863 @cindex D
14864 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14865 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14866 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14867
14868 @node Go
14869 @subsection Go
14870
14871 @cindex Go (programming language)
14872 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14873 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14874
14875 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14876
14877 @table @code
14878 @cindex current Go package
14879 @item The current Go package
14880 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14881 specifying global variables and functions.
14882
14883 For example, given the program:
14884
14885 @example
14886 package main
14887 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14888 func main () @{
14889 // ...
14890 @}
14891 @end example
14892
14893 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14894
14895 @example
14896 (gdb) p myglob
14897 (gdb) p main.myglob
14898 @end example
14899
14900 @cindex builtin Go types
14901 @item Builtin Go types
14902 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14903 as a string.
14904
14905 @cindex builtin Go functions
14906 @item Builtin Go functions
14907 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14908 function and handles it internally.
14909
14910 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14911 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14912 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14913 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14914 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14915 @end table
14916
14917 @node Objective-C
14918 @subsection Objective-C
14919
14920 @cindex Objective-C
14921 This section provides information about some commands and command
14922 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14923 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14924 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14925
14926 @menu
14927 * Method Names in Commands::
14928 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14929 @end menu
14930
14931 @node Method Names in Commands
14932 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14933
14934 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14935 names as line specifications:
14936
14937 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14938 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14939 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14940 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14941 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14942 @itemize
14943 @item @code{clear}
14944 @item @code{break}
14945 @item @code{info line}
14946 @item @code{jump}
14947 @item @code{list}
14948 @end itemize
14949
14950 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14951
14952 @smallexample
14953 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14954 @end smallexample
14955
14956 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14957 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14958 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14959 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14960 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14961 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14962 debugged, enter:
14963
14964 @smallexample
14965 break -[Fruit create]
14966 @end smallexample
14967
14968 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14969 enter:
14970
14971 @smallexample
14972 list +[NSText initialize]
14973 @end smallexample
14974
14975 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14976 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14977 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14978 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14979
14980 @smallexample
14981 break create
14982 @end smallexample
14983
14984 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14985 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14986 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14987 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14988 none apply.
14989
14990 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14991 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14992
14993 @smallexample
14994 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14995 @end smallexample
14996
14997 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14998 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14999 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15000 @kindex print-object
15001 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15002
15003 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15004
15005 @smallexample
15006 print -[@var{object} hash]
15007 @end smallexample
15008
15009 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15010 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15011 @noindent
15012 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15013 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15014 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15015 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15016 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15017 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15018
15019 @node OpenCL C
15020 @subsection OpenCL C
15021
15022 @cindex OpenCL C
15023 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15024
15025 @menu
15026 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15027 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15028 * OpenCL C Operators::
15029 @end menu
15030
15031 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15032 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15033
15034 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15035 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15036 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15037 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15038 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15039
15040 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15041 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15042
15043 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15044 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15045 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15046 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15047
15048 @node OpenCL C Operators
15049 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15050
15051 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15052 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15053 vector data types.
15054
15055 @node Fortran
15056 @subsection Fortran
15057 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15058
15059 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15060 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15061
15062 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15063 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15064 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15065 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15066 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15067 underscore.
15068
15069 @menu
15070 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15071 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15072 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15073 @end menu
15074
15075 @node Fortran Operators
15076 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15077
15078 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15079
15080 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15081 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15082 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15083
15084 @table @code
15085 @item **
15086 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15087 of the second one.
15088
15089 @item :
15090 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15091 represent a section of array.
15092
15093 @item %
15094 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15095 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15096 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15097 union type.
15098 @end table
15099
15100 @node Fortran Defaults
15101 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15102
15103 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15104
15105 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15106 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15107 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15108 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15109
15110 @node Special Fortran Commands
15111 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15112
15113 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15114
15115 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15116 such as displaying common blocks.
15117
15118 @table @code
15119 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15120 @kindex info common
15121 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15122 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15123 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15124 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15125 printed.
15126 @end table
15127
15128 @node Pascal
15129 @subsection Pascal
15130
15131 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15132 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15133 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15134 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15135 syntax.
15136
15137 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15138 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15139 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15140
15141 @node Modula-2
15142 @subsection Modula-2
15143
15144 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15145
15146 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15147 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15148 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15149 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15150 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15151 table.
15152
15153 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15154 @menu
15155 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15156 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15157 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15158 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15159 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15160 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15161 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15162 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15163 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15164 @end menu
15165
15166 @node M2 Operators
15167 @subsubsection Operators
15168 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15169
15170 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15171 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15172 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15173 following definitions hold:
15174
15175 @itemize @bullet
15176
15177 @item
15178 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15179 their subranges.
15180
15181 @item
15182 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15183
15184 @item
15185 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15186
15187 @item
15188 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15189 @var{type}}.
15190
15191 @item
15192 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15193
15194 @item
15195 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15196
15197 @item
15198 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15199 @end itemize
15200
15201 @noindent
15202 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15203 increasing precedence:
15204
15205 @table @code
15206 @item ,
15207 Function argument or array index separator.
15208
15209 @item :=
15210 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15211 @var{value}.
15212
15213 @item <@r{, }>
15214 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15215 types.
15216
15217 @item <=@r{, }>=
15218 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15219 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15220 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15221
15222 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15223 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15224 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15225 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15226 comment character.
15227
15228 @item IN
15229 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15230 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15231
15232 @item OR
15233 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15234
15235 @item AND@r{, }&
15236 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15237
15238 @item @@
15239 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15240
15241 @item +@r{, }-
15242 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15243 and difference on set types.
15244
15245 @item *
15246 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15247 on set types.
15248
15249 @item /
15250 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15251 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15252
15253 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15254 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15255 precedence as @code{*}.
15256
15257 @item -
15258 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15259
15260 @item ^
15261 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15262
15263 @item NOT
15264 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15265 @code{^}.
15266
15267 @item .
15268 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15269 precedence as @code{^}.
15270
15271 @item []
15272 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15273
15274 @item ()
15275 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15276 as @code{^}.
15277
15278 @item ::@r{, }.
15279 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15280 @end table
15281
15282 @quotation
15283 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15284 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15285 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15286 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15287 @end quotation
15288
15289
15290 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15291 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15292 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15293
15294 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15295 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15296
15297 @table @var
15298
15299 @item a
15300 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15301
15302 @item c
15303 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15304
15305 @item i
15306 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15307
15308 @item m
15309 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15310 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15311 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15312
15313 @item n
15314 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15315
15316 @item r
15317 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15318
15319 @item t
15320 represents a type.
15321
15322 @item v
15323 represents a variable.
15324
15325 @item x
15326 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15327 explanation of the function for details.
15328 @end table
15329
15330 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15331
15332 @table @code
15333 @item ABS(@var{n})
15334 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15335
15336 @item CAP(@var{c})
15337 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15338 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15339
15340 @item CHR(@var{i})
15341 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15342
15343 @item DEC(@var{v})
15344 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15345
15346 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15347 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15348 new value.
15349
15350 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15351 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15352 set.
15353
15354 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15355 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15356
15357 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15358 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15359
15360 @item INC(@var{v})
15361 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15362
15363 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15364 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15365 new value.
15366
15367 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15368 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15369 there. Returns the new set.
15370
15371 @item MAX(@var{t})
15372 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15373
15374 @item MIN(@var{t})
15375 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15376
15377 @item ODD(@var{i})
15378 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15379
15380 @item ORD(@var{x})
15381 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15382 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15383 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15384 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15385
15386 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15387 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15388 variable or a type.
15389
15390 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15391 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15392
15393 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15394 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15395 variable or a type.
15396
15397 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15398 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15399 @end table
15400
15401 @quotation
15402 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15403 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15404 an error.
15405 @end quotation
15406
15407 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15408 @node M2 Constants
15409 @subsubsection Constants
15410
15411 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15412 ways:
15413
15414 @itemize @bullet
15415
15416 @item
15417 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15418 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15419 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15420 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15421
15422 @item
15423 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15424 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15425 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15426 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15427 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15428 digits.
15429
15430 @item
15431 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15432 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15433 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15434 followed by a @samp{C}.
15435
15436 @item
15437 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15438 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15439 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15440 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15441 sequences.
15442
15443 @item
15444 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15445
15446 @item
15447 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15448 @code{FALSE}.
15449
15450 @item
15451 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15452
15453 @item
15454 Set constants are not yet supported.
15455 @end itemize
15456
15457 @node M2 Types
15458 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15459 @cindex Modula-2 types
15460
15461 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15462 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15463 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15464 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15465 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15466 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15467
15468 The first example contains the following section of code:
15469
15470 @smallexample
15471 VAR
15472 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15473 r: [20..40] ;
15474 @end smallexample
15475
15476 @noindent
15477 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15478 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15479
15480 @smallexample
15481 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15482 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15483 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15484 SET OF CHAR
15485 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15486 21
15487 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15488 [20..40]
15489 @end smallexample
15490
15491 @noindent
15492 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15493
15494 @smallexample
15495 VAR
15496 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15497 @end smallexample
15498
15499 @noindent
15500 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15501
15502 @smallexample
15503 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15504 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15505 @end smallexample
15506
15507 @noindent
15508 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15509 expressions using the debugger.
15510
15511 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15512 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15513
15514 @smallexample
15515 VAR
15516 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15517 @end smallexample
15518
15519 @smallexample
15520 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15521 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15522 @end smallexample
15523
15524 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15525 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15526 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15527 above.
15528
15529 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15530
15531 @smallexample
15532 TYPE
15533 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15534 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15535 VAR
15536 s: t ;
15537 BEGIN
15538 s := blue ;
15539 @end smallexample
15540
15541 @noindent
15542 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15543 and value of a variable.
15544
15545 @smallexample
15546 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15547 $1 = blue
15548 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15549 type = [blue..yellow]
15550 @end smallexample
15551
15552 @noindent
15553 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15554 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15555 their @code{C} counterparts.
15556
15557 @smallexample
15558 VAR
15559 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15560 BEGIN
15561 s[1] := 1 ;
15562 @end smallexample
15563
15564 @smallexample
15565 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15566 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15567 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15568 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15569 @end smallexample
15570
15571 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15572 pointer types as shown in this example:
15573
15574 @smallexample
15575 VAR
15576 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15577 BEGIN
15578 NEW(s) ;
15579 s^[1] := 1 ;
15580 @end smallexample
15581
15582 @noindent
15583 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15584
15585 @smallexample
15586 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15587 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15588 @end smallexample
15589
15590 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15591 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15592 types:
15593
15594 @smallexample
15595 TYPE
15596 foo = RECORD
15597 f1: CARDINAL ;
15598 f2: CHAR ;
15599 f3: myarray ;
15600 END ;
15601
15602 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15603 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15604 VAR
15605 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15606 @end smallexample
15607
15608 @noindent
15609 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15610 below.
15611
15612 @smallexample
15613 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15614 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15615 f1 : CARDINAL;
15616 f2 : CHAR;
15617 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15618 END
15619 @end smallexample
15620
15621 @node M2 Defaults
15622 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15623 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15624
15625 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15626 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15627 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15628 selected the working language.
15629
15630 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15631 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15632 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15633 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15634
15635 @node Deviations
15636 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15637 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15638
15639 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15640 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15641
15642 @itemize @bullet
15643 @item
15644 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15645 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15646 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15647 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15648 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15649 returned a pointer.)
15650
15651 @item
15652 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15653 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15654 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15655 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15656
15657 @item
15658 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15659 argument.
15660
15661 @item
15662 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15663 @end itemize
15664
15665 @node M2 Checks
15666 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15667 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15668
15669 @quotation
15670 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15671 range checking.
15672 @end quotation
15673 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15674
15675 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15676
15677 @itemize @bullet
15678 @item
15679 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15680 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15681
15682 @item
15683 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15684 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15685 @end itemize
15686
15687 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15688 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15689
15690 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15691 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15692
15693 @node M2 Scope
15694 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15695 @cindex scope
15696 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15697 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15698 @ifinfo
15699 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15700 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15701 @end ifinfo
15702 @ifnotinfo
15703 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15704 @end ifnotinfo
15705
15706 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15707 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15708 similar syntax:
15709
15710 @smallexample
15711
15712 @var{module} . @var{id}
15713 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15714 @end smallexample
15715
15716 @noindent
15717 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15718 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15719 identifier within your program, except another module.
15720
15721 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15722 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15723 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15724 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15725
15726 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15727 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15728 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15729 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15730 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15731 @var{module}.
15732
15733 @node GDB/M2
15734 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15735
15736 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15737 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15738 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15739 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15740 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15741 analogue in Modula-2.
15742
15743 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15744 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15745 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15746 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15747 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15748 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15749
15750 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15751 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15752 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15753
15754 @node Ada
15755 @subsection Ada
15756 @cindex Ada
15757
15758 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15759 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15760 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15761 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15762 to be difficult.
15763
15764
15765 @cindex expressions in Ada
15766 @menu
15767 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15768 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15769 in @value{GDBN}.
15770 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15771 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15772 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15773 subprograms.
15774 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15775 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15776 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15777 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15778 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15779 Profile
15780 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15781 @end menu
15782
15783 @node Ada Mode Intro
15784 @subsubsection Introduction
15785 @cindex Ada mode, general
15786
15787 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15788 syntax, with some extensions.
15789 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15790
15791 @itemize @bullet
15792 @item
15793 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15794 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15795 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15796 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15797
15798 @item
15799 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15800 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15801
15802 @item
15803 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15804 @end itemize
15805
15806 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15807 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15808 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15809 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15810 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15811
15812 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15813 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15814 was translated from an Ada source file.
15815
15816 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15817 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15818 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15819 middle (to allow based literals).
15820
15821 @node Omissions from Ada
15822 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15823 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15824
15825 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15826
15827 @itemize @bullet
15828 @item
15829 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15830
15831 @itemize @minus
15832 @item
15833 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15834 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15835
15836 @item
15837 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15838
15839 @item
15840 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15841
15842 @item
15843 @t{'Tag}.
15844
15845 @item
15846 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15847 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15848
15849 @item
15850 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15851 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15852
15853 @item
15854 @t{'Address}.
15855 @end itemize
15856
15857 @item
15858 The names in
15859 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15860 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15861 not currently available.
15862
15863 @item
15864 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15865 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15866 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15867 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15868 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15869 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15870 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15871 indeterminate values.
15872
15873 @item
15874 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15875 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15876 are not implemented.
15877
15878 @item
15879 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15880 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15881 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15882 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15883 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15884
15885 @smallexample
15886 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15887 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15888 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15889 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15890 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15891 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15892 @end smallexample
15893
15894 Changing a
15895 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15896 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15897 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15898 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15899 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15900 declared to have a type such as:
15901
15902 @smallexample
15903 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15904 Id : Integer;
15905 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15906 end record;
15907 @end smallexample
15908
15909 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15910 assignments:
15911
15912 @smallexample
15913 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15914 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15915 @end smallexample
15916
15917 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15918 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15919 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15920 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15921 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15922 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15923 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15924 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15925
15926 @item
15927 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15928
15929 @item
15930 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15931 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15932 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15933 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15934 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15935 the proper resolution.
15936
15937 @item
15938 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15939
15940 @item
15941 Entry calls are not implemented.
15942
15943 @item
15944 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15945 formats are not supported.
15946
15947 @item
15948 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15949
15950 @item
15951 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15952 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15953 context.
15954 Should your program
15955 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15956 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15957 @end itemize
15958
15959 @node Additions to Ada
15960 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15961 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15962
15963 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15964 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15965
15966 @itemize @bullet
15967 @item
15968 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15969 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15970 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15971 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15972 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15973 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15974 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15975 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15976
15977 @item
15978 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15979 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15980 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15981
15982 @item
15983 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15984 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15985
15986 @item
15987 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15988 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15989 @end itemize
15990
15991 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15992 additions specific to Ada:
15993
15994 @itemize @bullet
15995 @item
15996 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15997 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15998
15999 @smallexample
16000 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16001 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16002 @end smallexample
16003
16004 @item
16005 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16006 the value of its right-hand operand.
16007 This allows, for example,
16008 complex conditional breaks:
16009
16010 @smallexample
16011 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16012 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16013 @end smallexample
16014
16015 @item
16016 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16017 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16018 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16019 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16020 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16021 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16022 in strings. For example,
16023 @smallexample
16024 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16025 @end smallexample
16026 @noindent
16027 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16028 after each period.
16029
16030 @item
16031 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16032 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16033 to write
16034
16035 @smallexample
16036 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16037 @end smallexample
16038
16039 @item
16040 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16041 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16042 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16043 of 3 might print as
16044
16045 @smallexample
16046 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16047 @end smallexample
16048
16049 @noindent
16050 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16051 clause.
16052
16053 @item
16054 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16055 multi-character subsequence of
16056 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16057 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16058 in place of @t{a'length}.
16059
16060 @item
16061 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16062 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16063 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16064 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16065 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16066 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16067 For example,
16068 @smallexample
16069 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16070 @end smallexample
16071
16072 @item
16073 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16074 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16075 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16076 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16077 object.
16078
16079 @end itemize
16080
16081 @node Overloading support for Ada
16082 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16083 @cindex overloading, Ada
16084
16085 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16086 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16087 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16088 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16089 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16090 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16091
16092 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16093 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16094 use, for instance:
16095
16096 @smallexample
16097 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16098 Multiple matches for f
16099 [0] cancel
16100 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16101 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16102 >
16103 @end smallexample
16104
16105 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16106 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16107 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16108
16109 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16110 case:
16111
16112 @table @code
16113
16114 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16115 @item set ada print-signatures
16116 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16117 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16118 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16119
16120 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16121 @item show ada print-signatures
16122 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16123 overloads selection menu.
16124 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16125
16126 @end table
16127
16128 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16129 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16130
16131 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16132 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16133 before reaching the main procedure.
16134 As defined in the Ada Reference
16135 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16136 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16137 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16138 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16139
16140 @node Ada Exceptions
16141 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16142
16143 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16144
16145 @table @code
16146 @kindex info exceptions
16147 @item info exceptions
16148 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16149 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16150 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16151 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16152 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16153 @end table
16154
16155 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16156 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16157 argument.
16158
16159 @smallexample
16160 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16161 All defined Ada exceptions:
16162 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16163 program_error: 0x613d20
16164 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16165 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16166 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16167 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16168 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16169 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16170 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16171 @end smallexample
16172
16173 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16174 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16175
16176 @node Ada Tasks
16177 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16178 @cindex Ada, tasking
16179
16180 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16181 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16182
16183 @table @code
16184 @kindex info tasks
16185 @item info tasks
16186 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16187
16188
16189 @smallexample
16190 @iftex
16191 @leftskip=0.5cm
16192 @end iftex
16193 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16194 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16195 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16196 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16197 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16198 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16199
16200 @end smallexample
16201
16202 @noindent
16203 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16204 task currently being inspected.
16205
16206 @table @asis
16207 @item ID
16208 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16209
16210 @item TID
16211 The Ada task ID.
16212
16213 @item P-ID
16214 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16215
16216 @item Pri
16217 The base priority of the task.
16218
16219 @item State
16220 Current state of the task.
16221
16222 @table @code
16223 @item Unactivated
16224 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16225 executing.
16226
16227 @item Runnable
16228 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16229 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16230
16231 @item Terminated
16232 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16233 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16234 terminated themselves.
16235
16236 @item Child Activation Wait
16237 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16238
16239 @item Accept Statement
16240 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16241
16242 @item Waiting on entry call
16243 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16244
16245 @item Async Select Wait
16246 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16247 select statement.
16248
16249 @item Delay Sleep
16250 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16251 alternative open.
16252
16253 @item Child Termination Wait
16254 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16255 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16256 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16257
16258 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16259 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16260 finish terminating.
16261
16262 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16263 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16264 @end table
16265
16266 @item Name
16267 Name of the task in the program.
16268
16269 @end table
16270
16271 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16272 @item info task @var{taskno}
16273 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16274 the following example:
16275 @smallexample
16276 @iftex
16277 @leftskip=0.5cm
16278 @end iftex
16279 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16280 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16281 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16282 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16283 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16284 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16285 Name: task_1
16286 Thread: 0x807f378
16287 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16288 Base Priority: 15
16289 State: Runnable
16290 @end smallexample
16291
16292 @item task
16293 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16294 @cindex current Ada task ID
16295 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16296
16297 @smallexample
16298 @iftex
16299 @leftskip=0.5cm
16300 @end iftex
16301 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16302 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16303 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16304 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16305 (@value{GDBP}) task
16306 [Current task is 2]
16307 @end smallexample
16308
16309 @item task @var{taskno}
16310 @cindex Ada task switching
16311 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16312 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16313 from the current task to the given task.
16314
16315 @smallexample
16316 @iftex
16317 @leftskip=0.5cm
16318 @end iftex
16319 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16320 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16321 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16322 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16323 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16324 [Switching to task 1]
16325 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16326 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16327 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16328 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16329 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16330 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16331 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16332 @end smallexample
16333
16334 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16335 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16336 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16337 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16338 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16339 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16340 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16341 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16342 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16343
16344 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16345 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16346 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16347 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16348 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16349
16350 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16351 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16352 program.
16353
16354 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16355 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16356 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16357
16358 For example,
16359
16360 @smallexample
16361 @iftex
16362 @leftskip=0.5cm
16363 @end iftex
16364 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16365 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16366 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16367 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16368 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16369 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16370 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16371 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16372 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16373 Continuing.
16374 task # 1 running
16375 task # 2 running
16376
16377 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16378 15 flush;
16379 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16380 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16381 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16382 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16383 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16384 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16385 @end smallexample
16386 @end table
16387
16388 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16389 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16390 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16391
16392 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16393 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16394 the platform being used.
16395 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16396 switching is not supported.
16397
16398 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16399 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16400 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16401 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16402 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16403 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16404
16405 @node Ravenscar Profile
16406 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16407 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16408
16409 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16410 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16411 requirements.
16412
16413 @table @code
16414 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16415 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16416 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16417 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16418 Profile. This is the default.
16419
16420 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16421 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16422 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16423 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16424 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16425 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16426 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16427
16428 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16429 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16430 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16431 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16432
16433 @end table
16434
16435 @node Ada Glitches
16436 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16437 @cindex Ada, problems
16438
16439 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16440 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16441 @value{GDBN},
16442 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16443 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16444
16445 @itemize @bullet
16446 @item
16447 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16448 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16449
16450 @item
16451 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16452 argument lists are treated as positional).
16453
16454 @item
16455 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16456
16457 @item
16458 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16459 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16460 the host machine.
16461
16462 @item
16463 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16464 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16465 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16466 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16467 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16468 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16469 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16470 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16471 you can usually resolve the confusion
16472 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16473 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16474 @end itemize
16475
16476 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16477 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16478 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16479 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16480 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16481 enabled.
16482
16483 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16484 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16485 @table @code
16486
16487 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16488 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16489 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16490 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16491 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16492 This is the default.
16493
16494 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16495 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16496 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16497 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16498 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16499 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16500 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16501
16502 @end table
16503
16504 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16505 @cindex GNAT encoding
16506 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16507 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16508 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16509 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16510 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16511 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16512
16513 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16514 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16515 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16516 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16517 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16518 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16519 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16520 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16521
16522 @table @code
16523
16524 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16525 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16526 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16527 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16528
16529 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16530 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16531 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16532
16533 @end table
16534
16535 @node Unsupported Languages
16536 @section Unsupported Languages
16537
16538 @cindex unsupported languages
16539 @cindex minimal language
16540 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16541 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16542 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16543 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16544 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16545 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16546
16547 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16548 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16549 language.
16550
16551 @node Symbols
16552 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16553
16554 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16555 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16556 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16557 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16558 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16559 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16560 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16561
16562 @cindex symbol names
16563 @cindex names of symbols
16564 @cindex quoting names
16565 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16566 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16567 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16568 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16569 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16570 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16571 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16572 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16573
16574 @smallexample
16575 p 'foo.c'::x
16576 @end smallexample
16577
16578 @noindent
16579 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16580
16581 @table @code
16582 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16583 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16584 @kindex set case-sensitive
16585 @item set case-sensitive on
16586 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16587 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16588 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16589 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16590 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16591 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16592 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16593 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16594 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16595 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16596 case-insensitive matches.
16597
16598 @kindex show case-sensitive
16599 @item show case-sensitive
16600 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16601 lookups.
16602
16603 @kindex set print type methods
16604 @item set print type methods
16605 @itemx set print type methods on
16606 @itemx set print type methods off
16607 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16608 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16609 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16610 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16611 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16612 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16613
16614 @kindex show print type methods
16615 @item show print type methods
16616 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16617 classes.
16618
16619 @kindex set print type typedefs
16620 @item set print type typedefs
16621 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16622 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16623
16624 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16625 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16626 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16627 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16628 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16629 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16630 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16631 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16632 types.
16633
16634 @kindex show print type typedefs
16635 @item show print type typedefs
16636 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16637 printing classes.
16638
16639 @kindex info address
16640 @cindex address of a symbol
16641 @item info address @var{symbol}
16642 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16643 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16644 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16645 is always stored.
16646
16647 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16648 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16649 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16650
16651 @kindex info symbol
16652 @cindex symbol from address
16653 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16654 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16655 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16656 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16657 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16658
16659 @smallexample
16660 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16661 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16662 @end smallexample
16663
16664 @noindent
16665 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16666 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16667
16668 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16669 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16670
16671 @smallexample
16672 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16673 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16674 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16675 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16676 @end smallexample
16677
16678 @kindex demangle
16679 @cindex demangle
16680 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16681 Demangle @var{name}.
16682 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16683 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16684
16685 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16686 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16687
16688 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16689 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16690
16691 @kindex whatis
16692 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16693 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16694 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16695 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16696
16697 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16698 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16699 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16700
16701 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16702 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16703 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16704 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16705 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16706 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16707 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16708 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16709 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16710
16711 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16712 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16713 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16714 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16715 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16716 unroll it.
16717
16718 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16719 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16720 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16721
16722 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16723 Available flags are:
16724
16725 @table @code
16726 @item r
16727 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16728 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16729 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16730
16731 @item m
16732 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16733
16734 @item M
16735 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16736 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16737
16738 @item t
16739 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16740 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16741 names are substituted when printing other types.
16742
16743 @item T
16744 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16745 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16746 @end table
16747
16748 @kindex ptype
16749 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16750 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16751 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16752 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16753
16754 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16755 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16756 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16757 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16758 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16759 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16760 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16761 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16762
16763 For example, for this variable declaration:
16764
16765 @smallexample
16766 typedef double real_t;
16767 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16768 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16769 complex_t var;
16770 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16771 @end smallexample
16772
16773 @noindent
16774 the two commands give this output:
16775
16776 @smallexample
16777 @group
16778 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16779 type = complex_t
16780 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16781 type = struct complex @{
16782 real_t real;
16783 double imag;
16784 @}
16785 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16786 type = struct complex
16787 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16788 type = struct complex
16789 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16790 type = struct complex @{
16791 real_t real;
16792 double imag;
16793 @}
16794 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16795 type = real_t *
16796 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16797 type = double *
16798 @end group
16799 @end smallexample
16800
16801 @noindent
16802 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16803 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16804
16805 @cindex incomplete type
16806 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16807 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16808 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16809 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16810 given these declarations:
16811
16812 @smallexample
16813 struct foo;
16814 struct foo *fooptr;
16815 @end smallexample
16816
16817 @noindent
16818 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16819
16820 @smallexample
16821 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16822 $1 = <incomplete type>
16823 @end smallexample
16824
16825 @noindent
16826 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16827 completely specified.
16828
16829 @kindex info types
16830 @item info types @var{regexp}
16831 @itemx info types
16832 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16833 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16834 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16835 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16836 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16837 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16838 name is @code{value}.
16839
16840 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16841 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16842 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16843
16844 @kindex info type-printers
16845 @item info type-printers
16846 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16847 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16848 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16849 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16850 type printers.
16851
16852 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16853
16854 @kindex enable type-printer
16855 @kindex disable type-printer
16856 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16857 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16858 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16859
16860 @kindex info scope
16861 @cindex local variables
16862 @item info scope @var{location}
16863 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16864 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16865 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16866 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16867 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16868
16869 @smallexample
16870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16871 Scope for command_line_handler:
16872 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16873 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16874 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16875 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16876 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16877 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16878 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16879 @end smallexample
16880
16881 @noindent
16882 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16883 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16884 collect}.
16885
16886 @kindex info source
16887 @item info source
16888 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16889 the function containing the current point of execution:
16890 @itemize @bullet
16891 @item
16892 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16893 @item
16894 the directory it was compiled in,
16895 @item
16896 its length, in lines,
16897 @item
16898 which programming language it is written in,
16899 @item
16900 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16901 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16902 @item
16903 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16904 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16905 @item
16906 whether the debugging information includes information about
16907 preprocessor macros.
16908 @end itemize
16909
16910
16911 @kindex info sources
16912 @item info sources
16913 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16914 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16915 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16916
16917 @kindex info functions
16918 @item info functions
16919 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16920
16921 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16922 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16923 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16924 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16925 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16926 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16927 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16928 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16929
16930 @kindex info variables
16931 @item info variables
16932 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16933 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16934
16935 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16936 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16937 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16938 @var{regexp}.
16939
16940 @kindex info classes
16941 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16942 @item info classes
16943 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16944 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16945 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16946 expression.
16947
16948 @kindex info selectors
16949 @item info selectors
16950 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16951 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16952 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16953 expression.
16954
16955 @ignore
16956 This was never implemented.
16957 @kindex info methods
16958 @item info methods
16959 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16960 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16961 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16962 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16963 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16964 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16965 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16966 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16967 @end ignore
16968
16969 @cindex opaque data types
16970 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16971 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16972 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16973 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16974 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16975 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16976 another source file. The default is on.
16977
16978 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16979 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16980
16981 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16982 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16983 is printed as follows:
16984 @smallexample
16985 @{<no data fields>@}
16986 @end smallexample
16987
16988 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16989 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16990 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16991
16992 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16993 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16994 @item set print symbol-loading
16995 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16996 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16997 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16998 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16999 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17000 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17001 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17002 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17003 can be annoying.
17004 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17005 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17006 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17007 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17008
17009 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17010 @item show print symbol-loading
17011 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17012 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17013
17014 @kindex maint print symbols
17015 @cindex symbol dump
17016 @kindex maint print psymbols
17017 @cindex partial symbol dump
17018 @kindex maint print msymbols
17019 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17020 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
17021 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
17022 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
17023 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
17024 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
17025 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
17026 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
17027 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
17028 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
17029 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
17030 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
17031 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
17032 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
17033 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
17034 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
17035 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17036 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17037
17038 @kindex maint info symtabs
17039 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17040 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17041 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17042 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17043 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17044 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17045 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17046
17047 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17048 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17049 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17050 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17051 structure in more detail. For example:
17052
17053 @smallexample
17054 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17055 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17056 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17057 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17058 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17059 readin no
17060 fullname (null)
17061 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17062 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17063 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17064 dependencies (none)
17065 @}
17066 @}
17067 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17068 (@value{GDBP})
17069 @end smallexample
17070 @noindent
17071 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17072 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17073 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17074 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17075 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17076
17077 @smallexample
17078 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17079 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17080 line 1574.
17081 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17082 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17083 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17084 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17085 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17086 dirname (null)
17087 fullname (null)
17088 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17089 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17090 debugformat DWARF 2
17091 @}
17092 @}
17093 (@value{GDBP})
17094 @end smallexample
17095
17096 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17097 @cindex symbol cache size
17098 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17099 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17100 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17101 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17102 with different sizes.
17103
17104 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17105 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17106 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17107
17108 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17109 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17110 @item maint print symbol-cache
17111 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17112 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17113
17114 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17115 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17116 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17117 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17118 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17119
17120 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17121 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17122 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17123 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17124 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17125 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17126
17127 @end table
17128
17129 @node Altering
17130 @chapter Altering Execution
17131
17132 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17133 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17134 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17135 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17136 program.
17137
17138 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17139 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17140 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17141
17142 @menu
17143 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17144 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17145 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17146 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17147 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17148 * Patching:: Patching your program
17149 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17150 @end menu
17151
17152 @node Assignment
17153 @section Assignment to Variables
17154
17155 @cindex assignment
17156 @cindex setting variables
17157 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17158 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17159
17160 @smallexample
17161 print x=4
17162 @end smallexample
17163
17164 @noindent
17165 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17166 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17167 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17168 information on operators in supported languages.
17169
17170 @kindex set variable
17171 @cindex variables, setting
17172 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17173 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17174 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17175 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17176 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17177
17178 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17179 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17180 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17181 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17182 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17183 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17184 command @code{set width}:
17185
17186 @smallexample
17187 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17188 type = double
17189 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17190 $4 = 13
17191 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17192 Invalid syntax in expression.
17193 @end smallexample
17194
17195 @noindent
17196 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17197 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17198
17199 @smallexample
17200 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17201 @end smallexample
17202
17203 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17204 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17205 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17206 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17207 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17208 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17209
17210 @smallexample
17211 @group
17212 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17213 type = double
17214 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17215 $1 = 1
17216 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17217 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17218 $2 = 1
17219 (@value{GDBP}) r
17220 The program being debugged has been started already.
17221 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17222 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17223 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17224 Invalid bfd target.
17225 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17226 The current BFD target is "=4".
17227 @end group
17228 @end smallexample
17229
17230 @noindent
17231 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17232 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17233 @code{g}, use
17234
17235 @smallexample
17236 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17237 @end smallexample
17238
17239 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17240 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17241 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17242 same length or shorter.
17243 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17244 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17245
17246 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17247 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17248 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17249 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17250 and representation in memory), and
17251
17252 @smallexample
17253 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17254 @end smallexample
17255
17256 @noindent
17257 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17258
17259 @node Jumping
17260 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17261
17262 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17263 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17264 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17265
17266 @table @code
17267 @kindex jump
17268 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17269 @item jump @var{location}
17270 @itemx j @var{location}
17271 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17272 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17273 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17274 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17275 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17276
17277 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17278 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17279 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17280 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17281 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17282 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17283 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17284 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17285 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17286 @end table
17287
17288 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17289 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17290 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17291 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17292 example,
17293
17294 @smallexample
17295 set $pc = 0x485
17296 @end smallexample
17297
17298 @noindent
17299 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17300 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17301 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17302
17303 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17304 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17305 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17306 detail.
17307
17308 @c @group
17309 @node Signaling
17310 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17311 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17312
17313 @table @code
17314 @kindex signal
17315 @item signal @var{signal}
17316 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17317 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17318 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17319 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17320
17321 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17322 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17323 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17324 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17325 signal.
17326
17327 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17328 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17329 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17330 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17331 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17332 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17333 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17334 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17335
17336 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17337 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17338 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17339 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17340 passes the signal directly to your program.
17341
17342 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17343 after executing the command.
17344
17345 @kindex queue-signal
17346 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17347 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17348 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17349 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17350 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17351 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17352 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17353 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17354 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17355
17356 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17357 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17358 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17359 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17360 @code{continue} command.
17361
17362 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17363 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17364 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17365 (@pxref{Signals}).
17366 @end table
17367 @c @end group
17368
17369 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17370 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17371
17372 @node Returning
17373 @section Returning from a Function
17374
17375 @table @code
17376 @cindex returning from a function
17377 @kindex return
17378 @item return
17379 @itemx return @var{expression}
17380 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17381 command. If you give an
17382 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17383 value.
17384 @end table
17385
17386 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17387 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17388 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17389 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17390
17391 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17392 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17393 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17394 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17395 of functions.
17396
17397 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17398 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17399 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17400 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17401 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17402
17403 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17404 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17405 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17406 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17407 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17408 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17409 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17410 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17411 assignment into the right register(s).
17412
17413 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17414 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17415 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17416 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17417 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17418 into a @code{long long int}:
17419
17420 @smallexample
17421 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17422 29 return 31;
17423 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17424 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17425 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17426 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17427 (@value{GDBP})
17428 @end smallexample
17429
17430 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17431 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17432 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17433 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17434 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17435 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17436 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17437 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17438
17439 @smallexample
17440 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17441 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17442 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17443 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17444 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17445 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17446 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17447 (@value{GDBP})
17448 @end smallexample
17449
17450 @node Calling
17451 @section Calling Program Functions
17452
17453 @table @code
17454 @cindex calling functions
17455 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17456 @item print @var{expr}
17457 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17458 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17459 debugged.
17460
17461 @kindex call
17462 @item call @var{expr}
17463 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17464 returned values.
17465
17466 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17467 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17468 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17469 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17470 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17471 value history.
17472 @end table
17473
17474 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17475 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17476 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17477 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17478
17479 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17480 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17481 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17482 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17483 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17484 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17485 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17486 in that case is controlled by the
17487 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17488
17489 @table @code
17490 @item set unwindonsignal
17491 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17492 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17493 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17494 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17495 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17496 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17497 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17498 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17499 received.
17500
17501 @item show unwindonsignal
17502 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17503 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17504 @value{GDBN}.
17505
17506 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17507 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17508 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17509 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17510 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17511 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17512 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17513 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17514 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17515 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17516
17517 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17518 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17519 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17520 @value{GDBN}.
17521
17522 @end table
17523
17524 @cindex weak alias functions
17525 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17526 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17527 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17528 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17529 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17530 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17531 function instead.
17532
17533 @node Patching
17534 @section Patching Programs
17535
17536 @cindex patching binaries
17537 @cindex writing into executables
17538 @cindex writing into corefiles
17539
17540 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17541 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17542 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17543 patching your program's binary.
17544
17545 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17546 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17547 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17548 repairs.
17549
17550 @table @code
17551 @kindex set write
17552 @item set write on
17553 @itemx set write off
17554 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17555 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17556 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17557
17558 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17559 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17560 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17561
17562 @item show write
17563 @kindex show write
17564 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17565 as well as reading.
17566 @end table
17567
17568 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17569 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17570 @cindex injecting code
17571 @cindex writing into executables
17572 @cindex compiling code
17573
17574 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17575 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17576 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17577 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17578
17579 @table @code
17580 @kindex compile code
17581 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17582 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17583 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17584 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17585 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17586 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17587 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17588 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17589 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17590 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17591 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17592 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17593
17594 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17595 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17596 E.g.:
17597
17598 @smallexample
17599 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17600 @end smallexample
17601
17602 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17603 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17604 from actual source code. E.g.:
17605
17606 @smallexample
17607 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17608 @end smallexample
17609
17610 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17611 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17612 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17613 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17614 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17615 editor.
17616
17617 @smallexample
17618 compile code
17619 >printf ("hello\n");
17620 >printf ("world\n");
17621 >end
17622 @end smallexample
17623
17624 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17625 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17626 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17627 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17628 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17629 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17630 inferior symbols otherwise.
17631
17632 @kindex compile file
17633 @item compile file @var{filename}
17634 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17635 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17636
17637 @smallexample
17638 compile file /home/user/example.c
17639 @end smallexample
17640 @end table
17641
17642 @table @code
17643 @item compile print @var{expr}
17644 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17645 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17646 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17647 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17648 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17649 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17650 Formats}.
17651
17652 @item compile print
17653 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17654 @cindex reprint the last value
17655 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17656 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17657 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17658 multiple-line editor.
17659 @end table
17660
17661 @noindent
17662 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17663
17664 @table @code
17665 @anchor{set debug compile}
17666 @item set debug compile
17667 @cindex compile command debugging info
17668 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17669 injecting the code. The default is off.
17670
17671 @item show debug compile
17672 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17673 compiling and injecting the code.
17674 @end table
17675
17676 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17677
17678 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17679 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17680 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17681 injecting process.
17682
17683 @noindent
17684 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17685
17686 @table @asis
17687 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17688 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17689 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17690 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17691
17692 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17693 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17694 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17695 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17696 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17697 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17698 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17699 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17700
17701 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17702 @end table
17703
17704 @noindent
17705 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17706
17707 @table @code
17708 @item set compile-args
17709 @cindex compile command options override
17710 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17711 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17712 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17713 compilation.
17714
17715 @item show compile-args
17716 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17717 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17718 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17719 @end table
17720
17721 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17722
17723 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17724 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17725 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17726
17727 @table @asis
17728 @item C code examples and caveats
17729 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17730 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17731 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17732 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17733 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17734
17735 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17736 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17737 much like any other normal debugging session.
17738
17739 @smallexample
17740 void function1 (void)
17741 @{
17742 int i = 42;
17743 printf ("function 1\n");
17744 @}
17745
17746 void function2 (void)
17747 @{
17748 int j = 12;
17749 function1 ();
17750 @}
17751
17752 int main(void)
17753 @{
17754 int k = 6;
17755 int *p;
17756 function2 ();
17757 return 0;
17758 @}
17759 @end smallexample
17760
17761 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17762 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17763 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17764
17765 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17766 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17767 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17768 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17769 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17770
17771 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17772 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17773 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17774 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17775 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17776 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17777 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17778 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17779 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17780 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17781
17782 @smallexample
17783 compile code k = 3;
17784 @end smallexample
17785
17786 @noindent
17787 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17788 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17789 @code{compile} command changes it.
17790
17791 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17792 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17793 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17794 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17795 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17796
17797 @smallexample
17798 compile code j = 3;
17799 @end smallexample
17800
17801 @noindent
17802 will result in a compilation error message.
17803
17804 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17805 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17806 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17807
17808 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17809 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17810 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17811 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17812
17813 @smallexample
17814 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17815 @end smallexample
17816
17817 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17818 command has completed:
17819
17820 @smallexample
17821 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17822 @end smallexample
17823
17824 @noindent
17825 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17826 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17827 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17828 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17829 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17830
17831 @smallexample
17832 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17833 @end smallexample
17834
17835 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17836 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17837 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17838 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17839 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17840 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17841 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17842 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17843
17844 @smallexample
17845 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17846 @end smallexample
17847
17848 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17849 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17850 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17851 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17852 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17853 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17854 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17855
17856 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17857 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17858 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17859 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17860 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17861 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17862
17863 @smallexample
17864 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17865 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17866 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17867 Compilation failed.
17868 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17869 42
17870 @end smallexample
17871
17872 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17873 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17874 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17875 will print to the console.
17876 @end table
17877
17878 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17879
17880 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17881 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17882 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17883 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17884 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17885 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17886 target architecture and operating system.
17887
17888 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17889 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17890 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17891 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17892 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17893 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17894 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17895
17896 @node GDB Files
17897 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17898
17899 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17900 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17901 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17902 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17903
17904 @menu
17905 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17906 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
17907 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17908 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17909 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17910 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17911 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17912 @end menu
17913
17914 @node Files
17915 @section Commands to Specify Files
17916
17917 @cindex symbol table
17918 @cindex core dump file
17919
17920 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17921 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17922 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17923 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17924
17925 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17926 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17927 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17928 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17929 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17930 new files are useful.
17931
17932 @table @code
17933 @cindex executable file
17934 @kindex file
17935 @item file @var{filename}
17936 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17937 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17938 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17939 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17940 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17941 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17942 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17943 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17944
17945 @cindex unlinked object files
17946 @cindex patching object files
17947 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17948 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17949 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17950 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17951 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17952 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17953 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17954 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17955
17956 @item file
17957 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17958 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17959
17960 @kindex exec-file
17961 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17962 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17963 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17964 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17965 discard information on the executable file.
17966
17967 @kindex symbol-file
17968 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17969 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17970 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17971 table and program to run from the same file.
17972
17973 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17974 program's symbol table.
17975
17976 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17977 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17978 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17979 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17980 @value{GDBN}.
17981
17982 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17983 executing it once.
17984
17985 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17986 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17987 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17988 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17989 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17990 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17991 optimized code.
17992
17993 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17994 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17995 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17996 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17997 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17998
17999 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18000 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18001 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18002 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18003 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18004 Warnings and Messages}.)
18005
18006 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18007 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18008 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18009 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18010 in stabs format.
18011
18012 @kindex readnow
18013 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18014 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18015 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18016 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18017 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18018 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18019 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18020 entire symbol table available.
18021
18022 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18023 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18024 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18025 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18026 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18027 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18028 @c files.
18029
18030 @kindex core-file
18031 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18032 @itemx core
18033 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18034 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18035 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18036 executable file itself for other parts.
18037
18038 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18039 to be used.
18040
18041 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18042 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18043 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18044 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18045 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18046
18047 @kindex add-symbol-file
18048 @cindex dynamic linking
18049 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18050 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18051 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18052 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18053 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18054 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18055 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18056 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18057 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18058 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18059 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18060 @var{address} as an expression.
18061
18062 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18063 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18064 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18065 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18066
18067 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18068
18069 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18070 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18071 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18072 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18073 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18074 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18075 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18076 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18077 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18078
18079 @itemize @bullet
18080 @item
18081 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18082 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18083 @item
18084 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18085 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18086 @item
18087 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18088 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18089 @end itemize
18090
18091 @noindent
18092 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18093 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18094 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18095 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18096 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18097 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18098 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18099 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18100 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18101 way.
18102
18103 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18104
18105 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18106 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18107 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18108 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18109 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18110 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18111
18112 @smallexample
18113 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18114 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18115 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18116 (y or n) y
18117 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18118 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18119 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18120 (gdb)
18121 @end smallexample
18122
18123
18124 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18125
18126 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18127 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18128 @cindex load symbols from memory
18129 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18130 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18131 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18132 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18133 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18134 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18135 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18136 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18137 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18138
18139 @kindex section
18140 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18141 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18142 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18143 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18144 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18145 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18146 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18147 their addresses.
18148
18149 @kindex info files
18150 @kindex info target
18151 @item info files
18152 @itemx info target
18153 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18154 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18155 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18156 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18157 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18158 current ones.
18159
18160 @kindex maint info sections
18161 @item maint info sections
18162 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18163 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18164 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18165 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18166 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18167 may be arbitrarily combined):
18168
18169 @table @code
18170 @item ALLOBJ
18171 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18172 @item @var{sections}
18173 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18174 @item @var{section-flags}
18175 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18176 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18177 @table @code
18178 @item ALLOC
18179 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18180 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18181 @item LOAD
18182 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18183 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18184 @item RELOC
18185 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18186 @item READONLY
18187 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18188 @item CODE
18189 Section contains executable code only.
18190 @item DATA
18191 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18192 @item ROM
18193 Section will reside in ROM.
18194 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18195 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18196 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18197 Section is not empty.
18198 @item NEVER_LOAD
18199 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18200 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18201 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18202 COFF shared library information.
18203 @item IS_COMMON
18204 Section contains common symbols.
18205 @end table
18206 @end table
18207 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18208 @cindex read-only sections
18209 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18210 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18211 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18212 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18213 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18214 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18215 enhancement to debugging performance.
18216
18217 The default is off.
18218
18219 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18220 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18221 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18222 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18223
18224 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18225 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18226 @end table
18227
18228 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18229 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18230 name and remembers it that way.
18231
18232 @cindex shared libraries
18233 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18234 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18235 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18236 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18237
18238 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18239 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18240
18241 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18242 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18243 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18244 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18245 debugging a core file).
18246
18247 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18248 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18249 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18250
18251 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18252 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18253 particularly large or there are many of them.
18254
18255 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18256 commands:
18257
18258 @table @code
18259 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18260 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18261 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18262 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18263 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18264 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18265 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18266 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18267
18268 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18269 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18270 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18271 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18272 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18273 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18274 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18275 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18276 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18277
18278 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18279 @item show auto-solib-add
18280 Display the current autoloading mode.
18281 @end table
18282
18283 @cindex load shared library
18284 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18285 command:
18286
18287 @table @code
18288 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18289 @kindex info share
18290 @item info share @var{regex}
18291 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18292 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18293 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18294 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18295
18296 @kindex info dll
18297 @item info dll @var{regex}
18298 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18299
18300 @kindex sharedlibrary
18301 @kindex share
18302 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18303 @itemx share @var{regex}
18304 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18305 Unix regular expression.
18306 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18307 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18308 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18309 loaded.
18310
18311 @item nosharedlibrary
18312 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18313 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18314 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18315 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18316 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18317 discarded.
18318 @end table
18319
18320 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18321 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18322 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18323 Catchpoints}).
18324
18325 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18326 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18327 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18328 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18329
18330 @table @code
18331 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18332 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18333 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18334 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18335 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18336 shared library.
18337
18338 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18339 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18340 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18341 library events happen.
18342 @end table
18343
18344 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18345 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18346 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18347 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18348 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18349 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18350 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18351 not.
18352
18353 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18354 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18355 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18356 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18357 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18358
18359 @table @code
18360 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18361 @cindex system root, alternate
18362 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18363 @kindex set sysroot
18364 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18365 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18366 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18367 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18368 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18369 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18370 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18371 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18372 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18373 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18374 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18375 @var{path}.
18376
18377 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18378 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18379 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18380 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18381 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18382 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18383 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18384 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18385 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18386 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18387 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18388 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18389 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18390 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18391
18392 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18393 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18394 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18395 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18396 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18397
18398 @smallexample
18399 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18400 @end smallexample
18401
18402 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18403 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18404 system:
18405
18406 @smallexample
18407 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18408 @end smallexample
18409
18410 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18411 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18412 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18413 colons:
18414
18415 @smallexample
18416 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18417 @end smallexample
18418
18419 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18420 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18421 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18422 @samp{z}):
18423
18424 @smallexample
18425 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18426 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18427 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18428 @end smallexample
18429
18430 @noindent
18431 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18432 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18433 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18434
18435 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18436 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18437
18438 @smallexample
18439 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18440 @end smallexample
18441
18442 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18443 if you don't want or need to.
18444
18445 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18446 sysroot}.
18447
18448 @cindex default system root
18449 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18450 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18451 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18452 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18453 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18454 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18455 location.
18456
18457 @kindex show sysroot
18458 @item show sysroot
18459 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18460
18461 @kindex set solib-search-path
18462 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18463 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18464 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18465 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18466 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18467 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18468 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18469 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18470 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18471 of shared library symbols.
18472
18473 @kindex show solib-search-path
18474 @item show solib-search-path
18475 Display the current shared library search path.
18476
18477 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18478 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18479 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18480 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18481 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18482
18483 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18484 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18485 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18486 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18487 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18488 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18489 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18490 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18491 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18492 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18493 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18494 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18495 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18496 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18497 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18498 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18499 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18500 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18501 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18502 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18503 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18504 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18505
18506 @table @code
18507 @item unix
18508 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18509 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18510 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18511 the forward slash.
18512
18513 @item dos-based
18514 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18515 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18516 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18517 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18518 considered directory separators.
18519
18520 @item auto
18521 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18522 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18523 This is the default.
18524 @end table
18525 @end table
18526
18527 @cindex file name canonicalization
18528 @cindex base name differences
18529 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18530 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18531 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18532 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18533 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18534 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18535 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18536 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18537 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18538 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18539 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18540 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18541 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18542 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18543 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18544
18545 @table @code
18546 @item set basenames-may-differ
18547 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18548 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18549
18550 @item show basenames-may-differ
18551 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18552 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18553 @end table
18554
18555 @node File Caching
18556 @section File Caching
18557 @cindex caching of opened files
18558 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18559
18560 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18561 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18562 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18563 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18564
18565 @table @code
18566 @kindex maint info bfds
18567 @item maint info bfds
18568 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18569 @value{GDBN}.
18570
18571 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18572 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18573 @kindex bfd caching
18574 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18575 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18576 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18577 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18578 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18579 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18580 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18581 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18582 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18583
18584 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18585 @kindex bfd caching
18586 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18587 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18588
18589 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18590 @kindex bfd caching
18591 @item show debug bfd-cache
18592 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18593 @end table
18594
18595 @node Separate Debug Files
18596 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18597 @cindex separate debugging information files
18598 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18599 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18600 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18601 @cindex global debugging information directories
18602 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18603 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18604
18605 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18606 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18607 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18608 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18609 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18610 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18611 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18612
18613 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18614 file:
18615
18616 @itemize @bullet
18617 @item
18618 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18619 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18620 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18621 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18622 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18623 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18624 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18625 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18626
18627 @item
18628 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18629 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18630 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18631 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18632 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18633 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18634 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18635 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18636 below.
18637 @end itemize
18638
18639 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18640 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18641
18642 @itemize @bullet
18643 @item
18644 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18645 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18646 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18647 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18648 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18649
18650 @item
18651 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18652 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18653 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18654 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18655 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18656 hex characters, not 10.)
18657 @end itemize
18658
18659 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18660 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18661 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18662 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18663 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18664 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18665
18666 @itemize @minus
18667 @item
18668 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18669 @item
18670 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18671 @item
18672 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18673 @item
18674 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18675 @end itemize
18676
18677 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18678 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18679 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18680 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18681 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18682
18683 @table @code
18684
18685 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18686 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18687 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18688 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18689 concatenating them by a path separator.
18690
18691 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18692 @item show debug-file-directory
18693 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18694 information files.
18695
18696 @end table
18697
18698 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18699 @cindex debug link sections
18700 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18701 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18702
18703 @itemize
18704 @item
18705 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18706 a zero byte,
18707 @item
18708 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18709 boundary within the section, and
18710 @item
18711 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18712 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18713 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18714 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18715 @end itemize
18716
18717 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18718 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18719 described above.
18720
18721 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18722 @cindex build ID sections
18723 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18724 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18725 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18726 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18727 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18728 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18729 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18730 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18731 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18732
18733 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18734 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18735 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18736 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18737 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18738 in an ordinary executable.
18739
18740 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18741 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18742 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18743 following commands:
18744
18745 @smallexample
18746 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18747 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18748 @end smallexample
18749
18750 @noindent
18751 These commands remove the debugging
18752 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18753 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18754 two files:
18755
18756 @itemize @bullet
18757 @item
18758 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18759 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18760
18761 @smallexample
18762 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18763 @end smallexample
18764
18765 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18766 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18767 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18768 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18769
18770 @item
18771 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18772 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18773 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18774 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18775 @end itemize
18776
18777 @noindent
18778
18779 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18780 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18781 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18782
18783 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18784 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18785 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18786 @c different ways!
18787 @ifhtml
18788 @display
18789 @html
18790 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18791 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18792 @end html
18793 @end display
18794 @end ifhtml
18795 @ifnothtml
18796 @display
18797 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18798 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18799 @end display
18800 @end ifnothtml
18801
18802 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18803 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18804 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18805 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18806 CRC.
18807
18808 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18809 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18810 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18811 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18812 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18813
18814 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18815 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18816 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18817 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18818 @code{0xffffffff}.
18819
18820 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18821 @smallexample
18822 unsigned long
18823 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18824 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18825 @{
18826 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18827 @{
18828 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18829 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18830 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18831 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18832 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18833 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18834 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18835 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18836 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18837 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18838 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18839 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18840 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18841 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18842 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18843 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18844 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18845 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18846 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18847 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18848 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18849 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18850 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18851 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18852 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18853 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18854 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18855 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18856 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18857 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18858 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18859 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18860 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18861 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18862 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18863 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18864 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18865 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18866 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18867 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18868 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18869 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18870 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18871 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18872 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18873 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18874 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18875 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18876 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18877 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18878 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18879 0x2d02ef8d
18880 @};
18881 unsigned char *end;
18882
18883 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18884 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18885 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18886 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18887 @}
18888 @end smallexample
18889
18890 @noindent
18891 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18892
18893 @node MiniDebugInfo
18894 @section Debugging information in a special section
18895 @cindex separate debug sections
18896 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18897
18898 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18899 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18900 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18901 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18902
18903 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18904 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18905 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18906 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18907 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18908 debugging information might be included in the section.
18909
18910 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18911 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18912 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18913
18914 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18915 standard utilities:
18916
18917 @smallexample
18918 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18919 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18920 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18921 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18922
18923 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18924 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18925 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18926 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18927 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18928 | sort > funcsyms
18929
18930 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18931 # table.
18932 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18933
18934 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18935 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18936
18937 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18938 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18939 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18940 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18941
18942 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18943 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18944
18945 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18946 # original binary.
18947 xz mini_debuginfo
18948 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18949 @end smallexample
18950
18951 @node Index Files
18952 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18953 @cindex index files
18954 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18955
18956 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18957 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18958 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18959 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18960 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18961 startup.
18962
18963 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18964 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18965 using @command{objcopy}.
18966
18967 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18968
18969 @table @code
18970 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18971 @kindex save gdb-index
18972 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18973 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18974 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18975 @var{directory}.
18976 @end table
18977
18978 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18979 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18980
18981 @smallexample
18982 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18983 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18984 @end smallexample
18985
18986 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18987 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18988 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18989 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18990 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18991 The default is @code{off}.
18992 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18993 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18994
18995 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18996 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18997
18998 @smallexample
18999 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19000 @end smallexample
19001
19002 Instead you must do, for example,
19003
19004 @smallexample
19005 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19006 @end smallexample
19007
19008 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19009 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19010 currently work for programs using Ada.
19011
19012 @node Symbol Errors
19013 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19014
19015 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19016 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19017 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19018 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19019 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19020 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19021 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19022 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19023 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19024 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19025 Messages}).
19026
19027 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19028
19029 @table @code
19030 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19031
19032 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19033 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19034 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19035 in its outer scope blocks.
19036
19037 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19038 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19039 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19040 function.
19041
19042 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19043
19044 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19045 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19046 do so.
19047
19048 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19049 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19050 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19051 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19052 Messages}.)
19053
19054 @item bad block start address patched
19055
19056 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19057 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19058 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19059
19060 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19061 starting on the previous source line.
19062
19063 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19064
19065 @cindex foo
19066 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19067 larger than the size of the string table.
19068
19069 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19070 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19071 with this name.
19072
19073 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19074
19075 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19076 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19077 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19078
19079 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19080 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19081 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19082 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19083 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19084 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19085
19086 @item stub type has NULL name
19087
19088 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19089
19090 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19091 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19092 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19093 it.
19094
19095 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19096
19097 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19098
19099 @end table
19100
19101 @node Data Files
19102 @section GDB Data Files
19103
19104 @cindex prefix for data files
19105 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19106 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19107
19108 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19109 is currently using.
19110
19111 @table @code
19112 @kindex set data-directory
19113 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19114 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19115 to @var{directory}.
19116
19117 @kindex show data-directory
19118 @item show data-directory
19119 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19120 @end table
19121
19122 @cindex default data directory
19123 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19124 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19125 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19126 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19127 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19128 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19129 location.
19130
19131 The data directory may also be specified with the
19132 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19133 @xref{Mode Options}.
19134
19135 @node Targets
19136 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19137
19138 @cindex debugging target
19139 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19140
19141 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19142 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19143 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19144 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19145 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19146 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19147 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19148 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19149
19150 @cindex target architecture
19151 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19152 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19153 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19154 command.
19155
19156 @table @code
19157 @kindex set architecture
19158 @kindex show architecture
19159 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19160 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19161 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19162 supported architectures.
19163
19164 @item show architecture
19165 Show the current target architecture.
19166
19167 @item set processor
19168 @itemx processor
19169 @kindex set processor
19170 @kindex show processor
19171 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19172 and @code{show architecture}.
19173 @end table
19174
19175 @menu
19176 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19177 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19178 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19179 @end menu
19180
19181 @node Active Targets
19182 @section Active Targets
19183
19184 @cindex stacking targets
19185 @cindex active targets
19186 @cindex multiple targets
19187
19188 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19189 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19190 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19191 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19192 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19193 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19194 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19195 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19196 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19197
19198 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19199 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19200 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19201 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19202
19203 @node Target Commands
19204 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19205
19206 @table @code
19207 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19208 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19209 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19210 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19211 protocol of the target machine.
19212
19213 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19214 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19215 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19216
19217 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19218 after executing the command.
19219
19220 @kindex help target
19221 @item help target
19222 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19223 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19224 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19225
19226 @item help target @var{name}
19227 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19228 select it.
19229
19230 @kindex set gnutarget
19231 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19232 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19233 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19234 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19235 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19236 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19237
19238 @quotation
19239 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19240 you must know the actual BFD name.
19241 @end quotation
19242
19243 @noindent
19244 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19245
19246 @kindex show gnutarget
19247 @item show gnutarget
19248 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19249 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19250 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19251 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19252 @end table
19253
19254 @cindex common targets
19255 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19256 configuration):
19257
19258 @table @code
19259 @kindex target
19260 @item target exec @var{program}
19261 @cindex executable file target
19262 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19263 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19264
19265 @item target core @var{filename}
19266 @cindex core dump file target
19267 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19268 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19269
19270 @item target remote @var{medium}
19271 @cindex remote target
19272 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19273 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19274 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19275
19276 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19277 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19278
19279 @smallexample
19280 target remote /dev/ttya
19281 @end smallexample
19282
19283 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19284 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19285 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19286 clobbered by the download.
19287
19288 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19289 @cindex built-in simulator target
19290 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19291 In general,
19292 @smallexample
19293 target sim
19294 load
19295 run
19296 @end smallexample
19297 @noindent
19298 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19299 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19300 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19301 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19302 Processors}.
19303
19304 @item target native
19305 @cindex native target
19306 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19307 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19308 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19309 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19310
19311 @end table
19312
19313 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19314 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19315
19316 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19317 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19318 various aspects of this process.
19319
19320 @table @code
19321
19322 @item set hash
19323 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19324 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19325 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19326 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19327 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19328 monitor.
19329
19330 @item show hash
19331 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19332 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19333
19334 @item set debug monitor
19335 @kindex set debug monitor
19336 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19337 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19338 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19339
19340 @item show debug monitor
19341 @kindex show debug monitor
19342 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19343 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19344 @end table
19345
19346 @table @code
19347
19348 @kindex load @var{filename}
19349 @item load @var{filename}
19350 @anchor{load}
19351 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19352 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19353 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19354 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19355 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19356 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19357
19358 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19359 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19360 target is @dots{}}''
19361
19362 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19363 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19364 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19365 specifies a fixed address.
19366 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19367
19368 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19369 load programs into flash memory.
19370
19371 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19372 @end table
19373
19374 @node Byte Order
19375 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19376
19377 @cindex choosing target byte order
19378 @cindex target byte order
19379
19380 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19381 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19382 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19383 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19384 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19385 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19386
19387 @table @code
19388 @kindex set endian
19389 @item set endian big
19390 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19391
19392 @item set endian little
19393 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19394
19395 @item set endian auto
19396 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19397 executable.
19398
19399 @item show endian
19400 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19401
19402 @end table
19403
19404 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19405 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19406 target system.
19407
19408
19409 @node Remote Debugging
19410 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19411 @cindex remote debugging
19412
19413 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19414 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19415 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19416 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19417 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19418
19419 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19420 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19421 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19422 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19423 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19424 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19425
19426 Other remote targets may be available in your
19427 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19428
19429 @menu
19430 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19431 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19432 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19433 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19434 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19435 @end menu
19436
19437 @node Connecting
19438 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19439 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19440 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19441 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19442 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19443 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19444 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19445
19446 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19447 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19448 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19449 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19450
19451 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19452
19453 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19454 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19455 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19456 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19457
19458 @table @asis
19459
19460 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19461 @item Result of detach or program exit
19462 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19463 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19464 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19465
19466 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19467 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19468 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19469 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19470
19471 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19472 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19473 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19474 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19475
19476 @item Specifying the program to debug
19477 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19478 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19479 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19480 target.
19481
19482 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19483 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19484 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19485
19486 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19487 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19488 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19489 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19490
19491 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19492 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19493 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19494 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19495 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19496 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19497 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19498 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19499 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19500
19501 @item The @code{run} command
19502 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19503 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19504 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19505 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19506 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19507
19508 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19509 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19510 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19511 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19512 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19513
19514 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19515 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19516 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19517 @code{target remote} mode.
19518
19519 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19520 @item Attaching
19521 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19522 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19523 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19524
19525 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19526 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19527 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19528 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19529 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19530
19531 @end table
19532
19533 @anchor{Host and target files}
19534 @subsection Host and Target Files
19535 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19536 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19537
19538 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19539 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19540 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19541 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19542 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19543
19544 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19545 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19546 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19547 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19548 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19549
19550 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19551 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19552 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19553 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19554 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19555 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19556 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19557 target libraries.
19558
19559 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19560 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19561 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19562 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19563 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19564 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19565 programs.
19566
19567 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19568 @cindex remote connection commands
19569 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19570 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19571 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19572 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19573 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19574 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19575 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19576
19577 @table @code
19578
19579 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19580 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19581 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19582 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19583 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19584
19585 @smallexample
19586 target remote /dev/ttyb
19587 @end smallexample
19588
19589 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19590 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19591 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19592 @code{target} command.
19593
19594 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19595 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19596 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19597 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19598 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19599 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19600 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19601 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19602 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19603 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19604 target.
19605
19606 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19607 @code{manyfarms}:
19608
19609 @smallexample
19610 target remote manyfarms:2828
19611 @end smallexample
19612
19613 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19614 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19615 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19616 port 1234 on your local machine:
19617
19618 @smallexample
19619 target remote :1234
19620 @end smallexample
19621 @noindent
19622
19623 Note that the colon is still required here.
19624
19625 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19626 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19627 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19628 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19629 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19630
19631 @smallexample
19632 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19633 @end smallexample
19634
19635 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19636 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19637 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19638 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19639
19640 @item target remote | @var{command}
19641 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19642 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19643 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19644 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19645 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19646 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19647 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19648 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19649 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19650
19651 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19652 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19653 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19654
19655 @end table
19656
19657 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19658 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19659 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19660 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19661 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19662 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19663 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19664
19665 @smallexample
19666 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19667 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19668 @end smallexample
19669
19670 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19671 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19672 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19673 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19674
19675 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19676 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19677
19678 @table @code
19679 @kindex detach (remote)
19680 @item detach
19681 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19682 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19683 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19684 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19685 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19686 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19687 still connected to the target.
19688
19689 @kindex disconnect
19690 @item disconnect
19691 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19692 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19693 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19694 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19695 another target.
19696
19697 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19698 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19699 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19700 @kindex monitor
19701 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19702 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19703 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19704 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19705 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19706 and implement.
19707 @end table
19708
19709 @node File Transfer
19710 @section Sending files to a remote system
19711 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19712 @cindex file transfer
19713 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19714
19715 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19716 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19717 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19718 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19719 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19720 the only way to upload or download files.
19721
19722 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19723
19724 @table @code
19725 @kindex remote put
19726 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19727 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19728 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19729
19730 @kindex remote get
19731 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19732 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19733 on the host system.
19734
19735 @kindex remote delete
19736 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19737 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19738
19739 @end table
19740
19741 @node Server
19742 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19743
19744 @kindex gdbserver
19745 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19746 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19747 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19748 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19749 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19750
19751 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19752 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19753 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19754 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19755 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19756 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19757 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19758 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19759 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19760 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19761 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19762 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19763 choice for debugging.
19764
19765 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19766 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19767 protocol.
19768
19769 @quotation
19770 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19771 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19772 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19773 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19774 @code{gdbserver}.
19775 @end quotation
19776
19777 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
19778 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19779 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19780 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19781
19782 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19783 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19784 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19785 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19786 system does all the symbol handling.
19787
19788 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19789 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19790 syntax is:
19791
19792 @smallexample
19793 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19794 @end smallexample
19795
19796 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19797 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19798 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19799 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19800 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19801 @file{/dev/com1}:
19802
19803 @smallexample
19804 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19805 @end smallexample
19806
19807 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19808 with it.
19809
19810 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19811
19812 @smallexample
19813 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19814 @end smallexample
19815
19816 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19817 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19818 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19819 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19820 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19821 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19822 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19823 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19824 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19825 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19826 @code{target remote} command.
19827
19828 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19829 with ssh:
19830
19831 @smallexample
19832 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19833 @end smallexample
19834
19835 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19836 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19837 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19838 You could elide it if you want to.
19839
19840 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19841 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19842 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19843 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19844
19845 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
19846 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19847 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19848 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19849
19850 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19851 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19852
19853 @smallexample
19854 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19855 @end smallexample
19856
19857 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
19858 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19859
19860 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
19861 @value{GDBN} attach command
19862 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
19863
19864 @pindex pidof
19865 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19866 @code{pidof} utility:
19867
19868 @smallexample
19869 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19870 @end smallexample
19871
19872 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19873 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19874 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19875
19876 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19877
19878 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
19879 port.
19880
19881 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19882 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19883 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19884 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19885 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19886 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19887 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19888 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19889
19890 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19891 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19892 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19893
19894 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19895 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19896 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19897 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19898 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19899 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19900 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19901 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19902 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19903 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19904 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19905 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19906
19907 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19908 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19909
19910 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
19911 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
19912 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
19913 program. For more information,
19914 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
19915
19916 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19917 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19918 status information about the debugging process.
19919 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19920 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19921 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19922 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19923
19924 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19925 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19926 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19927 Possible options are:
19928
19929 @table @code
19930 @item none
19931 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19932 @item all
19933 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19934 @item timestamps
19935 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19936 @end table
19937
19938 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19939 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19940
19941 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19942 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19943 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19944 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19945 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19946
19947 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19948 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19949 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19950 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19951
19952 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19953 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19954 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19955 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19956
19957 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19958 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19959 environment:
19960
19961 @smallexample
19962 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19963 @end smallexample
19964
19965 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19966
19967 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
19968 @itemize
19969
19970 @item
19971 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19972
19973 @item
19974 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
19975 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
19976 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
19977 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
19978 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
19979 @code{--with-sysroot}).
19980
19981 @item
19982 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19983 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19984 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19985 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19986 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19987 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
19988 program is already on the target.
19989
19990 @end itemize
19991
19992 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19993 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19994 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19995
19996 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19997 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19998 Here are the available commands.
19999
20000 @table @code
20001 @item monitor help
20002 List the available monitor commands.
20003
20004 @item monitor set debug 0
20005 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20006 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20007
20008 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20009 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20010 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20011 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20012
20013 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20014 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20015 Possible options are:
20016
20017 @table @code
20018 @item none
20019 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20020 @item all
20021 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20022 @item timestamps
20023 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20024 @end table
20025
20026 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20027 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20028
20029 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20030 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20031 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20032 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20033 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20034 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20035
20036 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20037 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20038
20039 @item monitor exit
20040 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20041 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20042 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20043 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20044 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20045
20046 @end table
20047
20048 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20049 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20050
20051 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20052 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20053
20054 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20055 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20056 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20057 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20058 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20059 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20060 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20061 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20062 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20063 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20064 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20065 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20066
20067 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20068
20069 @table @code
20070 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20071
20072 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20073 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20074 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20075
20076 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20077
20078 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20079 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20080 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20081 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20082 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20083 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20084
20085 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20086
20087 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20088 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20089 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20090 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20091 command for that. For example:
20092
20093 @smallexample
20094 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20095 @end smallexample
20096
20097 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20098 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20099 @end table
20100
20101 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20102 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20103 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20104 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20105 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20106 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20107 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20108 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20109 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20110 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20111
20112 @smallexample
20113 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20114 @end smallexample
20115
20116 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20117
20118 @smallexample
20119 $ gdb myprogram
20120 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20121 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20122 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20123 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20124 @end smallexample
20125
20126 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20127 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20128 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20129 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20130 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20131 tracing.
20132
20133 @node Remote Configuration
20134 @section Remote Configuration
20135
20136 @kindex set remote
20137 @kindex show remote
20138 This section documents the configuration options available when
20139 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20140 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20141 system-call-allowed}.
20142
20143 @table @code
20144 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20145 @cindex address size for remote targets
20146 @cindex bits in remote address
20147 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20148 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20149 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20150 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20151
20152 @item show remoteaddresssize
20153 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20154
20155 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20156 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20157 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20158 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20159 remote targets.
20160
20161 @item show serial baud
20162 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20163
20164 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20165 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20166 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20167
20168 @item show serial parity
20169 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20170
20171 @item set remotebreak
20172 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20173 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20174 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20175 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20176 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20177 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20178 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20179 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20180
20181 @item show remotebreak
20182 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20183 interrupt the remote program.
20184
20185 @item set remoteflow on
20186 @itemx set remoteflow off
20187 @kindex set remoteflow
20188 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20189 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20190
20191 @item show remoteflow
20192 @kindex show remoteflow
20193 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20194
20195 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20196 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20197 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20198 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20199 @code{ascii}.
20200
20201 @item show remotelogbase
20202 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20203 protocol.
20204
20205 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20206 @cindex record serial communications on file
20207 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20208 default is not to record at all.
20209
20210 @item show remotelogfile.
20211 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20212 serial communications.
20213
20214 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20215 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20216 @cindex remote timeout
20217 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20218 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20219
20220 @item show remotetimeout
20221 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20222 responses.
20223
20224 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20225 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20226 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20227 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20228 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20229 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20230 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20231 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20232
20233 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20234 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20235 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20236 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20237 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20238 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20239 as unlimited.
20240
20241 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20242 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20243 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20244
20245 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20246 @itemx show remote exec-file
20247 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20248 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20249 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20250 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20251 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20252 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20253
20254 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20255 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20256 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20257 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20258 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20259 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20260 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20261 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20262 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20263 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20264
20265 @item show interrupt-sequence
20266 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20267 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20268 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20269 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20270
20271 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20272 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20273 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20274 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20275 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20276 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20277
20278 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20279 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20280 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20281
20282 @kindex set tcp
20283 @kindex show tcp
20284 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20285 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20286 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20287 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20288 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20289 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20290 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20291 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20292 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20293
20294 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20295 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20296
20297 @item show tcp auto-retry
20298 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20299
20300 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20301 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20302 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20303 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20304 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20305 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20306 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20307 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20308 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20309 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20310 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20311
20312 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20313 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20314 @end table
20315
20316 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20317 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20318 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20319 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20320 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20321 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20322 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20323 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20324 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20325
20326 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20327 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20328 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20329 @value{GDBN} developers.
20330
20331 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20332 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20333 are:
20334
20335 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20336 @item Command Name
20337 @tab Remote Packet
20338 @tab Related Features
20339
20340 @item @code{fetch-register}
20341 @tab @code{p}
20342 @tab @code{info registers}
20343
20344 @item @code{set-register}
20345 @tab @code{P}
20346 @tab @code{set}
20347
20348 @item @code{binary-download}
20349 @tab @code{X}
20350 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20351
20352 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20353 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20354 @tab @code{info auxv}
20355
20356 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20357 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20358 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20359
20360 @item @code{attach}
20361 @tab @code{vAttach}
20362 @tab @code{attach}
20363
20364 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20365 @tab @code{vCont}
20366 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20367
20368 @item @code{run}
20369 @tab @code{vRun}
20370 @tab @code{run}
20371
20372 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20373 @tab @code{Z0}
20374 @tab @code{break}
20375
20376 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20377 @tab @code{Z1}
20378 @tab @code{hbreak}
20379
20380 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20381 @tab @code{Z2}
20382 @tab @code{watch}
20383
20384 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20385 @tab @code{Z3}
20386 @tab @code{rwatch}
20387
20388 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20389 @tab @code{Z4}
20390 @tab @code{awatch}
20391
20392 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20393 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20394 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20395
20396 @item @code{target-features}
20397 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20398 @tab @code{set architecture}
20399
20400 @item @code{library-info}
20401 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20402 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20403
20404 @item @code{memory-map}
20405 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20406 @tab @code{info mem}
20407
20408 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20409 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20410 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20411
20412 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20413 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20414 @tab @code{info spu}
20415
20416 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20417 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20418 @tab @code{info spu}
20419
20420 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20421 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20422 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20423
20424 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20425 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20426 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20427
20428 @item @code{threads}
20429 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20430 @tab @code{info threads}
20431
20432 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20433 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20434 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20435
20436 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20437 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20438 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20439
20440 @item @code{search-memory}
20441 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20442 @tab @code{find}
20443
20444 @item @code{supported-packets}
20445 @tab @code{qSupported}
20446 @tab Remote communications parameters
20447
20448 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20449 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20450 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20451
20452 @item @code{pass-signals}
20453 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20454 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20455
20456 @item @code{program-signals}
20457 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20458 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20459
20460 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20461 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20462 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20463
20464 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20465 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20466 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20467
20468 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20469 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20470 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20471
20472 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20473 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20474 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20475
20476 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20477 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20478 @tab @code{remote delete}
20479
20480 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20481 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20482 @tab Host I/O
20483
20484 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20485 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20486 @tab Host I/O
20487
20488 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20489 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20490 @tab Host I/O
20491
20492 @item @code{noack-packet}
20493 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20494 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20495
20496 @item @code{osdata}
20497 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20498 @tab @code{info os}
20499
20500 @item @code{query-attached}
20501 @tab @code{qAttached}
20502 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20503
20504 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20505 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20506 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20507
20508 @item @code{trace-status}
20509 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20510 @tab @code{tstatus}
20511
20512 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20513 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20514 @tab Traceframe info
20515
20516 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20517 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20518 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20519
20520 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20521 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20522 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20523
20524 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20525 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20526 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20527
20528 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20529 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20530 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20531
20532 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20533 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20534 @tab @code{break}
20535
20536 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20537 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20538 @tab @code{hbreak}
20539
20540 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20541 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20542 @tab @code{fork}
20543
20544 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20545 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20546 @tab @code{vfork}
20547
20548 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20549 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20550 @tab @code{exec}
20551
20552 @item @code{thread-events}
20553 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20554 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20555
20556 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20557 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20558 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20559
20560 @end multitable
20561
20562 @node Remote Stub
20563 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20564
20565 @cindex debugging stub, example
20566 @cindex remote stub, example
20567 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20568 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20569 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20570 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20571 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20572 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20573 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20574 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20575
20576 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20577 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20578 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20579 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20580 program, you need:
20581
20582 @enumerate
20583 @item
20584 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20585 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20586 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20587
20588 @item
20589 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20590 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20591
20592 @item
20593 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20594 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20595 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20596 documentation.
20597 @end enumerate
20598
20599 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20600 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20601 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20602
20603 @table @emph
20604 @item On the host,
20605 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20606 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20607 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20608
20609 @item On the target,
20610 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20611 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20612 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20613
20614 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20615 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20616 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20617 @end table
20618
20619 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20620 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20621 @sc{sparc} boards.
20622
20623 @cindex remote serial stub list
20624 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20625
20626 @table @code
20627
20628 @item i386-stub.c
20629 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20630 @cindex Intel
20631 @cindex i386
20632 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20633
20634 @item m68k-stub.c
20635 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20636 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20637 @cindex m680x0
20638 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20639
20640 @item sh-stub.c
20641 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20642 @cindex Renesas
20643 @cindex SH
20644 For Renesas SH architectures.
20645
20646 @item sparc-stub.c
20647 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20648 @cindex Sparc
20649 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20650
20651 @item sparcl-stub.c
20652 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20653 @cindex Fujitsu
20654 @cindex SparcLite
20655 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20656
20657 @end table
20658
20659 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20660 recently added stubs.
20661
20662 @menu
20663 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20664 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20665 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20666 @end menu
20667
20668 @node Stub Contents
20669 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20670
20671 @cindex remote serial stub
20672 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20673 subroutines:
20674
20675 @table @code
20676 @item set_debug_traps
20677 @findex set_debug_traps
20678 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20679 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20680 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20681 program's startup code.
20682
20683 @item handle_exception
20684 @findex handle_exception
20685 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20686 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20687 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20688 run when a trap is triggered.
20689
20690 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20691 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20692 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20693 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20694 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20695 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20696 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20697 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20698 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20699 machine.
20700
20701 @item breakpoint
20702 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20703 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20704 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20705 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20706 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20707 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20708 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20709 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20710 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20711 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20712 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20713
20714 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20715 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20716 start of your debugging session.
20717 @end table
20718
20719 @node Bootstrapping
20720 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20721
20722 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20723 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20724 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20725 debugging target machine.
20726
20727 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20728 serial port.
20729
20730 @table @code
20731 @item int getDebugChar()
20732 @findex getDebugChar
20733 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20734 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20735 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20736
20737 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20738 @findex putDebugChar
20739 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20740 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20741 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20742 @end table
20743
20744 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20745 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20746 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20747 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20748 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20749 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20750 remote system to stop.
20751
20752 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20753 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20754 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20755 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20756
20757 Other routines you need to supply are:
20758
20759 @table @code
20760 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20761 @findex exceptionHandler
20762 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20763 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20764 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20765 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20766 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20767 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20768 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20769 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20770 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20771 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20772 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20773 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20774 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20775
20776 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20777 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20778 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20779 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20780 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20781
20782 @item void flush_i_cache()
20783 @findex flush_i_cache
20784 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20785 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20786 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20787
20788 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20789 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20790 @end table
20791
20792 @noindent
20793 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20794
20795 @table @code
20796 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20797 @findex memset
20798 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20799 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20800 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20801 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20802 @end table
20803
20804 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20805 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20806 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20807 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20808
20809
20810 @node Debug Session
20811 @subsection Putting it All Together
20812
20813 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20814 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20815 steps.
20816
20817 @enumerate
20818 @item
20819 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20820 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20821 @display
20822 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20823 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20824 @end display
20825
20826 @item
20827 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20828 procedure is called:
20829
20830 @smallexample
20831 set_debug_traps();
20832 breakpoint();
20833 @end smallexample
20834
20835 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20836 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20837 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20838 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20839 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20840 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20841 progress.
20842
20843 @item
20844 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20845 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20846
20847 @smallexample
20848 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20849 @end smallexample
20850
20851 @noindent
20852 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20853 function in your program, that function is called when
20854 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20855 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20856 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20857
20858 @item
20859 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20860 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20861
20862 @item
20863 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20864 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20865
20866 @item
20867 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20868 @c document that. FIXME.
20869 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20870 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20871
20872 @item
20873 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20874 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20875
20876 @end enumerate
20877
20878 @node Configurations
20879 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20880
20881 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20882 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20883 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20884
20885 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20886 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20887 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20888 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20889 are quite different from each other.
20890
20891 @menu
20892 * Native::
20893 * Embedded OS::
20894 * Embedded Processors::
20895 * Architectures::
20896 @end menu
20897
20898 @node Native
20899 @section Native
20900
20901 This section describes details specific to particular native
20902 configurations.
20903
20904 @menu
20905 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20906 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20907 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20908 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20909 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20910 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20911 @end menu
20912
20913 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20914 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20915
20916 @cindex libkvm
20917 @cindex kernel memory image
20918 @cindex kernel crash dump
20919
20920 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20921 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20922 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20923 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20924 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20925 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20926 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20927 @code{kvm} target:
20928
20929 @smallexample
20930 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20931 @end smallexample
20932
20933 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20934 argument:
20935
20936 @smallexample
20937 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20938 @end smallexample
20939
20940 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20941 available:
20942
20943 @table @code
20944 @kindex kvm
20945 @item kvm pcb
20946 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20947
20948 @item kvm proc
20949 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20950 modern FreeBSD systems.
20951 @end table
20952
20953 @node SVR4 Process Information
20954 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20955 @cindex /proc
20956 @cindex examine process image
20957 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20958
20959 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20960 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20961 process using file-system subroutines.
20962
20963 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20964 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20965 information about the process running your program, or about any
20966 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20967 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
20968
20969 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20970 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20971
20972 @table @code
20973 @kindex info proc
20974 @cindex process ID
20975 @item info proc
20976 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20977 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20978 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20979 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20980 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20981 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20982 executable file's absolute file name.
20983
20984 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20985 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20986 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20987 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20988 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20989 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20990
20991 @item info proc cmdline
20992 @cindex info proc cmdline
20993 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20994 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20995
20996 @item info proc cwd
20997 @cindex info proc cwd
20998 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20999 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21000
21001 @item info proc exe
21002 @cindex info proc exe
21003 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21004 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21005
21006 @item info proc mappings
21007 @cindex memory address space mappings
21008 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21009 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21010 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21011 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21012 memory access rights to that range.
21013
21014 @item info proc stat
21015 @itemx info proc status
21016 @cindex process detailed status information
21017 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21018 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21019 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21020 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21021 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21022 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21023 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21024
21025 @item info proc all
21026 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21027 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21028
21029 @ignore
21030 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21031 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21032 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21033 @kindex info proc times
21034 @item info proc times
21035 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21036 its children.
21037
21038 @kindex info proc id
21039 @item info proc id
21040 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21041 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21042 @end ignore
21043
21044 @item set procfs-trace
21045 @kindex set procfs-trace
21046 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21047 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21048
21049 @item show procfs-trace
21050 @kindex show procfs-trace
21051 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21052
21053 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21054 @kindex set procfs-file
21055 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21056 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21057 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21058 standard output.
21059
21060 @item show procfs-file
21061 @kindex show procfs-file
21062 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21063
21064 @item proc-trace-entry
21065 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21066 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21067 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21068 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21069 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21070 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21071 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21072 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21073 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21074
21075 @item info pidlist
21076 @kindex info pidlist
21077 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21078 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21079 processes and all the threads within each process.
21080
21081 @item info meminfo
21082 @kindex info meminfo
21083 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21084 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21085 @end table
21086
21087 @node DJGPP Native
21088 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21089 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21090 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21091 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21092
21093 @cindex DPMI
21094 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21095 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21096 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21097 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21098
21099 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21100 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21101 subsection describes those commands.
21102
21103 @table @code
21104 @kindex info dos
21105 @item info dos
21106 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21107 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21108
21109 @kindex sysinfo
21110 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21111 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21112 @item info dos sysinfo
21113 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21114 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21115 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21116
21117 @cindex GDT
21118 @cindex LDT
21119 @cindex IDT
21120 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21121 @cindex descriptor tables display
21122 @item info dos gdt
21123 @itemx info dos ldt
21124 @itemx info dos idt
21125 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21126 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21127 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21128 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21129 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21130 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21131 rights.
21132
21133 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21134 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21135 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21136 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21137 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21138
21139 @cindex garbled pointers
21140 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21141 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21142 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21143 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21144 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21145 debugged program's data segment:
21146
21147 @smallexample
21148 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21149 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21150 @end smallexample
21151
21152 @noindent
21153 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21154 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21155
21156 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21157 @item info dos pde
21158 @itemx info dos pte
21159 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21160 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21161 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21162 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21163 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21164 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21165 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21166 that is currently in use.
21167
21168 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21169 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21170 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21171 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21172 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21173 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21174 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21175
21176 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21177 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21178 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21179 controller.
21180
21181 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21182
21183 @cindex physical address from linear address
21184 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21185 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21186 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21187 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21188 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21189 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21190 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21191
21192 @smallexample
21193 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21194 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21195 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21196 @end smallexample
21197
21198 @noindent
21199 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21200 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21201 attributes of that page.
21202
21203 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21204 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21205 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21206 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21207 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21208 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21209
21210 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21211 transfer buffer:
21212
21213 @smallexample
21214 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21215 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21216 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21217 @end smallexample
21218
21219 @noindent
21220 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21221 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21222 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21223 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21224 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21225
21226 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21227 @end table
21228
21229 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21230 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21231 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21232 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21233
21234 @table @code
21235 @kindex set com1base
21236 @kindex set com1irq
21237 @kindex set com2base
21238 @kindex set com2irq
21239 @kindex set com3base
21240 @kindex set com3irq
21241 @kindex set com4base
21242 @kindex set com4irq
21243 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21244 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21245 port.
21246
21247 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21248 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21249 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21250
21251 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21252 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21253 other 3 COM ports.
21254
21255 @kindex show com1base
21256 @kindex show com1irq
21257 @kindex show com2base
21258 @kindex show com2irq
21259 @kindex show com3base
21260 @kindex show com3irq
21261 @kindex show com4base
21262 @kindex show com4irq
21263 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21264 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21265 lines used by the COM ports.
21266
21267 @item info serial
21268 @kindex info serial
21269 @cindex DOS serial port status
21270 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21271 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21272 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21273 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21274 @end table
21275
21276
21277 @node Cygwin Native
21278 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21279 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21280 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21281 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21282
21283 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21284 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21285
21286 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21287 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21288 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21289 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21290 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21291 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21292 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21293 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21294
21295 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21296 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21297 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21298
21299 @table @code
21300 @kindex info w32
21301 @item info w32
21302 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21303 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21304
21305 @item info w32 selector
21306 This command displays information returned by
21307 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21308 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21309 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21310 Without argument, this command displays information
21311 about the six segment registers.
21312
21313 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21314 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21315 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21316 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21317
21318 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21319 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21320 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21321 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21322 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21323 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21324 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21325 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21326 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21327 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21328 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21329
21330 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21331 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21332 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21333 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21334
21335 @kindex set new-console
21336 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21337 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21338 be started in a new console on next start.
21339 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21340 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21341
21342 @kindex show new-console
21343 @item show new-console
21344 Displays whether a new console is used
21345 when the debuggee is started.
21346
21347 @kindex set new-group
21348 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21349 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21350 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21351 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21352 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21353
21354 @kindex show new-group
21355 @item show new-group
21356 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21357
21358 @kindex set debugevents
21359 @item set debugevents
21360 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21361 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21362 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21363 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21364 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21365
21366 @kindex set debugexec
21367 @item set debugexec
21368 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21369 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21370
21371 @kindex set debugexceptions
21372 @item set debugexceptions
21373 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21374 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21375
21376 @kindex set debugmemory
21377 @item set debugmemory
21378 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21379 and writes by the debugger.
21380
21381 @kindex set shell
21382 @item set shell
21383 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21384 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21385
21386 @kindex show shell
21387 @item show shell
21388 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21389
21390 @end table
21391
21392 @menu
21393 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21394 @end menu
21395
21396 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21397 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21398 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21399 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21400
21401 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21402 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21403 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21404 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21405 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21406 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21407 ``minimal symbols''.
21408
21409 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21410 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21411 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21412 program run once to completion.
21413
21414 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21415
21416 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21417 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21418 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21419 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21420 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21421 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21422 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21423 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21424 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21425
21426 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21427 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21428 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21429 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21430 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21431 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21432
21433 @smallexample
21434 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21435 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21436
21437 Non-debugging symbols:
21438 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21439 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21440 @end smallexample
21441
21442 @smallexample
21443 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21444 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21445
21446 Non-debugging symbols:
21447 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21448 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21449 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21450 [etc...]
21451 @end smallexample
21452
21453 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21454
21455 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21456 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21457 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21458 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21459 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21460 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21461 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21462
21463 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21464 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21465 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21466 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21467 problem:
21468
21469 @smallexample
21470 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21471 $1 = 268572168
21472 @end smallexample
21473
21474 @smallexample
21475 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21476 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21477 @end smallexample
21478
21479 And two possible solutions:
21480
21481 @smallexample
21482 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21483 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21484 @end smallexample
21485
21486 @smallexample
21487 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21488 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21489 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21490 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21491 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21492 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21493 @end smallexample
21494
21495 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21496 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21497 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21498 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21499 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21500
21501 @smallexample
21502 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21503 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21504 @end smallexample
21505
21506 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21507 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21508 safe.
21509
21510 @node Hurd Native
21511 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21512 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21513
21514 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21515 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21516
21517 @table @code
21518 @item set signals
21519 @itemx set sigs
21520 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21521 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21522 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21523 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21524 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21525 @code{signals}.
21526
21527 @item show signals
21528 @itemx show sigs
21529 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21530 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21531 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21532
21533 @item set signal-thread
21534 @itemx set sigthread
21535 @kindex set signal-thread
21536 @kindex set sigthread
21537 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21538 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21539 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21540 signal-thread}.
21541
21542 @item show signal-thread
21543 @itemx show sigthread
21544 @kindex show signal-thread
21545 @kindex show sigthread
21546 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21547 delivered a signal.
21548
21549 @item set stopped
21550 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21551 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21552 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21553 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21554
21555 @item show stopped
21556 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21557 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21558 stopped.
21559
21560 @item set exceptions
21561 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21562 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21563 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21564 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21565 trapping on.
21566
21567 @item show exceptions
21568 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21569 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21570
21571 @item set task pause
21572 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21573 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21574 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21575 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21576 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21577 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21578 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21579 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21580 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21581
21582 @item show task pause
21583 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21584 Show the current state of task suspension.
21585
21586 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21587 @cindex task suspend count
21588 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21589 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21590 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21591
21592 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21593 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21594
21595 @item set task exception-port
21596 @itemx set task excp
21597 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21598 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21599 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21600 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21601
21602 @item set noninvasive
21603 @cindex noninvasive task options
21604 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21605 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21606 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21607 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21608
21609 @item info send-rights
21610 @itemx info receive-rights
21611 @itemx info port-rights
21612 @itemx info port-sets
21613 @itemx info dead-names
21614 @itemx info ports
21615 @itemx info psets
21616 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21617 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21618 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21619 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21620 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21621 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21622 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21623 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21624 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21625
21626 @item set thread pause
21627 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21628 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21629 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21630 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21631 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21632 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21633 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21634 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21635 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21636 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21637 only the current thread.
21638
21639 @item show thread pause
21640 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21641 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21642
21643 @item set thread run
21644 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21645
21646 @item show thread run
21647 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21648
21649 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21650 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21651 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21652 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21653 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21654 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21655 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21656
21657 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21658 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21659 detaching.
21660
21661 @item set thread exception-port
21662 @itemx set thread excp
21663 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21664 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21665 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21666
21667 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21668 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21669 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21670 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21671
21672 @item set thread default
21673 @itemx show thread default
21674 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21675 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21676 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21677 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21678 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21679 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21680 the non-default commands.
21681 @end table
21682
21683 @node Darwin
21684 @subsection Darwin
21685 @cindex Darwin
21686
21687 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21688
21689 @table @code
21690 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21691 @kindex set debug darwin
21692 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21693 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21694
21695 @item show debug darwin
21696 @kindex show debug darwin
21697 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21698
21699 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21700 @kindex set debug mach-o
21701 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21702 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21703 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21704 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21705 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21706 usage.
21707
21708 @item show debug mach-o
21709 @kindex show debug mach-o
21710 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21711
21712 @item set mach-exceptions on
21713 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21714 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21715 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21716 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21717 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21718 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21719
21720 @item show mach-exceptions
21721 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21722 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21723 @end table
21724
21725
21726 @node Embedded OS
21727 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21728
21729 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21730 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21731 architectures.
21732
21733 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21734 various real-time operating systems.
21735
21736 @node Embedded Processors
21737 @section Embedded Processors
21738
21739 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21740 configurations.
21741
21742 @cindex send command to simulator
21743 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21744 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21745
21746 @table @code
21747 @item sim @var{command}
21748 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21749 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21750 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21751 acceptable commands.
21752 @end table
21753
21754
21755 @menu
21756 * ARM:: ARM
21757 * M32R/SDI:: Renesas M32R/SDI
21758 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21759 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21760 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21761 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21762 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21763 * CRIS:: CRIS
21764 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21765 @end menu
21766
21767 @node ARM
21768 @subsection ARM
21769
21770 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21771
21772 @table @code
21773 @item set arm disassembler
21774 @kindex set arm
21775 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21776 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21777
21778 @item show arm disassembler
21779 @kindex show arm
21780 Show the current disassembly style.
21781
21782 @item set arm apcs32
21783 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21784 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21785
21786 @item show arm apcs32
21787 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21788
21789 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21790 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21791 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21792
21793 @table @code
21794 @item auto
21795 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21796 @item softfpa
21797 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21798 processors.
21799 @item fpa
21800 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21801 @item softvfp
21802 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21803 @item vfp
21804 VFP co-processor.
21805 @end table
21806
21807 @item show arm fpu
21808 Show the current type of the FPU.
21809
21810 @item set arm abi
21811 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21812
21813 @item show arm abi
21814 Show the currently used ABI.
21815
21816 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21817 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21818 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21819 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21820 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21821 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21822 register).
21823
21824 @item show arm fallback-mode
21825 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21826
21827 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21828 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21829 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21830 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21831 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21832
21833 @item show arm force-mode
21834 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21835
21836 @item set debug arm
21837 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21838 target support subsystem.
21839
21840 @item show debug arm
21841 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21842 @end table
21843
21844 @table @code
21845 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21846 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21847
21848 @table @code
21849 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21850 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21851 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21852 The default value is @code{all}.
21853
21854 @table @code
21855 @item none
21856 @item demon
21857 @item angel
21858 @item redboot
21859 @item all
21860 @end table
21861 @end table
21862 @end table
21863
21864 @node M32R/SDI
21865 @subsection Renesas M32R/SDI
21866
21867 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21868
21869 @table @code
21870 @item sdireset
21871 @kindex sdireset
21872 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21873 This command resets the SDI connection.
21874
21875 @item sdistatus
21876 @kindex sdistatus
21877 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21878
21879 @item debug_chaos
21880 @kindex debug_chaos
21881 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21882 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21883
21884 @item use_debug_dma
21885 @kindex use_debug_dma
21886 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21887
21888 @item use_mon_code
21889 @kindex use_mon_code
21890 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21891
21892 @item use_ib_break
21893 @kindex use_ib_break
21894 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21895
21896 @item use_dbt_break
21897 @kindex use_dbt_break
21898 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21899 @end table
21900
21901 @node M68K
21902 @subsection M68k
21903
21904 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
21905
21906 @node MicroBlaze
21907 @subsection MicroBlaze
21908 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21909 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21910
21911 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21912 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21913 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21914 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21915 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21916 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21917 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21918 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21919 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21920 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21921 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21922
21923 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21924
21925 @table @code
21926 @item target remote :1234
21927 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21928 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21929
21930 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21931 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21932 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21933
21934 @item load
21935 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21936
21937 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21938 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21939
21940 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21941 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21942 @end table
21943
21944 @node MIPS Embedded
21945 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21946
21947 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21948 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21949 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21950 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21951
21952 @need 1000
21953 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21954
21955 @table @code
21956 @item target mips @var{port}
21957 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21958 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21959 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21960 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21961 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21962 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21963 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21964
21965 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21966 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21967 debugger:
21968
21969 @smallexample
21970 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21971 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21972 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21973 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21974 (@value{GDBP}) run
21975 @end smallexample
21976
21977 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21978 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21979 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21980 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21981 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21982
21983 @item target pmon @var{port}
21984 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21985 PMON ROM monitor.
21986
21987 @item target ddb @var{port}
21988 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21989 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21990
21991 @item target lsi @var{port}
21992 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21993 LSI variant of PMON.
21994
21995 @end table
21996
21997
21998 @noindent
21999 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22000
22001 @table @code
22002 @item set mipsfpu double
22003 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22004 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22005 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22006 @itemx show mipsfpu
22007 @kindex set mipsfpu
22008 @kindex show mipsfpu
22009 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22010 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22011 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22012 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22013 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22014 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22015 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22016 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22017 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22018 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22019 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22020 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22021 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22022
22023 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22024 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22025 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22026
22027 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22028 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22029
22030 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
22031 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
22032 @itemx show timeout
22033 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
22034 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
22035 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
22036 @kindex set timeout
22037 @kindex show timeout
22038 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
22039 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
22040 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
22041 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
22042 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
22043 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
22044 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
22045 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
22046 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
22047 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
22048
22049 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
22050 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
22051 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
22052 to run before stopping.
22053
22054 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
22055 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22056 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
22057 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
22058 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
22059 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
22060
22061 @item show syn-garbage-limit
22062 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22063 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
22064 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
22065
22066 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
22067 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22068 @cindex remote monitor prompt
22069 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
22070 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
22071 @table @asis
22072 @item pmon target
22073 @samp{PMON}
22074 @item ddb target
22075 @samp{NEC010}
22076 @item lsi target
22077 @samp{PMON>}
22078 @end table
22079
22080 @item show monitor-prompt
22081 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22082 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
22083 remote monitor.
22084
22085 @item set monitor-warnings
22086 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22087 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
22088 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
22089 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
22090 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
22091
22092 @item show monitor-warnings
22093 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22094 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
22095
22096 @item pmon @var{command}
22097 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22098 @cindex send PMON command
22099 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
22100 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
22101 @end table
22102
22103 @node PowerPC Embedded
22104 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22105
22106 @cindex DVC register
22107 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22108 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22109
22110 @smallexample
22111 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22112 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22113 @end smallexample
22114
22115 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22116 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22117 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22118 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22119 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22120 or newer.
22121
22122 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22123 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22124 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22125 watching variables of scalar types.
22126
22127 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22128 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22129
22130 @smallexample
22131 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22132 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22133 @end smallexample
22134
22135 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22136 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22137
22138 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22139 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22140 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22141 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22142 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22143 use the @code{break-range} command.
22144
22145 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22146
22147 @table @code
22148 @kindex break-range
22149 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22150 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22151 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22152 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22153 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22154 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22155 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22156 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22157 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22158
22159 @kindex set powerpc
22160 @item set powerpc soft-float
22161 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22162 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22163 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22164 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22165
22166 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22167 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22168 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22169 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22170 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22171 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22172 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22173 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22174
22175 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22176 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22177 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22178 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22179 address of its first byte.
22180
22181 @end table
22182
22183 @node AVR
22184 @subsection Atmel AVR
22185 @cindex AVR
22186
22187 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22188 following AVR-specific commands:
22189
22190 @table @code
22191 @item info io_registers
22192 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22193 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22194 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22195 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22196 @end table
22197
22198 @node CRIS
22199 @subsection CRIS
22200 @cindex CRIS
22201
22202 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22203 following CRIS-specific commands:
22204
22205 @table @code
22206 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22207 @cindex CRIS version
22208 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22209 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22210 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22211
22212 @item show cris-version
22213 Show the current CRIS version.
22214
22215 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22216 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22217 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22218 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22219 @code{R59}.
22220
22221 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22222 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22223
22224 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22225 @cindex CRIS mode
22226 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22227 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22228 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22229
22230 @item show cris-mode
22231 Show the current CRIS mode.
22232 @end table
22233
22234 @node Super-H
22235 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22236 @cindex Super-H
22237
22238 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22239 commands:
22240
22241 @table @code
22242 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22243 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22244 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22245 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22246 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22247 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22248 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22249 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22250 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22251 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22252 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22253 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22254
22255 @item show sh calling-convention
22256 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22257 Show the current calling convention setting.
22258
22259 @end table
22260
22261
22262 @node Architectures
22263 @section Architectures
22264
22265 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22266 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22267
22268 @menu
22269 * AArch64::
22270 * i386::
22271 * Alpha::
22272 * MIPS::
22273 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22274 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22275 * PowerPC::
22276 * Nios II::
22277 @end menu
22278
22279 @node AArch64
22280 @subsection AArch64
22281 @cindex AArch64 support
22282
22283 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22284 following special commands:
22285
22286 @table @code
22287 @item set debug aarch64
22288 @kindex set debug aarch64
22289 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22290 messages are to be displayed.
22291
22292 @item show debug aarch64
22293 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22294
22295 @end table
22296
22297 @node i386
22298 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22299
22300 @table @code
22301 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22302 @kindex set struct-convention
22303 @cindex struct return convention
22304 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22305 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22306 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22307 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22308 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22309 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22310 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22311 be returned in a register.
22312
22313 @item show struct-convention
22314 @kindex show struct-convention
22315 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22316 from functions.
22317 @end table
22318
22319
22320 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22321 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22322
22323 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22324 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22325 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22326 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22327 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22328 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22329 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22330
22331 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22332 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22333 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22334 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22335 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22336 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22337
22338 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22339 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22340 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22341
22342 @smallexample
22343 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22344 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22345 @end smallexample
22346
22347 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22348 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22349 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22350 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22351 the pointer.
22352
22353 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22354 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22355 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22356 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22357 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22358
22359 @table @code
22360 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22361 @kindex show mpx bound
22362 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22363
22364 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22365 @kindex set mpx bound
22366 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22367 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22368 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22369 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22370 @end table
22371
22372 @node Alpha
22373 @subsection Alpha
22374
22375 See the following section.
22376
22377 @node MIPS
22378 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22379
22380 @cindex stack on Alpha
22381 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22382 @cindex Alpha stack
22383 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22384 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22385 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22386 find the beginning of a function.
22387
22388 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22389 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22390 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22391 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22392 commands:
22393
22394 @table @code
22395 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22396 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22397 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22398 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22399 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22400 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22401 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22402 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22403
22404 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22405 Display the current limit.
22406 @end table
22407
22408 @noindent
22409 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22410 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22411
22412 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22413 programs:
22414
22415 @table @code
22416 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22417 @kindex set mips abi
22418 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22419 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22420 values of @var{arg} are:
22421
22422 @table @samp
22423 @item auto
22424 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22425 default).
22426 @item o32
22427 @item o64
22428 @item n32
22429 @item n64
22430 @item eabi32
22431 @item eabi64
22432 @end table
22433
22434 @item show mips abi
22435 @kindex show mips abi
22436 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22437
22438 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22439 @kindex set mips compression
22440 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22441 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22442 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22443 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22444 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22445 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22446 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22447 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22448 provided by the executable.
22449
22450 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22451 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22452 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22453 identified as such.
22454
22455 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22456 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22457 implicitly from an executable.
22458
22459 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22460 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22461 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22462 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22463 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22464
22465 @item show mips compression
22466 @kindex show mips compression
22467 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22468 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22469
22470 @item set mipsfpu
22471 @itemx show mipsfpu
22472 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22473
22474 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22475 @kindex set mips mask-address
22476 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22477 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22478 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22479 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22480 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22481
22482 @item show mips mask-address
22483 @kindex show mips mask-address
22484 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22485 not.
22486
22487 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22488 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22489 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22490 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22491 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22492 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22493
22494 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22495 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22496 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22497
22498 @item set debug mips
22499 @kindex set debug mips
22500 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22501 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22502
22503 @item show debug mips
22504 @kindex show debug mips
22505 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22506 @end table
22507
22508
22509 @node HPPA
22510 @subsection HPPA
22511 @cindex HPPA support
22512
22513 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22514 following special commands:
22515
22516 @table @code
22517 @item set debug hppa
22518 @kindex set debug hppa
22519 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22520 messages are to be displayed.
22521
22522 @item show debug hppa
22523 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22524
22525 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22526 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22527 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22528 given @var{address}.
22529
22530 @end table
22531
22532
22533 @node SPU
22534 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22535 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22536 @cindex SPU
22537
22538 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22539 it provides the following special commands:
22540
22541 @table @code
22542 @item info spu event
22543 @kindex info spu
22544 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22545 and pending event status.
22546
22547 @item info spu signal
22548 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22549 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22550 notification channels.
22551
22552 @item info spu mailbox
22553 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22554 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22555 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22556
22557 @item info spu dma
22558 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22559 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22560 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22561
22562 @item info spu proxydma
22563 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22564 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22565 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22566
22567 @end table
22568
22569 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22570 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22571 special commands:
22572
22573 @table @code
22574 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22575 @kindex set spu
22576 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22577 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22578 function. The default is @code{off}.
22579
22580 @item show spu stop-on-load
22581 @kindex show spu
22582 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22583
22584 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22585 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22586 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22587 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22588 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22589 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22590
22591 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22592 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22593
22594 @end table
22595
22596 @node PowerPC
22597 @subsection PowerPC
22598 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22599
22600 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22601 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22602 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22603 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22604 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22605
22606 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22607 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22608 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22609
22610 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22611 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22612
22613 @node Nios II
22614 @subsection Nios II
22615 @cindex Nios II architecture
22616
22617 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22618 it provides the following special commands:
22619
22620 @table @code
22621
22622 @item set debug nios2
22623 @kindex set debug nios2
22624 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22625 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22626
22627 @item show debug nios2
22628 @kindex show debug nios2
22629 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22630 @end table
22631
22632 @node Controlling GDB
22633 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22634
22635 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22636 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22637 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22638 described here.
22639
22640 @menu
22641 * Prompt:: Prompt
22642 * Editing:: Command editing
22643 * Command History:: Command history
22644 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22645 * Numbers:: Numbers
22646 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22647 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22648 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22649 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22650 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22651 @end menu
22652
22653 @node Prompt
22654 @section Prompt
22655
22656 @cindex prompt
22657
22658 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22659 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22660 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22661 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22662 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22663 which one you are talking to.
22664
22665 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22666 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22667 or a prompt that does not.
22668
22669 @table @code
22670 @kindex set prompt
22671 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22672 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22673
22674 @kindex show prompt
22675 @item show prompt
22676 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22677 @end table
22678
22679 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22680 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22681 are:
22682
22683 @table @code
22684 @kindex set extended-prompt
22685 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22686 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22687 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22688 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22689 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22690 is displayed.
22691
22692 For example:
22693
22694 @smallexample
22695 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22696 @end smallexample
22697
22698 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22699 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22700
22701 @kindex show extended-prompt
22702 @item show extended-prompt
22703 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22704 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22705 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22706 @end table
22707
22708 @node Editing
22709 @section Command Editing
22710 @cindex readline
22711 @cindex command line editing
22712
22713 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22714 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22715 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22716 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22717 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22718 debugging sessions.
22719
22720 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22721 command @code{set}.
22722
22723 @table @code
22724 @kindex set editing
22725 @cindex editing
22726 @item set editing
22727 @itemx set editing on
22728 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22729
22730 @item set editing off
22731 Disable command line editing.
22732
22733 @kindex show editing
22734 @item show editing
22735 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22736 @end table
22737
22738 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22739 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22740 @end ifset
22741 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22742 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22743 @end ifclear
22744 for more details about the Readline
22745 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22746 encouraged to read that chapter.
22747
22748 @node Command History
22749 @section Command History
22750 @cindex command history
22751
22752 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22753 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22754 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22755 history facility.
22756
22757 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22758 package, to provide the history facility.
22759 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22760 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22761 @end ifset
22762 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22763 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22764 @end ifclear
22765 for the detailed description of the History library.
22766
22767 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22768 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22769 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22770 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22771 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22772 pressed on a line by itself.
22773
22774 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22775 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22776 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22777 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22778
22779 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22780 history.
22781
22782 @table @code
22783 @cindex history substitution
22784 @cindex history file
22785 @kindex set history filename
22786 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22787 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22788 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22789 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22790 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22791 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22792 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22793 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22794 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22795 is not set.
22796
22797 @cindex save command history
22798 @kindex set history save
22799 @item set history save
22800 @itemx set history save on
22801 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22802 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22803
22804 @item set history save off
22805 Stop recording command history in a file.
22806
22807 @cindex history size
22808 @kindex set history size
22809 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22810 @item set history size @var{size}
22811 @itemx set history size unlimited
22812 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22813 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22814 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22815 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22816 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22817 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22818
22819 @cindex remove duplicate history
22820 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22821 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22822 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22823 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22824 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22825 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22826 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22827 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22828 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22829
22830 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22831 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22832
22833 @end table
22834
22835 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22836 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22837 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22838 @end ifset
22839 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22840 @xref{Event Designators},
22841 @end ifclear
22842 for more details.
22843
22844 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22845 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22846 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22847 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22848 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22849 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22850 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22851 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22852
22853 The commands to control history expansion are:
22854
22855 @table @code
22856 @item set history expansion on
22857 @itemx set history expansion
22858 @kindex set history expansion
22859 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22860
22861 @item set history expansion off
22862 Disable history expansion.
22863
22864 @c @group
22865 @kindex show history
22866 @item show history
22867 @itemx show history filename
22868 @itemx show history save
22869 @itemx show history size
22870 @itemx show history expansion
22871 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22872 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22873 @c @end group
22874 @end table
22875
22876 @table @code
22877 @kindex show commands
22878 @cindex show last commands
22879 @cindex display command history
22880 @item show commands
22881 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22882
22883 @item show commands @var{n}
22884 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22885
22886 @item show commands +
22887 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22888 @end table
22889
22890 @node Screen Size
22891 @section Screen Size
22892 @cindex size of screen
22893 @cindex screen size
22894 @cindex pagination
22895 @cindex page size
22896 @cindex pauses in output
22897
22898 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22899 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22900 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22901 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22902 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22903 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22904 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22905 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22906
22907 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22908 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22909 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22910 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22911 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22912 width} commands:
22913
22914 @table @code
22915 @kindex set height
22916 @kindex set width
22917 @kindex show width
22918 @kindex show height
22919 @item set height @var{lpp}
22920 @itemx set height unlimited
22921 @itemx show height
22922 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22923 @itemx set width unlimited
22924 @itemx show width
22925 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22926 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22927 commands display the current settings.
22928
22929 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22930 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22931 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22932 buffer.
22933
22934 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22935 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22936
22937 @item set pagination on
22938 @itemx set pagination off
22939 @kindex set pagination
22940 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22941 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22942 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22943 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22944
22945 @item show pagination
22946 @kindex show pagination
22947 Show the current pagination mode.
22948 @end table
22949
22950 @node Numbers
22951 @section Numbers
22952 @cindex number representation
22953 @cindex entering numbers
22954
22955 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22956 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22957 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22958 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22959 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22960 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22961 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22962 both input and output with the commands described below.
22963
22964 @table @code
22965 @kindex set input-radix
22966 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22967 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22968 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22969 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22970 example, any of
22971
22972 @smallexample
22973 set input-radix 012
22974 set input-radix 10.
22975 set input-radix 0xa
22976 @end smallexample
22977
22978 @noindent
22979 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22980 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22981 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22982 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22983 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22984 change the radix.
22985
22986 @kindex set output-radix
22987 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22988 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22989 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22990 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22991
22992 @kindex show input-radix
22993 @item show input-radix
22994 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22995
22996 @kindex show output-radix
22997 @item show output-radix
22998 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22999
23000 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23001 @itemx show radix
23002 @kindex set radix
23003 @kindex show radix
23004 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23005 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23006 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23007 default value of 10.
23008
23009 @end table
23010
23011 @node ABI
23012 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23013
23014 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23015 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23016 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23017 current ABI.
23018
23019 @cindex OS ABI
23020 @kindex set osabi
23021 @kindex show osabi
23022 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23023
23024 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23025 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23026 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23027 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23028 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23029 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23030 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23031 platform provides.
23032
23033 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23034 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23035 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23036 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23037
23038 @table @code
23039 @item show osabi
23040 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23041
23042 @item set osabi
23043 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23044
23045 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23046 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23047 @end table
23048
23049 @cindex float promotion
23050
23051 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23052 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23053 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23054 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23055 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23056 @code{double} and then passed.
23057
23058 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23059 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23060 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23061
23062 @table @code
23063 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23064 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23065 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23066 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23067 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23068
23069 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23070 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23071 functions.
23072
23073 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23074 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23075 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23076 @end table
23077
23078 @kindex set cp-abi
23079 @kindex show cp-abi
23080 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23081 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23082 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23083 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23084 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23085 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23086 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23087 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23088 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23089 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23090 ``auto''.
23091
23092 @table @code
23093 @item show cp-abi
23094 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23095
23096 @item set cp-abi
23097 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23098
23099 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23100 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23101 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23102 @end table
23103
23104 @node Auto-loading
23105 @section Automatically loading associated files
23106 @cindex auto-loading
23107
23108 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23109 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23110 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23111 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23112 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23113 sources).
23114
23115 @menu
23116 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23117 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23118
23119 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23120 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23121 @end menu
23122
23123 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23124 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23125 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23126
23127 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23128 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23129 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23130
23131 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23132 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23133
23134 @table @code
23135 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23136 @kindex set auto-load off
23137 @item set auto-load off
23138 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23139 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23140 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23141 @smallexample
23142 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23143 @end smallexample
23144
23145 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23146 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23147 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23148 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23149 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23150 @code{set auto-load no}.
23151
23152 @anchor{show auto-load}
23153 @kindex show auto-load
23154 @item show auto-load
23155 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23156 or disabled.
23157
23158 @smallexample
23159 (gdb) show auto-load
23160 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23161 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23162 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23163 is on.
23164 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23165 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23166 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23167 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23168 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23169 @end smallexample
23170
23171 @anchor{info auto-load}
23172 @kindex info auto-load
23173 @item info auto-load
23174 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23175 not.
23176
23177 @smallexample
23178 (gdb) info auto-load
23179 gdb-scripts:
23180 Loaded Script
23181 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23182 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23183 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23184 loaded.
23185 python-scripts:
23186 Loaded Script
23187 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23188 @end smallexample
23189 @end table
23190
23191 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23192
23193 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23194 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23195 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23196 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23197 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23198 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23199 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23200 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23201 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23202 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23203 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23204 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23205 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23206 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23207 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23208 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23209 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23210 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23211 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23212 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23213 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23214 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23215 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23216 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23217 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23218 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23219 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23220 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23221 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23222 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23223 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23224 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23225 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23226 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23227 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23228 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23229 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23230 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23231 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23232 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23233 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23234 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23235 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23236 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23237 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23238 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23239 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23240 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23241 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23242 @end multitable
23243
23244 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23245 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23246 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23247
23248 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23249 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23250 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23251
23252 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23253 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23254
23255 @table @code
23256 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23257 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23258 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23259 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23260 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23261
23262 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23263 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23264 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23265 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23266 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23267
23268 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23269 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23270 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23271 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23272 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23273 @end table
23274
23275 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23276 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23277 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23278
23279 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23280
23281 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23282 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23283
23284 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23285 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23286 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23287 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23288 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23289 library.
23290
23291 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23292 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23293
23294 @table @code
23295 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23296 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23297 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23298 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23299
23300 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23301 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23302 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23303 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23304 enabled or disabled.
23305
23306 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23307 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23308 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23309 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23310 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23311 @end table
23312
23313 @node Auto-loading safe path
23314 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23315 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23316
23317 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23318 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23319 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23320 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23321 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23322
23323 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23324 get loaded:
23325
23326 @smallexample
23327 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23328 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23329 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23330 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23331 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23332 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23333 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23334 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23335 @end smallexample
23336
23337 @noindent
23338 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23339 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23340
23341 @smallexample
23342 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23343 @end smallexample
23344
23345 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23346
23347 @table @code
23348 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23349 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23350 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23351 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23352 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23353 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23354 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23355 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23356 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23357 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23358
23359 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23360 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23361 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23362
23363 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23364 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23365 @item show auto-load safe-path
23366 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23367 scripts.
23368
23369 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23370 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23371 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23372 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23373 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23374 by the host platform path separator in use.
23375 @end table
23376
23377 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23378 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23379 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23380 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23381 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23382
23383 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23384 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23385 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23386 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23387 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23388 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23389 init file in the current directory
23390 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23391
23392 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23393 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23394
23395 @table @asis
23396 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23397 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23398 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23399 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23400
23401 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23402 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23403 @value{GDBN} session.
23404
23405 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23406 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23407 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23408 from trusted sources.
23409
23410 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23411 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23412 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23413 trusted sources.
23414 @end table
23415
23416 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23417 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23418
23419 @table @asis
23420 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23421 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23422
23423 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23424 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23425 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23426 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23427 @end table
23428
23429 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23430 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23431 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23432 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23433 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23434 recommended to be entered.
23435
23436 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23437 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23438 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23439
23440 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23441 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23442 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23443 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23444 be printed.
23445
23446 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23447 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23448 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23449
23450 @smallexample
23451 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23452 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23453 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23454 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23455 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23456 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23457 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23458 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23459 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23460 @end smallexample
23461
23462 @table @code
23463 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23464 @kindex set debug auto-load
23465 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23466 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23467
23468 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23469 @kindex show debug auto-load
23470 @item show debug auto-load
23471 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23472 on or off.
23473 @end table
23474
23475 @node Messages/Warnings
23476 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23477
23478 @cindex verbose operation
23479 @cindex optional warnings
23480 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23481 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23482 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23483 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23484
23485 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23486 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23487 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23488
23489 @table @code
23490 @kindex set verbose
23491 @item set verbose on
23492 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23493
23494 @item set verbose off
23495 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23496
23497 @kindex show verbose
23498 @item show verbose
23499 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23500 @end table
23501
23502 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23503 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23504 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23505 Symbol Files}).
23506
23507 @table @code
23508
23509 @kindex set complaints
23510 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23511 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23512 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23513 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23514 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23515
23516 @kindex show complaints
23517 @item show complaints
23518 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23519
23520 @end table
23521
23522 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23523 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23524 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23525 you try to run a program which is already running:
23526
23527 @smallexample
23528 (@value{GDBP}) run
23529 The program being debugged has been started already.
23530 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23531 @end smallexample
23532
23533 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23534 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23535
23536 @table @code
23537
23538 @kindex set confirm
23539 @cindex flinching
23540 @cindex confirmation
23541 @cindex stupid questions
23542 @item set confirm off
23543 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23544 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23545 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23546
23547 @item set confirm on
23548 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23549
23550 @kindex show confirm
23551 @item show confirm
23552 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23553
23554 @end table
23555
23556 @cindex command tracing
23557 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23558 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23559 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23560 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23561
23562 @table @code
23563 @kindex set trace-commands
23564 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23565 @item set trace-commands on
23566 Enable command tracing.
23567 @item set trace-commands off
23568 Disable command tracing.
23569 @item show trace-commands
23570 Display the current state of command tracing.
23571 @end table
23572
23573 @node Debugging Output
23574 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23575 @cindex optional debugging messages
23576
23577 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23578 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23579 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23580 section documents those commands.
23581
23582 @table @code
23583 @kindex set exec-done-display
23584 @item set exec-done-display
23585 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23586 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23587 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23588 @kindex show exec-done-display
23589 @item show exec-done-display
23590 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23591 notification.
23592 @kindex set debug
23593 @cindex ARM AArch64
23594 @item set debug aarch64
23595 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23596 The default is off.
23597 @kindex show debug
23598 @item show debug aarch64
23599 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23600 ARM AArch64.
23601 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23602 @cindex architecture debugging info
23603 @item set debug arch
23604 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23605 @item show debug arch
23606 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23607 @item set debug aix-solib
23608 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23609 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23610 support module. The default is off.
23611 @item show debug aix-thread
23612 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23613 @item set debug aix-thread
23614 @cindex AIX threads
23615 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23616 module.
23617 @item show debug aix-thread
23618 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23619 @item set debug check-physname
23620 @cindex physname
23621 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23622 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23623 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23624 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23625 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23626 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23627 @item show debug check-physname
23628 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23629 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23630 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23631 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23632 exported symbols. The default is off.
23633 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23634 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23635 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23636 @item set debug dwarf-die
23637 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23638 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23639 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23640 A value of zero turns off the display.
23641 @item show debug dwarf-die
23642 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23643 @item set debug dwarf-line
23644 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23645 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23646 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23647 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23648 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23649 @item show debug dwarf-line
23650 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23651 @item set debug dwarf-read
23652 @cindex DWARF Reading
23653 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23654 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23655 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23656 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23657 @item show debug dwarf-read
23658 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23659 @item set debug displaced
23660 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23661 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23662 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23663 @item show debug displaced
23664 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23665 related to displaced stepping.
23666 @item set debug event
23667 @cindex event debugging info
23668 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23669 default is off.
23670 @item show debug event
23671 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23672 info.
23673 @item set debug expression
23674 @cindex expression debugging info
23675 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23676 expression parsing. The default is off.
23677 @item show debug expression
23678 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23679 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23680 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23681 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23682 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23683 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23684 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23685 @item set debug frame
23686 @cindex frame debugging info
23687 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23688 default is off.
23689 @item show debug frame
23690 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23691 info.
23692 @item set debug gnu-nat
23693 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23694 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23695 @item show debug gnu-nat
23696 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23697 @item set debug infrun
23698 @cindex inferior debugging info
23699 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23700 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23701 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23702 @item show debug infrun
23703 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23704 @item set debug jit
23705 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23706 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23707 @item show debug jit
23708 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23709 @item set debug lin-lwp
23710 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23711 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23712 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23713 @item show debug lin-lwp
23714 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23715 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23716 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23717 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23718 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23719 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23720 @item set debug mach-o
23721 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23722 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23723 processing. The default is off.
23724 @item show debug mach-o
23725 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23726 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23727 @item set debug notification
23728 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23729 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23730 The default is off.
23731 @item show debug notification
23732 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23733 @item set debug observer
23734 @cindex observer debugging info
23735 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23736 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23737 @item show debug observer
23738 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23739 @item set debug overload
23740 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23741 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23742 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23743 is off.
23744 @item show debug overload
23745 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23746 debugging info.
23747 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23748 @cindex debug expression parser
23749 @item set debug parser
23750 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23751 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23752 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23753 details. The default is off.
23754 @item show debug parser
23755 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23756 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23757 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23758 @cindex debug remote protocol
23759 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23760 @cindex display remote packets
23761 @item set debug remote
23762 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23763 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23764 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23765 @item show debug remote
23766 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23767 @item set debug serial
23768 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23769 default is off.
23770 @item show debug serial
23771 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23772 info.
23773 @item set debug solib-frv
23774 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23775 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23776 @item show debug solib-frv
23777 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23778 messages.
23779 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23780 @cindex symbol lookup
23781 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23782 The default is 0 (off).
23783 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23784 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23785 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23786 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23787 @item set debug symfile
23788 @cindex symbol file functions
23789 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23790 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23791 @item show debug symfile
23792 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23793 @item set debug symtab-create
23794 @cindex symbol table creation
23795 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23796 The default is 0 (off).
23797 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23798 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23799 @item show debug symtab-create
23800 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23801 @item set debug target
23802 @cindex target debugging info
23803 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23804 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23805 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23806 value of large memory transfers.
23807 @item show debug target
23808 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23809 info.
23810 @item set debug timestamp
23811 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23812 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23813 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23814 message.
23815 @item show debug timestamp
23816 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23817 debugging info.
23818 @item set debug varobj
23819 @cindex variable object debugging info
23820 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23821 info. The default is off.
23822 @item show debug varobj
23823 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23824 debugging info.
23825 @item set debug xml
23826 @cindex XML parser debugging
23827 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23828 @item show debug xml
23829 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23830 @end table
23831
23832 @node Other Misc Settings
23833 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23834 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23835
23836 @table @code
23837 @kindex set interactive-mode
23838 @item set interactive-mode
23839 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23840 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23841 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23842 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23843 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23844 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23845 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23846 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23847
23848 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23849 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23850 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23851 inside a cygwin window.
23852
23853 @kindex show interactive-mode
23854 @item show interactive-mode
23855 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23856 @end table
23857
23858 @node Extending GDB
23859 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23860 @cindex extending GDB
23861
23862 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23863 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23864 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23865 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23866 being debugged.
23867
23868 @menu
23869 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23870 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23871 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23872 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23873 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23874 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23875 @end menu
23876
23877 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23878 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23879 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23880 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23881 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23882 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23883
23884 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23885 setting:
23886
23887 @table @code
23888 @kindex set script-extension
23889 @kindex show script-extension
23890 @item set script-extension off
23891 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23892
23893 @item set script-extension soft
23894 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23895 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23896 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23897 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23898
23899 @item set script-extension strict
23900 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23901 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23902 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23903
23904 @item show script-extension
23905 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23906
23907 @end table
23908
23909 @node Sequences
23910 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23911
23912 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23913 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23914 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23915 files.
23916
23917 @menu
23918 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23919 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23920 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23921 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23922 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23923 @end menu
23924
23925 @node Define
23926 @subsection User-defined Commands
23927
23928 @cindex user-defined command
23929 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23930 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23931 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23932 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23933 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23934 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23935
23936 @smallexample
23937 define adder
23938 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23939 end
23940 @end smallexample
23941
23942 @noindent
23943 To execute the command use:
23944
23945 @smallexample
23946 adder 1 2 3
23947 @end smallexample
23948
23949 @noindent
23950 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23951 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23952 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23953 functions calls.
23954
23955 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23956 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23957 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23958 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23959
23960 @smallexample
23961 define adder
23962 if $argc == 2
23963 print $arg0 + $arg1
23964 end
23965 if $argc == 3
23966 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23967 end
23968 end
23969 @end smallexample
23970
23971 @table @code
23972
23973 @kindex define
23974 @item define @var{commandname}
23975 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23976 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23977 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23978 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23979 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23980 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23981
23982 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23983 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23984 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23985
23986 @kindex document
23987 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23988 @item document @var{commandname}
23989 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23990 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23991 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23992 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23993 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23994 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23995
23996 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23997 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23998 does not change the documentation.
23999
24000 @kindex dont-repeat
24001 @cindex don't repeat command
24002 @item dont-repeat
24003 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24004 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24005 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24006
24007 @kindex help user-defined
24008 @item help user-defined
24009 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24010 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24011 included (if any).
24012
24013 @kindex show user
24014 @item show user
24015 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24016 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24017 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24018 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24019 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24020
24021 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24022 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24023 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24024 @item show max-user-call-depth
24025 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24026 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24027 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24028 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24029 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24030 @end table
24031
24032 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24033 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24034
24035 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24036 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24037 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24038
24039 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24040 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24041 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24042 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24043
24044 @node Hooks
24045 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24046 @cindex command hooks
24047 @cindex hooks, for commands
24048 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24049
24050 @kindex hook
24051 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24052 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24053 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24054 before that command.
24055
24056 @cindex hooks, post-command
24057 @kindex hookpost
24058 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24059 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24060 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24061 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24062 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24063
24064 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24065 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24066
24067 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24068 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24069
24070 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24071 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24072 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24073 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24074 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24075
24076 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24077 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24078 you could define:
24079
24080 @smallexample
24081 define hook-stop
24082 handle SIGALRM nopass
24083 end
24084
24085 define hook-run
24086 handle SIGALRM pass
24087 end
24088
24089 define hook-continue
24090 handle SIGALRM pass
24091 end
24092 @end smallexample
24093
24094 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24095 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24096 you could define:
24097
24098 @smallexample
24099 define hook-echo
24100 echo <<<---
24101 end
24102
24103 define hookpost-echo
24104 echo --->>>\n
24105 end
24106
24107 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24108 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24109 (@value{GDBP})
24110
24111 @end smallexample
24112
24113 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24114 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24115 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24116 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24117 @c or not?
24118 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24119 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24120 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24121
24122 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24123 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24124 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24125
24126 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24127 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24128
24129 @node Command Files
24130 @subsection Command Files
24131
24132 @cindex command files
24133 @cindex scripting commands
24134 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24135 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24136 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24137 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24138 terminal.
24139
24140 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24141 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24142 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24143 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24144 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24145
24146 @table @code
24147 @kindex source
24148 @cindex execute commands from a file
24149 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24150 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24151 @end table
24152
24153 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24154 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24155 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24156 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24157 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24158
24159 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24160 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24161 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24162 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24163 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24164 is not relevant to scripts.
24165
24166 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24167 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24168 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24169 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24170 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24171 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24172 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24173 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24174 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24175 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24176 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24177 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24178 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24179 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24180
24181 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24182 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24183 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24184
24185 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24186 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24187 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24188 when called from command files.
24189
24190 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24191 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24192 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24193 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24194 the next command.
24195
24196 @smallexample
24197 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24198 @end smallexample
24199
24200 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24201 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24202 would be directed to @file{log}.
24203
24204 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24205 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24206 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24207 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24208 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24209 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24210 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24211 conditionally, etc.
24212
24213 @table @code
24214 @kindex if
24215 @kindex else
24216 @item if
24217 @itemx else
24218 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24219 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24220 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24221 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24222 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24223 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24224 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24225
24226 @kindex while
24227 @item while
24228 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24229 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24230 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24231 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24232 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24233 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24234
24235 @kindex loop_break
24236 @item loop_break
24237 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24238 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24239 line.
24240
24241 @kindex loop_continue
24242 @item loop_continue
24243 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24244 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24245 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24246 the controlling expression.
24247
24248 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24249 @item end
24250 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24251 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24252 @end table
24253
24254
24255 @node Output
24256 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24257
24258 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24259 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24260 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24261 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24262 want.
24263
24264 @table @code
24265 @kindex echo
24266 @item echo @var{text}
24267 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24268 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24269 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24270 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24271 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24272 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24273 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24274 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24275 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24276 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24277 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24278
24279 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24280 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24281
24282 @smallexample
24283 echo This is some text\n\
24284 which is continued\n\
24285 onto several lines.\n
24286 @end smallexample
24287
24288 produces the same output as
24289
24290 @smallexample
24291 echo This is some text\n
24292 echo which is continued\n
24293 echo onto several lines.\n
24294 @end smallexample
24295
24296 @kindex output
24297 @item output @var{expression}
24298 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24299 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24300 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24301 on expressions.
24302
24303 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24304 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24305 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24306 Formats}, for more information.
24307
24308 @kindex printf
24309 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24310 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24311 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24312 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24313 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24314 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24315 executing the code below:
24316
24317 @smallexample
24318 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24319 @end smallexample
24320
24321 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24322 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24323 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24324 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24325 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24326 printed.
24327
24328 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24329
24330 @smallexample
24331 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24332 @end smallexample
24333
24334 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24335 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24336 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24337
24338 @itemize @bullet
24339 @item
24340 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24341
24342 @item
24343 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24344 width.
24345
24346 @item
24347 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24348 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24349
24350 @item
24351 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24352 supported.
24353
24354 @item
24355 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24356
24357 @item
24358 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24359 @end itemize
24360
24361 @noindent
24362 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24363 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24364 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24365 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24366
24367 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24368 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24369 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24370 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24371 supported.
24372
24373 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24374 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24375 together with a floating point specifier.
24376 letters:
24377
24378 @itemize @bullet
24379 @item
24380 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24381
24382 @item
24383 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24384
24385 @item
24386 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24387 @end itemize
24388
24389 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24390 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24391 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24392
24393 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24394 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24395
24396 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24397 @smallexample
24398 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24399 @end smallexample
24400
24401 @kindex eval
24402 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24403 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24404 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24405
24406 @end table
24407
24408 @node Auto-loading sequences
24409 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24410 @cindex native script auto-loading
24411
24412 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24413 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24414 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24415 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24416
24417 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24418 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24419
24420 @table @code
24421 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24422 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24423 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24424 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24425
24426 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24427 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24428 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24429 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24430 disabled.
24431
24432 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24433 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24434 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24435 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24436 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24437 auto-loaded.
24438 @end table
24439
24440 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24441 matching names are printed.
24442
24443 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24444 @include python.texi
24445
24446 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24447 @include guile.texi
24448
24449 @node Auto-loading extensions
24450 @section Auto-loading extensions
24451 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24452
24453 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24454 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24455 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24456 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24457 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24458
24459 @menu
24460 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24461 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24462 * Which flavor to choose?::
24463 @end menu
24464
24465 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24466 debugging commands and features.
24467
24468 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24469 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24470 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24471 for more information.
24472 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24473 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24474
24475 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24476 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24477
24478 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24479 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24480 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24481 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24482 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24483
24484 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24485 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24486 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24487 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24488
24489 @table @code
24490 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24491 GDB's own command language
24492 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24493 Python
24494 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24495 Guile
24496 @end table
24497
24498 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24499 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24500 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24501 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24502 script in the specified extension language.
24503
24504 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24505 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24506
24507 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24508 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24509
24510 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24511 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24512 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24513 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24514 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24515 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24516
24517 @table @code
24518 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24519 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24520 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24521 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24522 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24523 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24524
24525 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24526 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24527
24528 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24529 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24530 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24531 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24532
24533 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24534 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24535 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24536 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24537 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24538 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24539 platform.
24540
24541 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24542 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24543 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24544
24545 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24546 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24547 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24548 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24549
24550 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24551 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24552 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24553 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24554 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24555 @end table
24556
24557 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24558 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24559 @var{objfile} is opened.
24560 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24561 is evaluated more than once.
24562
24563 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24564 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24565 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24566
24567 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24568 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24569 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24570 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24571 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24572 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24573 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24574
24575 The following entries are supported:
24576
24577 @table @code
24578 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24579 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24580 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24581 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24582 @end table
24583
24584 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24585
24586 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24587 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24588 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24589 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24590 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24591
24592 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24593 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24594
24595 @example
24596 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24597 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24598 asm("\
24599 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24600 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24601 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24602 .popsection \n\
24603 ");
24604 @end example
24605
24606 @noindent
24607 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24608 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24609
24610 @example
24611 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24612 @end example
24613
24614 The script name may include directories if desired.
24615
24616 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24617 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24618
24619 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24620 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24621 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24622 will remove duplicates.
24623
24624 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24625
24626 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24627 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24628 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24629 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24630 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24631 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24632 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24633 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24634 on its name.
24635
24636 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24637 testsuite.
24638
24639 @example
24640 #include "symcat.h"
24641 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24642 asm(
24643 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24644 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24645 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24646 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24647 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24648 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24649 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24650 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24651 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24652 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24653 ".byte 0\n"
24654 ".popsection\n"
24655 );
24656 @end example
24657
24658 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24659 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24660 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24661 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24662
24663 @node Which flavor to choose?
24664 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24665
24666 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24667 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24668
24669 @noindent
24670 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24671
24672 @itemize @bullet
24673 @item
24674 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24675
24676 @item
24677 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24678
24679 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24680 in the source search path.
24681 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24682 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24683
24684 @item
24685 Doesn't require source code additions.
24686 @end itemize
24687
24688 @noindent
24689 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24690
24691 @itemize @bullet
24692 @item
24693 Works with static linking.
24694
24695 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24696 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24697 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24698 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24699 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24700
24701 @item
24702 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24703
24704 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24705 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24706
24707 @item
24708 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24709
24710 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24711 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24712 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24713 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24714 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24715 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24716 @end itemize
24717
24718 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24719 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24720
24721 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24722 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24723 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24724
24725 @subsection Python comes first
24726
24727 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24728 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24729 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24730 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24731 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24732 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24733 pretty-printed form of a value).
24734 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24735 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24736 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24737
24738 @node Aliases
24739 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24740 @cindex aliases for commands
24741
24742 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24743 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24744 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24745 that involves less typing.
24746
24747 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24748 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24749 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24750
24751 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24752 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24753 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24754
24755 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24756
24757 @table @code
24758
24759 @kindex alias
24760 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24761
24762 @end table
24763
24764 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24765 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24766 underscores.
24767
24768 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24769 that is being aliased.
24770
24771 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24772 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24773 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24774
24775 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24776 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24777
24778 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24779 of a command so that there is less to type.
24780 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24781 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24782 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24783 The following will accomplish this.
24784
24785 @smallexample
24786 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24787 @end smallexample
24788
24789 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24790 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24791 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24792 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24793
24794 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24795 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24796 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24797 of a command.
24798
24799 @smallexample
24800 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24801 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24802 (gdb) set p elms 20
24803 (gdb) show p elms
24804 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24805 @end smallexample
24806
24807 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24808 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24809 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24810
24811 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24812 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24813
24814 @smallexample
24815 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24816 @end smallexample
24817
24818 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24819 alias for a more complex command.
24820 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24821
24822 @smallexample
24823 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24824 (gdb) spe 20
24825 @end smallexample
24826
24827 @node Interpreters
24828 @chapter Command Interpreters
24829 @cindex command interpreters
24830
24831 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24832 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24833 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24834
24835 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24836 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24837 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24838 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24839
24840 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24841 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24842 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24843 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24844
24845 @table @code
24846 @item console
24847 @cindex console interpreter
24848 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24849 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24850 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24851
24852 @item mi
24853 @cindex mi interpreter
24854 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24855 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24856 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24857 Interface}.
24858
24859 @item mi2
24860 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24861 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24862
24863 @item mi1
24864 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24865 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24866
24867 @end table
24868
24869 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24870 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24871 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24872 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24873 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24874 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24875 the IDE inoperable!
24876
24877 @kindex interpreter-exec
24878 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24879 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24880 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24881 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24882
24883 @smallexample
24884 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24885 @end smallexample
24886
24887 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24888 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24889
24890 @node TUI
24891 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24892 @cindex TUI
24893 @cindex Text User Interface
24894
24895 @menu
24896 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24897 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24898 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24899 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24900 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24901 @end menu
24902
24903 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24904 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24905 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24906 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24907 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24908 is available.
24909
24910 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24911 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24912 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24913 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24914 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
24915 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24916
24917 @node TUI Overview
24918 @section TUI Overview
24919
24920 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24921
24922 @table @emph
24923 @item command
24924 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24925 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24926 managed using readline.
24927
24928 @item source
24929 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24930 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24931
24932 @item assembly
24933 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24934
24935 @item register
24936 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24937 when their values change.
24938 @end table
24939
24940 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24941 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24942 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24943 indicates the breakpoint type:
24944
24945 @table @code
24946 @item B
24947 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24948
24949 @item b
24950 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24951
24952 @item H
24953 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24954
24955 @item h
24956 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24957 @end table
24958
24959 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24960
24961 @table @code
24962 @item +
24963 Breakpoint is enabled.
24964
24965 @item -
24966 Breakpoint is disabled.
24967 @end table
24968
24969 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24970 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24971 changes.
24972
24973 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24974 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24975 layouts:
24976
24977 @itemize @bullet
24978 @item
24979 source only,
24980
24981 @item
24982 assembly only,
24983
24984 @item
24985 source and assembly,
24986
24987 @item
24988 source and registers, or
24989
24990 @item
24991 assembly and registers.
24992 @end itemize
24993
24994 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24995
24996 @table @emph
24997 @item target
24998 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24999 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25000
25001 @item process
25002 Gives the current process or thread number.
25003 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25004
25005 @item function
25006 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25007 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25008 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25009 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25010
25011 @item line
25012 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25013 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25014
25015 @item pc
25016 Indicates the current program counter address.
25017 @end table
25018
25019 @node TUI Keys
25020 @section TUI Key Bindings
25021 @cindex TUI key bindings
25022
25023 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25024 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25025 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25026 @end ifset
25027 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25028 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25029 @end ifclear
25030 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25031 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25032
25033 @table @kbd
25034 @kindex C-x C-a
25035 @item C-x C-a
25036 @kindex C-x a
25037 @itemx C-x a
25038 @kindex C-x A
25039 @itemx C-x A
25040 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25041 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25042 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25043 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25044 The screen is then refreshed.
25045
25046 @kindex C-x 1
25047 @item C-x 1
25048 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25049 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25050 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25051
25052 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25053
25054 @kindex C-x 2
25055 @item C-x 2
25056 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25057 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25058 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25059 previous layout and the new one.
25060
25061 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25062
25063 @kindex C-x o
25064 @item C-x o
25065 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25066 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25067 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25068
25069 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25070
25071 @kindex C-x s
25072 @item C-x s
25073 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25074 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25075 @end table
25076
25077 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25078
25079 @table @asis
25080 @kindex PgUp
25081 @item @key{PgUp}
25082 Scroll the active window one page up.
25083
25084 @kindex PgDn
25085 @item @key{PgDn}
25086 Scroll the active window one page down.
25087
25088 @kindex Up
25089 @item @key{Up}
25090 Scroll the active window one line up.
25091
25092 @kindex Down
25093 @item @key{Down}
25094 Scroll the active window one line down.
25095
25096 @kindex Left
25097 @item @key{Left}
25098 Scroll the active window one column left.
25099
25100 @kindex Right
25101 @item @key{Right}
25102 Scroll the active window one column right.
25103
25104 @kindex C-L
25105 @item @kbd{C-L}
25106 Refresh the screen.
25107 @end table
25108
25109 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25110 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25111 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25112 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25113 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25114
25115 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25116 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25117 @cindex TUI single key mode
25118
25119 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25120 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25121 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25122
25123 @table @kbd
25124 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25125 @item c
25126 continue
25127
25128 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25129 @item d
25130 down
25131
25132 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25133 @item f
25134 finish
25135
25136 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25137 @item n
25138 next
25139
25140 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25141 @item q
25142 exit the SingleKey mode.
25143
25144 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25145 @item r
25146 run
25147
25148 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25149 @item s
25150 step
25151
25152 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25153 @item u
25154 up
25155
25156 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25157 @item v
25158 info locals
25159
25160 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25161 @item w
25162 where
25163 @end table
25164
25165 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25166 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25167 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25168 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25169 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25170 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25171
25172
25173 @node TUI Commands
25174 @section TUI-specific Commands
25175 @cindex TUI commands
25176
25177 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25178 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25179 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25180 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25181
25182 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25183 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25184 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25185 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25186 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25187
25188 @table @code
25189 @item tui enable
25190 @kindex tui enable
25191 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25192 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25193 otherwise a default layout is used.
25194
25195 @item tui disable
25196 @kindex tui disable
25197 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25198
25199 @item info win
25200 @kindex info win
25201 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25202
25203 @item layout @var{name}
25204 @kindex layout
25205 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25206 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25207 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25208
25209 @table @code
25210 @item next
25211 Display the next layout.
25212
25213 @item prev
25214 Display the previous layout.
25215
25216 @item src
25217 Display the source and command windows.
25218
25219 @item asm
25220 Display the assembly and command windows.
25221
25222 @item split
25223 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25224
25225 @item regs
25226 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25227 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25228 register, assembler, and command windows.
25229 @end table
25230
25231 @item focus @var{name}
25232 @kindex focus
25233 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25234 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25235
25236 @table @code
25237 @item next
25238 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25239
25240 @item prev
25241 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25242
25243 @item src
25244 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25245
25246 @item asm
25247 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25248
25249 @item regs
25250 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25251
25252 @item cmd
25253 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25254 @end table
25255
25256 @item refresh
25257 @kindex refresh
25258 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25259
25260 @item tui reg @var{group}
25261 @kindex tui reg
25262 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25263 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25264 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25265 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25266 following groups are available on most targets:
25267 @table @code
25268 @item next
25269 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25270 through all of the available register groups.
25271
25272 @item prev
25273 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25274 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25275 @var{next}.
25276
25277 @item general
25278 Display the general registers.
25279 @item float
25280 Display the floating point registers.
25281 @item system
25282 Display the system registers.
25283 @item vector
25284 Display the vector registers.
25285 @item all
25286 Display all registers.
25287 @end table
25288
25289 @item update
25290 @kindex update
25291 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25292
25293 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25294 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25295 @kindex winheight
25296 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25297 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25298 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25299 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25300 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25301
25302 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25303 @kindex tabset
25304 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25305 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25306 assembly windows.
25307 @end table
25308
25309 @node TUI Configuration
25310 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25311 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25312
25313 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25314
25315 @table @code
25316 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25317 @kindex set tui border-kind
25318 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25319 The possible values are the following:
25320 @table @code
25321 @item space
25322 Use a space character to draw the border.
25323
25324 @item ascii
25325 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25326
25327 @item acs
25328 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25329 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25330 @end table
25331
25332 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25333 @kindex set tui border-mode
25334 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25335 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25336 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25337 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25338 @table @code
25339 @item normal
25340 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25341
25342 @item standout
25343 Use standout mode.
25344
25345 @item reverse
25346 Use reverse video mode.
25347
25348 @item half
25349 Use half bright mode.
25350
25351 @item half-standout
25352 Use half bright and standout mode.
25353
25354 @item bold
25355 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25356
25357 @item bold-standout
25358 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25359 @end table
25360 @end table
25361
25362 @node Emacs
25363 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25364
25365 @cindex Emacs
25366 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25367 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25368 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25369 @value{GDBN}.
25370
25371 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25372 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25373 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25374 created Emacs buffer.
25375 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25376
25377 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25378 things:
25379
25380 @itemize @bullet
25381 @item
25382 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25383 the GUD buffer.
25384
25385 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25386 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25387
25388 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25389 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25390 in this way.
25391
25392 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25393 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25394 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25395 stop.
25396
25397 @item
25398 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25399
25400 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25401 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25402 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25403 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25404 and the source.
25405
25406 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25407 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25408 @end itemize
25409
25410 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25411 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25412 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25413 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25414
25415 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25416 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25417 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25418 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25419 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25420 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25421 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25422 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25423 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25424
25425 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25426 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25427 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25428 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25429
25430 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25431 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25432 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25433 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25434 one you want.
25435
25436 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25437 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25438
25439 @table @kbd
25440 @item C-h m
25441 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25442
25443 @item C-c C-s
25444 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25445 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25446
25447 @item C-c C-n
25448 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25449 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25450 to show the current file and location.
25451
25452 @item C-c C-i
25453 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25454 display window accordingly.
25455
25456 @item C-c C-f
25457 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25458 @code{finish} command.
25459
25460 @item C-c C-r
25461 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25462 command.
25463
25464 @item C-c <
25465 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25466 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25467 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25468
25469 @item C-c >
25470 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25471 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25472 @end table
25473
25474 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25475 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25476
25477 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25478 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25479 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25480 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25481 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25482 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25483 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25484
25485 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25486 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25487 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25488 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25489 frame.
25490
25491 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25492 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25493 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25494 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25495 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25496 to correspond properly with the code.
25497
25498 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25499 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25500 Emacs Manual}).
25501
25502 @node GDB/MI
25503 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25504
25505 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25506
25507 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25508 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25509 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25510 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25511 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25512 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25513
25514 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25515 in the form of a reference manual.
25516
25517 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25518 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25519 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25520
25521 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25522
25523 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25524 This chapter uses the following notation:
25525
25526 @itemize @bullet
25527 @item
25528 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25529
25530 @item
25531 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25532 it may or may not be given.
25533
25534 @item
25535 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25536 may repeat zero or more times.
25537
25538 @item
25539 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25540 may repeat one or more times.
25541
25542 @item
25543 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25544 @end itemize
25545
25546 @ignore
25547 @heading Dependencies
25548 @end ignore
25549
25550 @menu
25551 * GDB/MI General Design::
25552 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25553 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25554 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25555 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25556 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25557 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25558 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25559 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25560 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25561 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25562 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25563 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25564 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25565 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25566 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25567 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25568 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25569 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25570 @ignore
25571 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25572 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25573 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25574 @end ignore
25575 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25576 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25577 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25578 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25579 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25580 @end menu
25581
25582 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25583 @node GDB/MI General Design
25584 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25585 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25586
25587 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25588 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25589 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25590 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25591 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25592 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25593 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25594 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25595 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25596 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25597
25598 The important examples of notifications are:
25599 @itemize @bullet
25600
25601 @item
25602 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25603 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25604 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25605 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25606 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25607 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25608 command itself was successfully executed.
25609
25610 @item
25611 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25612 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25613 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25614 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25615 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25616 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25617
25618 @item
25619 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25620 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25621 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25622 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25623 orthogonal frontend design.
25624
25625 @end itemize
25626
25627 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25628 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25629 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25630 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25631 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25632 the user interface.
25633
25634
25635 @menu
25636 * Context management::
25637 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25638 * Thread groups::
25639 @end menu
25640
25641 @node Context management
25642 @subsection Context management
25643
25644 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25645
25646 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25647 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25648 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25649 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25650 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25651 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25652 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25653 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25654 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25655
25656 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25657 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25658 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25659 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25660 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25661 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25662 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25663 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25664 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25665 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25666 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25667
25668 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25669 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25670 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25671 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25672 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25673 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25674 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25675 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25676 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25677 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25678
25679 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25680 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25681 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25682 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25683 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25684 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25685 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25686 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25687 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25688 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25689 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25690 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25691 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25692 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25693 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25694 @samp{--frame} options.
25695
25696 @subsubsection Language
25697
25698 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25699 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25700 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25701 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25702 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25703 For instance:
25704
25705 @smallexample
25706 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25707 ^done,value="4"
25708 (gdb)
25709 @end smallexample
25710
25711 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25712 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25713 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25714
25715 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25716 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25717
25718 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25719 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25720 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25721 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25722 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25723 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25724 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25725 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25726 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25727
25728 @table @code
25729 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25730 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25731 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25732
25733 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25734 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25735 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25736
25737 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25738 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25739 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25740 MI commands even while the target is running.
25741
25742 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25743 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25744 @end table
25745
25746 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25747 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25748 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25749 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25750 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25751 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25752
25753 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25754 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25755 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25756 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25757 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25758 are running.
25759
25760 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25761 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25762 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25763 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25764 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25765 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25766 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25767 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25768 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25769 @samp{--thread} option).
25770
25771 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25772 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25773 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25774 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25775
25776 @node Thread groups
25777 @subsection Thread groups
25778 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25779 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25780 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25781 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25782 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25783
25784 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25785 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25786 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25787 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25788 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25789 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25790 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25791 into processes.
25792
25793 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25794 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25795 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25796 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25797 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25798 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25799 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25800 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25801 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25802 the members of specific thread group.
25803
25804 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25805 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25806 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25807 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25808 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25809 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25810 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25811 after attaching to that thread group.
25812
25813 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25814 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25815 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25816 such thread groups.
25817
25818 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25819 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25820 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25821
25822 @menu
25823 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25824 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25825 @end menu
25826
25827 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25828 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25829
25830 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25831 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25832 @table @code
25833 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25834 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25835
25836 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25837 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25838 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25839
25840 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25841 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25842 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25843
25844 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25845 "any sequence of digits"
25846
25847 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25848 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25849
25850 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25851 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25852
25853 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25854 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25855
25856 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25857 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25858 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25859
25860 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25861 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25862
25863 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25864 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25865 @end table
25866
25867 @noindent
25868 Notes:
25869
25870 @itemize @bullet
25871 @item
25872 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25873 output is described below.
25874
25875 @item
25876 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25877 finishes.
25878
25879 @item
25880 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25881 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25882 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25883 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25884 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25885 @end itemize
25886
25887 Pragmatics:
25888
25889 @itemize @bullet
25890 @item
25891 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25892
25893 @item
25894 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25895 @end itemize
25896
25897 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25898 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25899
25900 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25901 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25902 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25903 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25904 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25905 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25906
25907 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25908 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25909 @var{token}.
25910
25911 @table @code
25912 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25913 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25914
25915 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25916 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25917
25918 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25919 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25920
25921 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25922 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25923
25924 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25925 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25926
25927 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25928 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25929
25930 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25931 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25932
25933 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25934 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25935
25936 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25937 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25938
25939 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25940 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25941 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25942
25943 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25944 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25945
25946 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25947 @code{ @var{string} }
25948
25949 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25950 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25951
25952 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25953 @code{@var{c-string}}
25954
25955 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25956 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25957
25958 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25959 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25960 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25961
25962 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25963 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25964
25965 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25966 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25967
25968 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25969 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25970
25971 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25972 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25973
25974 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25975 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25976
25977 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25978 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25979 @end table
25980
25981 @noindent
25982 Notes:
25983
25984 @itemize @bullet
25985 @item
25986 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25987
25988 @item
25989 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25990 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25991 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25992 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25993 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25994 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25995 prior command.
25996
25997 @item
25998 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25999 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26000 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26001 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26002
26003 @item
26004 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26005 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26006 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26007 @samp{*}.
26008
26009 @item
26010 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26011 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26012 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26013 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26014
26015 @item
26016 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26017 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26018 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26019 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26020
26021 @item
26022 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26023 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26024 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26025
26026 @item
26027 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26028 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26029 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26030 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26031
26032 @item
26033 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26034 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26035 @var{values}.
26036
26037
26038 @end itemize
26039
26040 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26041 details about the various output records.
26042
26043 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26044 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26045 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26046
26047 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26048 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26049
26050 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26051 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26052 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26053 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26054 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26055 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26056
26057 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26058 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26059 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26060
26061 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26062 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26063 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26064 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26065
26066 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26067 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26068
26069 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26070 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26071 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26072 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26073 might change.
26074
26075 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26076 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26077 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26078 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26079
26080 @itemize @bullet
26081 @item
26082 New MI commands may be added.
26083
26084 @item
26085 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26086
26087 @item
26088 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26089 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26090
26091 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26092 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26093
26094 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26095 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26096 @end itemize
26097
26098 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26099 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26100 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26101 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26102 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26103
26104 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26105 @c version?
26106
26107 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26108 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26109 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26110 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26111 @cindex mailing lists
26112
26113 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26114 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26115 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26116
26117 @menu
26118 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26119 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26120 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26121 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26122 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26123 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26124 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26125 @end menu
26126
26127 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26128 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26129
26130 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26131 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26132 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26133 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26134
26135 @table @code
26136 @findex ^done
26137 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26138 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26139 values.
26140
26141 @item "^running"
26142 @findex ^running
26143 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26144 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26145 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26146 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26147 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26148 which threads are resumed.
26149
26150 @item "^connected"
26151 @findex ^connected
26152 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26153
26154 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26155 @findex ^error
26156 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26157 the corresponding error message.
26158
26159 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26160 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26161 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26162
26163 @table @samp
26164 @item "undefined-command"
26165 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26166 @end table
26167
26168 @item "^exit"
26169 @findex ^exit
26170 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26171
26172 @end table
26173
26174 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26175 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26176
26177 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26178 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26179 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26180 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26181 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26182
26183 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26184 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26185 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26186 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26187 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26188
26189 @table @code
26190 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26191 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26192 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26193
26194 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26195 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26196 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26197 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26198
26199 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26200 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26201 internals.
26202 @end table
26203
26204 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26205 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26206
26207 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26208 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26209 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26210 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26211 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26212 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26213
26214 The following is the list of possible async records:
26215
26216 @table @code
26217
26218 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26219 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26220 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26221 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26222 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26223 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26224 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26225 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26226 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26227 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26228 it run freely.
26229
26230 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26231 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26232 following values:
26233
26234 @table @code
26235 @item breakpoint-hit
26236 A breakpoint was reached.
26237 @item watchpoint-trigger
26238 A watchpoint was triggered.
26239 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26240 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26241 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26242 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26243 @item function-finished
26244 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26245 @item location-reached
26246 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26247 @item watchpoint-scope
26248 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26249 @item end-stepping-range
26250 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26251 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26252 @item exited-signalled
26253 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26254 @item exited
26255 The inferior exited.
26256 @item exited-normally
26257 The inferior exited normally.
26258 @item signal-received
26259 A signal was received by the inferior.
26260 @item solib-event
26261 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26262 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26263 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26264 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26265 @item fork
26266 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26267 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26268 @item vfork
26269 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26270 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26271 @item syscall-entry
26272 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26273 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26274 @item syscall-return
26275 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26276 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26277 @item exec
26278 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26279 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26280 @end table
26281
26282 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26283 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26284 Depending on whether all-stop
26285 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26286 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26287 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26288 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26289 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26290 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26291 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26292 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26293 if such information is not available.
26294
26295 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26296 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26297 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26298 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26299 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26300 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26301 cannot be used in any way.
26302
26303 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26304 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26305 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26306 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26307 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26308 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26309
26310 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26311 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26312 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26313 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26314 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26315 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26316
26317 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26318 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26319 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26320 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26321 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26322
26323 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26324 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26325 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26326 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26327 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26328 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26329 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26330
26331 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26332 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26333 that thread.
26334
26335 @item =library-loaded,...
26336 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26337 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26338 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26339 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26340 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26341 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26342 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26343 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26344 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26345 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26346 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26347 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26348 thread groups.
26349
26350 @item =library-unloaded,...
26351 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26352 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26353 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26354 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26355 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26356 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26357 thread groups.
26358
26359 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26360 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26361 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26362 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26363 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26364
26365 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26366 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26367 initial value @var{initial}.
26368
26369 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26370 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26371 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26372 trace state variables are deleted.
26373
26374 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26375 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26376 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26377 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26378 value of trace state variable is known.
26379
26380 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26381 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26382 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26383 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26384 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26385 user.
26386
26387 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26388 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26389 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26390
26391 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26392 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26393
26394 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26395 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26396 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26397 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26398 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26399
26400 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26401 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26402 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26403 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26404 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26405 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26406
26407 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26408 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26409 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26410 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26411 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26412 executable code.
26413 @end table
26414
26415 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26416 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26417
26418 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26419 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26420 following fields:
26421
26422 @table @code
26423 @item number
26424 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26425 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26426 @samp{1.2}.
26427
26428 @item type
26429 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26430 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26431
26432 @item catch-type
26433 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26434 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26435
26436 @item disp
26437 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26438 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26439 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26440
26441 @item enabled
26442 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26443 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26444 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26445
26446 @item addr
26447 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26448 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26449 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26450 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26451 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26452
26453 @item func
26454 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26455 If not known, this field is not present.
26456
26457 @item filename
26458 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26459 If not known, this field is not present.
26460
26461 @item fullname
26462 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26463 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26464
26465 @item line
26466 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26467 If not known, this field is not present.
26468
26469 @item at
26470 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26471 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26472 by a symbol name.
26473
26474 @item pending
26475 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26476 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26477
26478 @item evaluated-by
26479 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26480 @samp{target}.
26481
26482 @item thread
26483 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26484 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26485
26486 @item task
26487 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26488 field will hold the task identifier.
26489
26490 @item cond
26491 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26492
26493 @item ignore
26494 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26495
26496 @item enable
26497 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26498
26499 @item traceframe-usage
26500 FIXME.
26501
26502 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26503 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26504
26505 @item mask
26506 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26507
26508 @item pass
26509 A tracepoint's pass count.
26510
26511 @item original-location
26512 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26513 This field is optional.
26514
26515 @item times
26516 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26517
26518 @item installed
26519 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26520 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26521 is not.
26522
26523 @item what
26524 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26525
26526 @end table
26527
26528 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26529 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26530
26531 @smallexample
26532 -> -break-insert main
26533 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26534 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26535 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26536 times="0"@}
26537 <- (gdb)
26538 @end smallexample
26539
26540 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26541 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26542
26543 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26544 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26545 fields:
26546
26547 @table @code
26548 @item level
26549 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26550 zero. This field is always present.
26551
26552 @item func
26553 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26554 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26555
26556 @item addr
26557 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26558
26559 @item file
26560 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26561 address. This field may be absent.
26562
26563 @item line
26564 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26565 may be absent.
26566
26567 @item from
26568 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26569 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26570
26571 @end table
26572
26573 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26574 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26575
26576 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26577 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26578
26579 @table @code
26580 @item id
26581 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26582 always present.
26583
26584 @item target-id
26585 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26586
26587 @item details
26588 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26589 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26590 frontend. This field is optional.
26591
26592 @item state
26593 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26594 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26595
26596 @item core
26597 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26598 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26599 @end table
26600
26601 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26602 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26603
26604 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26605 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26606 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26607 the @code{exception-name} field.
26608
26609 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26610 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26611 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26612 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26613
26614 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26615 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26616 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26617 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26618
26619 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26620 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26621
26622 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26623
26624 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26625 information of the breakpoint.
26626
26627 @smallexample
26628 -> -break-insert main
26629 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26630 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26631 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26632 times="0"@}
26633 <- (gdb)
26634 @end smallexample
26635
26636 @subheading Program Execution
26637
26638 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26639 reason that execution stopped.
26640
26641 @smallexample
26642 -> -exec-run
26643 <- ^running
26644 <- (gdb)
26645 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26646 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26647 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26648 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26649 <- (gdb)
26650 -> -exec-continue
26651 <- ^running
26652 <- (gdb)
26653 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26654 <- (gdb)
26655 @end smallexample
26656
26657 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26658
26659 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26660
26661 @smallexample
26662 -> (gdb)
26663 <- -gdb-exit
26664 <- ^exit
26665 @end smallexample
26666
26667 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26668 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26669 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26670 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26671 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26672 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26673
26674 @subheading A Bad Command
26675
26676 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26677
26678 @smallexample
26679 -> -rubbish
26680 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26681 <- (gdb)
26682 @end smallexample
26683
26684
26685 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26686 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26687 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26688
26689 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26690 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26691
26692 @subheading Motivation
26693
26694 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26695
26696 @subheading Introduction
26697
26698 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26699
26700 @subheading Commands
26701
26702 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26703
26704 @subsubheading Synopsis
26705
26706 @smallexample
26707 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26708 @end smallexample
26709
26710 @subsubheading Result
26711
26712 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26713
26714 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26715
26716 @subsubheading Example
26717
26718 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26719 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26720
26721
26722 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26723 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26724 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26725
26726 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26727 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26728 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26729 breakpoints.
26730
26731 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26732 @findex -break-after
26733
26734 @subsubheading Synopsis
26735
26736 @smallexample
26737 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26738 @end smallexample
26739
26740 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26741 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26742 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26743 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26744
26745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26746
26747 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26748
26749 @subsubheading Example
26750
26751 @smallexample
26752 (gdb)
26753 -break-insert main
26754 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26755 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26756 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26757 times="0"@}
26758 (gdb)
26759 -break-after 1 3
26760 ~
26761 ^done
26762 (gdb)
26763 -break-list
26764 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26765 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26766 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26767 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26768 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26769 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26770 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26771 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26772 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26773 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26774 (gdb)
26775 @end smallexample
26776
26777 @ignore
26778 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26779 @findex -break-catch
26780 @end ignore
26781
26782 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26783 @findex -break-commands
26784
26785 @subsubheading Synopsis
26786
26787 @smallexample
26788 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26789 @end smallexample
26790
26791 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26792 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26793 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26794 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26795 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26796 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26797
26798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26799
26800 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26801
26802 @subsubheading Example
26803
26804 @smallexample
26805 (gdb)
26806 -break-insert main
26807 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26808 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26809 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26810 times="0"@}
26811 (gdb)
26812 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26813 ^done
26814 (gdb)
26815 @end smallexample
26816
26817 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26818 @findex -break-condition
26819
26820 @subsubheading Synopsis
26821
26822 @smallexample
26823 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26824 @end smallexample
26825
26826 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26827 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26828 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26829 command below).
26830
26831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26832
26833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26834
26835 @subsubheading Example
26836
26837 @smallexample
26838 (gdb)
26839 -break-condition 1 1
26840 ^done
26841 (gdb)
26842 -break-list
26843 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26844 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26845 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26846 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26847 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26848 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26849 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26850 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26851 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26852 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26853 (gdb)
26854 @end smallexample
26855
26856 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26857 @findex -break-delete
26858
26859 @subsubheading Synopsis
26860
26861 @smallexample
26862 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26863 @end smallexample
26864
26865 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26866 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26867
26868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26869
26870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26871
26872 @subsubheading Example
26873
26874 @smallexample
26875 (gdb)
26876 -break-delete 1
26877 ^done
26878 (gdb)
26879 -break-list
26880 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26881 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26882 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26883 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26884 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26885 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26886 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26887 body=[]@}
26888 (gdb)
26889 @end smallexample
26890
26891 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26892 @findex -break-disable
26893
26894 @subsubheading Synopsis
26895
26896 @smallexample
26897 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26898 @end smallexample
26899
26900 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26901 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26902
26903 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26904
26905 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26906
26907 @subsubheading Example
26908
26909 @smallexample
26910 (gdb)
26911 -break-disable 2
26912 ^done
26913 (gdb)
26914 -break-list
26915 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26916 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26917 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26918 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26919 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26920 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26921 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26922 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26923 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26924 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26925 (gdb)
26926 @end smallexample
26927
26928 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26929 @findex -break-enable
26930
26931 @subsubheading Synopsis
26932
26933 @smallexample
26934 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26935 @end smallexample
26936
26937 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26938
26939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26940
26941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26942
26943 @subsubheading Example
26944
26945 @smallexample
26946 (gdb)
26947 -break-enable 2
26948 ^done
26949 (gdb)
26950 -break-list
26951 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26952 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26953 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26954 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26955 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26956 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26957 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26958 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26959 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26960 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26961 (gdb)
26962 @end smallexample
26963
26964 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26965 @findex -break-info
26966
26967 @subsubheading Synopsis
26968
26969 @smallexample
26970 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26971 @end smallexample
26972
26973 @c REDUNDANT???
26974 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26975
26976 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26977 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26978 table.
26979
26980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26981
26982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26983
26984 @subsubheading Example
26985 N.A.
26986
26987 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26988 @findex -break-insert
26989 @anchor{-break-insert}
26990
26991 @subsubheading Synopsis
26992
26993 @smallexample
26994 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26995 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26996 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26997 @end smallexample
26998
26999 @noindent
27000 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27001
27002 @table @var
27003 @item linespec location
27004 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27005
27006 @item explicit location
27007 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27008 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27009 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27010
27011 @table @samp
27012 @item --source @var{filename}
27013 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27014 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27015
27016 @item --function @var{function}
27017 The name of a function or method.
27018
27019 @item --label @var{label}
27020 The name of a label.
27021
27022 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27023 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27024 @end table
27025
27026 @item address location
27027 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27028 @end table
27029
27030 @noindent
27031 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27032
27033 @table @samp
27034 @item -t
27035 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27036 @item -h
27037 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27038 @item -f
27039 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27040 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27041 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27042 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27043 cannot be parsed.
27044 @item -d
27045 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27046 @item -a
27047 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27048 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27049 @item -c @var{condition}
27050 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27051 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27052 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27053 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27054 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27055 @var{thread-id}.
27056 @end table
27057
27058 @subsubheading Result
27059
27060 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27061 resulting breakpoint.
27062
27063 Note: this format is open to change.
27064 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27065
27066 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27067
27068 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27069 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27070
27071 @subsubheading Example
27072
27073 @smallexample
27074 (gdb)
27075 -break-insert main
27076 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27077 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27078 times="0"@}
27079 (gdb)
27080 -break-insert -t foo
27081 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27082 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27083 times="0"@}
27084 (gdb)
27085 -break-list
27086 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27087 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27088 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27089 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27090 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27091 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27092 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27093 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27094 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27095 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27096 times="0"@},
27097 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27098 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27099 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27100 times="0"@}]@}
27101 (gdb)
27102 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27103 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27104 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27105 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27106 @c times="0"@}
27107 @c (gdb)
27108 @end smallexample
27109
27110 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27111 @findex -dprintf-insert
27112
27113 @subsubheading Synopsis
27114
27115 @smallexample
27116 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27117 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27118 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27119 [ @var{argument} ]
27120 @end smallexample
27121
27122 @noindent
27123 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27124 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27125
27126 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27127
27128 @table @samp
27129 @item -t
27130 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27131 @item -f
27132 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27133 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27134 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27135 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27136 cannot be parsed.
27137 @item -d
27138 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27139 @item -c @var{condition}
27140 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27141 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27142 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27143 to @var{ignore-count}.
27144 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27145 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27146 @var{thread-id}.
27147 @end table
27148
27149 @subsubheading Result
27150
27151 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27152 resulting breakpoint.
27153
27154 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27155
27156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27157
27158 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27159
27160 @subsubheading Example
27161
27162 @smallexample
27163 (gdb)
27164 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27165 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27166 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27167 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27168 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27169 original-location="foo"@}
27170 (gdb)
27171 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27172 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27173 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27174 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27175 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27176 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27177 (gdb)
27178 @end smallexample
27179
27180 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27181 @findex -break-list
27182
27183 @subsubheading Synopsis
27184
27185 @smallexample
27186 -break-list
27187 @end smallexample
27188
27189 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27190
27191 @table @samp
27192 @item Number
27193 number of the breakpoint
27194 @item Type
27195 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27196 @item Disposition
27197 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27198 or @samp{nokeep}
27199 @item Enabled
27200 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27201 @item Address
27202 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27203 @item What
27204 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27205 name, line number
27206 @item Thread-groups
27207 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27208 @item Times
27209 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27210 @end table
27211
27212 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27213 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27214
27215 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27216
27217 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27218
27219 @subsubheading Example
27220
27221 @smallexample
27222 (gdb)
27223 -break-list
27224 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27225 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27226 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27227 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27228 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27229 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27230 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27231 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27232 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27233 times="0"@},
27234 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27235 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27236 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27237 (gdb)
27238 @end smallexample
27239
27240 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27241
27242 @smallexample
27243 (gdb)
27244 -break-list
27245 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27246 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27247 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27248 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27249 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27250 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27251 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27252 body=[]@}
27253 (gdb)
27254 @end smallexample
27255
27256 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27257 @findex -break-passcount
27258
27259 @subsubheading Synopsis
27260
27261 @smallexample
27262 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27263 @end smallexample
27264
27265 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27266 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27267 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27268 command @samp{passcount}.
27269
27270 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27271 @findex -break-watch
27272
27273 @subsubheading Synopsis
27274
27275 @smallexample
27276 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27277 @end smallexample
27278
27279 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27280 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27281 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27282 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27283 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27284 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27285 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27286 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27287
27288 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27289 breakpoints inserted.
27290
27291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27292
27293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27294 @samp{rwatch}.
27295
27296 @subsubheading Example
27297
27298 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27299
27300 @smallexample
27301 (gdb)
27302 -break-watch x
27303 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27304 (gdb)
27305 -exec-continue
27306 ^running
27307 (gdb)
27308 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27309 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27310 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27311 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27312 (gdb)
27313 @end smallexample
27314
27315 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27316 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27317 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27318
27319 @smallexample
27320 (gdb)
27321 -break-watch C
27322 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27323 (gdb)
27324 -exec-continue
27325 ^running
27326 (gdb)
27327 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27328 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27329 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27330 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27331 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27332 (gdb)
27333 -exec-continue
27334 ^running
27335 (gdb)
27336 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27337 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27338 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27339 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27340 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27341 (gdb)
27342 @end smallexample
27343
27344 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27345 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27346 deleted.
27347
27348 @smallexample
27349 (gdb)
27350 -break-watch C
27351 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27352 (gdb)
27353 -break-list
27354 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27355 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27356 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27357 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27358 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27359 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27360 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27361 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27362 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27363 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27364 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27365 times="1"@},
27366 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27367 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27368 (gdb)
27369 -exec-continue
27370 ^running
27371 (gdb)
27372 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27373 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27374 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27375 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27376 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27377 (gdb)
27378 -break-list
27379 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27380 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27381 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27382 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27383 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27384 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27385 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27386 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27387 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27388 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27389 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27390 times="1"@},
27391 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27392 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27393 (gdb)
27394 -exec-continue
27395 ^running
27396 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27397 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27398 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27399 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27400 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27401 (gdb)
27402 -break-list
27403 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27404 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27405 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27406 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27407 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27408 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27409 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27410 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27411 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27412 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27413 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27414 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27415 (gdb)
27416 @end smallexample
27417
27418
27419 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27420 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27421 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27422
27423 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27424 catchpoints.
27425
27426 @menu
27427 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27428 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27429 @end menu
27430
27431 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27432 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27433
27434 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27435 @findex -catch-load
27436
27437 @subsubheading Synopsis
27438
27439 @smallexample
27440 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27441 @end smallexample
27442
27443 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27444 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27445 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27446 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27447 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27448
27449
27450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27451
27452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27453
27454 @subsubheading Example
27455
27456 @smallexample
27457 -catch-load -t foo.so
27458 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27459 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27460 (gdb)
27461 @end smallexample
27462
27463
27464 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27465 @findex -catch-unload
27466
27467 @subsubheading Synopsis
27468
27469 @smallexample
27470 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27471 @end smallexample
27472
27473 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27474 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27475 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27476 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27477 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27478
27479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27480
27481 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27482
27483 @subsubheading Example
27484
27485 @smallexample
27486 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27487 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27488 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27489 (gdb)
27490 @end smallexample
27491
27492 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27493 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27494
27495 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27496 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27497
27498 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27499 @findex -catch-assert
27500
27501 @subsubheading Synopsis
27502
27503 @smallexample
27504 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27505 @end smallexample
27506
27507 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27508
27509 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27510
27511 @table @samp
27512 @item -c @var{condition}
27513 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27514 @item -d
27515 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27516 @item -t
27517 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27518 @end table
27519
27520 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27521
27522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27523
27524 @subsubheading Example
27525
27526 @smallexample
27527 -catch-assert
27528 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27529 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27530 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27531 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27532 (gdb)
27533 @end smallexample
27534
27535 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27536 @findex -catch-exception
27537
27538 @subsubheading Synopsis
27539
27540 @smallexample
27541 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27542 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27543 @end smallexample
27544
27545 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27546 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27547 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27548 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27549 catchpoints.
27550
27551 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27552
27553 @table @samp
27554 @item -c @var{condition}
27555 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27556 @item -d
27557 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27558 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27559 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27560 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27561 @item -t
27562 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27563 @item -u
27564 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27565 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27566 @end table
27567
27568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27569
27570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27571 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27572
27573 @subsubheading Example
27574
27575 @smallexample
27576 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27577 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27578 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27579 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27580 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27581 (gdb)
27582 @end smallexample
27583
27584 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27585 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27586 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27587
27588 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27589 @findex -exec-arguments
27590
27591
27592 @subsubheading Synopsis
27593
27594 @smallexample
27595 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27596 @end smallexample
27597
27598 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27599 @samp{-exec-run}.
27600
27601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27602
27603 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27604
27605 @subsubheading Example
27606
27607 @smallexample
27608 (gdb)
27609 -exec-arguments -v word
27610 ^done
27611 (gdb)
27612 @end smallexample
27613
27614
27615 @ignore
27616 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27617 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27618
27619 @subsubheading Synopsis
27620
27621 @smallexample
27622 -exec-show-arguments
27623 @end smallexample
27624
27625 Print the arguments of the program.
27626
27627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27628
27629 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27630
27631 @subsubheading Example
27632 N.A.
27633 @end ignore
27634
27635
27636 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27637 @findex -environment-cd
27638
27639 @subsubheading Synopsis
27640
27641 @smallexample
27642 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27643 @end smallexample
27644
27645 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27646
27647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27648
27649 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27650
27651 @subsubheading Example
27652
27653 @smallexample
27654 (gdb)
27655 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27656 ^done
27657 (gdb)
27658 @end smallexample
27659
27660
27661 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27662 @findex -environment-directory
27663
27664 @subsubheading Synopsis
27665
27666 @smallexample
27667 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27668 @end smallexample
27669
27670 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27671 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27672 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27673 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27674 occurs as normal.
27675 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27676 multiple directories in a single command
27677 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27678 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27679 If blanks are needed as
27680 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27681 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27682 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27683 character must not be used
27684 in any directory name.
27685 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27686
27687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27688
27689 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27690
27691 @subsubheading Example
27692
27693 @smallexample
27694 (gdb)
27695 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27696 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27697 (gdb)
27698 -environment-directory ""
27699 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27700 (gdb)
27701 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27702 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27703 (gdb)
27704 -environment-directory -r
27705 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27706 (gdb)
27707 @end smallexample
27708
27709
27710 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27711 @findex -environment-path
27712
27713 @subsubheading Synopsis
27714
27715 @smallexample
27716 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27717 @end smallexample
27718
27719 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27720 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27721 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27722 supplied in addition to the
27723 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27724 occurs as normal.
27725 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27726 multiple directories in a single command
27727 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27728 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27729 If blanks are needed as
27730 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27731 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27732 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27733 character must not be used
27734 in any directory name.
27735 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27736
27737
27738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27739
27740 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27741
27742 @subsubheading Example
27743
27744 @smallexample
27745 (gdb)
27746 -environment-path
27747 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27748 (gdb)
27749 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27750 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27751 (gdb)
27752 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27753 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27754 (gdb)
27755 @end smallexample
27756
27757
27758 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27759 @findex -environment-pwd
27760
27761 @subsubheading Synopsis
27762
27763 @smallexample
27764 -environment-pwd
27765 @end smallexample
27766
27767 Show the current working directory.
27768
27769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27770
27771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27772
27773 @subsubheading Example
27774
27775 @smallexample
27776 (gdb)
27777 -environment-pwd
27778 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27779 (gdb)
27780 @end smallexample
27781
27782 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27783 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27784 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27785
27786
27787 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27788 @findex -thread-info
27789
27790 @subsubheading Synopsis
27791
27792 @smallexample
27793 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27794 @end smallexample
27795
27796 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27797 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27798 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
27799 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
27800 current thread.
27801
27802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27803
27804 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27805 about all threads.
27806
27807 @subsubheading Result
27808
27809 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27810 defined for a given thread:
27811
27812 @table @samp
27813 @item current
27814 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27815
27816 @item id
27817 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27818
27819 @item target-id
27820 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27821
27822 @item details
27823 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27824 field is optional.
27825
27826 @item name
27827 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27828 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27829 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27830 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27831 field is omitted.
27832
27833 @item frame
27834 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27835
27836 @item state
27837 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27838 values:
27839
27840 @table @code
27841 @item stopped
27842 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27843 threads.
27844
27845 @item running
27846 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27847 threads.
27848
27849 @end table
27850
27851 @item core
27852 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27853 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27854
27855 @end table
27856
27857 @subsubheading Example
27858
27859 @smallexample
27860 -thread-info
27861 ^done,threads=[
27862 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27863 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27864 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27865 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27866 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27867 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27868 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27869 state="running"@}],
27870 current-thread-id="1"
27871 (gdb)
27872 @end smallexample
27873
27874 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27875 @findex -thread-list-ids
27876
27877 @subsubheading Synopsis
27878
27879 @smallexample
27880 -thread-list-ids
27881 @end smallexample
27882
27883 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
27884 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
27885 threads.
27886
27887 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27888 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27889
27890 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27891
27892 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27893
27894 @subsubheading Example
27895
27896 @smallexample
27897 (gdb)
27898 -thread-list-ids
27899 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27900 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27901 (gdb)
27902 @end smallexample
27903
27904
27905 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27906 @findex -thread-select
27907
27908 @subsubheading Synopsis
27909
27910 @smallexample
27911 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
27912 @end smallexample
27913
27914 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
27915 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
27916 topmost frame for that thread.
27917
27918 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27919 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27920
27921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27922
27923 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27924
27925 @subsubheading Example
27926
27927 @smallexample
27928 (gdb)
27929 -exec-next
27930 ^running
27931 (gdb)
27932 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27933 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27934 (gdb)
27935 -thread-list-ids
27936 ^done,
27937 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27938 number-of-threads="3"
27939 (gdb)
27940 -thread-select 3
27941 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27942 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27943 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27944 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27945 (gdb)
27946 @end smallexample
27947
27948 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27949 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27950 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27951
27952 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27953 @findex -ada-task-info
27954
27955 @subsubheading Synopsis
27956
27957 @smallexample
27958 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27959 @end smallexample
27960
27961 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27962 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27963
27964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27965
27966 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27967 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27968
27969 @subsubheading Result
27970
27971 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27972 defined for each Ada task:
27973
27974 @table @samp
27975 @item current
27976 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27977
27978 @item id
27979 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27980
27981 @item task-id
27982 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27983
27984 @item thread-id
27985 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
27986 task.
27987
27988 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27989 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27990 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27991
27992 @item parent-id
27993 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27994 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27995
27996 @item priority
27997 The base priority of the task.
27998
27999 @item state
28000 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28001 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28002
28003 @item name
28004 The name of the task.
28005
28006 @end table
28007
28008 @subsubheading Example
28009
28010 @smallexample
28011 -ada-task-info
28012 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28013 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28014 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28015 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28016 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28017 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28018 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28019 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28020 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28021 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28022 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28023 (gdb)
28024 @end smallexample
28025
28026 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28027 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28028 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28029
28030 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28031 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28032 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28033 other cases.
28034
28035 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28036 @findex -exec-continue
28037
28038 @subsubheading Synopsis
28039
28040 @smallexample
28041 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28042 @end smallexample
28043
28044 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28045 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28046 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28047 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28048 @itemize @bullet
28049 @item
28050 breakpoints or watchpoints
28051 @item
28052 signals or exceptions
28053 @item
28054 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28055 @item
28056 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28057 @end itemize
28058 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28059 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28060 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28061 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28062 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28063 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28064
28065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28066
28067 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28068
28069 @subsubheading Example
28070
28071 @smallexample
28072 -exec-continue
28073 ^running
28074 (gdb)
28075 @@Hello world
28076 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28077 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28078 line="13"@}
28079 (gdb)
28080 @end smallexample
28081
28082
28083 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28084 @findex -exec-finish
28085
28086 @subsubheading Synopsis
28087
28088 @smallexample
28089 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28090 @end smallexample
28091
28092 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28093 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28094 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28095 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28096 function was called.
28097
28098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28099
28100 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28101
28102 @subsubheading Example
28103
28104 Function returning @code{void}.
28105
28106 @smallexample
28107 -exec-finish
28108 ^running
28109 (gdb)
28110 @@hello from foo
28111 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28112 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28113 (gdb)
28114 @end smallexample
28115
28116 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28117 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28118 value itself.
28119
28120 @smallexample
28121 -exec-finish
28122 ^running
28123 (gdb)
28124 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28125 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28126 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28127 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28128 (gdb)
28129 @end smallexample
28130
28131
28132 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28133 @findex -exec-interrupt
28134
28135 @subsubheading Synopsis
28136
28137 @smallexample
28138 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28139 @end smallexample
28140
28141 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28142 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28143 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28144 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28145 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28146
28147 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28148 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28149 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28150 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28151
28152 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28153 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28154 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28155 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28156
28157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28158
28159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28160
28161 @subsubheading Example
28162
28163 @smallexample
28164 (gdb)
28165 111-exec-continue
28166 111^running
28167
28168 (gdb)
28169 222-exec-interrupt
28170 222^done
28171 (gdb)
28172 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28173 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28174 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28175 (gdb)
28176
28177 (gdb)
28178 -exec-interrupt
28179 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28180 (gdb)
28181 @end smallexample
28182
28183 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28184 @findex -exec-jump
28185
28186 @subsubheading Synopsis
28187
28188 @smallexample
28189 -exec-jump @var{location}
28190 @end smallexample
28191
28192 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28193 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28194 different forms of @var{location}.
28195
28196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28197
28198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28199
28200 @subsubheading Example
28201
28202 @smallexample
28203 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28204 *running,thread-id="all"
28205 ^running
28206 @end smallexample
28207
28208
28209 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28210 @findex -exec-next
28211
28212 @subsubheading Synopsis
28213
28214 @smallexample
28215 -exec-next [--reverse]
28216 @end smallexample
28217
28218 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28219 of the next source line is reached.
28220
28221 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28222 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28223 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28224 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28225 source line where the function was called.
28226
28227
28228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28229
28230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28231
28232 @subsubheading Example
28233
28234 @smallexample
28235 -exec-next
28236 ^running
28237 (gdb)
28238 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28239 (gdb)
28240 @end smallexample
28241
28242
28243 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28244 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28245
28246 @subsubheading Synopsis
28247
28248 @smallexample
28249 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28250 @end smallexample
28251
28252 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28253 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28254 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28255 printed as well.
28256
28257 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28258 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28259 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28260 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28261 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28262
28263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28264
28265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28266
28267 @subsubheading Example
28268
28269 @smallexample
28270 (gdb)
28271 -exec-next-instruction
28272 ^running
28273
28274 (gdb)
28275 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28276 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28277 (gdb)
28278 @end smallexample
28279
28280
28281 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28282 @findex -exec-return
28283
28284 @subsubheading Synopsis
28285
28286 @smallexample
28287 -exec-return
28288 @end smallexample
28289
28290 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28291 Displays the new current frame.
28292
28293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28294
28295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28296
28297 @subsubheading Example
28298
28299 @smallexample
28300 (gdb)
28301 200-break-insert callee4
28302 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28303 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28304 (gdb)
28305 000-exec-run
28306 000^running
28307 (gdb)
28308 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28309 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28310 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28311 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28312 (gdb)
28313 205-break-delete
28314 205^done
28315 (gdb)
28316 111-exec-return
28317 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28318 args=[@{name="strarg",
28319 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28320 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28321 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28322 (gdb)
28323 @end smallexample
28324
28325
28326 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28327 @findex -exec-run
28328
28329 @subsubheading Synopsis
28330
28331 @smallexample
28332 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28333 @end smallexample
28334
28335 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28336 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28337 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28338 the program has exited exceptionally.
28339
28340 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28341 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28342 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28343 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28344 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28345
28346 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28347 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28348 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28349 (@pxref{Starting}).
28350
28351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28352
28353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28354
28355 @subsubheading Examples
28356
28357 @smallexample
28358 (gdb)
28359 -break-insert main
28360 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28361 (gdb)
28362 -exec-run
28363 ^running
28364 (gdb)
28365 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28366 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28367 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28368 (gdb)
28369 @end smallexample
28370
28371 @noindent
28372 Program exited normally:
28373
28374 @smallexample
28375 (gdb)
28376 -exec-run
28377 ^running
28378 (gdb)
28379 x = 55
28380 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28381 (gdb)
28382 @end smallexample
28383
28384 @noindent
28385 Program exited exceptionally:
28386
28387 @smallexample
28388 (gdb)
28389 -exec-run
28390 ^running
28391 (gdb)
28392 x = 55
28393 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28394 (gdb)
28395 @end smallexample
28396
28397 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28398 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28399
28400 @smallexample
28401 (gdb)
28402 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28403 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28404 @end smallexample
28405
28406
28407 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28408
28409
28410 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28411 @findex -exec-step
28412
28413 @subsubheading Synopsis
28414
28415 @smallexample
28416 -exec-step [--reverse]
28417 @end smallexample
28418
28419 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28420 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28421 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28422 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28423 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28424 previously executed source line.
28425
28426 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28427
28428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28429
28430 @subsubheading Example
28431
28432 Stepping into a function:
28433
28434 @smallexample
28435 -exec-step
28436 ^running
28437 (gdb)
28438 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28439 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28440 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28441 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28442 (gdb)
28443 @end smallexample
28444
28445 Regular stepping:
28446
28447 @smallexample
28448 -exec-step
28449 ^running
28450 (gdb)
28451 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28452 (gdb)
28453 @end smallexample
28454
28455
28456 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28457 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28458
28459 @subsubheading Synopsis
28460
28461 @smallexample
28462 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28463 @end smallexample
28464
28465 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28466 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28467 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28468 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28469 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28470 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28471 as well.
28472
28473 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28474
28475 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28476
28477 @subsubheading Example
28478
28479 @smallexample
28480 (gdb)
28481 -exec-step-instruction
28482 ^running
28483
28484 (gdb)
28485 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28486 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28487 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28488 (gdb)
28489 -exec-step-instruction
28490 ^running
28491
28492 (gdb)
28493 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28494 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28495 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28496 (gdb)
28497 @end smallexample
28498
28499
28500 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28501 @findex -exec-until
28502
28503 @subsubheading Synopsis
28504
28505 @smallexample
28506 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28507 @end smallexample
28508
28509 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28510 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28511 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28512 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28513
28514 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28515
28516 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28517
28518 @subsubheading Example
28519
28520 @smallexample
28521 (gdb)
28522 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28523 ^running
28524 (gdb)
28525 x = 55
28526 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28527 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28528 (gdb)
28529 @end smallexample
28530
28531 @ignore
28532 @subheading -file-clear
28533 Is this going away????
28534 @end ignore
28535
28536 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28537 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28538 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28539
28540 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28541 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28542
28543 @smallexample
28544 -enable-frame-filters
28545 @end smallexample
28546
28547 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28548 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28549 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28550 request that this functionality be enabled.
28551
28552 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28553
28554 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28555 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28556
28557 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28558 @findex -stack-info-frame
28559
28560 @subsubheading Synopsis
28561
28562 @smallexample
28563 -stack-info-frame
28564 @end smallexample
28565
28566 Get info on the selected frame.
28567
28568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28569
28570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28571 (without arguments).
28572
28573 @subsubheading Example
28574
28575 @smallexample
28576 (gdb)
28577 -stack-info-frame
28578 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28579 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28580 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28581 (gdb)
28582 @end smallexample
28583
28584 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28585 @findex -stack-info-depth
28586
28587 @subsubheading Synopsis
28588
28589 @smallexample
28590 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28591 @end smallexample
28592
28593 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28594 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28595
28596 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28597
28598 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28599
28600 @subsubheading Example
28601
28602 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28603
28604 @smallexample
28605 (gdb)
28606 -stack-info-depth
28607 ^done,depth="12"
28608 (gdb)
28609 -stack-info-depth 4
28610 ^done,depth="4"
28611 (gdb)
28612 -stack-info-depth 12
28613 ^done,depth="12"
28614 (gdb)
28615 -stack-info-depth 11
28616 ^done,depth="11"
28617 (gdb)
28618 -stack-info-depth 13
28619 ^done,depth="12"
28620 (gdb)
28621 @end smallexample
28622
28623 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28624 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28625 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28626
28627 @subsubheading Synopsis
28628
28629 @smallexample
28630 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28631 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28632 @end smallexample
28633
28634 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28635 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28636 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28637 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28638 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28639 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28640 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28641 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28642
28643 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28644 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28645 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28646 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28647 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28648 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28649
28650 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28651 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28652 are still displayed, however.
28653
28654 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28655 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28656
28657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28658
28659 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28660 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28661 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28662
28663 @subsubheading Example
28664
28665 @smallexample
28666 (gdb)
28667 -stack-list-frames
28668 ^done,
28669 stack=[
28670 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28671 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28672 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28673 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28674 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28675 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28676 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28677 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28678 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28679 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28680 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28681 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28682 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28683 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28684 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28685 (gdb)
28686 -stack-list-arguments 0
28687 ^done,
28688 stack-args=[
28689 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28690 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28691 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28692 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28693 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28694 (gdb)
28695 -stack-list-arguments 1
28696 ^done,
28697 stack-args=[
28698 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28699 frame=@{level="1",
28700 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28701 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28702 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28703 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28704 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28705 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28706 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28707 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28708 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28709 (gdb)
28710 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28711 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28712 (gdb)
28713 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28714 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28715 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28716 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28717 (gdb)
28718 @end smallexample
28719
28720 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28721
28722
28723 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28724 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28725 @findex -stack-list-frames
28726
28727 @subsubheading Synopsis
28728
28729 @smallexample
28730 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28731 @end smallexample
28732
28733 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28734 following info:
28735
28736 @table @samp
28737 @item @var{level}
28738 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28739 @item @var{addr}
28740 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28741 @item @var{func}
28742 Function name.
28743 @item @var{file}
28744 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28745 @item @var{fullname}
28746 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28747 @item @var{line}
28748 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28749 @item @var{from}
28750 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28751 if the frame's function is not known.
28752 @end table
28753
28754 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28755 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28756 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28757 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28758 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28759 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28760 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28761 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28762 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28763
28764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28765
28766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28767
28768 @subsubheading Example
28769
28770 Full stack backtrace:
28771
28772 @smallexample
28773 (gdb)
28774 -stack-list-frames
28775 ^done,stack=
28776 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28777 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28778 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28779 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28780 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28781 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28782 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28783 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28784 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28785 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28786 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28787 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28788 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28789 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28790 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28791 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28792 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28793 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28794 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28795 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28796 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28797 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28798 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28799 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28800 (gdb)
28801 @end smallexample
28802
28803 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28804
28805 @smallexample
28806 (gdb)
28807 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28808 ^done,stack=
28809 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28810 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28811 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28812 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28813 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28814 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28815 (gdb)
28816 @end smallexample
28817
28818 Show a single frame:
28819
28820 @smallexample
28821 (gdb)
28822 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28823 ^done,stack=
28824 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28825 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28826 (gdb)
28827 @end smallexample
28828
28829
28830 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28831 @findex -stack-list-locals
28832 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28833
28834 @subsubheading Synopsis
28835
28836 @smallexample
28837 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28838 @end smallexample
28839
28840 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28841 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28842 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28843 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28844 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28845 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28846 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28847 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28848 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28849 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28850
28851 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28852 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28853 variables are still displayed, however.
28854
28855 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28856 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28857
28858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28859
28860 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28861
28862 @subsubheading Example
28863
28864 @smallexample
28865 (gdb)
28866 -stack-list-locals 0
28867 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28868 (gdb)
28869 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28870 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28871 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28872 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28873 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28874 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28875 (gdb)
28876 @end smallexample
28877
28878 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28879 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28880 @findex -stack-list-variables
28881
28882 @subsubheading Synopsis
28883
28884 @smallexample
28885 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28886 @end smallexample
28887
28888 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28889 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28890 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28891 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28892 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28893 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28894 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28895
28896 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28897 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28898 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28899
28900 @subsubheading Example
28901
28902 @smallexample
28903 (gdb)
28904 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28905 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28906 (gdb)
28907 @end smallexample
28908
28909
28910 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28911 @findex -stack-select-frame
28912
28913 @subsubheading Synopsis
28914
28915 @smallexample
28916 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28917 @end smallexample
28918
28919 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28920 the stack.
28921
28922 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28923 option to every command.
28924
28925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28926
28927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28928 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28929
28930 @subsubheading Example
28931
28932 @smallexample
28933 (gdb)
28934 -stack-select-frame 2
28935 ^done
28936 (gdb)
28937 @end smallexample
28938
28939 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28940 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28941 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28942
28943 @ignore
28944
28945 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28946
28947 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28948 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28949 used by @code{Insight}.
28950
28951 The two main reasons for that are:
28952
28953 @enumerate 1
28954 @item
28955 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28956
28957 @item
28958 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28959 now).
28960 @end enumerate
28961
28962 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28963 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28964 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28965 hints about their use.
28966
28967 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28968 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28969 least, the following operations:
28970
28971 @itemize @bullet
28972 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28973 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28974 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28975 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28976 @end itemize
28977
28978 @end ignore
28979
28980 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28981
28982 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28983
28984 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28985 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28986 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28987 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28988 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28989 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28990 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28991 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28992 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28993 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28994 object, or to change display format.
28995
28996 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28997 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28998 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28999 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29000 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29001 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29002 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29003 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29004 child will be created.
29005
29006 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29007 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29008 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29009 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29010 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29011
29012 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29013 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29014 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29015 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29016 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29017 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29018 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29019 variables that frontend has created.
29020
29021 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29022 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29023 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29024 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29025 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29026 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29027 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29028 implicitly updated.
29029
29030 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29031 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29032 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29033 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29034 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29035 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29036 frame. Consider this example:
29037
29038 @smallexample
29039 void do_work(...)
29040 @{
29041 struct work_state state;
29042
29043 if (...)
29044 do_work(...);
29045 @}
29046 @end smallexample
29047
29048 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29049 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29050 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29051 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29052 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29053
29054 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29055 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29056 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29057 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29058 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29059 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29060
29061 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29062 access this functionality:
29063
29064 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29065 @item @strong{Operation}
29066 @tab @strong{Description}
29067
29068 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29069 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29070 @item @code{-var-create}
29071 @tab create a variable object
29072 @item @code{-var-delete}
29073 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29074 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29075 @tab set the display format of this variable
29076 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29077 @tab show the display format of this variable
29078 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29079 @tab tells how many children this object has
29080 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29081 @tab return a list of the object's children
29082 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29083 @tab show the type of this variable object
29084 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29085 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29086 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29087 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29088 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29089 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29090 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29091 @tab get the value of this variable
29092 @item @code{-var-assign}
29093 @tab set the value of this variable
29094 @item @code{-var-update}
29095 @tab update the variable and its children
29096 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29097 @tab set frozeness attribute
29098 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29099 @tab set range of children to display on update
29100 @end multitable
29101
29102 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29103 how it can be used.
29104
29105 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29106
29107 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29108 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29109
29110 @smallexample
29111 -enable-pretty-printing
29112 @end smallexample
29113
29114 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29115 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29116 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29117 request that this functionality be enabled.
29118
29119 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29120
29121 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29122 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29123
29124 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29125 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29126
29127 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29128 @findex -var-create
29129
29130 @subsubheading Synopsis
29131
29132 @smallexample
29133 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29134 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29135 @end smallexample
29136
29137 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29138 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29139 register.
29140
29141 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29142 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29143 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29144 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29145 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29146
29147 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29148 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29149 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29150 object must be created.
29151
29152 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29153 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29154
29155 @itemize @bullet
29156 @item
29157 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29158
29159 @item
29160 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29161
29162 @item
29163 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29164 @end itemize
29165
29166 @cindex dynamic varobj
29167 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29168 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29169 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29170 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29171 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29172 compatibility for existing clients.
29173
29174 @subsubheading Result
29175
29176 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29177 are:
29178
29179 @table @samp
29180 @item name
29181 The name of the varobj.
29182
29183 @item numchild
29184 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29185 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29186 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29187
29188 @item value
29189 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29190 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29191 will not be interesting.
29192
29193 @item type
29194 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29195 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29196 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29197 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29198 @emph{declared} one.
29199
29200 @item thread-id
29201 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29202 thread's global identifier.
29203
29204 @item has_more
29205 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29206 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29207
29208 @item dynamic
29209 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29210 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29211 then this attribute will not be present.
29212
29213 @item displayhint
29214 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29215 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29216 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29217 @end table
29218
29219 Typical output will look like this:
29220
29221 @smallexample
29222 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29223 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29224 @end smallexample
29225
29226
29227 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29228 @findex -var-delete
29229
29230 @subsubheading Synopsis
29231
29232 @smallexample
29233 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29234 @end smallexample
29235
29236 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29237 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29238
29239 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29240
29241
29242 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29243 @findex -var-set-format
29244
29245 @subsubheading Synopsis
29246
29247 @smallexample
29248 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29249 @end smallexample
29250
29251 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29252 @var{format-spec}.
29253
29254 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29255 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29256
29257 @smallexample
29258 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29259 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29260 @end smallexample
29261
29262 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29263 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29264 for pointers, etc.).
29265
29266 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29267 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29268 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29269 zero-hexadecimal format.
29270
29271 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29272 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29273
29274 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29275 @findex -var-show-format
29276
29277 @subsubheading Synopsis
29278
29279 @smallexample
29280 -var-show-format @var{name}
29281 @end smallexample
29282
29283 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29284
29285 @smallexample
29286 @var{format} @expansion{}
29287 @var{format-spec}
29288 @end smallexample
29289
29290
29291 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29292 @findex -var-info-num-children
29293
29294 @subsubheading Synopsis
29295
29296 @smallexample
29297 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29298 @end smallexample
29299
29300 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29301
29302 @smallexample
29303 numchild=@var{n}
29304 @end smallexample
29305
29306 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29307 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29308 be available.
29309
29310
29311 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29312 @findex -var-list-children
29313
29314 @subsubheading Synopsis
29315
29316 @smallexample
29317 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29318 @end smallexample
29319 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29320
29321 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29322 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29323 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29324 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29325 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29326 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29327 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29328 and unions.
29329
29330 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29331 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29332 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29333 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29334 reported.
29335
29336 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29337 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29338 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29339 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29340 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29341 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29342 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29343 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29344 the visible items.
29345
29346 For each child the following results are returned:
29347
29348 @table @var
29349
29350 @item name
29351 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29352
29353 @item exp
29354 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29355 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29356
29357 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29358 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29359
29360 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29361 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29362 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29363 type and value are not present.
29364
29365 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29366 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29367 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29368
29369 @item numchild
29370 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29371 0.
29372
29373 @item type
29374 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29375 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29376 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29377 @emph{declared} one.
29378
29379 @item value
29380 If values were requested, this is the value.
29381
29382 @item thread-id
29383 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29384 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29385
29386 @item frozen
29387 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29388
29389 @item displayhint
29390 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29391 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29392 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29393
29394 @item dynamic
29395 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29396 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29397 then this attribute will not be present.
29398
29399 @end table
29400
29401 The result may have its own attributes:
29402
29403 @table @samp
29404 @item displayhint
29405 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29406 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29407 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29408
29409 @item has_more
29410 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29411 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29412 @end table
29413
29414 @subsubheading Example
29415
29416 @smallexample
29417 (gdb)
29418 -var-list-children n
29419 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29420 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29421 (gdb)
29422 -var-list-children --all-values n
29423 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29424 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29425 @end smallexample
29426
29427
29428 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29429 @findex -var-info-type
29430
29431 @subsubheading Synopsis
29432
29433 @smallexample
29434 -var-info-type @var{name}
29435 @end smallexample
29436
29437 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29438 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29439 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29440
29441 @smallexample
29442 type=@var{typename}
29443 @end smallexample
29444
29445
29446 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29447 @findex -var-info-expression
29448
29449 @subsubheading Synopsis
29450
29451 @smallexample
29452 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29456 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29457 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29458
29459 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29460 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29461
29462 @smallexample
29463 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29464 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29465 @end smallexample
29466
29467 @noindent
29468 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29469 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29470
29471 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29472 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29473 is of limited use.
29474
29475 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29476 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29477
29478 @subsubheading Synopsis
29479
29480 @smallexample
29481 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29482 @end smallexample
29483
29484 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29485 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29486 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29487 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29488 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29489 watchpoint from a variable object.
29490
29491 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29492 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29493
29494 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29495 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29496 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29497 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29498 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29499 @smallexample
29500 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29501 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29502 @end smallexample
29503
29504 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29505 @findex -var-show-attributes
29506
29507 @subsubheading Synopsis
29508
29509 @smallexample
29510 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29511 @end smallexample
29512
29513 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29514
29515 @smallexample
29516 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29517 @end smallexample
29518
29519 @noindent
29520 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29521
29522 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29523 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29524
29525 @subsubheading Synopsis
29526
29527 @smallexample
29528 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29529 @end smallexample
29530
29531 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29532 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29533 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29534 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29535 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29536 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29537 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29538
29539 @smallexample
29540 value=@var{value}
29541 @end smallexample
29542
29543 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29544 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29545
29546 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29547 @findex -var-assign
29548
29549 @subsubheading Synopsis
29550
29551 @smallexample
29552 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29553 @end smallexample
29554
29555 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29556 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29557 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29558 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29559
29560 @subsubheading Example
29561
29562 @smallexample
29563 (gdb)
29564 -var-assign var1 3
29565 ^done,value="3"
29566 (gdb)
29567 -var-update *
29568 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29569 (gdb)
29570 @end smallexample
29571
29572 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29573 @findex -var-update
29574
29575 @subsubheading Synopsis
29576
29577 @smallexample
29578 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29579 @end smallexample
29580
29581 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29582 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29583 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29584 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29585 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29586 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29587 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29588 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29589 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29590 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29591 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29592 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29593 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29594
29595 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29596 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29597 diagnostic.
29598
29599 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29600 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29601
29602 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29603 @samp{changelist}.
29604
29605 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29606
29607 @table @samp
29608 @item name
29609 The name of the varobj.
29610
29611 @item value
29612 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29613 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29614
29615 @item in_scope
29616 @anchor{-var-update}
29617 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29618
29619 @table @code
29620 @item "true"
29621 The variable object's current value is valid.
29622
29623 @item "false"
29624 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29625 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29626 scope.
29627
29628 @item "invalid"
29629 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29630 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29631 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29632 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29633 objects.
29634 @end table
29635
29636 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29637 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29638
29639 @item type_changed
29640 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29641 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29642 be @samp{false}.
29643
29644 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29645 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29646 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29647 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29648 unset.
29649
29650 @item new_type
29651 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29652 hold the new type.
29653
29654 @item new_num_children
29655 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29656 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29657
29658 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29659 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29660 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29661 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29662 children which may be available.
29663
29664 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29665 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29666 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29667 only happen at the end of the update range).
29668
29669 @item displayhint
29670 The display hint, if any.
29671
29672 @item has_more
29673 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29674 available outside the varobj's update range.
29675
29676 @item dynamic
29677 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29678 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29679 then this attribute will not be present.
29680
29681 @item new_children
29682 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29683 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29684 be listed in this attribute.
29685 @end table
29686
29687 @subsubheading Example
29688
29689 @smallexample
29690 (gdb)
29691 -var-assign var1 3
29692 ^done,value="3"
29693 (gdb)
29694 -var-update --all-values var1
29695 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29696 type_changed="false"@}]
29697 (gdb)
29698 @end smallexample
29699
29700 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29701 @findex -var-set-frozen
29702 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29703
29704 @subsubheading Synopsis
29705
29706 @smallexample
29707 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29708 @end smallexample
29709
29710 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29711 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29712 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29713 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29714 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29715 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29716 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29717 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29718 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29719 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29720 @code{-var-update} does.
29721
29722 @subsubheading Example
29723
29724 @smallexample
29725 (gdb)
29726 -var-set-frozen V 1
29727 ^done
29728 (gdb)
29729 @end smallexample
29730
29731 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29732 @findex -var-set-update-range
29733 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29734
29735 @subsubheading Synopsis
29736
29737 @smallexample
29738 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29739 @end smallexample
29740
29741 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29742 @code{-var-update}.
29743
29744 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29745 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29746 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29747 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29748
29749 @subsubheading Example
29750
29751 @smallexample
29752 (gdb)
29753 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29754 ^done
29755 @end smallexample
29756
29757 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29758 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29759 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29760
29761 @subsubheading Synopsis
29762
29763 @smallexample
29764 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29765 @end smallexample
29766
29767 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29768
29769 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29770 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29771
29772 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29773 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29774 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29775 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29776 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29777 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29778 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29779
29780 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29781 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29782 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29783 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29784
29785 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29786 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29787 can be used to check this.
29788
29789 @subsubheading Example
29790
29791 Resetting the visualizer:
29792
29793 @smallexample
29794 (gdb)
29795 -var-set-visualizer V None
29796 ^done
29797 @end smallexample
29798
29799 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29800
29801 @smallexample
29802 (gdb)
29803 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29804 ^done
29805 @end smallexample
29806
29807 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29808 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29809
29810 @smallexample
29811 (gdb)
29812 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29813 ^done
29814 @end smallexample
29815
29816 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29817 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29818 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29819
29820 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29821 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29822 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29823 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29824
29825 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29826 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29827
29828 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29829 @c @subheading -data-assign
29830 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29831 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29832 @c set variable
29833 @c @subsubheading Example
29834 @c N.A.
29835
29836 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29837 @findex -data-disassemble
29838
29839 @subsubheading Synopsis
29840
29841 @smallexample
29842 -data-disassemble
29843 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29844 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29845 -- @var{mode}
29846 @end smallexample
29847
29848 @noindent
29849 Where:
29850
29851 @table @samp
29852 @item @var{start-addr}
29853 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29854 @item @var{end-addr}
29855 is the end address
29856 @item @var{filename}
29857 is the name of the file to disassemble
29858 @item @var{linenum}
29859 is the line number to disassemble around
29860 @item @var{lines}
29861 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29862 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29863 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29864 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29865 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29866 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29867 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29868 are displayed.
29869 @item @var{mode}
29870 is one of:
29871 @itemize @bullet
29872 @item 0 disassembly only
29873 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
29874 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
29875 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
29876 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
29877 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
29878 @end itemize
29879
29880 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
29881 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
29882 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
29883 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
29884 @end table
29885
29886 @subsubheading Result
29887
29888 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29889 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29890 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29891
29892 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29893 following fields:
29894
29895 @table @code
29896 @item address
29897 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29898
29899 @item func-name
29900 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29901
29902 @item offset
29903 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29904
29905 @item inst
29906 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29907
29908 @item opcodes
29909 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
29910 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29911
29912 @end table
29913
29914 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29915 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29916
29917 @table @code
29918 @item line
29919 The line number within @samp{file}.
29920
29921 @item file
29922 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29923 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29924 used.
29925
29926 @item fullname
29927 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29928 using the source file search path
29929 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29930 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29931
29932 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29933 present in the debug information.
29934
29935 @item line_asm_insn
29936 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29937 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29938 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29939 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29940 @samp{opcodes}.
29941
29942 @end table
29943
29944 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29945 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29946 adjust its format.
29947
29948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29949
29950 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29951
29952 @subsubheading Example
29953
29954 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29955
29956 @smallexample
29957 (gdb)
29958 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29959 ^done,
29960 asm_insns=[
29961 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29962 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29963 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29964 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29965 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29966 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29967 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29968 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29969 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29970 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29971 (gdb)
29972 @end smallexample
29973
29974 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29975 @code{main}.
29976
29977 @smallexample
29978 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29979 ^done,asm_insns=[
29980 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29981 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29982 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29983 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29984 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29985 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29986 [@dots{}]
29987 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29988 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29989 (gdb)
29990 @end smallexample
29991
29992 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29993
29994 @smallexample
29995 (gdb)
29996 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29997 ^done,asm_insns=[
29998 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29999 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30000 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30001 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30002 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30003 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30004 (gdb)
30005 @end smallexample
30006
30007 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30008
30009 @smallexample
30010 (gdb)
30011 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30012 ^done,asm_insns=[
30013 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30014 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30015 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30016 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30017 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30018 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30019 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30020 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30021 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30022 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30023 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30024 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30025 (gdb)
30026 @end smallexample
30027
30028
30029 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30030 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30031
30032 @subsubheading Synopsis
30033
30034 @smallexample
30035 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30036 @end smallexample
30037
30038 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30039 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30040 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30041
30042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30043
30044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30045 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30046 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30047
30048 @subsubheading Example
30049
30050 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30051 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30052 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30053 output.
30054
30055 @smallexample
30056 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30057 211^done,value="1"
30058 (gdb)
30059 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30060 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30061 (gdb)
30062 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30063 411^done,value="4"
30064 (gdb)
30065 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30066 511^done,value="4"
30067 (gdb)
30068 @end smallexample
30069
30070
30071 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30072 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30073
30074 @subsubheading Synopsis
30075
30076 @smallexample
30077 -data-list-changed-registers
30078 @end smallexample
30079
30080 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30081
30082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30083
30084 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30085 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30086
30087 @subsubheading Example
30088
30089 On a PPC MBX board:
30090
30091 @smallexample
30092 (gdb)
30093 -exec-continue
30094 ^running
30095
30096 (gdb)
30097 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30098 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30099 line="5"@}
30100 (gdb)
30101 -data-list-changed-registers
30102 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30103 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30104 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30105 (gdb)
30106 @end smallexample
30107
30108
30109 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30110 @findex -data-list-register-names
30111
30112 @subsubheading Synopsis
30113
30114 @smallexample
30115 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30116 @end smallexample
30117
30118 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30119 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30120 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30121 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30122 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30123 include empty register names.
30124
30125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30126
30127 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30128 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30129 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30130
30131 @subsubheading Example
30132
30133 For the PPC MBX board:
30134 @smallexample
30135 (gdb)
30136 -data-list-register-names
30137 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30138 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30139 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30140 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30141 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30142 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30143 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30144 (gdb)
30145 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30146 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30147 (gdb)
30148 @end smallexample
30149
30150 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30151 @findex -data-list-register-values
30152
30153 @subsubheading Synopsis
30154
30155 @smallexample
30156 -data-list-register-values
30157 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30158 @end smallexample
30159
30160 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30161 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30162 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30163 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30164 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30165 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30166
30167 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30168
30169 @table @code
30170 @item x
30171 Hexadecimal
30172 @item o
30173 Octal
30174 @item t
30175 Binary
30176 @item d
30177 Decimal
30178 @item r
30179 Raw
30180 @item N
30181 Natural
30182 @end table
30183
30184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30185
30186 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30187 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30188
30189 @subsubheading Example
30190
30191 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30192 don't appear in the actual output):
30193
30194 @smallexample
30195 (gdb)
30196 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30197 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30198 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30199 (gdb)
30200 -data-list-register-values x
30201 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30202 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30203 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30204 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30205 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30206 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30207 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30208 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30209 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30210 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30211 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30212 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30213 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30214 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30215 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30216 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30217 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30218 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30219 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30220 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30221 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30222 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30223 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30224 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30225 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30226 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30227 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30228 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30229 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30230 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30231 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30232 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30233 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30234 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30235 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30236 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30237 (gdb)
30238 @end smallexample
30239
30240
30241 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30242 @findex -data-read-memory
30243
30244 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30245
30246 @subsubheading Synopsis
30247
30248 @smallexample
30249 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30250 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30251 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30252 @end smallexample
30253
30254 @noindent
30255 where:
30256
30257 @table @samp
30258 @item @var{address}
30259 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30260 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30261 quoted using the C convention.
30262
30263 @item @var{word-format}
30264 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30265 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30266 ,Output Formats}).
30267
30268 @item @var{word-size}
30269 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30270
30271 @item @var{nr-rows}
30272 The number of rows in the output table.
30273
30274 @item @var{nr-cols}
30275 The number of columns in the output table.
30276
30277 @item @var{aschar}
30278 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30279 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30280 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30281 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30282
30283 @item @var{byte-offset}
30284 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30285 @end table
30286
30287 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30288 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30289 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30290 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30291 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30292 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30293 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30294 @samp{addr}.
30295
30296 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30297 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30298 @samp{prev-page}.
30299
30300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30301
30302 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30303 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30304
30305 @subsubheading Example
30306
30307 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30308 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30309 word. Display each word in hex.
30310
30311 @smallexample
30312 (gdb)
30313 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30314 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30315 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30316 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30317 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30318 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30319 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30320 (gdb)
30321 @end smallexample
30322
30323 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30324 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30325
30326 @smallexample
30327 (gdb)
30328 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30329 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30330 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30331 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30332 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30333 (gdb)
30334 @end smallexample
30335
30336 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30337 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30338 used as the non-printable character.
30339
30340 @smallexample
30341 (gdb)
30342 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30343 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30344 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30345 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30346 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30347 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30348 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30349 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30350 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30351 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30352 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30353 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30354 (gdb)
30355 @end smallexample
30356
30357 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30358 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30359
30360 @subsubheading Synopsis
30361
30362 @smallexample
30363 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30364 @var{address} @var{count}
30365 @end smallexample
30366
30367 @noindent
30368 where:
30369
30370 @table @samp
30371 @item @var{address}
30372 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30373 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30374 quoted using the C convention.
30375
30376 @item @var{count}
30377 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30378 literal.
30379
30380 @item @var{offset}
30381 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30382 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30383 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30384 arithmetics itself.
30385
30386 @end table
30387
30388 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30389 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30390 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30391 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30392 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30393 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30394
30395 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30396 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30397 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30398 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30399 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30400 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30401 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30402 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30403
30404 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30405 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30406 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30407 and has the following fields:
30408
30409 @table @code
30410 @item begin
30411 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30412
30413 @item end
30414 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30415
30416 @item offset
30417 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30418 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30419
30420 @item contents
30421 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30422
30423 @end table
30424
30425
30426
30427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30428
30429 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30430
30431 @subsubheading Example
30432
30433 @smallexample
30434 (gdb)
30435 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30436 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30437 end="0xbffff15e",
30438 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30439 (gdb)
30440 @end smallexample
30441
30442
30443 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30444 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30445
30446 @subsubheading Synopsis
30447
30448 @smallexample
30449 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30450 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30451 @end smallexample
30452
30453 @noindent
30454 where:
30455
30456 @table @samp
30457 @item @var{address}
30458 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30459 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30460 be quoted using the C convention.
30461
30462 @item @var{contents}
30463 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30464 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30465
30466 @item @var{count}
30467 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30468 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30469 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30470 @var{count} memory units.
30471
30472 @end table
30473
30474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30475
30476 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30477
30478 @subsubheading Example
30479
30480 @smallexample
30481 (gdb)
30482 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30483 ^done
30484 (gdb)
30485 @end smallexample
30486
30487 @smallexample
30488 (gdb)
30489 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30490 ^done
30491 (gdb)
30492 @end smallexample
30493
30494 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30495 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30496 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30497
30498 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30499 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30500
30501 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30502 @findex -trace-find
30503
30504 @subsubheading Synopsis
30505
30506 @smallexample
30507 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30508 @end smallexample
30509
30510 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30511 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30512 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30513
30514 @table @samp
30515
30516 @item none
30517 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30518
30519 @item frame-number
30520 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30521 that index.
30522
30523 @item tracepoint-number
30524 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30525 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30526
30527 @item pc
30528 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30529 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30530 address.
30531
30532 @item pc-inside-range
30533 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30534 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30535 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30536
30537 @item pc-outside-range
30538 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30539 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30540 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30541
30542 @item line
30543 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30544 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30545 the specified location.
30546
30547 @end table
30548
30549 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30550 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30551
30552 @table @samp
30553 @item found
30554 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30555 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30556
30557 @item traceframe
30558 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30559 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30560
30561 @item tracepoint
30562 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30563 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30564
30565 @item frame
30566 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30567 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30568 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30569
30570 @end table
30571
30572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30573
30574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30575
30576 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30577 @findex -trace-define-variable
30578
30579 @subsubheading Synopsis
30580
30581 @smallexample
30582 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30583 @end smallexample
30584
30585 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30586 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30587 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30588 with the @samp{$} character.
30589
30590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30591
30592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30593
30594 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30595 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30596
30597 @subsubheading Synopsis
30598
30599 @smallexample
30600 -trace-frame-collected
30601 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30602 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30603 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30604 [--memory-contents]
30605 @end smallexample
30606
30607 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30608 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30609 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30610 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30611 See the output description table below for more details.
30612
30613 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30614 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30615 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30616 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30617 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30618
30619 For instance, if the actions were
30620 @smallexample
30621 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30622 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30623 @end smallexample
30624
30625 @noindent
30626 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30627 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30628 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30629 objects would be computed expressions.
30630
30631 An example output would be:
30632
30633 @smallexample
30634 (gdb)
30635 -trace-frame-collected
30636 ^done,
30637 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30638 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30639 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30640 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30641 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30642 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30643 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30644 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30645 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30646 ...
30647 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30648 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30649 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30650 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30651 (gdb)
30652 @end smallexample
30653
30654 Where:
30655
30656 @table @code
30657 @item explicit-variables
30658 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30659 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30660 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30661 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30662 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30663 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30664 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30665 arrays, structures and unions.
30666
30667 @item computed-expressions
30668 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30669 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30670 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30671 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30672
30673 @item registers
30674 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30675 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30676 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30677 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30678 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30679
30680 @item tvars
30681 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30682 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30683 current value are returned.
30684
30685 @item memory
30686 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30687 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30688 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30689
30690 @table @code
30691 @item address
30692 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30693
30694 @item length
30695 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30696
30697 @item contents
30698 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30699 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30700
30701 @end table
30702
30703 @end table
30704
30705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30706
30707 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30708
30709 @subsubheading Example
30710
30711 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30712 @findex -trace-list-variables
30713
30714 @subsubheading Synopsis
30715
30716 @smallexample
30717 -trace-list-variables
30718 @end smallexample
30719
30720 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30721 table has the following fields:
30722
30723 @table @samp
30724 @item name
30725 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30726
30727 @item initial
30728 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30729 field is always present.
30730
30731 @item current
30732 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30733 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30734 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30735 presently running.
30736
30737 @end table
30738
30739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30740
30741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30742
30743 @subsubheading Example
30744
30745 @smallexample
30746 (gdb)
30747 -trace-list-variables
30748 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30749 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30750 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30751 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30752 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30753 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30754 (gdb)
30755 @end smallexample
30756
30757 @subheading -trace-save
30758 @findex -trace-save
30759
30760 @subsubheading Synopsis
30761
30762 @smallexample
30763 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30764 @end smallexample
30765
30766 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30767 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30768 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30769 to perform the save.
30770
30771 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30772
30773 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30774
30775
30776 @subheading -trace-start
30777 @findex -trace-start
30778
30779 @subsubheading Synopsis
30780
30781 @smallexample
30782 -trace-start
30783 @end smallexample
30784
30785 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30786 have any fields.
30787
30788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30789
30790 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30791
30792 @subheading -trace-status
30793 @findex -trace-status
30794
30795 @subsubheading Synopsis
30796
30797 @smallexample
30798 -trace-status
30799 @end smallexample
30800
30801 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30802 the following fields:
30803
30804 @table @samp
30805
30806 @item supported
30807 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30808 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30809 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30810 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30811 started. This field is always present.
30812
30813 @item running
30814 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30815 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30816 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30817
30818 @item stop-reason
30819 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30820 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30821 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30822 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30823 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30824 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30825 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30826 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30827 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30828
30829 @item stopping-tracepoint
30830 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30831 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30832 @samp{passcount}.
30833
30834 @item frames
30835 @itemx frames-created
30836 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30837 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30838 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30839 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30840
30841 @item buffer-size
30842 @itemx buffer-free
30843 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30844 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30845
30846 @item circular
30847 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30848 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30849 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30850 and may fill up.
30851
30852 @item disconnected
30853 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30854 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30855 that the trace run will stop.
30856
30857 @item trace-file
30858 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30859 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30860
30861 @end table
30862
30863 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30864
30865 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30866
30867 @subheading -trace-stop
30868 @findex -trace-stop
30869
30870 @subsubheading Synopsis
30871
30872 @smallexample
30873 -trace-stop
30874 @end smallexample
30875
30876 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30877 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30878 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30879
30880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30881
30882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30883
30884
30885 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30886 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30887 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30888
30889
30890 @ignore
30891 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30892 @findex -symbol-info-address
30893
30894 @subsubheading Synopsis
30895
30896 @smallexample
30897 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30898 @end smallexample
30899
30900 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30901
30902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30903
30904 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30905
30906 @subsubheading Example
30907 N.A.
30908
30909
30910 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30911 @findex -symbol-info-file
30912
30913 @subsubheading Synopsis
30914
30915 @smallexample
30916 -symbol-info-file
30917 @end smallexample
30918
30919 Show the file for the symbol.
30920
30921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30922
30923 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30924 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30925
30926 @subsubheading Example
30927 N.A.
30928
30929
30930 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30931 @findex -symbol-info-function
30932
30933 @subsubheading Synopsis
30934
30935 @smallexample
30936 -symbol-info-function
30937 @end smallexample
30938
30939 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30940
30941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30942
30943 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30944
30945 @subsubheading Example
30946 N.A.
30947
30948
30949 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30950 @findex -symbol-info-line
30951
30952 @subsubheading Synopsis
30953
30954 @smallexample
30955 -symbol-info-line
30956 @end smallexample
30957
30958 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30959
30960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30961
30962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30963 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30964
30965 @subsubheading Example
30966 N.A.
30967
30968
30969 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30970 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30971
30972 @subsubheading Synopsis
30973
30974 @smallexample
30975 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30976 @end smallexample
30977
30978 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30979
30980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30981
30982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30983
30984 @subsubheading Example
30985 N.A.
30986
30987
30988 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30989 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30990
30991 @subsubheading Synopsis
30992
30993 @smallexample
30994 -symbol-list-functions
30995 @end smallexample
30996
30997 List the functions in the executable.
30998
30999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31000
31001 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31002 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31003
31004 @subsubheading Example
31005 N.A.
31006 @end ignore
31007
31008
31009 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31010 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31011
31012 @subsubheading Synopsis
31013
31014 @smallexample
31015 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31016 @end smallexample
31017
31018 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31019 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31020 ascending PC order.
31021
31022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31023
31024 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31025
31026 @subsubheading Example
31027 @smallexample
31028 (gdb)
31029 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31030 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31031 (gdb)
31032 @end smallexample
31033
31034
31035 @ignore
31036 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31037 @findex -symbol-list-types
31038
31039 @subsubheading Synopsis
31040
31041 @smallexample
31042 -symbol-list-types
31043 @end smallexample
31044
31045 List all the type names.
31046
31047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31048
31049 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31050 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31051
31052 @subsubheading Example
31053 N.A.
31054
31055
31056 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31057 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31058
31059 @subsubheading Synopsis
31060
31061 @smallexample
31062 -symbol-list-variables
31063 @end smallexample
31064
31065 List all the global and static variable names.
31066
31067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31068
31069 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31070
31071 @subsubheading Example
31072 N.A.
31073
31074
31075 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31076 @findex -symbol-locate
31077
31078 @subsubheading Synopsis
31079
31080 @smallexample
31081 -symbol-locate
31082 @end smallexample
31083
31084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31085
31086 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31087
31088 @subsubheading Example
31089 N.A.
31090
31091
31092 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31093 @findex -symbol-type
31094
31095 @subsubheading Synopsis
31096
31097 @smallexample
31098 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31099 @end smallexample
31100
31101 Show type of @var{variable}.
31102
31103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31104
31105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31106 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31107
31108 @subsubheading Example
31109 N.A.
31110 @end ignore
31111
31112
31113 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31114 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31115 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31116
31117 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31118 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31119
31120 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31121 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31122
31123 @subsubheading Synopsis
31124
31125 @smallexample
31126 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31127 @end smallexample
31128
31129 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31130 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31131 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31132 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31133 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31134 notification.
31135
31136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31137
31138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31139
31140 @subsubheading Example
31141
31142 @smallexample
31143 (gdb)
31144 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31145 ^done
31146 (gdb)
31147 @end smallexample
31148
31149
31150 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31151 @findex -file-exec-file
31152
31153 @subsubheading Synopsis
31154
31155 @smallexample
31156 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31157 @end smallexample
31158
31159 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31160 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31161 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31162 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31163 notification.
31164
31165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31166
31167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31168
31169 @subsubheading Example
31170
31171 @smallexample
31172 (gdb)
31173 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31174 ^done
31175 (gdb)
31176 @end smallexample
31177
31178
31179 @ignore
31180 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31181 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31182
31183 @subsubheading Synopsis
31184
31185 @smallexample
31186 -file-list-exec-sections
31187 @end smallexample
31188
31189 List the sections of the current executable file.
31190
31191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31192
31193 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31194 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31195 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31196
31197 @subsubheading Example
31198 N.A.
31199 @end ignore
31200
31201
31202 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31203 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31204
31205 @subsubheading Synopsis
31206
31207 @smallexample
31208 -file-list-exec-source-file
31209 @end smallexample
31210
31211 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31212 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31213 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31214 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31215
31216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31217
31218 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31219
31220 @subsubheading Example
31221
31222 @smallexample
31223 (gdb)
31224 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31225 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31226 (gdb)
31227 @end smallexample
31228
31229
31230 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31231 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31232
31233 @subsubheading Synopsis
31234
31235 @smallexample
31236 -file-list-exec-source-files
31237 @end smallexample
31238
31239 List the source files for the current executable.
31240
31241 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31242 name) of a source file.
31243
31244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31245
31246 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31247 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31248
31249 @subsubheading Example
31250 @smallexample
31251 (gdb)
31252 -file-list-exec-source-files
31253 ^done,files=[
31254 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31255 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31256 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31257 (gdb)
31258 @end smallexample
31259
31260 @ignore
31261 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31262 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31263
31264 @subsubheading Synopsis
31265
31266 @smallexample
31267 -file-list-shared-libraries
31268 @end smallexample
31269
31270 List the shared libraries in the program.
31271
31272 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31273
31274 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31275
31276 @subsubheading Example
31277 N.A.
31278
31279
31280 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31281 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31282
31283 @subsubheading Synopsis
31284
31285 @smallexample
31286 -file-list-symbol-files
31287 @end smallexample
31288
31289 List symbol files.
31290
31291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31292
31293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31294
31295 @subsubheading Example
31296 N.A.
31297 @end ignore
31298
31299
31300 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31301 @findex -file-symbol-file
31302
31303 @subsubheading Synopsis
31304
31305 @smallexample
31306 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31307 @end smallexample
31308
31309 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31310 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31311 produced, except for a completion notification.
31312
31313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31314
31315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31316
31317 @subsubheading Example
31318
31319 @smallexample
31320 (gdb)
31321 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31322 ^done
31323 (gdb)
31324 @end smallexample
31325
31326 @ignore
31327 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31328 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31329 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31330
31331 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31332
31333 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31334
31335 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31336
31337 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31338
31339 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31340
31341 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31342
31343 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31344
31345 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31346
31347 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31348 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31349 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31350
31351 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31352
31353 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31354
31355 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31356
31357 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31358 @end ignore
31359
31360
31361 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31362 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31363 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31364
31365
31366 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31367 @findex -target-attach
31368
31369 @subsubheading Synopsis
31370
31371 @smallexample
31372 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31373 @end smallexample
31374
31375 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31376 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31377 group, the id previously returned by
31378 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31379
31380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31381
31382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31383
31384 @subsubheading Example
31385 @smallexample
31386 (gdb)
31387 -target-attach 34
31388 =thread-created,id="1"
31389 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31390 ^done
31391 (gdb)
31392 @end smallexample
31393
31394 @ignore
31395 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31396 @findex -target-compare-sections
31397
31398 @subsubheading Synopsis
31399
31400 @smallexample
31401 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31402 @end smallexample
31403
31404 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31405 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31406
31407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31408
31409 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31410
31411 @subsubheading Example
31412 N.A.
31413 @end ignore
31414
31415
31416 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31417 @findex -target-detach
31418
31419 @subsubheading Synopsis
31420
31421 @smallexample
31422 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31423 @end smallexample
31424
31425 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31426 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31427 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31428
31429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31430
31431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31432
31433 @subsubheading Example
31434
31435 @smallexample
31436 (gdb)
31437 -target-detach
31438 ^done
31439 (gdb)
31440 @end smallexample
31441
31442
31443 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31444 @findex -target-disconnect
31445
31446 @subsubheading Synopsis
31447
31448 @smallexample
31449 -target-disconnect
31450 @end smallexample
31451
31452 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31453 generally not resumed.
31454
31455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31456
31457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31458
31459 @subsubheading Example
31460
31461 @smallexample
31462 (gdb)
31463 -target-disconnect
31464 ^done
31465 (gdb)
31466 @end smallexample
31467
31468
31469 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31470 @findex -target-download
31471
31472 @subsubheading Synopsis
31473
31474 @smallexample
31475 -target-download
31476 @end smallexample
31477
31478 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31479 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31480
31481 @table @samp
31482 @item section
31483 The name of the section.
31484 @item section-sent
31485 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31486 @item section-size
31487 The size of the section.
31488 @item total-sent
31489 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31490 @item total-size
31491 The size of the overall executable to download.
31492 @end table
31493
31494 @noindent
31495 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31496 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31497
31498 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31499 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31500
31501 @table @samp
31502 @item section
31503 The name of the section.
31504 @item section-size
31505 The size of the section.
31506 @item total-size
31507 The size of the overall executable to download.
31508 @end table
31509
31510 @noindent
31511 At the end, a summary is printed.
31512
31513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31514
31515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31516
31517 @subsubheading Example
31518
31519 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31520 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31521
31522 @smallexample
31523 (gdb)
31524 -target-download
31525 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31526 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31527 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31528 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31529 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31530 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31531 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31532 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31533 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31534 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31535 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31536 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31537 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31538 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31539 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31540 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31541 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31542 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31543 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31544 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31545 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31546 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31547 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31548 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31549 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31550 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31551 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31552 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31553 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31554 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31555 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31556 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31557 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31558 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31559 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31560 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31561 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31562 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31563 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31564 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31565 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31566 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31567 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31568 write-rate="429"
31569 (gdb)
31570 @end smallexample
31571
31572
31573 @ignore
31574 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31575 @findex -target-exec-status
31576
31577 @subsubheading Synopsis
31578
31579 @smallexample
31580 -target-exec-status
31581 @end smallexample
31582
31583 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31584 not, for instance).
31585
31586 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31587
31588 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31589
31590 @subsubheading Example
31591 N.A.
31592
31593
31594 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31595 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31596
31597 @subsubheading Synopsis
31598
31599 @smallexample
31600 -target-list-available-targets
31601 @end smallexample
31602
31603 List the possible targets to connect to.
31604
31605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31606
31607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31608
31609 @subsubheading Example
31610 N.A.
31611
31612
31613 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31614 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31615
31616 @subsubheading Synopsis
31617
31618 @smallexample
31619 -target-list-current-targets
31620 @end smallexample
31621
31622 Describe the current target.
31623
31624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31625
31626 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31627 other things).
31628
31629 @subsubheading Example
31630 N.A.
31631
31632
31633 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31634 @findex -target-list-parameters
31635
31636 @subsubheading Synopsis
31637
31638 @smallexample
31639 -target-list-parameters
31640 @end smallexample
31641
31642 @c ????
31643 @end ignore
31644
31645 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31646
31647 No equivalent.
31648
31649 @subsubheading Example
31650 N.A.
31651
31652
31653 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31654 @findex -target-select
31655
31656 @subsubheading Synopsis
31657
31658 @smallexample
31659 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31660 @end smallexample
31661
31662 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31663
31664 @table @samp
31665 @item @var{type}
31666 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31667 @item @var{parameters}
31668 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31669 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31670 @end table
31671
31672 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31673 which the target program is, in the following form:
31674
31675 @smallexample
31676 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31677 args=[@var{arg list}]
31678 @end smallexample
31679
31680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31681
31682 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31683
31684 @subsubheading Example
31685
31686 @smallexample
31687 (gdb)
31688 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31689 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31690 (gdb)
31691 @end smallexample
31692
31693 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31694 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31695 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31696
31697
31698 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31699 @findex -target-file-put
31700
31701 @subsubheading Synopsis
31702
31703 @smallexample
31704 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31705 @end smallexample
31706
31707 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31708 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31709
31710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31711
31712 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31713
31714 @subsubheading Example
31715
31716 @smallexample
31717 (gdb)
31718 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31719 ^done
31720 (gdb)
31721 @end smallexample
31722
31723
31724 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31725 @findex -target-file-get
31726
31727 @subsubheading Synopsis
31728
31729 @smallexample
31730 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31731 @end smallexample
31732
31733 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31734 on the host system.
31735
31736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31737
31738 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31739
31740 @subsubheading Example
31741
31742 @smallexample
31743 (gdb)
31744 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31745 ^done
31746 (gdb)
31747 @end smallexample
31748
31749
31750 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31751 @findex -target-file-delete
31752
31753 @subsubheading Synopsis
31754
31755 @smallexample
31756 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31757 @end smallexample
31758
31759 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31760
31761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31762
31763 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31764
31765 @subsubheading Example
31766
31767 @smallexample
31768 (gdb)
31769 -target-file-delete remotefile
31770 ^done
31771 (gdb)
31772 @end smallexample
31773
31774
31775 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31776 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31777 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31778
31779 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31780 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31781
31782 @subsubheading Synopsis
31783
31784 @smallexample
31785 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31786 @end smallexample
31787
31788 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31789 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31790 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31791
31792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31793
31794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31795
31796 @subsubheading Result
31797
31798 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31799 defined for each exception:
31800
31801 @table @samp
31802 @item name
31803 The name of the exception.
31804
31805 @item address
31806 The address of the exception.
31807
31808 @end table
31809
31810 @subsubheading Example
31811
31812 @smallexample
31813 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31814 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31815 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31816 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31817 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31818 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31819 @end smallexample
31820
31821 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31822
31823 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31824 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31825 Catchpoint Commands}.
31826
31827
31828 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31829 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31830 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31831
31832 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31833 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31834 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31835 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31836
31837 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31838 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31839 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31840
31841 @subsubheading Synopsis
31842
31843 @smallexample
31844 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31845 @end smallexample
31846
31847 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31848
31849 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31850 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31851 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31852 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31853 dash.
31854
31855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31856
31857 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31858
31859 @subsubheading Result
31860
31861 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31862
31863 @table @samp
31864 @item exists
31865 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31866 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31867
31868 @end table
31869
31870 @subsubheading Example
31871
31872 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31873
31874 @smallexample
31875 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31876 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31877 @end smallexample
31878
31879 @noindent
31880 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31881 to the debugger:
31882
31883 @smallexample
31884 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31885 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31886 @end smallexample
31887
31888 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31889 @findex -list-features
31890 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31891
31892 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31893 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31894 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31895 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31896 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31897 startup.
31898
31899 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31900 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31901 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31902 is given below.
31903
31904 Example output:
31905
31906 @smallexample
31907 (gdb) -list-features
31908 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31909 @end smallexample
31910
31911 The current list of features is:
31912
31913 @ftable @samp
31914 @item frozen-varobjs
31915 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31916 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31917 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31918 @item pending-breakpoints
31919 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31920 command.
31921 @item python
31922 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31923 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31924 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31925 @item thread-info
31926 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31927 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31928 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31929 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31930 @item breakpoint-notifications
31931 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31932 CLI will be announced via async records.
31933 @item ada-task-info
31934 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31935 @item language-option
31936 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31937 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31938 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31939 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31940 @item undefined-command-error-code
31941 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31942 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31943 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31944 @item exec-run-start-option
31945 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31946 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31947 @end ftable
31948
31949 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31950 @findex -list-target-features
31951
31952 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31953 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31954 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31955 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31956 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31957 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31958 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31959 Example output:
31960
31961 @smallexample
31962 (gdb) -list-target-features
31963 ^done,result=["async"]
31964 @end smallexample
31965
31966 The current list of features is:
31967
31968 @table @samp
31969 @item async
31970 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31971 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31972 while the target is running.
31973
31974 @item reverse
31975 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31976 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31977
31978 @end table
31979
31980 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31981 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31982 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31983
31984 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31985
31986 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31987 @findex -gdb-exit
31988
31989 @subsubheading Synopsis
31990
31991 @smallexample
31992 -gdb-exit
31993 @end smallexample
31994
31995 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31996
31997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31998
31999 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32000
32001 @subsubheading Example
32002
32003 @smallexample
32004 (gdb)
32005 -gdb-exit
32006 ^exit
32007 @end smallexample
32008
32009
32010 @ignore
32011 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32012 @findex -exec-abort
32013
32014 @subsubheading Synopsis
32015
32016 @smallexample
32017 -exec-abort
32018 @end smallexample
32019
32020 Kill the inferior running program.
32021
32022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32023
32024 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32025
32026 @subsubheading Example
32027 N.A.
32028 @end ignore
32029
32030
32031 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32032 @findex -gdb-set
32033
32034 @subsubheading Synopsis
32035
32036 @smallexample
32037 -gdb-set
32038 @end smallexample
32039
32040 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32041 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32042
32043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32044
32045 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32046
32047 @subsubheading Example
32048
32049 @smallexample
32050 (gdb)
32051 -gdb-set $foo=3
32052 ^done
32053 (gdb)
32054 @end smallexample
32055
32056
32057 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32058 @findex -gdb-show
32059
32060 @subsubheading Synopsis
32061
32062 @smallexample
32063 -gdb-show
32064 @end smallexample
32065
32066 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32067
32068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32069
32070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32071
32072 @subsubheading Example
32073
32074 @smallexample
32075 (gdb)
32076 -gdb-show annotate
32077 ^done,value="0"
32078 (gdb)
32079 @end smallexample
32080
32081 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32082
32083
32084 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32085 @findex -gdb-version
32086
32087 @subsubheading Synopsis
32088
32089 @smallexample
32090 -gdb-version
32091 @end smallexample
32092
32093 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32094
32095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32096
32097 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32098 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32099
32100 @subsubheading Example
32101
32102 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32103 @c box in TeX.
32104 @smallexample
32105 (gdb)
32106 -gdb-version
32107 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32108 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32109 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32110 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32111 ~ certain conditions.
32112 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32113 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32114 ~ details.
32115 ~This GDB was configured as
32116 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32117 ^done
32118 (gdb)
32119 @end smallexample
32120
32121 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32122 @findex -list-thread-groups
32123
32124 @subheading Synopsis
32125
32126 @smallexample
32127 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32128 @end smallexample
32129
32130 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32131 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32132 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32133 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32134 top-level thread groups.
32135
32136 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32137 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32138 available on the target.
32139
32140 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32141 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32142 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32143 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32144 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32145 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32146 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32147 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32148
32149 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32150 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32151 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32152 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32153 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32154 @samp{threads} field.
32155
32156 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32157 the following caveats:
32158
32159 @itemize @bullet
32160 @item
32161 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32162 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32163 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32164
32165 @item
32166 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32167 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32168 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32169 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32170 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32171 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32172
32173 @end itemize
32174
32175 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32176 have the following fields:
32177
32178 @table @code
32179 @item id
32180 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32181 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32182 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32183
32184 @item type
32185 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32186 valid type.
32187
32188 @item pid
32189 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32190 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32191
32192 @item exit-code
32193 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32194 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32195 only if the process is not running.
32196
32197 @item num_children
32198 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32199 absent for an available thread group.
32200
32201 @item threads
32202 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32203 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32204 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32205
32206 @item cores
32207 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32208 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32209 such information is not available.
32210
32211 @item executable
32212 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32213 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32214 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32215
32216 @end table
32217
32218 @subheading Example
32219
32220 @smallexample
32221 @value{GDBP}
32222 -list-thread-groups
32223 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32224 -list-thread-groups 17
32225 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32226 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32227 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32228 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32229 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32230 -list-thread-groups --available
32231 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32232 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32233 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32234 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32235 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32236 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32237 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32238 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32239 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32240 @end smallexample
32241
32242 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32243 @findex -info-os
32244
32245 @subsubheading Synopsis
32246
32247 @smallexample
32248 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32249 @end smallexample
32250
32251 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32252 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32253 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32254 of data of that type.
32255
32256 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32257 system.
32258
32259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32260
32261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32262
32263 @subsubheading Example
32264
32265 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32266 like this:
32267
32268 @smallexample
32269 @value{GDBP}
32270 -info-os
32271 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32272 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32273 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32274 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32275 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32276 col2="CPUs"@},
32277 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32278 col2="File descriptors"@},
32279 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32280 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32281 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32282 col2="Message queues"@},
32283 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32284 col2="Processes"@},
32285 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32286 col2="Process groups"@},
32287 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32288 col2="Semaphores"@},
32289 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32290 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32291 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32292 col2="Sockets"@},
32293 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32294 col2="Threads"@}]
32295 @value{GDBP}
32296 -info-os processes
32297 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32298 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32299 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32300 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32301 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32302 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32303 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32304 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32305 ...
32306 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32307 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32308 (gdb)
32309 @end smallexample
32310
32311 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32312 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32313 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32314 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32315 @code{info os} omits it.)
32316
32317 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32318 @findex -add-inferior
32319
32320 @subheading Synopsis
32321
32322 @smallexample
32323 -add-inferior
32324 @end smallexample
32325
32326 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32327 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32328 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32329 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32330 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32331 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32332
32333 @subheading Example
32334
32335 @smallexample
32336 @value{GDBP}
32337 -add-inferior
32338 ^done,inferior="i3"
32339 @end smallexample
32340
32341 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32342 @findex -interpreter-exec
32343
32344 @subheading Synopsis
32345
32346 @smallexample
32347 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32348 @end smallexample
32349 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32350
32351 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32352
32353 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32354
32355 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32356
32357 @subheading Example
32358
32359 @smallexample
32360 (gdb)
32361 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32362 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32363 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32364 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32365 ^done
32366 (gdb)
32367 @end smallexample
32368
32369 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32370 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32371
32372 @subheading Synopsis
32373
32374 @smallexample
32375 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32376 @end smallexample
32377
32378 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32379
32380 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32381
32382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32383
32384 @subheading Example
32385
32386 @smallexample
32387 (gdb)
32388 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32389 ^done
32390 (gdb)
32391 @end smallexample
32392
32393 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32394 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32395
32396 @subheading Synopsis
32397
32398 @smallexample
32399 -inferior-tty-show
32400 @end smallexample
32401
32402 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32403
32404 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32405
32406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32407
32408 @subheading Example
32409
32410 @smallexample
32411 (gdb)
32412 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32413 ^done
32414 (gdb)
32415 -inferior-tty-show
32416 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32417 (gdb)
32418 @end smallexample
32419
32420 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32421 @findex -enable-timings
32422
32423 @subheading Synopsis
32424
32425 @smallexample
32426 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32427 @end smallexample
32428
32429 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32430 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32431 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32432 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32433
32434 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32435
32436 No equivalent.
32437
32438 @subheading Example
32439
32440 @smallexample
32441 (gdb)
32442 -enable-timings
32443 ^done
32444 (gdb)
32445 -break-insert main
32446 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32447 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32448 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32449 times="0"@},
32450 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32451 (gdb)
32452 -enable-timings no
32453 ^done
32454 (gdb)
32455 -exec-run
32456 ^running
32457 (gdb)
32458 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32459 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32460 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32461 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32462 (gdb)
32463 @end smallexample
32464
32465 @node Annotations
32466 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32467
32468 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32469 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32470 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32471 relatively high level.
32472
32473 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32474 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32475
32476 @ignore
32477 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32478 @end ignore
32479
32480 @menu
32481 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32482 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32483 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32484 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32485 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32486 * Annotations for Running::
32487 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32488 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32489 @end menu
32490
32491 @node Annotations Overview
32492 @section What is an Annotation?
32493 @cindex annotations
32494
32495 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32496 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32497 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32498 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32499 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32500 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32501 cannot contain newline characters.
32502
32503 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32504 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32505 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32506 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32507 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32508 means those three characters as output.
32509
32510 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32511 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32512 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32513 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32514 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32515 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32516 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32517 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32518 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32519
32520 @table @code
32521 @kindex set annotate
32522 @item set annotate @var{level}
32523 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32524 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32525
32526 @item show annotate
32527 @kindex show annotate
32528 Show the current annotation level.
32529 @end table
32530
32531 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32532
32533 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32534
32535 @smallexample
32536 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32537 GNU gdb 6.0
32538 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32539 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32540 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32541 under certain conditions.
32542 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32543 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32544 for details.
32545 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32546
32547 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32548 (@value{GDBP})
32549 ^Z^Zprompt
32550 @kbd{quit}
32551
32552 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32553 $
32554 @end smallexample
32555
32556 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32557 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32558 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32559 output from @value{GDBN}.
32560
32561 @node Server Prefix
32562 @section The Server Prefix
32563 @cindex server prefix
32564
32565 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32566 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32567 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32568 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32569 a transparent manner.
32570
32571 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32572 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32573 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32574 @code{print} command.
32575
32576 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32577 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32578
32579 @node Prompting
32580 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32581
32582 @cindex annotations for prompts
32583 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32584 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32585 over, etc.
32586
32587 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32588 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32589 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32590 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32591 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32592 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32593 features the following annotations:
32594
32595 @smallexample
32596 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32597 ^Z^Zprompt
32598 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32599 @end smallexample
32600
32601 The input types are
32602
32603 @table @code
32604 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32605 @findex prompt annotation
32606 @findex post-prompt annotation
32607 @item prompt
32608 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32609
32610 @findex pre-commands annotation
32611 @findex commands annotation
32612 @findex post-commands annotation
32613 @item commands
32614 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32615 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32616
32617 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32618 @findex overload-choice annotation
32619 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32620 @item overload-choice
32621 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32622
32623 @findex pre-query annotation
32624 @findex query annotation
32625 @findex post-query annotation
32626 @item query
32627 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32628
32629 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32630 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32631 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32632 @item prompt-for-continue
32633 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32634 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32635 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32636 presence of annotations.
32637 @end table
32638
32639 @node Errors
32640 @section Errors
32641 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32642
32643 @findex quit annotation
32644 @smallexample
32645 ^Z^Zquit
32646 @end smallexample
32647
32648 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32649
32650 @findex error annotation
32651 @smallexample
32652 ^Z^Zerror
32653 @end smallexample
32654
32655 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32656
32657 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32658 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32659 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32660 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32661 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32662 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32663 to the top level.
32664
32665 @findex error-begin annotation
32666 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32667
32668 @smallexample
32669 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32670 @end smallexample
32671
32672 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32673 message.
32674
32675 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32676 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32677 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32678
32679 @node Invalidation
32680 @section Invalidation Notices
32681
32682 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32683 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32684 changed.
32685
32686 @table @code
32687 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32688 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32689
32690 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32691 have changed.
32692
32693 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32694 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32695
32696 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32697 deleted a breakpoint.
32698 @end table
32699
32700 @node Annotations for Running
32701 @section Running the Program
32702 @cindex annotations for running programs
32703
32704 @findex starting annotation
32705 @findex stopping annotation
32706 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32707 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32708
32709 @smallexample
32710 ^Z^Zstarting
32711 @end smallexample
32712
32713 is output. When the program stops,
32714
32715 @smallexample
32716 ^Z^Zstopped
32717 @end smallexample
32718
32719 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32720 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32721
32722 @table @code
32723 @findex exited annotation
32724 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32725 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32726 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32727
32728 @findex signalled annotation
32729 @findex signal-name annotation
32730 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32731 @findex signal-string annotation
32732 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32733 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32734 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32735 annotation continues:
32736
32737 @smallexample
32738 @var{intro-text}
32739 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32740 @var{name}
32741 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32742 @var{middle-text}
32743 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32744 @var{string}
32745 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32746 @var{end-text}
32747 @end smallexample
32748
32749 @noindent
32750 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32751 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32752 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32753 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32754 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32755
32756 @findex signal annotation
32757 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32758 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32759 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32760 terminated with it.
32761
32762 @findex breakpoint annotation
32763 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32764 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32765
32766 @findex watchpoint annotation
32767 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32768 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32769 @end table
32770
32771 @node Source Annotations
32772 @section Displaying Source
32773 @cindex annotations for source display
32774
32775 @findex source annotation
32776 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32777
32778 @smallexample
32779 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32780 @end smallexample
32781
32782 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32783 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32784 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32785 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32786 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32787 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32788 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32789 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32790 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32791 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32792 depend on the language).
32793
32794 @node JIT Interface
32795 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32796 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32797 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32798
32799 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32800 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32801 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32802 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32803
32804 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32805 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32806 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32807 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32808 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32809 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32810
32811 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32812 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32813 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32814 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32815 LLVM JIT.
32816
32817 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32818 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32819 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32820 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32821 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32822 out about additional code.
32823
32824 @menu
32825 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32826 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32827 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32828 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32829 @end menu
32830
32831 @node Declarations
32832 @section JIT Declarations
32833
32834 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32835 implement the interface:
32836
32837 @smallexample
32838 typedef enum
32839 @{
32840 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32841 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32842 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32843 @} jit_actions_t;
32844
32845 struct jit_code_entry
32846 @{
32847 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32848 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32849 const char *symfile_addr;
32850 uint64_t symfile_size;
32851 @};
32852
32853 struct jit_descriptor
32854 @{
32855 uint32_t version;
32856 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32857 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32858 uint32_t action_flag;
32859 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32860 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32861 @};
32862
32863 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32864 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32865
32866 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32867 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32868 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32869 @end smallexample
32870
32871 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32872 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32873 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32874
32875 @node Registering Code
32876 @section Registering Code
32877
32878 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32879
32880 @itemize @bullet
32881 @item
32882 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32883 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32884
32885 @item
32886 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32887 file.
32888
32889 @item
32890 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32891
32892 @item
32893 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32894
32895 @item
32896 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32897 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32898 @end itemize
32899
32900 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32901 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32902 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32903 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32904
32905 @node Unregistering Code
32906 @section Unregistering Code
32907
32908 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32909
32910 @itemize @bullet
32911 @item
32912 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32913
32914 @item
32915 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32916
32917 @item
32918 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32919 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32920 @end itemize
32921
32922 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32923 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32924
32925 @node Custom Debug Info
32926 @section Custom Debug Info
32927 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32928 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32929
32930 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32931 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32932 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32933 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32934 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32935 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32936 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32937 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32938 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32939
32940 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32941 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32942 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32943 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32944 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32945 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32946 compiler.
32947
32948 @menu
32949 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32950 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32951 @end menu
32952
32953 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32954 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32955 @kindex jit-reader-load
32956 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32957
32958 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32959 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32960
32961 @table @code
32962 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32963 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32964 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32965 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32966 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32967 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32968 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32969
32970 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32971 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32972 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32973 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32974 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32975
32976 @item jit-reader-unload
32977 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32978
32979 @end table
32980
32981 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32982 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32983 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32984
32985 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32986 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32987
32988 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32989 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32990 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32991 the system include directory.
32992
32993 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32994 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32995 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32996
32997 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32998 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32999
33000 @findex gdb_init_reader
33001 @smallexample
33002 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33003 @end smallexample
33004
33005 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33006
33007 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33008 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33009 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33010 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33011 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33012 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33013
33014 @smallexample
33015 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33016 @{
33017 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33018 int reader_version;
33019
33020 /* For use by the reader. */
33021 void *priv_data;
33022
33023 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33024 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33025 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33026 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33027 @};
33028 @end smallexample
33029
33030 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33031 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33032
33033 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33034 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33035 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33036 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33037 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33038 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33039 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33040 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33041 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33042 target's address space.
33043
33044 @node In-Process Agent
33045 @chapter In-Process Agent
33046 @cindex debugging agent
33047 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33048 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33049 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33050 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33051 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33052 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33053 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33054 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33055 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33056 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33057 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33058 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33059 behavior without interrupting it.
33060
33061 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33062 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33063 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33064 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33065 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33066 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33067 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33068 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33069 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33070
33071 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33072 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33073 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33074 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33075
33076 @anchor{Control Agent}
33077 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33078 debugging with the following commands:
33079
33080 @table @code
33081 @kindex set agent on
33082 @item set agent on
33083 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33084 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33085 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33086 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33087 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33088 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33089
33090 @kindex set agent off
33091 @item set agent off
33092 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33093 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33094
33095 @kindex show agent
33096 @item show agent
33097 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33098 the in-process agent.
33099 @end table
33100
33101 @menu
33102 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33103 @end menu
33104
33105 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33106 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33107 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33108
33109 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33110 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33111 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33112 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33113 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33114 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33115 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33116 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33117 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33118
33119 @menu
33120 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33121 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33122 @end menu
33123
33124 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33125 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33126 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33127
33128 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33129 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33130
33131 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33132 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33133 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33134 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33135
33136 @enumerate
33137 @item
33138 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33139 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33140 @item
33141 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33142 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33143 the other one.
33144 @end enumerate
33145
33146 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33147
33148 @enumerate
33149 @item
33150 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33151 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33152 @anchor{agent expression object}
33153 @item
33154 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33155 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33156 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33157 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33158 @item
33159 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33160 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33161
33162 @end enumerate
33163
33164 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33165 object:
33166
33167 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33168 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33169 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33170 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33171 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33172 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33173 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33174 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33175 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33176 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33177 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33178 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33179 memory address for collecting.
33180 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33181 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33182 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33183 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33184 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33185 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33186 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33187 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33188 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33189 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33190 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33191 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33192 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33193 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33194 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33195 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33196 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33197 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33198 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33199 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33200 @ref{agent expression object}
33201 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33202 @ref{agent expression object}
33203 @item actions @tab variable
33204 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33205 @end multitable
33206
33207 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33208 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33209 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33210
33211 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33212 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33213
33214 @table @samp
33215
33216 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33217 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33218 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33219 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33220 in IPA finally.
33221
33222 Replies:
33223 @table @samp
33224 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33225 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33226 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33227 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33228 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33229 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33230 @item E @var{NN}
33231 for an error
33232
33233 @end table
33234
33235 @item close
33236 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33237 is about to kill inferiors.
33238
33239 @item qTfSTM
33240 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33241 @item qTsSTM
33242 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33243 @item qTSTMat
33244 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33245 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33246 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33247
33248 Replies:
33249 @table @samp
33250 @item E @var{NN}
33251 for an error
33252 @end table
33253 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33254 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33255 @end table
33256
33257 @node GDB Bugs
33258 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33259 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33260 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33261
33262 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33263
33264 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33265 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33266 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33267 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33268
33269 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33270 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33271
33272 @menu
33273 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33274 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33275 @end menu
33276
33277 @node Bug Criteria
33278 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33279 @cindex bug criteria
33280
33281 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33282
33283 @itemize @bullet
33284 @cindex fatal signal
33285 @cindex debugger crash
33286 @cindex crash of debugger
33287 @item
33288 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33289 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33290
33291 @cindex error on valid input
33292 @item
33293 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33294 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33295 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33296
33297 @cindex invalid input
33298 @item
33299 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33300 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33301 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33302 for traditional practice''.
33303
33304 @item
33305 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33306 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33307 @end itemize
33308
33309 @node Bug Reporting
33310 @section How to Report Bugs
33311 @cindex bug reports
33312 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33313
33314 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33315 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33316 contact that organization first.
33317
33318 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33319 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33320 distribution.
33321 @c should add a web page ref...
33322
33323 @ifset BUGURL
33324 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33325 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33326 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33327 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33328 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33329 be used.
33330
33331 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33332 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33333 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33334 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33335
33336 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33337 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33338 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33339 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33340 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33341 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33342 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33343 bug reports to the mailing list.
33344 @end ifset
33345 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33346 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33347 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33348 @end ifclear
33349 @end ifset
33350
33351 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33352 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33353 fact or leave it out, state it!
33354
33355 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33356 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33357 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33358 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33359 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33360 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33361 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33362 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33363 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33364
33365 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33366 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33367 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33368 self-contained.
33369
33370 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33371 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33372 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33373 bugs properly.
33374
33375 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33376
33377 @itemize @bullet
33378 @item
33379 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33380 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33381 version}.
33382
33383 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33384 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33385
33386 @item
33387 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33388 version number.
33389
33390 @item
33391 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33392 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33393 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33394 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33395
33396 @item
33397 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33398 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33399
33400 @item
33401 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33402 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33403 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33404 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33405 those compilers.
33406
33407 @item
33408 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33409 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33410 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33411 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33412
33413 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33414 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33415
33416 @item
33417 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33418 reproduce the bug.
33419
33420 @item
33421 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33422 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33423
33424 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33425 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33426 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33427 a chance to make a mistake.
33428
33429 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33430 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33431 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33432 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33433 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33434 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33435 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33436 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33437
33438 @pindex script
33439 @cindex recording a session script
33440 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33441 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33442 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33443 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33444
33445 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33446 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33447
33448 @item
33449 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33450 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33451 it by context, not by line number.
33452
33453 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33454 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33455
33456 @end itemize
33457
33458 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33459
33460 @itemize @bullet
33461 @item
33462 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33463
33464 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33465 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33466 changes will not affect it.
33467
33468 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33469 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33470 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33471 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33472
33473 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33474 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33475 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33476 less time, and so on.
33477
33478 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33479 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33480
33481 @item
33482 A patch for the bug.
33483
33484 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33485 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33486 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33487 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33488
33489 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33490 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33491 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33492 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33493
33494 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33495 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33496 help us to understand.
33497
33498 @item
33499 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33500
33501 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33502 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33503 @end itemize
33504
33505 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33506 @c and consists of the two following files:
33507 @c rluser.texi
33508 @c hsuser.texi
33509 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33510 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33511 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33512 @include rluser.texi
33513 @include hsuser.texi
33514 @end ifclear
33515
33516 @node In Memoriam
33517 @appendix In Memoriam
33518
33519 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33520 contributors:
33521
33522 @table @code
33523 @item Fred Fish
33524 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33525 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33526 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33527
33528 @item Michael Snyder
33529 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33530 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33531 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33532 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33533 @end table
33534
33535 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33536 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33537
33538 @node Formatting Documentation
33539 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33540
33541 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33542 @cindex reference card
33543 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33544 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33545 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33546 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33547 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33548 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33549
33550 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33551 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33552
33553 @smallexample
33554 make refcard.dvi
33555 @end smallexample
33556
33557 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33558 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33559 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33560 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33561 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33562
33563 @cindex documentation
33564
33565 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33566 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33567 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33568 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33569 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33570 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33571
33572 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33573 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33574 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33575 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33576 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33577 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33578 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33579 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33580
33581 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33582 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33583 @code{makeinfo}.
33584
33585 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33586 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33587 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33588
33589 @smallexample
33590 cd gdb
33591 make gdb.info
33592 @end smallexample
33593
33594 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33595 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33596 Texinfo definitions file.
33597
33598 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33599 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33600 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33601 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33602 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33603 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33604 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33605
33606 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33607 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33608 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33609 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33610 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33611 directory.
33612
33613 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33614 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33615 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33616 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33617
33618 @smallexample
33619 make gdb.dvi
33620 @end smallexample
33621
33622 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33623
33624 @node Installing GDB
33625 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33626 @cindex installation
33627
33628 @menu
33629 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33630 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33631 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33632 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33633 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33634 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33635 @end menu
33636
33637 @node Requirements
33638 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33639 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33640
33641 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33642 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33643
33644 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33645 @table @asis
33646 @item ISO C90 compiler
33647 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33648 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33649
33650 @end table
33651
33652 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33653 @table @asis
33654 @item Expat
33655 @anchor{Expat}
33656 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33657 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33658 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33659 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33660 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33661 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33662
33663 Expat is used for:
33664
33665 @itemize @bullet
33666 @item
33667 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33668 @item
33669 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33670 @item
33671 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33672 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33673 @item
33674 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33675 @item
33676 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33677 @item
33678 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33679 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33680 @end itemize
33681
33682 @item zlib
33683 @cindex compressed debug sections
33684 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33685 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33686 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33687 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33688 information in such binaries.
33689
33690 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33691 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33692 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33693
33694 @item iconv
33695 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33696 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33697 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33698 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33699
33700 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33701 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33702 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33703 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33704
33705 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33706 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33707 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33708
33709 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33710 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33711 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33712 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33713 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33714 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33715 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33716 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33717 @end table
33718
33719 @node Running Configure
33720 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33721 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33722 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33723 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33724 build the @code{gdb} program.
33725 @iftex
33726 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33727 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33728 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33729 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33730 @end iftex
33731
33732 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33733 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33734 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33735
33736 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33737 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33738
33739 @table @code
33740 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33741 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33742
33743 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33744 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33745
33746 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33747 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33748
33749 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33750 @sc{gnu} include files
33751
33752 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33753 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33754
33755 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33756 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33757
33758 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33759 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33760
33761 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33762 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33763
33764 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33765 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33766 @end table
33767
33768 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33769 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33770 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33771
33772 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33773 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33774 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33775 argument.
33776
33777 For example:
33778
33779 @smallexample
33780 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33781 ./configure @var{host}
33782 make
33783 @end smallexample
33784
33785 @noindent
33786 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33787 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33788 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33789 correct value by examining your system.)
33790
33791 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33792 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33793 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33794 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33795
33796 @need 750
33797 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33798 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33799 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33800
33801 @smallexample
33802 sh configure @var{host}
33803 @end smallexample
33804
33805 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33806 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33807 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33808 @file{configure}
33809 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33810 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33811
33812 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33813 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33814 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33815 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33816 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33817 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33818 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33819 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33820 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33821
33822 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33823 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33824 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33825 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33826 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33827
33828 @node Separate Objdir
33829 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33830
33831 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33832 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33833 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33834 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33835 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33836 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33837 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33838 program specified there.
33839
33840 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33841 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33842 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33843 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33844 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33845 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33846
33847 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33848 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33849
33850 @smallexample
33851 @group
33852 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33853 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33854 cd ../gdb-sun4
33855 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33856 make
33857 @end group
33858 @end smallexample
33859
33860 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33861 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33862 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33863 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33864 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33865 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33866
33867 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33868 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33869 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33870 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33871 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33872
33873 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33874 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33875 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33876 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33877 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33878 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33879
33880 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33881 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33882 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33883
33884 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33885 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33886 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33887 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33888 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33889
33890 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33891 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33892 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33893 with each other.
33894
33895 @node Config Names
33896 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33897
33898 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33899 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33900 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33901 of information in the following pattern:
33902
33903 @smallexample
33904 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33905 @end smallexample
33906
33907 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33908 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33909 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33910
33911 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33912 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33913 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33914 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33915 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33916 abbreviations---for example:
33917
33918 @smallexample
33919 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33920 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33921 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33922 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33923 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33924 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33925 % sh config.sub sun4
33926 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33927 % sh config.sub sun3
33928 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33929 % sh config.sub i986v
33930 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33931 @end smallexample
33932
33933 @noindent
33934 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33935 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33936
33937 @node Configure Options
33938 @section @file{configure} Options
33939
33940 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33941 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33942 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33943 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33944
33945 @smallexample
33946 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33947 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33948 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33949 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33950 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33951 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33952 @var{host}
33953 @end smallexample
33954
33955 @noindent
33956 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33957 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33958 @samp{--}.
33959
33960 @table @code
33961 @item --help
33962 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33963
33964 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33965 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33966 @file{@var{dir}}.
33967
33968 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33969 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33970 @file{@var{dir}}.
33971
33972 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33973 @need 2000
33974 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33975 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33976 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33977 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33978 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33979 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33980 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33981 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33982 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33983 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33984 @var{dirname}.
33985
33986 @item --norecursion
33987 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33988 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33989
33990 @item --target=@var{target}
33991 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33992 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33993 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33994
33995 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33996
33997 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33998 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33999
34000 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34001 @end table
34002
34003 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34004 needed for special purposes only.
34005
34006 @node System-wide configuration
34007 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34008 @cindex system-wide init file
34009
34010 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34011 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34012 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34013
34014 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34015
34016 @table @code
34017 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34018 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34019 @var{file}.
34020 @end table
34021
34022 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34023 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34024
34025 @itemize @bullet
34026 @item
34027 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34028 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34029 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34030 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34031 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34032 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34033
34034 @item
34035 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34036 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34037 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34038 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34039 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34040 @end itemize
34041
34042 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34043 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34044 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34045 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34046 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34047 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34048 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34049 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34050 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34051 reread.
34052
34053 @menu
34054 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34055 @end menu
34056
34057 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34058 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34059 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34060
34061 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34062 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34063 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34064 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34065 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34066 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34067
34068 The following scripts are currently available:
34069 @itemize @bullet
34070
34071 @item @file{elinos.py}
34072 @pindex elinos.py
34073 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34074 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34075 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34076 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34077 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34078 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34079
34080 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34081 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34082 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34083 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34084 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34085 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34086
34087 @end itemize
34088
34089 @node Maintenance Commands
34090 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34091 @cindex maintenance commands
34092 @cindex internal commands
34093
34094 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34095 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34096 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34097 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34098 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34099
34100 @table @code
34101 @kindex maint agent
34102 @kindex maint agent-eval
34103 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34104 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34105 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34106 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34107 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34108 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34109 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34110 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34111 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34112 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34113 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34114 addition and return the sum.
34115 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34116 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34117
34118 @kindex maint agent-printf
34119 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34120 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34121 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34122 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34123 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34124
34125 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34126 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34127 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34128 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34129 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34130 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34131 is shown:
34132
34133 @table @code
34134 @item breakpoint
34135 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34136
34137 @item watchpoint
34138 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34139
34140 @item longjmp
34141 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34142 @code{longjmp} calls.
34143
34144 @item longjmp resume
34145 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34146
34147 @item until
34148 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34149
34150 @item finish
34151 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34152
34153 @item shlib events
34154 Shared library events.
34155
34156 @end table
34157
34158 @kindex maint info btrace
34159 @item maint info btrace
34160 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34161
34162 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34163 @item maint btrace packet-history
34164 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34165 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34166 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34167 recording format.
34168
34169 @table @code
34170 @item bts
34171 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34172 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34173
34174 @table @asis
34175 @item Block number
34176 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34177 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34178 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34179 @end table
34180
34181 @item pt
34182 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34183 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34184 information is printed:
34185
34186 @table @asis
34187 @item Packet number
34188 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34189 @item Trace offset
34190 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34191 @item Packet opcode and payload
34192 @end table
34193 @end table
34194
34195 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34196 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34197 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34198 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34199 needed.
34200
34201 @kindex maint btrace clear
34202 @item maint btrace clear
34203 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34204 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34205
34206 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34207 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34208 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34209 buffer.
34210
34211 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34212 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34213 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34214 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34215 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34216 packet history.
34217
34218 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34219 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34220 @cindex displaced stepping support
34221 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34222 @item set displaced-stepping
34223 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34224 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34225 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34226 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34227 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34228 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34229
34230 @table @code
34231 @item set displaced-stepping on
34232 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34233 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34234
34235 @item set displaced-stepping off
34236 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34237 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34238
34239 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34240 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34241 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34242 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34243 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34244 @end table
34245
34246 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34247 @item maint check-psymtabs
34248 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34249 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34250
34251 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34252 @item maint check-symtabs
34253 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34254
34255 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34256 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34257 Expand symbol tables.
34258 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34259 names matching @var{regexp}.
34260
34261 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34262 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34263 @cindex demangler crashes
34264 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34265 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34266 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34267 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34268 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34269 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34270 option to terminate the current session.
34271
34272 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34273 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34274 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34275
34276 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34277 @item maint cplus namespace
34278 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34279
34280 @kindex maint deprecate
34281 @kindex maint undeprecate
34282 @cindex deprecated commands
34283 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34284 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34285 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34286 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34287 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34288 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34289 the replacement as part of the warning.
34290
34291 @kindex maint dump-me
34292 @item maint dump-me
34293 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34294 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34295 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34296 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34297
34298 @kindex maint internal-error
34299 @kindex maint internal-warning
34300 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34301 @cindex demangler crashes
34302 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34303 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34304 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34305
34306 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34307 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34308 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34309 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34310 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34311 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34312 @value{GDBN} session.
34313
34314 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34315 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34316
34317 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34318
34319 @smallexample
34320 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34321 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34322 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34323 debugging may prove unreliable.
34324 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34325 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34326 (@value{GDBP})
34327 @end smallexample
34328
34329 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34330 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34331 @cindex demangler crashes
34332
34333 @kindex maint set internal-error
34334 @kindex maint show internal-error
34335 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34336 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34337 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34338 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34339 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34340 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34341 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34342 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34343 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34344 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34345 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34346 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34347 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34348 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34349 described in the table below.
34350
34351 @table @samp
34352 @item quit
34353 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34354 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34355
34356 @item corefile
34357 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34358 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34359 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34360 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34361 disabled.
34362 @end table
34363
34364 @kindex maint packet
34365 @item maint packet @var{text}
34366 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34367 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34368 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34369 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34370 checksum.
34371
34372 @kindex maint print architecture
34373 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34374 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34375 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34376
34377 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34378 @item maint print c-tdesc
34379 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34380 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34381 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34382
34383 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34384 @item maint print dummy-frames
34385 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34386
34387 @smallexample
34388 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34389 @dots{}
34390 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34391 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34392 58 return (a + b);
34393 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34394 @dots{}
34395 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34396 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34397 (@value{GDBP})
34398 @end smallexample
34399
34400 Takes an optional file parameter.
34401
34402 @kindex maint print registers
34403 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34404 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34405 @kindex maint print register-groups
34406 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34407 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34408 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34409 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34410 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34411 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34412 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34413
34414 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34415 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34416 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34417 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34418 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34419 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34420 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34421 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34422
34423 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34424 write the information.
34425
34426 @kindex maint print reggroups
34427 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34428 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34429 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34430 information.
34431
34432 The register groups info looks like this:
34433
34434 @smallexample
34435 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34436 Group Type
34437 general user
34438 float user
34439 all user
34440 vector user
34441 system user
34442 save internal
34443 restore internal
34444 @end smallexample
34445
34446 @kindex flushregs
34447 @item flushregs
34448 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34449
34450 @kindex maint print objfiles
34451 @cindex info for known object files
34452 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34453 Print a dump of all known object files.
34454 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34455 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34456 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34457
34458 @kindex maint print user-registers
34459 @cindex user registers
34460 @item maint print user-registers
34461 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34462 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34463 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34464 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34465 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34466 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34467 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34468
34469 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34470 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34471 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34472 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34473 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34474 matching @var{regexp}.
34475 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34476 and the full path if known.
34477 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34478
34479 @kindex maint print statistics
34480 @cindex bcache statistics
34481 @item maint print statistics
34482 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34483 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34484 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34485 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34486 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34487 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34488 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34489 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34490 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34491 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34492 lengths.
34493
34494 @kindex maint print target-stack
34495 @cindex target stack description
34496 @item maint print target-stack
34497 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34498 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34499 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34500 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34501 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34502 address.
34503
34504 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34505 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34506
34507 @kindex maint print type
34508 @cindex type chain of a data type
34509 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34510 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34511 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34512 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34513 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34514 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34515
34516 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34517 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34518 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34519 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34520 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34521 information.
34522
34523 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34524 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34525 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34526 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34527 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34528 always see the disassembly form.
34529
34530 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34531
34532 @smallexample
34533 (gdb) info addr argc
34534 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34535 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34536 @end smallexample
34537
34538 For more information on these expressions, see
34539 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34540
34541 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34542 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34543 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34544 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34545 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34546
34547 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34548 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34549 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34550 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34551 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34552 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34553 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34554 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34555 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34556
34557 @kindex maint set profile
34558 @kindex maint show profile
34559 @cindex profiling GDB
34560 @item maint set profile
34561 @itemx maint show profile
34562 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34563
34564 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34565 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34566 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34567 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34568 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34569 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34570 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34571
34572 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34573 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34574
34575 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34576 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34577 @cindex hardware debug registers
34578 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34579 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34580 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34581 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34582 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34583 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34584 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34585
34586 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34587 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34588 @item maint set show-all-tib
34589 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34590 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34591 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34592 command.
34593
34594 @kindex maint set target-async
34595 @kindex maint show target-async
34596 @item maint set target-async
34597 @itemx maint show target-async
34598 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34599 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34600 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34601 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34602
34603 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34604 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34605 @item maint set target-non-stop
34606 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34607
34608 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34609 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34610 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34611 if supported by the target.
34612
34613 @table @code
34614 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34615 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34616 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34617
34618 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34619 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34620 does not indicate support.
34621
34622 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34623 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34624 target supports it.
34625 @end table
34626
34627 @kindex maint set per-command
34628 @kindex maint show per-command
34629 @item maint set per-command
34630 @itemx maint show per-command
34631 @cindex resources used by commands
34632
34633 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34634 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34635
34636 @table @code
34637 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34638 @itemx maint show per-command space
34639 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34640 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34641 took, following the command's own output.
34642 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34643 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34644
34645 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34646 @itemx maint show per-command time
34647 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34648 for each command.
34649 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34650 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34651 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34652 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34653 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34654 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34655 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34656 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34657 spent by the program been debugged.
34658 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34659 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34660
34661 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34662 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34663 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34664 for each command.
34665 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34666
34667 @enumerate a
34668 @item
34669 number of symbol tables
34670 @item
34671 number of primary symbol tables
34672 @item
34673 number of blocks in the blockvector
34674 @end enumerate
34675 @end table
34676
34677 @kindex maint space
34678 @cindex memory used by commands
34679 @item maint space @var{value}
34680 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34681 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34682
34683 @kindex maint time
34684 @cindex time of command execution
34685 @item maint time @var{value}
34686 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34687 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34688
34689 @kindex maint translate-address
34690 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34691 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34692 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34693 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34694 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34695 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34696 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34697
34698 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34699 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34700 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34701
34702 @end table
34703
34704 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34705 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34706
34707 @table @code
34708 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34709 @kindex set watchdog
34710 @cindex watchdog timer
34711 @cindex timeout for commands
34712 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34713 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34714 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34715
34716 @item show watchdog
34717 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34718 @end table
34719
34720 @node Remote Protocol
34721 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34722
34723 @menu
34724 * Overview::
34725 * Packets::
34726 * Stop Reply Packets::
34727 * General Query Packets::
34728 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34729 * Tracepoint Packets::
34730 * Host I/O Packets::
34731 * Interrupts::
34732 * Notification Packets::
34733 * Remote Non-Stop::
34734 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34735 * Examples::
34736 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34737 * Library List Format::
34738 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34739 * Memory Map Format::
34740 * Thread List Format::
34741 * Traceframe Info Format::
34742 * Branch Trace Format::
34743 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34744 @end menu
34745
34746 @node Overview
34747 @section Overview
34748
34749 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34750 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34751 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34752 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34753
34754 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34755 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34756
34757 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34758 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34759 @cindex remote serial protocol
34760 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34761 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34762 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34763 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34764 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34765
34766 @smallexample
34767 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34768 @end smallexample
34769 @noindent
34770
34771 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34772 @noindent
34773 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34774 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34775 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34776
34777 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34778 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34779
34780 @smallexample
34781 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34782 @end smallexample
34783
34784 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34785 @noindent
34786 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34787 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34788 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34789
34790 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34791 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34792 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34793 retransmission):
34794
34795 @smallexample
34796 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34797 <- @code{+}
34798 @end smallexample
34799 @noindent
34800
34801 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34802 once a connection is established.
34803 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34804
34805 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34806 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34807 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34808 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34809 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34810 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34811 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34812
34813 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34814 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34815 exceptions).
34816
34817 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34818 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34819 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34820 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34821
34822 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34823 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34824 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34825
34826 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34827 @anchor{Binary Data}
34828 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34829 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34830 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34831 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34832 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34833 binary data.
34834
34835 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34836 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34837 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34838 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34839 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34840 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34841 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34842 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34843 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34844 (described next).
34845
34846 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34847 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34848 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34849 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34850 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34851 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34852 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34853 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34854 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34855 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34856 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34857 3}} more times.
34858
34859 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34860 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34861 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34862 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34863 @samp{0*"00}.
34864
34865 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34866 error number. That number is not well defined.
34867
34868 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34869 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34870 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34871 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34872 on that response.
34873
34874 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34875 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34876 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34877 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34878 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34879 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34880
34881 @node Packets
34882 @section Packets
34883
34884 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34885 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34886 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34887 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34888
34889 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34890 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34891 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34892 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34893 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34894 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34895 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34896 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34897 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34898 @var{baz}.
34899
34900 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34901 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34902 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34903 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34904 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34905 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34906 pick any thread.
34907
34908 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34909 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34910 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34911 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34912 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34913 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34914 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34915 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34916 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34917 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34918 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34919 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34920 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34921
34922 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34923 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34924 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34925 more information.
34926
34927 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34928 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34929
34930 Here are the packet descriptions.
34931
34932 @table @samp
34933
34934 @item !
34935 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34936 @anchor{extended mode}
34937 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34938 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34939 debugged.
34940
34941 Reply:
34942 @table @samp
34943 @item OK
34944 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34945 @end table
34946
34947 @item ?
34948 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34949 @anchor{? packet}
34950 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34951 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34952 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34953
34954 Reply:
34955 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34956
34957 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34958 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34959 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34960 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34961 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34962
34963 Reply:
34964 @table @samp
34965 @item OK
34966 The arguments were set.
34967 @item E @var{NN}
34968 An error occurred.
34969 @end table
34970
34971 @item b @var{baud}
34972 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34973 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34974 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34975
34976 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34977 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34978 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34979
34980 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34981 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34982 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34983 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34984 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34985
34986 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34987 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34988 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34989 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34990
34991 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34992 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34993
34994 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34995 @anchor{bc}
34996 @item bc
34997 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34998 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34999
35000 Reply:
35001 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35002
35003 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35004 @anchor{bs}
35005 @item bs
35006 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35007 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35008
35009 Reply:
35010 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35011
35012 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35013 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35014 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35015 is omitted, resume at current address.
35016
35017 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35018 packet}.
35019
35020 Reply:
35021 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35022
35023 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35024 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35025 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35026 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35027
35028 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35029 packet}.
35030
35031 Reply:
35032 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35033
35034 @item d
35035 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35036 Toggle debug flag.
35037
35038 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35039 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35040
35041 @item D
35042 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35043 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35044 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35045 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35046 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35047
35048 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35049 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35050 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35051 big-endian hex string.
35052
35053 Reply:
35054 @table @samp
35055 @item OK
35056 for success
35057 @item E @var{NN}
35058 for an error
35059 @end table
35060
35061 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35062 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35063 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35064 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35065 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35066
35067 @item g
35068 @anchor{read registers packet}
35069 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35070 Read general registers.
35071
35072 Reply:
35073 @table @samp
35074 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35075 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35076 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35077 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35078 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35079 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
35080 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
35081
35082 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35083 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35084 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35085 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35086 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35087 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35088 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35089 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35090
35091 @smallexample
35092 -> @code{g}
35093 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35094 @end smallexample
35095
35096 @item E @var{NN}
35097 for an error.
35098 @end table
35099
35100 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35101 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35102 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35103 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35104
35105 Reply:
35106 @table @samp
35107 @item OK
35108 for success
35109 @item E @var{NN}
35110 for an error
35111 @end table
35112
35113 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35114 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35115 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35116 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35117 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35118 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35119 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35120 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35121 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35122
35123 Reply:
35124 @table @samp
35125 @item OK
35126 for success
35127 @item E @var{NN}
35128 for an error
35129 @end table
35130
35131 @c FIXME: JTC:
35132 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35133 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35134 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35135 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35136 @c described. For example:
35137 @c
35138 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35139 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35140 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35141 @c
35142 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35143 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35144 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35145
35146 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35147 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35148 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35149 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35150 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35151 step starting at that address.
35152
35153 @item I
35154 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35155 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35156 step packet}.
35157
35158 @item k
35159 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35160 Kill request.
35161
35162 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35163
35164 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35165 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35166
35167 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35168
35169 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35170 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35171 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35172
35173 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35174 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35175 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35176
35177 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35178 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35179 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35180 (@pxref{? packet}).
35181
35182 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35183 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35184 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35185 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35186 any particular boundary.
35187
35188 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35189 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35190 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35191 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35192 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35193 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35194 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35195 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35196
35197 Reply:
35198 @table @samp
35199 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35200 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35201 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35202 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35203 @item E @var{NN}
35204 @var{NN} is errno
35205 @end table
35206
35207 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35208 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35209 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35210 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35211 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35212
35213 Reply:
35214 @table @samp
35215 @item OK
35216 for success
35217 @item E @var{NN}
35218 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35219 written).
35220 @end table
35221
35222 @item p @var{n}
35223 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35224 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35225 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35226 register value is encoded.
35227
35228 Reply:
35229 @table @samp
35230 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35231 the register's value
35232 @item E @var{NN}
35233 for an error
35234 @item @w{}
35235 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35236 @end table
35237
35238 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35239 @anchor{write register packet}
35240 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35241 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35242 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35243 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35244
35245 Reply:
35246 @table @samp
35247 @item OK
35248 for success
35249 @item E @var{NN}
35250 for an error
35251 @end table
35252
35253 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35254 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35255 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35256 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35257 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35258 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35259
35260 @item r
35261 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35262 Reset the entire system.
35263
35264 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35265
35266 @item R @var{XX}
35267 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35268 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35269 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35270
35271 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35272
35273 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35274 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35275 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35276 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35277
35278 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35279 packet}.
35280
35281 Reply:
35282 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35283
35284 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35285 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35286 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35287 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35288 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35289
35290 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35291 packet}.
35292
35293 Reply:
35294 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35295
35296 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35297 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35298 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35299 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35300 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35301
35302 @item T @var{thread-id}
35303 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35304 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35305
35306 Reply:
35307 @table @samp
35308 @item OK
35309 thread is still alive
35310 @item E @var{NN}
35311 thread is dead
35312 @end table
35313
35314 @item v
35315 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35316 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35317
35318 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35319 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35320 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35321 The process ID is a
35322 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35323 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35324 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35325
35326 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35327 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35328 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35329 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35330 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35331 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35332 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35333 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35334
35335 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35336
35337 Reply:
35338 @table @samp
35339 @item E @var{nn}
35340 for an error
35341 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35342 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35343 @item OK
35344 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35345 @end table
35346
35347 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35348 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35349 @anchor{vCont packet}
35350 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35351 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35352 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35353 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35354 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35355 Specifying multiple
35356 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35357 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35358
35359 Currently supported actions are:
35360
35361 @table @samp
35362 @item c
35363 Continue.
35364 @item C @var{sig}
35365 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35366 @item s
35367 Step.
35368 @item S @var{sig}
35369 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35370 @item t
35371 Stop.
35372 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35373 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35374 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35375 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35376 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35377 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35378
35379 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35380 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35381 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35382 jumps to @var{start}).
35383
35384 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35385 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35386 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35387
35388 @end table
35389
35390 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35391 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35392 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35393
35394 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35395 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35396 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35397 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35398 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35399 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35400 as an implementation detail.
35401
35402 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35403 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35404 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35405 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35406 @var{thread-id}.
35407
35408 Reply:
35409 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35410
35411 @item vCont?
35412 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35413 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35414
35415 Reply:
35416 @table @samp
35417 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35418 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35419 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35420 @item @w{}
35421 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35422 @end table
35423
35424 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35425 @item vCtrlC
35426 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35427 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35428 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35429 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35430 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35431 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35432 variant.
35433
35434 Reply:
35435 @table @samp
35436 @item E @var{nn}
35437 for an error
35438 @item OK
35439 for success
35440 @end table
35441
35442 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35443 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35444 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35445 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35446
35447 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35448 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35449 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35450 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35451 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35452 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35453 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35454 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35455 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35456 packet is received.
35457
35458 Reply:
35459 @table @samp
35460 @item OK
35461 for success
35462 @item E @var{NN}
35463 for an error
35464 @end table
35465
35466 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35467 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35468 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35469 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35470 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35471 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35472 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35473 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35474 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35475 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35476 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35477 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35478
35479
35480 Reply:
35481 @table @samp
35482 @item OK
35483 for success
35484 @item E.memtype
35485 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35486 @item E @var{NN}
35487 for an error
35488 @end table
35489
35490 @item vFlashDone
35491 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35492 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35493 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35494 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35495 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35496 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35497 request is completed.
35498
35499 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35500 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35501 @anchor{vKill packet}
35502 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35503 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35504 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35505 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35506
35507 Reply:
35508 @table @samp
35509 @item E @var{nn}
35510 for an error
35511 @item OK
35512 for success
35513 @end table
35514
35515 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35516 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35517 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35518 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35519 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35520 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35521 state.
35522
35523 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35524
35525 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35526
35527 Reply:
35528 @table @samp
35529 @item E @var{nn}
35530 for an error
35531 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35532 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35533 @end table
35534
35535 @item vStopped
35536 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35537 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35538
35539 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35540 @anchor{X packet}
35541 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35542 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35543 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35544 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35545 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35546
35547 Reply:
35548 @table @samp
35549 @item OK
35550 for success
35551 @item E @var{NN}
35552 for an error
35553 @end table
35554
35555 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35556 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35557 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35558 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35559 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35560 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35561 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35562
35563 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35564 separately.
35565
35566 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35567 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35568 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35569 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35570 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35571 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35572
35573 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35574 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35575 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35576 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35577 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35578 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35579
35580 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35581 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35582 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35583 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35584 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35585 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35586 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35587 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35588 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35589 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35590
35591 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35592 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35593
35594 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35595 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35596
35597 @table @samp
35598
35599 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35600 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35601 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35602
35603 @end table
35604
35605 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35606 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35607 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35608 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35609 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35610 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35611 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35612
35613 @table @samp
35614
35615 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35616 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35617 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35618
35619 @end table
35620
35621 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35622
35623 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35624 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35625 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35626 target, is not defined.}
35627
35628 Reply:
35629 @table @samp
35630 @item OK
35631 success
35632 @item @w{}
35633 not supported
35634 @item E @var{NN}
35635 for an error
35636 @end table
35637
35638 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35639 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35640 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35641 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35642 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35643 address @var{addr}.
35644
35645 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35646 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35647 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35648
35649 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35650 movement.}
35651
35652 Reply:
35653 @table @samp
35654 @item OK
35655 success
35656 @item @w{}
35657 not supported
35658 @item E @var{NN}
35659 for an error
35660 @end table
35661
35662 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35663 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35664 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35665 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35666 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35667 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35668
35669 Reply:
35670 @table @samp
35671 @item OK
35672 success
35673 @item @w{}
35674 not supported
35675 @item E @var{NN}
35676 for an error
35677 @end table
35678
35679 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35680 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35681 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35682 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35683 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35684 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35685
35686 Reply:
35687 @table @samp
35688 @item OK
35689 success
35690 @item @w{}
35691 not supported
35692 @item E @var{NN}
35693 for an error
35694 @end table
35695
35696 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35697 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35698 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35699 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35700 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35701 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35702
35703 Reply:
35704 @table @samp
35705 @item OK
35706 success
35707 @item @w{}
35708 not supported
35709 @item E @var{NN}
35710 for an error
35711 @end table
35712
35713 @end table
35714
35715 @node Stop Reply Packets
35716 @section Stop Reply Packets
35717 @cindex stop reply packets
35718
35719 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35720 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35721 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35722 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35723 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35724 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35725 @value{GDBN} source code.
35726
35727 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35728 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35729 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35730 components.
35731
35732 @table @samp
35733
35734 @item S @var{AA}
35735 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35736 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35737 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35738
35739 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35740 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35741 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35742 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35743 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35744 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35745 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35746 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35747
35748 @itemize @bullet
35749 @item
35750 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35751 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35752 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35753 two-digit hex number.
35754
35755 @item
35756 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35757 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35758
35759 @item
35760 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35761 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35762
35763 @item
35764 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35765 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35766 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35767 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35768
35769 @item
35770 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35771 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35772 future.
35773 @end itemize
35774
35775 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35776
35777 @table @samp
35778 @item watch
35779 @itemx rwatch
35780 @itemx awatch
35781 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35782 hex.
35783
35784 @item syscall_entry
35785 @itemx syscall_return
35786 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35787 syscall number, in hex.
35788
35789 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35790 @item library
35791 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35792 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35793 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35794
35795 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35796 @item replaylog
35797 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35798 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35799 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35800 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35801 for more information.
35802
35803 @item swbreak
35804 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35805 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35806 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35807 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35808 part must be left empty.
35809
35810 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35811 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35812 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35813 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35814 address.
35815
35816 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35817 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35818 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35819 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35820 indicating support.
35821
35822 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35823
35824 @item hwbreak
35825 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35826 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35827
35828 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35829 apply.
35830
35831 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35832 @item fork
35833 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35834 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35835 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35836 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35837 fork events.
35838
35839 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35840 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35841 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35842 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35843 indicating support.
35844
35845 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35846 @item vfork
35847 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35848 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35849 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35850 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35851 vfork events.
35852
35853 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35854 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35855 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35856 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35857 indicating support.
35858
35859 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35860 @item vforkdone
35861 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35862 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35863 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35864 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35865 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35866
35867 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35868 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35869 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35870 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35871 indicating support.
35872
35873 @cindex exec events, remote reply
35874 @item exec
35875 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
35876 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
35877 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
35878
35879 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35880 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35881 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35882 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35883 indicating support.
35884
35885 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
35886 @anchor{thread create event}
35887 @item create
35888 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
35889 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
35890 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
35891 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
35892 also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
35893
35894 @end table
35895
35896 @item W @var{AA}
35897 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35898 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35899 applicable to certain targets.
35900
35901 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35902 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35903 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35904 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35905
35906 @item X @var{AA}
35907 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35908 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35909
35910 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35911 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35912 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35913 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35914
35915 @anchor{thread exit event}
35916 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
35917 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
35918
35919 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
35920 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
35921 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
35922
35923 @item N
35924 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
35925 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
35926 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
35927 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
35928 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
35929 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
35930 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
35931 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
35932 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
35933 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
35934 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
35935 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
35936 support.
35937
35938 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35939 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35940 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35941 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35942 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35943
35944 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35945 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35946 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35947 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35948 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35949 system calls.
35950
35951 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35952 this very system call.
35953
35954 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35955 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35956 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35957 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35958 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35959 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35960
35961 @end table
35962
35963 @node General Query Packets
35964 @section General Query Packets
35965 @cindex remote query requests
35966
35967 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35968 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35969 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35970 sending information to and from the stub.
35971
35972 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35973 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35974 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35975 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35976 conventions:
35977
35978 @itemize @bullet
35979 @item
35980 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35981 @item
35982 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35983 letter.
35984 @item
35985 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35986 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35987 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35988 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35989 @end itemize
35990
35991 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35992 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35993 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35994 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35995 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35996 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35997 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35998 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35999 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36000 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36001 packet.}.
36002
36003 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36004 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36005 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36006 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36007 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36008
36009 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36010
36011 @table @samp
36012
36013 @item QAgent:1
36014 @itemx QAgent:0
36015 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36016 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36017
36018 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36019 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36020 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36021 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36022 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36023 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36024 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36025 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36026 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36027 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36028 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36029
36030 @item qC
36031 @cindex current thread, remote request
36032 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36033 Return the current thread ID.
36034
36035 Reply:
36036 @table @samp
36037 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36038 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36039 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36040 @item @r{(anything else)}
36041 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36042 @end table
36043
36044 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36045 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36046 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36047 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36048 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36049 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36050 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36051 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36052
36053 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36054 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36055 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36056 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36057 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36058 detect trailing zeros.
36059
36060 Reply:
36061 @table @samp
36062 @item E @var{NN}
36063 An error (such as memory fault)
36064 @item C @var{crc32}
36065 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36066 @end table
36067
36068 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36069 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36070 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36071 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36072 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36073 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36074 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36075 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36076 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36077 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36078 randomization.
36079
36080 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36081
36082 Reply:
36083 @table @samp
36084 @item OK
36085 The request succeeded.
36086
36087 @item E @var{nn}
36088 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36089
36090 @item @w{}
36091 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36092 by the stub.
36093 @end table
36094
36095 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36096 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36097 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36098 address space randomization.
36099
36100 @item qfThreadInfo
36101 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36102 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36103 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36104 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36105 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36106 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36107 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36108 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36109 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36110 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36111
36112 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36113
36114 Reply:
36115 @table @samp
36116 @item m @var{thread-id}
36117 A single thread ID
36118 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36119 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36120 @item l
36121 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36122 @end table
36123
36124 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36125 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36126 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36127 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36128 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36129 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36130 fields.
36131
36132 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36133 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36134 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36135 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36136 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36137
36138 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36139 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36140 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36141 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36142 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36143
36144 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36145 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36146
36147 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36148 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36149 information associated with the variable.)
36150
36151 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36152 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36153 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36154 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36155 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36156 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36157
36158 Reply:
36159 @table @samp
36160 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36161 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36162 local storage requested.
36163
36164 @item E @var{nn}
36165 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36166
36167 @item @w{}
36168 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36169 @end table
36170
36171 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36172 @cindex get thread information block address
36173 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36174 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36175
36176 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36177
36178 Reply:
36179 @table @samp
36180 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36181 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36182 thread information block.
36183
36184 @item E @var{nn}
36185 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36186 address could not be retrieved.
36187
36188 @item @w{}
36189 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36190 @end table
36191
36192 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36193 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36194 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36195 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36196 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36197 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36198 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36199
36200 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36201
36202 Reply:
36203 @table @samp
36204 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36205 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36206 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36207 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36208 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36209 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36210 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36211 @end table
36212
36213 @item qOffsets
36214 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36215 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36216 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36217 image.
36218
36219 Reply:
36220 @table @samp
36221 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36222 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36223 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36224 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36225 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36226 segments by the supplied offsets.
36227
36228 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36229 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36230 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36231
36232 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36233 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36234 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36235 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36236 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36237 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36238 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36239 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36240 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36241 @end table
36242
36243 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36244 @cindex thread information, remote request
36245 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36246 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36247 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36248 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36249
36250 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36251 (see below).
36252
36253 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36254
36255 @item QNonStop:1
36256 @itemx QNonStop:0
36257 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36258 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36259 @anchor{QNonStop}
36260 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36261 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36262
36263 Reply:
36264 @table @samp
36265 @item OK
36266 The request succeeded.
36267
36268 @item E @var{nn}
36269 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36270
36271 @item @w{}
36272 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36273 the stub.
36274 @end table
36275
36276 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36277 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36278 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36279 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36280
36281 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36282 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36283 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36284 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36285 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36286 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36287 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36288
36289 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36290 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36291 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36292
36293 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36294 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36295 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36296 report the requested syscalls.
36297
36298 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36299 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36300
36301 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36302 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36303 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36304 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36305
36306 Reply:
36307 @table @samp
36308 @item OK
36309 The request succeeded.
36310
36311 @item E @var{nn}
36312 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36313
36314 @item @w{}
36315 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36316 the stub.
36317 @end table
36318
36319 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36320 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36321 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36322 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36323
36324 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36325 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36326 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36327 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36328 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36329 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36330 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36331 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36332 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36333 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36334 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36335 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36336 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36337
36338 Reply:
36339 @table @samp
36340 @item OK
36341 The request succeeded.
36342
36343 @item E @var{nn}
36344 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36345
36346 @item @w{}
36347 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36348 the stub.
36349 @end table
36350
36351 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36352 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36353 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36354 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36355
36356 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36357 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36358 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36359 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36360 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36361 Others should be silently discarded.
36362
36363 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36364 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36365 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36366 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36367 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36368 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36369 signals.
36370
36371 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36372 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36373
36374 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36375 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36376 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36377 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36378 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36379
36380 Reply:
36381 @table @samp
36382 @item OK
36383 The request succeeded.
36384
36385 @item E @var{nn}
36386 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36387
36388 @item @w{}
36389 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36390 by the stub.
36391 @end table
36392
36393 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36394 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36395 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36396 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36397
36398 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36399 @item QThreadEvents:1
36400 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36401 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36402 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36403
36404 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36405 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36406 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36407 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36408 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36409 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36410 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36411 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36412 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36413 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36414
36415 Reply:
36416 @table @samp
36417 @item OK
36418 The request succeeded.
36419
36420 @item E @var{nn}
36421 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36422
36423 @item @w{}
36424 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36425 the stub.
36426 @end table
36427
36428 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36429 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36430
36431 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36432 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36433 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36434 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36435 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36436 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36437 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36438 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36439 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36440
36441 Reply:
36442 @table @samp
36443 @item OK
36444 A command response with no output.
36445 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36446 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36447 @item E @var{NN}
36448 Indicate a badly formed request.
36449 @item @w{}
36450 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36451 @end table
36452
36453 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36454 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36455 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36456 packets.)
36457
36458 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36459 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36460 @ifnotinfo
36461 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36462 @end ifnotinfo
36463 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36464 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36465 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36466 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36467 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36468
36469 Reply:
36470 @table @samp
36471 @item 0
36472 The pattern was not found.
36473 @item 1,address
36474 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36475 @item E @var{NN}
36476 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36477 @item @w{}
36478 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36479 @end table
36480
36481 @item QStartNoAckMode
36482 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36483 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36484 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36485 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36486
36487 Reply:
36488 @table @samp
36489 @item OK
36490 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36491 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36492 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36493 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36494 @item @w{}
36495 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36496 @end table
36497
36498 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36499 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36500 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36501 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36502 @anchor{qSupported}
36503 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36504 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36505 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36506 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36507 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36508 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36509 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36510 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36511 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36512 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36513 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36514 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36515 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36516 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36517
36518 Reply:
36519 @table @samp
36520 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36521 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36522 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36523 possible forms).
36524 @item @w{}
36525 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36526 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36527 @end table
36528
36529 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36530 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36531 are:
36532
36533 @table @samp
36534 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36535 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36536 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36537 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36538 @item @var{name}+
36539 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36540 need an associated value.
36541 @item @var{name}-
36542 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36543 @item @var{name}?
36544 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36545 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36546 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36547 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36548 @end table
36549
36550 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36551 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36552 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36553 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36554 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36555
36556 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36557 are defined:
36558
36559 @table @samp
36560 @item multiprocess
36561 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36562 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36563 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36564 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36565 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36566
36567 @item xmlRegisters
36568 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36569 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36570 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36571 description.
36572
36573 @item qRelocInsn
36574 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36575 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36576 instruction reply packet}).
36577
36578 @item swbreak
36579 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36580 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36581
36582 @item hwbreak
36583 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36584 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36585
36586 @item fork-events
36587 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36588 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36589 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36590 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36591
36592 @item vfork-events
36593 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36594 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36595 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36596 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36597
36598 @item exec-events
36599 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36600 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36601 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36602 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36603
36604 @item vContSupported
36605 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36606 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36607 @end table
36608
36609 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36610 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36611 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36612 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36613 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36614 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36615 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36616 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36617 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36618 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36619 all the features it supports.
36620
36621 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36622 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36623
36624 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36625 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36626 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36627 form response.
36628
36629 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36630 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36631 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36632 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36633
36634 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36635 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36636 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36637 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36638 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36639
36640 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36641
36642 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36643 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36644 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36645 @item Feature Name
36646 @tab Value Required
36647 @tab Default
36648 @tab Probe Allowed
36649
36650 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36651 @tab Yes
36652 @tab @samp{-}
36653 @tab No
36654
36655 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36656 @tab No
36657 @tab @samp{-}
36658 @tab Yes
36659
36660 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36661 @tab No
36662 @tab @samp{-}
36663 @tab Yes
36664
36665 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36666 @tab No
36667 @tab @samp{-}
36668 @tab Yes
36669
36670 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36671 @tab No
36672 @tab @samp{-}
36673 @tab Yes
36674
36675 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36676 @tab No
36677 @tab @samp{-}
36678 @tab Yes
36679
36680 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36681 @tab No
36682 @tab @samp{-}
36683 @tab Yes
36684
36685 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36686 @tab No
36687 @tab @samp{-}
36688 @tab Yes
36689
36690 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36691 @tab No
36692 @tab @samp{-}
36693 @tab No
36694
36695 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36696 @tab No
36697 @tab @samp{-}
36698 @tab Yes
36699
36700 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36701 @tab No
36702 @tab @samp{-}
36703 @tab Yes
36704
36705 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36706 @tab No
36707 @tab @samp{-}
36708 @tab Yes
36709
36710 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36711 @tab No
36712 @tab @samp{-}
36713 @tab Yes
36714
36715 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36716 @tab No
36717 @tab @samp{-}
36718 @tab Yes
36719
36720 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36721 @tab No
36722 @tab @samp{-}
36723 @tab Yes
36724
36725 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36726 @tab No
36727 @tab @samp{-}
36728 @tab Yes
36729
36730 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36731 @tab No
36732 @tab @samp{-}
36733 @tab Yes
36734
36735 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36736 @tab No
36737 @tab @samp{-}
36738 @tab Yes
36739
36740 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36741 @tab No
36742 @tab @samp{-}
36743 @tab Yes
36744
36745 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36746 @tab Yes
36747 @tab @samp{-}
36748 @tab Yes
36749
36750 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36751 @tab Yes
36752 @tab @samp{-}
36753 @tab Yes
36754
36755 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36756 @tab Yes
36757 @tab @samp{-}
36758 @tab Yes
36759
36760 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36761 @tab Yes
36762 @tab @samp{-}
36763 @tab Yes
36764
36765 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36766 @tab Yes
36767 @tab @samp{-}
36768 @tab Yes
36769
36770 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36771 @tab No
36772 @tab @samp{-}
36773 @tab Yes
36774
36775 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36776 @tab No
36777 @tab @samp{-}
36778 @tab Yes
36779
36780 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36781 @tab No
36782 @tab @samp{-}
36783 @tab Yes
36784
36785 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36786 @tab No
36787 @tab @samp{-}
36788 @tab Yes
36789
36790 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36791 @tab No
36792 @tab @samp{-}
36793 @tab No
36794
36795 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36796 @tab No
36797 @tab @samp{-}
36798 @tab No
36799
36800 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36801 @tab No
36802 @tab @samp{-}
36803 @tab No
36804
36805 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36806 @tab No
36807 @tab @samp{-}
36808 @tab No
36809
36810 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36811 @tab No
36812 @tab @samp{-}
36813 @tab No
36814
36815 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36816 @tab No
36817 @tab @samp{-}
36818 @tab No
36819
36820 @item @samp{QAgent}
36821 @tab No
36822 @tab @samp{-}
36823 @tab No
36824
36825 @item @samp{QAllow}
36826 @tab No
36827 @tab @samp{-}
36828 @tab No
36829
36830 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36831 @tab No
36832 @tab @samp{-}
36833 @tab No
36834
36835 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36836 @tab No
36837 @tab @samp{-}
36838 @tab No
36839
36840 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36841 @tab No
36842 @tab @samp{-}
36843 @tab No
36844
36845 @item @samp{tracenz}
36846 @tab No
36847 @tab @samp{-}
36848 @tab No
36849
36850 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36851 @tab No
36852 @tab @samp{-}
36853 @tab No
36854
36855 @item @samp{swbreak}
36856 @tab No
36857 @tab @samp{-}
36858 @tab No
36859
36860 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36861 @tab No
36862 @tab @samp{-}
36863 @tab No
36864
36865 @item @samp{fork-events}
36866 @tab No
36867 @tab @samp{-}
36868 @tab No
36869
36870 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36871 @tab No
36872 @tab @samp{-}
36873 @tab No
36874
36875 @item @samp{exec-events}
36876 @tab No
36877 @tab @samp{-}
36878 @tab No
36879
36880 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
36881 @tab No
36882 @tab @samp{-}
36883 @tab No
36884
36885 @item @samp{no-resumed}
36886 @tab No
36887 @tab @samp{-}
36888 @tab No
36889
36890 @end multitable
36891
36892 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36893
36894 @table @samp
36895 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36896 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36897 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36898 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36899 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36900 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36901 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36902 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36903 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36904 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36905
36906 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36907 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36908 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36909
36910 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36911 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36912 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36913
36914 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36915 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36916 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36917
36918 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36919 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36920 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36921
36922 @item qXfer:features:read
36923 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36924 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36925
36926 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36927 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36928 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36929
36930 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36931 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36932 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36933
36934 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36935 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36936 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36937 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36938
36939 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36940 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36941 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36942
36943 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36944 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36945 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36946
36947 @item qXfer:spu:read
36948 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36949 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36950
36951 @item qXfer:spu:write
36952 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36953 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36954
36955 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36956 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36957 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36958
36959 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36960 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36961 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36962
36963 @item qXfer:threads:read
36964 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36965 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36966
36967 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36968 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36969 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36970
36971 @item qXfer:uib:read
36972 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36973 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36974
36975 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36976 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36977 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36978
36979 @item QNonStop
36980 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36981 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36982
36983 @item QCatchSyscalls
36984 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36985 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
36986
36987 @item QPassSignals
36988 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36989 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36990
36991 @item QStartNoAckMode
36992 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36993 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36994
36995 @item multiprocess
36996 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36997 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36998 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36999 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37000 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37001 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37002 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37003 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37004 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37005 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37006 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37007
37008 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37009 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37010 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37011
37012 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37013 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37014 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37015 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37016
37017 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37018 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37019 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37020
37021 @item ReverseContinue
37022 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37023 (@pxref{bc}).
37024
37025 @item ReverseStep
37026 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37027 (@pxref{bs}).
37028
37029 @item TracepointSource
37030 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37031 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37032
37033 @item QAgent
37034 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37035
37036 @item QAllow
37037 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37038
37039 @item QDisableRandomization
37040 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37041
37042 @item StaticTracepoint
37043 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37044 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37045
37046 @item InstallInTrace
37047 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37048 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37049
37050 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37051 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37052 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37053 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37054
37055 @item QTBuffer:size
37056 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37057 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37058
37059 @item tracenz
37060 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37061 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37062 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37063
37064 @item BreakpointCommands
37065 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37066 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37067 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37068
37069 @item Qbtrace:off
37070 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37071
37072 @item Qbtrace:bts
37073 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37074
37075 @item Qbtrace:pt
37076 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37077
37078 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37079 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37080
37081 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37082 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37083
37084 @item swbreak
37085 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37086 breakpoints.
37087
37088 @item hwbreak
37089 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37090 breakpoints.
37091
37092 @item fork-events
37093 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37094
37095 @item vfork-events
37096 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37097 and vforkdone events.
37098
37099 @item exec-events
37100 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37101
37102 @item vContSupported
37103 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37104 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37105
37106 @item QThreadEvents
37107 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37108
37109 @item no-resumed
37110 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37111
37112 @end table
37113
37114 @item qSymbol::
37115 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37116 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37117 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37118 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37119
37120 Reply:
37121 @table @samp
37122 @item OK
37123 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37124 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37125 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37126 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37127 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37128 below.
37129 @end table
37130
37131 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37132 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37133
37134 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37135 target has previously requested.
37136
37137 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37138 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37139 will be empty.
37140
37141 Reply:
37142 @table @samp
37143 @item OK
37144 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37145 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37146 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37147 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37148 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37149 @end table
37150
37151 @item qTBuffer
37152 @itemx QTBuffer
37153 @itemx QTDisconnected
37154 @itemx QTDP
37155 @itemx QTDPsrc
37156 @itemx QTDV
37157 @itemx qTfP
37158 @itemx qTfV
37159 @itemx QTFrame
37160 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37161
37162 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37163
37164 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37165 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37166 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37167 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37168 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37169 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37170 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37171 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37172 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37173 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37174 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37175
37176 Reply:
37177 @table @samp
37178 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37179 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37180 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37181 the thread's attributes.
37182 @end table
37183
37184 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37185 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37186 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37187 packets.)
37188
37189 @item QTNotes
37190 @itemx qTP
37191 @itemx QTSave
37192 @itemx qTsP
37193 @itemx qTsV
37194 @itemx QTStart
37195 @itemx QTStop
37196 @itemx QTEnable
37197 @itemx QTDisable
37198 @itemx QTinit
37199 @itemx QTro
37200 @itemx qTStatus
37201 @itemx qTV
37202 @itemx qTfSTM
37203 @itemx qTsSTM
37204 @itemx qTSTMat
37205 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37206
37207 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37208 @cindex read special object, remote request
37209 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37210 @anchor{qXfer read}
37211 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37212 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37213 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37214 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37215 additional details about what data to access.
37216
37217 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37218 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37219 formats, listed below.
37220
37221 @table @samp
37222 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37223 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37224 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37225 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37226
37227 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37228 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37229
37230 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37231 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37232
37233 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37234 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37235 packet may have one of the following values:
37236
37237 @table @code
37238 @item all
37239 Returns all available branch trace.
37240
37241 @item new
37242 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37243 the last read request.
37244
37245 @item delta
37246 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37247 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37248 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37249 used to stitch traces together.
37250
37251 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37252 @end table
37253
37254 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37255 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37256
37257 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37258 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37259
37260 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37261 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37262
37263 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37264 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37265
37266 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37267 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37268 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37269 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37270 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37271 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37272 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37273
37274 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37275 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37276
37277 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37278 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37279 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37280 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37281 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37282
37283 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37284 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37285
37286 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37287 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37288 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37289 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37290 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37291
37292 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37293 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37294 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37295
37296 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37297 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37298
37299 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37300 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37301 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37302 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37303 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37304 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37305 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37306 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37307
37308 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37309 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37310
37311 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37312 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37313
37314 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37315 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37316 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37317 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37318
37319 @table @code
37320 @item start=@var{address}
37321 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37322 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37323 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37324 chosen as the starting point.
37325
37326 @item prev=@var{address}
37327 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37328 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37329 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37330 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37331 exists prior to the starting point.
37332
37333 @end table
37334
37335 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37336 ignored.
37337
37338 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37339 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37340 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37341 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37342 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37343
37344 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37345 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37346
37347 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37348 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37349
37350 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37351 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37352 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37353 Action Lists}.
37354
37355 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37356 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37357 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37358
37359 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37360 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37361 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37362 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37363 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37364
37365 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37366 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37367 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37368
37369 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37370 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37371 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37372 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37373 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37374 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37375 in that context to be accessed.
37376
37377 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37378 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37379 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37380
37381 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37382 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37383 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37384 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37385 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37386
37387 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37388 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37389
37390 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37391 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37392
37393 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37394 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37395 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37396
37397 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37398 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37399
37400 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37401 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37402
37403 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37404 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37405
37406 This packet is not probed by default.
37407
37408 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37409 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37410 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37411 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37412 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37413
37414 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37415 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37416
37417 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37418 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37419 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37420 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37421
37422 @end table
37423
37424 Reply:
37425 @table @samp
37426 @item m @var{data}
37427 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37428 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37429 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37430 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37431 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37432 request.
37433
37434 @item l @var{data}
37435 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37436 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37437 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37438
37439 @item l
37440 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37441 There is no more data to be read.
37442
37443 @item E00
37444 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37445
37446 @item E @var{nn}
37447 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37448 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37449
37450 @item @w{}
37451 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37452 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37453 @end table
37454
37455 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37456 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37457 @anchor{qXfer write}
37458 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37459 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37460 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37461 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37462 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37463 to access.
37464
37465 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37466 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37467 formats, listed below.
37468
37469 @table @samp
37470 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37471 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37472 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37473 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37474 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37475
37476 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37477 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37478 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37479
37480 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37481 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37482 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37483 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37484 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37485 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37486 in that context to be accessed.
37487
37488 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37489 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37490 @end table
37491
37492 Reply:
37493 @table @samp
37494 @item @var{nn}
37495 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37496 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37497
37498 @item E00
37499 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37500
37501 @item E @var{nn}
37502 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37503 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37504
37505 @item @w{}
37506 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37507 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37508 @end table
37509
37510 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37511 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37512 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37513 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37514 must respond with an empty packet.
37515
37516 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37517 @cindex query attached, remote request
37518 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37519 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37520 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37521 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37522 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37523 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37524 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37525
37526 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37527 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37528 the @code{quit} command.
37529
37530 Reply:
37531 @table @samp
37532 @item 1
37533 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37534 @item 0
37535 The remote server created a new process.
37536 @item E @var{NN}
37537 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37538 @end table
37539
37540 @item Qbtrace:bts
37541 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37542
37543 Reply:
37544 @table @samp
37545 @item OK
37546 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37547 @item E.errtext
37548 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37549 @end table
37550
37551 @item Qbtrace:pt
37552 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37553
37554 Reply:
37555 @table @samp
37556 @item OK
37557 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37558 @item E.errtext
37559 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37560 @end table
37561
37562 @item Qbtrace:off
37563 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37564
37565 Reply:
37566 @table @samp
37567 @item OK
37568 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37569 @item E.errtext
37570 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37571 @end table
37572
37573 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37574 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37575 btrace recording method in bts format.
37576
37577 Reply:
37578 @table @samp
37579 @item OK
37580 The ring buffer size has been set.
37581 @item E.errtext
37582 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37583 @end table
37584
37585 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37586 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37587 btrace recording method in pt format.
37588
37589 Reply:
37590 @table @samp
37591 @item OK
37592 The ring buffer size has been set.
37593 @item E.errtext
37594 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37595 @end table
37596
37597 @end table
37598
37599 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37600 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37601
37602 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37603 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37604 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37605
37606 @menu
37607 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37608 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37609 @end menu
37610
37611 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37612 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37613
37614 @menu
37615 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37616 @end menu
37617
37618 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37619 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37620 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37621
37622 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37623
37624 @table @r
37625
37626 @item 2
37627 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37628
37629 @item 3
37630 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37631
37632 @item 4
37633 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37634
37635 @end table
37636
37637 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37638 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37639
37640 @menu
37641 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37642 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37643 @end menu
37644
37645 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37646 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37647 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37648
37649 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37650 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37651 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37652 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37653 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37654 most-significant -- least-significant.
37655
37656 @table @r
37657
37658 @item MIPS32
37659 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37660 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37661 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37662
37663 @item MIPS64
37664 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37665 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37666 as @code{MIPS32}.
37667
37668 @end table
37669
37670 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37671 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37672 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37673
37674 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37675
37676 @table @r
37677
37678 @item 2
37679 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37680
37681 @item 3
37682 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37683
37684 @item 4
37685 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37686
37687 @item 5
37688 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37689
37690 @end table
37691
37692 @node Tracepoint Packets
37693 @section Tracepoint Packets
37694 @cindex tracepoint packets
37695 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37696
37697 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37698 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37699
37700 @table @samp
37701
37702 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37703 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37704 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37705 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37706 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37707 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37708 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37709 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37710 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37711 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37712 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37713 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37714 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37715 actions.
37716
37717 Replies:
37718 @table @samp
37719 @item OK
37720 The packet was understood and carried out.
37721 @item qRelocInsn
37722 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37723 @item @w{}
37724 The packet was not recognized.
37725 @end table
37726
37727 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37728 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37729 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37730 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37731 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37732 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37733 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37734
37735 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37736 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37737 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37738 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37739 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37740 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37741 tracepoint actions.
37742
37743 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37744 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37745 following forms:
37746
37747 @table @samp
37748
37749 @item R @var{mask}
37750 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37751 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37752 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37753 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37754 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37755
37756 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37757 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37758 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37759 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37760 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37761 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37762 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37763
37764 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37765 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37766 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37767 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37768 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37769 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37770 packet).
37771
37772 @end table
37773
37774 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37775 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37776 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37777 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37778 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37779 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37780 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37781 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37782
37783 Replies:
37784 @table @samp
37785 @item OK
37786 The packet was understood and carried out.
37787 @item qRelocInsn
37788 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37789 @item @w{}
37790 The packet was not recognized.
37791 @end table
37792
37793 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37794 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37795 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37796 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37797 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37798 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37799 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37800 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37801
37802 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37803 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37804 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37805 fit in a single packet.
37806 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37807 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37808
37809 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37810 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37811 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37812 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37813
37814 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37815 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37816 query packets.
37817
37818 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37819 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37820 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37821 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37822 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37823 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37824 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37825 be found.
37826
37827 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37828 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37829 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37830 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37831 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37832 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37833 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37834 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37835 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37836 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37837 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37838 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37839 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37840 variable.
37841
37842 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37843 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37844 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37845 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37846 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37847
37848 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37849 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37850 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37851 one of the following forms:
37852
37853 @table @samp
37854 @item F @var{f}
37855 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37856 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37857 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37858
37859 @item T @var{t}
37860 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37861 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37862
37863 @end table
37864
37865 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37866 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37867 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37868 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37869
37870 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37871 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37872 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37873 is a hexadecimal number.
37874
37875 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37876 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37877 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37878 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37879 numbers.
37880
37881 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37882 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37883 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37884
37885 @item qTMinFTPILen
37886 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37887 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37888 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37889 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37890 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37891 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37892 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37893 arrange for that.
37894
37895 Replies:
37896
37897 @table @samp
37898 @item 0
37899 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37900 @item @var{length}
37901 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37902 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37903 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37904 regardless of size.
37905 @item E
37906 An error has occurred.
37907 @item @w{}
37908 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37909 @end table
37910
37911 @item QTStart
37912 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37913 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37914 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37915 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37916 instruction reply packet}).
37917
37918 @item QTStop
37919 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37920 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37921
37922 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37923 @anchor{QTEnable}
37924 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37925 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37926 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37927 of data from it will resume.
37928
37929 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37930 @anchor{QTDisable}
37931 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37932 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37933 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37934 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37935
37936 @item QTinit
37937 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37938 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37939
37940 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37941 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37942 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37943 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37944 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37945
37946 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37947 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37948 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37949 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37950
37951 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37952 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37953 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37954 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37955 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37956 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37957
37958 @item qTStatus
37959 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37960 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37961
37962 The reply has the form:
37963
37964 @table @samp
37965
37966 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37967 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37968 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37969 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37970
37971 @end table
37972
37973 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37974 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37975
37976 @table @samp
37977
37978 @item tnotrun:0
37979 No trace has been run yet.
37980
37981 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37982 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37983 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37984 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37985 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37986
37987 @item tfull:0
37988 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37989
37990 @item tdisconnected:0
37991 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37992
37993 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37994 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37995
37996 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37997 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37998 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37999 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38000 is hex encoded.
38001
38002 @item tunknown:0
38003 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38004
38005 @end table
38006
38007 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38008 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38009 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38010 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38011 trace.
38012
38013 @table @samp
38014
38015 @item tframes:@var{n}
38016 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38017
38018 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38019 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38020 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38021
38022 @item tsize:@var{n}
38023 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38024
38025 @item tfree:@var{n}
38026 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38027
38028 @item circular:@var{n}
38029 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38030 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38031 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38032 and may fill up.
38033
38034 @item disconn:@var{n}
38035 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38036 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38037 that the trace run will stop.
38038
38039 @end table
38040
38041 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38042 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38043 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38044 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38045 address @var{addr}.
38046
38047 Replies:
38048 @table @samp
38049 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38050 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38051 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38052 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38053 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38054
38055 @end table
38056
38057 @item qTV:@var{var}
38058 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38059 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38060 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38061
38062 Replies:
38063 @table @samp
38064 @item V@var{value}
38065 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38066 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38067 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38068 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38069 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38070 program is running.
38071
38072 @item U
38073 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38074 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38075 was not collected.
38076 @end table
38077
38078 @item qTfP
38079 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38080 @itemx qTsP
38081 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38082 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38083 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38084 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38085 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38086 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38087
38088 @item qTfV
38089 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38090 @itemx qTsV
38091 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38092 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38093 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38094 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38095 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38096 trace state variables.
38097
38098 @item qTfSTM
38099 @itemx qTsSTM
38100 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38101 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38102 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38103 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38104 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38105 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38106 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38107 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38108
38109 Reply:
38110 @table @samp
38111 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38112 A single marker
38113 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38114 a comma-separated list of markers
38115 @item l
38116 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38117 @item E @var{nn}
38118 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38119 @item @w{}
38120 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38121 stub.
38122 @end table
38123
38124 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38125 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38126
38127 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38128 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38129 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38130 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38131 @dfn{last}).
38132
38133 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38134 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38135 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38136 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38137 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38138 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38139 tracepoint markers.
38140
38141 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38142 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38143 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38144 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38145 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38146 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38147
38148 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38149 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38150 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38151 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38152 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38153 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38154 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38155 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38156 available.
38157
38158 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38159 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38160 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38161
38162 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38163 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38164 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38165 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38166 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38167 use whatever size it prefers.
38168
38169 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38170 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38171 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38172 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38173 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38174
38175 @end table
38176
38177 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38178 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38179 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38180 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38181 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38182 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38183 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38184 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38185 it had executed in the original location.
38186
38187 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38188 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38189 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38190 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38191 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38192 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38193 format of the request is:
38194
38195 @table @samp
38196 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38197
38198 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38199 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38200 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38201 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38202 memory starting at @var{to}.
38203 @end table
38204
38205 Replies:
38206 @table @samp
38207 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38208 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38209 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38210 @item E @var{NN}
38211 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38212 relocating the instruction.
38213 @end table
38214
38215 @node Host I/O Packets
38216 @section Host I/O Packets
38217 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38218 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38219
38220 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38221 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38222 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38223 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38224 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38225 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38226 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38227 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38228 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38229 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38230
38231 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38232 its arguments. They have this format:
38233
38234 @table @samp
38235
38236 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38237 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38238 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38239 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38240 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38241 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38242 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38243 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38244 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38245
38246 @end table
38247
38248 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38249
38250 @table @samp
38251
38252 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38253 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38254 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38255 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38256 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38257 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38258 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38259 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38260 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38261 @var{attachment}.
38262
38263 @item @w{}
38264 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38265
38266 @end table
38267
38268 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38269
38270 @table @samp
38271 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38272 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38273 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38274 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38275 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38276 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38277 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38278
38279 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38280 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38281 -1 if an error occurs.
38282
38283 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38284 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38285 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38286 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38287 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38288 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38289 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38290 @var{count} was zero.
38291
38292 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38293 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38294 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38295 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38296 some characters were escaped.
38297
38298 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38299 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38300 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38301 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38302 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38303 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38304 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38305 error occurred.
38306
38307 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38308 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38309 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38310 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38311 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38312 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38313
38314 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38315 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38316 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38317
38318 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38319 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38320 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38321
38322 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38323 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38324 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38325 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38326 some characters were escaped.
38327
38328 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38329 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38330 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38331 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38332 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38333 inferior(s).
38334
38335 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38336 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38337 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38338 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38339 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38340 operation.
38341
38342 @end table
38343
38344 @node Interrupts
38345 @section Interrupts
38346 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38347 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38348
38349 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38350 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38351 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38352 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38353
38354 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38355 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38356 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38357 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38358 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38359
38360 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38361 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38362 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38363 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38364 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38365 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38366 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38367 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38368
38369 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38370 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38371 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38372
38373 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38374 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38375 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38376 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38377 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38378 @code{0x03}.
38379
38380 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38381 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38382 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38383 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38384 currently-executing threads and processes.
38385 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38386 running program, it should send one of the stop
38387 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38388 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38389 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38390 Interrupts received while the
38391 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38392 it is resumed next time.
38393
38394 @node Notification Packets
38395 @section Notification Packets
38396 @cindex notification packets
38397 @cindex packets, notification
38398
38399 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38400 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38401 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38402 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38403 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38404 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38405 is not a problem.
38406
38407 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38408 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38409 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38410 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38411 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38412 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38413 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38414
38415 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38416 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38417
38418 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38419 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38420 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38421 not they understand it.
38422
38423 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38424 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38425 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38426 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38427 recipients.
38428
38429 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38430 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38431 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38432 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38433 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38434
38435 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38436 @table @samp
38437 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38438 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38439 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38440 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38441 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38442 @item @var{ack}
38443 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38444 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38445 @end table
38446
38447 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38448 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38449
38450 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38451 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38452 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38453 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38454 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38455 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38456 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38457 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38458 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38459 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38460
38461 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38462 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38463 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38464 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38465 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38466 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38467
38468 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38469 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38470 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38471 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38472 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38473
38474 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38475 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38476 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38477 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38478 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38479 normally.
38480
38481 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38482 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38483 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38484 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38485 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38486 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38487 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38488 the process shall be repeated.
38489
38490 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38491 following example:
38492 @smallexample
38493 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38494 @code{...}
38495 -> @code{vStopped}
38496 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38497 -> @code{vStopped}
38498 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38499 -> @code{vStopped}
38500 <- @code{OK}
38501 @end smallexample
38502
38503 The following notifications are defined:
38504 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38505
38506 @item Notification
38507 @tab Ack
38508 @tab Event
38509 @tab Description
38510
38511 @item Stop
38512 @tab vStopped
38513 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38514 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38515 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38516 @value{GDBN}.
38517 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38518
38519 @end multitable
38520
38521 @node Remote Non-Stop
38522 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38523
38524 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38525 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38526 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38527 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38528
38529 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38530 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38531 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38532 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38533 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38534 probe the target state after a mode change.
38535
38536 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38537 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38538 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38539 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38540 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38541 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38542 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38543 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38544 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38545 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38546 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38547
38548 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38549 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38550 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38551 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38552 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38553 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38554 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38555 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38556 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38557 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38558 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38559 @samp{OK}.
38560
38561 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38562 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38563 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38564 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38565 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38566 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38567 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38568 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38569 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38570 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38571 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38572 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38573 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38574
38575 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38576 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38577
38578 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38579 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38580 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38581 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38582 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38583 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38584 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38585
38586 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38587 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38588 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38589 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38590 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38591
38592 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38593 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38594 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38595 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38596
38597 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38598 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38599 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38600 @pxref{qSupported}.
38601 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38602 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38603 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38604 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38605 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38606 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38607 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38608
38609 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38610 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38611 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38612 connection.
38613 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38614 new connection is established,
38615 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38616 for the current connection, once disabled.
38617
38618 @node Examples
38619 @section Examples
38620
38621 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38622 does not get any direct output:
38623
38624 @smallexample
38625 -> @code{R00}
38626 <- @code{+}
38627 @emph{target restarts}
38628 -> @code{?}
38629 <- @code{+}
38630 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38631 -> @code{+}
38632 @end smallexample
38633
38634 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38635
38636 @smallexample
38637 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38638 <- @code{+}
38639 -> @code{s}
38640 <- @code{+}
38641 @emph{time passes}
38642 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38643 -> @code{+}
38644 -> @code{g}
38645 <- @code{+}
38646 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38647 -> @code{+}
38648 @end smallexample
38649
38650 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38651 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38652 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38653
38654 @menu
38655 * File-I/O Overview::
38656 * Protocol Basics::
38657 * The F Request Packet::
38658 * The F Reply Packet::
38659 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38660 * Console I/O::
38661 * List of Supported Calls::
38662 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38663 * Constants::
38664 * File-I/O Examples::
38665 @end menu
38666
38667 @node File-I/O Overview
38668 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38669 @cindex file-i/o overview
38670
38671 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38672 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38673 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38674 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38675 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38676 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38677
38678 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38679 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38680 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38681 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38682 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38683
38684 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38685 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38686 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38687 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38688 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38689 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38690 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38691
38692 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38693 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38694 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38695 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38696 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38697
38698 @smallexample
38699 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38700 <- target requests 'system call X'
38701 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38702 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38703 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38704 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38705 @end smallexample
38706
38707 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38708 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38709 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38710 system are not supported by this protocol.
38711
38712 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38713
38714 @node Protocol Basics
38715 @subsection Protocol Basics
38716 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38717
38718 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38719 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38720 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38721 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38722 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38723 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38724 to call the appropriate host system call:
38725
38726 @itemize @bullet
38727 @item
38728 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38729
38730 @item
38731 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38732 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38733 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38734 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38735
38736 @end itemize
38737
38738 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38739
38740 @itemize @bullet
38741 @item
38742 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38743 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38744 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38745 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38746 packet.
38747
38748 @item
38749 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38750 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38751
38752 @item
38753 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38754
38755 @item
38756 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38757
38758 @item
38759 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38760 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38761 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38762 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38763 packet.
38764
38765 @end itemize
38766
38767 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38768 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38769
38770 @itemize @bullet
38771 @item
38772 Return value.
38773
38774 @item
38775 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38776
38777 @item
38778 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38779
38780 @end itemize
38781
38782 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38783 the latest continue or step action.
38784
38785 @node The F Request Packet
38786 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38787 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38788 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38789
38790 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38791
38792 @table @samp
38793 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38794
38795 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38796 This is just the name of the function.
38797
38798 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38799 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38800 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38801 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38802 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38803 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38804 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38805
38806 @end table
38807
38808
38809
38810 @node The F Reply Packet
38811 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38812 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38813 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38814
38815 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38816
38817 @table @samp
38818
38819 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38820
38821 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38822
38823 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38824 representation.
38825 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38826
38827 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38828 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38829 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38830
38831 @smallexample
38832 F0,0,C
38833 @end smallexample
38834
38835 @noindent
38836 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38837
38838 @smallexample
38839 F-1,4,C
38840 @end smallexample
38841
38842 @noindent
38843 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38844
38845 @end table
38846
38847
38848 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38849 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38850 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38851
38852 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38853 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38854 the target should behave as if it had
38855 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38856 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38857 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38858 packet.
38859
38860 It's important for the target to know in which
38861 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38862
38863 @itemize @bullet
38864 @item
38865 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38866
38867 @item
38868 The system call on the host has been finished.
38869
38870 @end itemize
38871
38872 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38873 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38874 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38875 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38876 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38877 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38878
38879 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38880 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38881 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38882 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38883 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38884 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38885 or the full action has been completed.
38886
38887 @node Console I/O
38888 @subsection Console I/O
38889 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38890
38891 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38892 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38893 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38894 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38895 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38896 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38897 conditions is met:
38898
38899 @itemize @bullet
38900 @item
38901 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38902 @code{read}
38903 system call is treated as finished.
38904
38905 @item
38906 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38907 newline.
38908
38909 @item
38910 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38911 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38912
38913 @end itemize
38914
38915 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38916 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38917 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38918 is stopped at the user's request.
38919
38920
38921 @node List of Supported Calls
38922 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38923 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38924
38925 @menu
38926 * open::
38927 * close::
38928 * read::
38929 * write::
38930 * lseek::
38931 * rename::
38932 * unlink::
38933 * stat/fstat::
38934 * gettimeofday::
38935 * isatty::
38936 * system::
38937 @end menu
38938
38939 @node open
38940 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38941 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38942
38943 @table @asis
38944 @item Synopsis:
38945 @smallexample
38946 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38947 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38948 @end smallexample
38949
38950 @item Request:
38951 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38952
38953 @noindent
38954 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38955
38956 @table @code
38957 @item O_CREAT
38958 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38959 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38960 are concerned.
38961
38962 @item O_EXCL
38963 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38964 an error and open() fails.
38965
38966 @item O_TRUNC
38967 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38968 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38969 truncated to zero length.
38970
38971 @item O_APPEND
38972 The file is opened in append mode.
38973
38974 @item O_RDONLY
38975 The file is opened for reading only.
38976
38977 @item O_WRONLY
38978 The file is opened for writing only.
38979
38980 @item O_RDWR
38981 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38982 @end table
38983
38984 @noindent
38985 Other bits are silently ignored.
38986
38987
38988 @noindent
38989 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38990
38991 @table @code
38992 @item S_IRUSR
38993 User has read permission.
38994
38995 @item S_IWUSR
38996 User has write permission.
38997
38998 @item S_IRGRP
38999 Group has read permission.
39000
39001 @item S_IWGRP
39002 Group has write permission.
39003
39004 @item S_IROTH
39005 Others have read permission.
39006
39007 @item S_IWOTH
39008 Others have write permission.
39009 @end table
39010
39011 @noindent
39012 Other bits are silently ignored.
39013
39014
39015 @item Return value:
39016 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39017 occurred.
39018
39019 @item Errors:
39020
39021 @table @code
39022 @item EEXIST
39023 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39024
39025 @item EISDIR
39026 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39027
39028 @item EACCES
39029 The requested access is not allowed.
39030
39031 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39032 @var{pathname} was too long.
39033
39034 @item ENOENT
39035 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39036
39037 @item ENODEV
39038 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39039
39040 @item EROFS
39041 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39042 write access was requested.
39043
39044 @item EFAULT
39045 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39046
39047 @item ENOSPC
39048 No space on device to create the file.
39049
39050 @item EMFILE
39051 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39052
39053 @item ENFILE
39054 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39055 has been reached.
39056
39057 @item EINTR
39058 The call was interrupted by the user.
39059 @end table
39060
39061 @end table
39062
39063 @node close
39064 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39065 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39066
39067 @table @asis
39068 @item Synopsis:
39069 @smallexample
39070 int close(int fd);
39071 @end smallexample
39072
39073 @item Request:
39074 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39075
39076 @item Return value:
39077 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39078
39079 @item Errors:
39080
39081 @table @code
39082 @item EBADF
39083 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39084
39085 @item EINTR
39086 The call was interrupted by the user.
39087 @end table
39088
39089 @end table
39090
39091 @node read
39092 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39093 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39094
39095 @table @asis
39096 @item Synopsis:
39097 @smallexample
39098 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39099 @end smallexample
39100
39101 @item Request:
39102 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39103
39104 @item Return value:
39105 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39106 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39107 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39108
39109 @item Errors:
39110
39111 @table @code
39112 @item EBADF
39113 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39114 reading.
39115
39116 @item EFAULT
39117 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39118
39119 @item EINTR
39120 The call was interrupted by the user.
39121 @end table
39122
39123 @end table
39124
39125 @node write
39126 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39127 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39128
39129 @table @asis
39130 @item Synopsis:
39131 @smallexample
39132 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39133 @end smallexample
39134
39135 @item Request:
39136 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39137
39138 @item Return value:
39139 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39140 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39141 is returned.
39142
39143 @item Errors:
39144
39145 @table @code
39146 @item EBADF
39147 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39148 writing.
39149
39150 @item EFAULT
39151 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39152
39153 @item EFBIG
39154 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39155 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39156
39157 @item ENOSPC
39158 No space on device to write the data.
39159
39160 @item EINTR
39161 The call was interrupted by the user.
39162 @end table
39163
39164 @end table
39165
39166 @node lseek
39167 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39168 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39169
39170 @table @asis
39171 @item Synopsis:
39172 @smallexample
39173 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39174 @end smallexample
39175
39176 @item Request:
39177 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39178
39179 @var{flag} is one of:
39180
39181 @table @code
39182 @item SEEK_SET
39183 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39184
39185 @item SEEK_CUR
39186 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39187 bytes.
39188
39189 @item SEEK_END
39190 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39191 bytes.
39192 @end table
39193
39194 @item Return value:
39195 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39196 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39197 value of -1 is returned.
39198
39199 @item Errors:
39200
39201 @table @code
39202 @item EBADF
39203 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39204
39205 @item ESPIPE
39206 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39207
39208 @item EINVAL
39209 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39210
39211 @item EINTR
39212 The call was interrupted by the user.
39213 @end table
39214
39215 @end table
39216
39217 @node rename
39218 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39219 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39220
39221 @table @asis
39222 @item Synopsis:
39223 @smallexample
39224 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39225 @end smallexample
39226
39227 @item Request:
39228 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39229
39230 @item Return value:
39231 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39232
39233 @item Errors:
39234
39235 @table @code
39236 @item EISDIR
39237 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39238 directory.
39239
39240 @item EEXIST
39241 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39242
39243 @item EBUSY
39244 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39245 process.
39246
39247 @item EINVAL
39248 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39249 of itself.
39250
39251 @item ENOTDIR
39252 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39253 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39254 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39255
39256 @item EFAULT
39257 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39258
39259 @item EACCES
39260 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39261
39262 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39263
39264 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39265
39266 @item ENOENT
39267 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39268
39269 @item EROFS
39270 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39271
39272 @item ENOSPC
39273 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39274 directory entry.
39275
39276 @item EINTR
39277 The call was interrupted by the user.
39278 @end table
39279
39280 @end table
39281
39282 @node unlink
39283 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39284 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39285
39286 @table @asis
39287 @item Synopsis:
39288 @smallexample
39289 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39290 @end smallexample
39291
39292 @item Request:
39293 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39294
39295 @item Return value:
39296 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39297
39298 @item Errors:
39299
39300 @table @code
39301 @item EACCES
39302 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39303
39304 @item EPERM
39305 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39306
39307 @item EBUSY
39308 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39309 being used by another process.
39310
39311 @item EFAULT
39312 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39313
39314 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39315 @var{pathname} was too long.
39316
39317 @item ENOENT
39318 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39319
39320 @item ENOTDIR
39321 A component of the path is not a directory.
39322
39323 @item EROFS
39324 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39325
39326 @item EINTR
39327 The call was interrupted by the user.
39328 @end table
39329
39330 @end table
39331
39332 @node stat/fstat
39333 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39334 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39335 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39336
39337 @table @asis
39338 @item Synopsis:
39339 @smallexample
39340 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39341 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39342 @end smallexample
39343
39344 @item Request:
39345 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39346 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39347
39348 @item Return value:
39349 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39350
39351 @item Errors:
39352
39353 @table @code
39354 @item EBADF
39355 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39356
39357 @item ENOENT
39358 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39359 path is an empty string.
39360
39361 @item ENOTDIR
39362 A component of the path is not a directory.
39363
39364 @item EFAULT
39365 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39366
39367 @item EACCES
39368 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39369
39370 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39371 @var{pathname} was too long.
39372
39373 @item EINTR
39374 The call was interrupted by the user.
39375 @end table
39376
39377 @end table
39378
39379 @node gettimeofday
39380 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39381 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39382
39383 @table @asis
39384 @item Synopsis:
39385 @smallexample
39386 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39387 @end smallexample
39388
39389 @item Request:
39390 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39391
39392 @item Return value:
39393 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39394
39395 @item Errors:
39396
39397 @table @code
39398 @item EINVAL
39399 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39400
39401 @item EFAULT
39402 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39403 @end table
39404
39405 @end table
39406
39407 @node isatty
39408 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39409 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39410
39411 @table @asis
39412 @item Synopsis:
39413 @smallexample
39414 int isatty(int fd);
39415 @end smallexample
39416
39417 @item Request:
39418 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39419
39420 @item Return value:
39421 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39422
39423 @item Errors:
39424
39425 @table @code
39426 @item EINTR
39427 The call was interrupted by the user.
39428 @end table
39429
39430 @end table
39431
39432 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39433 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39434 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39435 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39436 needed.
39437
39438
39439 @node system
39440 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39441 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39442
39443 @table @asis
39444 @item Synopsis:
39445 @smallexample
39446 int system(const char *command);
39447 @end smallexample
39448
39449 @item Request:
39450 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39451
39452 @item Return value:
39453 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39454 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39455 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39456 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39457 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39458 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39459 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39460
39461 @item Errors:
39462
39463 @table @code
39464 @item EINTR
39465 The call was interrupted by the user.
39466 @end table
39467
39468 @end table
39469
39470 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39471 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39472 the host is simplified before it's returned
39473 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39474 is discarded, and the return value consists
39475 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39476
39477 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39478 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39479 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39480
39481 @table @code
39482 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39483 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39484 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39485 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39486
39487 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39488 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39489 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39490 protocol.
39491 @end table
39492
39493 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39494 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39495 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39496
39497 @menu
39498 * Integral Datatypes::
39499 * Pointer Values::
39500 * Memory Transfer::
39501 * struct stat::
39502 * struct timeval::
39503 @end menu
39504
39505 @node Integral Datatypes
39506 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39507 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39508
39509 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39510 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39511 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39512
39513 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39514 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39515
39516 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39517
39518 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39519 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39520
39521 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39522
39523 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39524 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39525 byte order.
39526
39527 @node Pointer Values
39528 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39529 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39530
39531 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39532 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39533 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39534 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39535
39536 @smallexample
39537 @code{1aaf/12}
39538 @end smallexample
39539
39540 @noindent
39541 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39542 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39543 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39544 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39545
39546 @smallexample
39547 @code{123456/d}
39548 @end smallexample
39549
39550 @node Memory Transfer
39551 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39552 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39553
39554 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39555 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39556 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39557 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39558 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39559 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39560 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39561
39562
39563 @node struct stat
39564 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39565 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39566
39567 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39568 is defined as follows:
39569
39570 @smallexample
39571 struct stat @{
39572 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39573 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39574 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39575 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39576 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39577 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39578 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39579 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39580 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39581 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39582 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39583 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39584 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39585 @};
39586 @end smallexample
39587
39588 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39589 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39590 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39591
39592 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39593 range of values.
39594
39595 @table @code
39596
39597 @item st_dev
39598 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39599
39600 @item st_ino
39601 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39602
39603 @item st_mode
39604 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39605 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39606
39607 @item st_uid
39608 @itemx st_gid
39609 @itemx st_rdev
39610 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39611
39612 @item st_atime
39613 @itemx st_mtime
39614 @itemx st_ctime
39615 These values have a host and file system dependent
39616 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39617 support exact timing values.
39618 @end table
39619
39620 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39621 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39622 continuing.
39623
39624 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39625 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39626 get truncated on the target.
39627
39628 @node struct timeval
39629 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39630 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39631
39632 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39633 is defined as follows:
39634
39635 @smallexample
39636 struct timeval @{
39637 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39638 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39639 @};
39640 @end smallexample
39641
39642 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39643 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39644 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39645
39646 @node Constants
39647 @subsection Constants
39648 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39649
39650 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39651 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39652 values before and after the call as needed.
39653
39654 @menu
39655 * Open Flags::
39656 * mode_t Values::
39657 * Errno Values::
39658 * Lseek Flags::
39659 * Limits::
39660 @end menu
39661
39662 @node Open Flags
39663 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39664 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39665
39666 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39667
39668 @smallexample
39669 O_RDONLY 0x0
39670 O_WRONLY 0x1
39671 O_RDWR 0x2
39672 O_APPEND 0x8
39673 O_CREAT 0x200
39674 O_TRUNC 0x400
39675 O_EXCL 0x800
39676 @end smallexample
39677
39678 @node mode_t Values
39679 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39680 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39681
39682 All values are given in octal representation.
39683
39684 @smallexample
39685 S_IFREG 0100000
39686 S_IFDIR 040000
39687 S_IRUSR 0400
39688 S_IWUSR 0200
39689 S_IXUSR 0100
39690 S_IRGRP 040
39691 S_IWGRP 020
39692 S_IXGRP 010
39693 S_IROTH 04
39694 S_IWOTH 02
39695 S_IXOTH 01
39696 @end smallexample
39697
39698 @node Errno Values
39699 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39700 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39701
39702 All values are given in decimal representation.
39703
39704 @smallexample
39705 EPERM 1
39706 ENOENT 2
39707 EINTR 4
39708 EBADF 9
39709 EACCES 13
39710 EFAULT 14
39711 EBUSY 16
39712 EEXIST 17
39713 ENODEV 19
39714 ENOTDIR 20
39715 EISDIR 21
39716 EINVAL 22
39717 ENFILE 23
39718 EMFILE 24
39719 EFBIG 27
39720 ENOSPC 28
39721 ESPIPE 29
39722 EROFS 30
39723 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39724 EUNKNOWN 9999
39725 @end smallexample
39726
39727 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39728 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39729
39730 @node Lseek Flags
39731 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39732 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39733
39734 @smallexample
39735 SEEK_SET 0
39736 SEEK_CUR 1
39737 SEEK_END 2
39738 @end smallexample
39739
39740 @node Limits
39741 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39742 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39743
39744 All values are given in decimal representation.
39745
39746 @smallexample
39747 INT_MIN -2147483648
39748 INT_MAX 2147483647
39749 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39750 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39751 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39752 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39753 @end smallexample
39754
39755 @node File-I/O Examples
39756 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39757 @cindex file-i/o examples
39758
39759 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39760 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39761
39762 @smallexample
39763 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39764 @emph{request memory read from target}
39765 -> @code{m1234,6}
39766 <- XXXXXX
39767 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39768 -> @code{F6}
39769 @end smallexample
39770
39771 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39772 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39773
39774 @smallexample
39775 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39776 @emph{request memory write to target}
39777 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39778 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39779 -> @code{F6}
39780 @end smallexample
39781
39782 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39783 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39784
39785 @smallexample
39786 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39787 -> @code{F-1,9}
39788 @end smallexample
39789
39790 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39791 host is called:
39792
39793 @smallexample
39794 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39795 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39796 <- @code{T02}
39797 @end smallexample
39798
39799 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39800 host is called:
39801
39802 @smallexample
39803 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39804 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39805 <- @code{T02}
39806 @end smallexample
39807
39808 @node Library List Format
39809 @section Library List Format
39810 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39811
39812 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39813 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39814 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39815 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39816 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39817 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39818 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39819 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39820 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39821 are loaded.
39822
39823 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39824 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39825 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39826 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39827
39828 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39829 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39830 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39831 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39832 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39833 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39834
39835 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39836 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39837
39838 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39839 offset, looks like this:
39840
39841 @smallexample
39842 <library-list>
39843 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39844 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39845 </library>
39846 </library-list>
39847 @end smallexample
39848
39849 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39850 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39851
39852 @smallexample
39853 <library-list>
39854 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39855 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39856 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39857 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39858 </library>
39859 </library-list>
39860 @end smallexample
39861
39862 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39863
39864 @smallexample
39865 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39866 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39867 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39868 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39869 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39870 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39871 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39872 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39873 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39874 @end smallexample
39875
39876 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39877 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39878 section for each library.
39879
39880 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39881 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39882 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39883
39884 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39885 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39886 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39887 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39888
39889 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39890 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39891 target, the following parameters are reported:
39892
39893 @itemize @minus
39894 @item
39895 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39896 @code{struct link_map}.
39897 @item
39898 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39899 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39900 @item
39901 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39902 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39903 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39904 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39905 @item
39906 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39907 @end itemize
39908
39909 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39910 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39911 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39912
39913 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39914 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39915
39916 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39917 looks like this:
39918
39919 @smallexample
39920 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39921 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39922 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39923 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39924 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39925 </library-list-svr>
39926 @end smallexample
39927
39928 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39929
39930 @smallexample
39931 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39932 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39933 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39934 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39935 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39936 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39937 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39938 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39939 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39940 @end smallexample
39941
39942 @node Memory Map Format
39943 @section Memory Map Format
39944 @cindex memory map format
39945
39946 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39947 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39948 memory map.
39949
39950 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39951 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39952 lists memory regions.
39953
39954 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39955 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39956
39957 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39958
39959 @smallexample
39960 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39961 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39962 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39963 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39964 <memory-map>
39965 region...
39966 </memory-map>
39967 @end smallexample
39968
39969 Each region can be either:
39970
39971 @itemize
39972
39973 @item
39974 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39975 bytes from there:
39976
39977 @smallexample
39978 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39979 @end smallexample
39980
39981
39982 @item
39983 A region of read-only memory:
39984
39985 @smallexample
39986 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39987 @end smallexample
39988
39989
39990 @item
39991 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39992 bytes in length:
39993
39994 @smallexample
39995 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39996 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39997 </memory>
39998 @end smallexample
39999
40000 @end itemize
40001
40002 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40003 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40004 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40005
40006 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40007
40008 @smallexample
40009 <!-- ................................................... -->
40010 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40011 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40012 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40013 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40014 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40015 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40016 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40017 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40018 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40019 and its type, or device. -->
40020 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40021 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40022 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40023 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40024 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40025 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40026 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40027 @end smallexample
40028
40029 @node Thread List Format
40030 @section Thread List Format
40031 @cindex thread list format
40032
40033 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40034 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40035 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40036 the following structure:
40037
40038 @smallexample
40039 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40040 <threads>
40041 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40042 ... description ...
40043 </thread>
40044 </threads>
40045 @end smallexample
40046
40047 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40048 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40049 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40050 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40051 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40052 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40053 auxiliary information.
40054
40055 @node Traceframe Info Format
40056 @section Traceframe Info Format
40057 @cindex traceframe info format
40058
40059 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40060 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40061 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40062 collected in a traceframe.
40063
40064 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40065 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40066
40067 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40068 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40069
40070 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40071
40072 @smallexample
40073 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40074 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40075 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40076 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40077 <traceframe-info>
40078 block...
40079 </traceframe-info>
40080 @end smallexample
40081
40082 Each traceframe block can be either:
40083
40084 @itemize
40085
40086 @item
40087 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40088 @var{length} bytes from there:
40089
40090 @smallexample
40091 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40092 @end smallexample
40093
40094 @item
40095 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40096 collected:
40097
40098 @smallexample
40099 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40100 @end smallexample
40101
40102 @end itemize
40103
40104 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40105
40106 @smallexample
40107 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40108 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40109
40110 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40111 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40112 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40113 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40114 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40115 @end smallexample
40116
40117 @node Branch Trace Format
40118 @section Branch Trace Format
40119 @cindex branch trace format
40120
40121 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40122 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40123 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40124 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40125
40126 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40127 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40128
40129 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40130 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40131
40132 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40133
40134 @smallexample
40135 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40136 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40137 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40138 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40139 <btrace>
40140 block...
40141 </btrace>
40142 @end smallexample
40143
40144 @itemize
40145
40146 @item
40147 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40148 and ending at @var{end}:
40149
40150 @smallexample
40151 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40152 @end smallexample
40153
40154 @end itemize
40155
40156 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40157
40158 @smallexample
40159 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40160 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40161
40162 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40163 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40164 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40165
40166 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40167
40168 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40169
40170 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40171 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40172 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40173 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40174 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40175
40176 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40177 @end smallexample
40178
40179 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40180 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40181 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40182
40183 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40184 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40185 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40186
40187 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40188 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40189
40190 @table @code
40191 @item bts
40192 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40193 @table @code
40194 @item size
40195 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40196 @end table
40197 @item pt
40198 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40199 PT}) format.
40200 @table @code
40201 @item size
40202 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40203 @end table
40204 @end table
40205
40206 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40207 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40208
40209 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40210
40211 @smallexample
40212 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40213 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40214
40215 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40216 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40217
40218 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40219 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40220 @end smallexample
40221
40222 @include agentexpr.texi
40223
40224 @node Target Descriptions
40225 @appendix Target Descriptions
40226 @cindex target descriptions
40227
40228 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40229 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40230 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40231 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40232 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40233 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40234 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40235
40236 @itemize @bullet
40237 @item
40238 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40239 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40240 @item
40241 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40242 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40243 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40244 @item
40245 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40246 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40247 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40248 @end itemize
40249
40250 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40251 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40252 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40253 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40254 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40255
40256 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40257 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40258
40259 @menu
40260 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40261 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40262 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40263 descriptions.
40264 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40265 @end menu
40266
40267 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40268 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40269
40270 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40271 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40272 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40273 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40274 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40275 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40276 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40277 Format}.
40278
40279 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40280 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40281 specify a file are:
40282
40283 @table @code
40284 @cindex set tdesc filename
40285 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40286 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40287
40288 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40289 @item unset tdesc filename
40290 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40291 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40292
40293 @cindex show tdesc filename
40294 @item show tdesc filename
40295 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40296 @end table
40297
40298
40299 @node Target Description Format
40300 @section Target Description Format
40301 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40302
40303 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40304 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40305 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40306 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40307 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40308 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40309 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40310
40311 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40312 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40313 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40314 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40315 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40316
40317 Here is a simple target description:
40318
40319 @smallexample
40320 <target version="1.0">
40321 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40322 </target>
40323 @end smallexample
40324
40325 @noindent
40326 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40327 the x86-64 architecture.
40328
40329 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40330 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40331 are explained further below.
40332
40333 @smallexample
40334 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40335 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40336 <target version="1.0">
40337 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40338 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40339 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40340 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40341 </target>
40342 @end smallexample
40343
40344 @noindent
40345 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40346 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40347 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40348 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40349 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40350 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40351 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40352 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40353 the version mismatch.
40354
40355 @subsection Inclusion
40356 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40357 @cindex XInclude
40358 @ifnotinfo
40359 @cindex <xi:include>
40360 @end ifnotinfo
40361
40362 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40363 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40364 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40365 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40366 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40367
40368 @smallexample
40369 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40370 @end smallexample
40371
40372 @noindent
40373 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40374 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40375 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40376 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40377 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40378 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40379 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40380 original description.
40381
40382 @subsection Architecture
40383 @cindex <architecture>
40384
40385 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40386
40387 @smallexample
40388 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40389 @end smallexample
40390
40391 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40392 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40393
40394 @subsection OS ABI
40395 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40396
40397 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40398 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40399
40400 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40401
40402 @smallexample
40403 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40404 @end smallexample
40405
40406 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40407 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40408
40409 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40410 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40411
40412 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40413 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40414
40415 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40416
40417 @smallexample
40418 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40419 @end smallexample
40420
40421 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40422 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40423
40424 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40425 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40426 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40427 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40428 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40429 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40430 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40431
40432 @smallexample
40433 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40434 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40435 @end smallexample
40436
40437 @subsection Features
40438 @cindex <feature>
40439
40440 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40441 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40442 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40443 has this form:
40444
40445 @smallexample
40446 <feature name="@var{name}">
40447 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40448 @var{reg}@dots{}
40449 </feature>
40450 @end smallexample
40451
40452 @noindent
40453 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40454 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40455 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40456 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40457
40458 @subsection Types
40459
40460 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40461 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40462 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40463 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40464 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
40465
40466 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40467 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40468 Types must be defined before they are used.
40469
40470 @cindex <vector>
40471 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40472 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40473 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40474 @var{count}:
40475
40476 @smallexample
40477 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40478 @end smallexample
40479
40480 @cindex <union>
40481 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40482 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40483 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40484 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40485
40486 @smallexample
40487 <union id="@var{id}">
40488 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40489 @dots{}
40490 </union>
40491 @end smallexample
40492
40493 @cindex <struct>
40494 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40495 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
40496 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
40497 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
40498 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
40499 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
40500 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
40501 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
40502
40503 @smallexample
40504 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40505 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40506 @dots{}
40507 </struct>
40508 @end smallexample
40509
40510 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
40511 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
40512
40513 @smallexample
40514 <struct id="@var{id}">
40515 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40516 @dots{}
40517 </struct>
40518 @end smallexample
40519
40520 @cindex <flags>
40521 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
40522 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
40523 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
40524 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
40525 are supported.
40526
40527 @smallexample
40528 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40529 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40530 @dots{}
40531 </flags>
40532 @end smallexample
40533
40534 @subsection Registers
40535 @cindex <reg>
40536
40537 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40538
40539 @smallexample
40540 <reg name="@var{name}"
40541 bitsize="@var{size}"
40542 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40543 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40544 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40545 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40546 @end smallexample
40547
40548 @noindent
40549 The components are as follows:
40550
40551 @table @var
40552
40553 @item name
40554 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40555
40556 @item bitsize
40557 The register's size, in bits.
40558
40559 @item regnum
40560 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40561 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40562 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40563 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40564 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40565 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40566 in order of increasing register number.
40567
40568 @item save-restore
40569 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40570 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40571 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40572 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40573 ABI.
40574
40575 @item type
40576 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40577 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40578 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40579 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40580 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40581 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40582
40583 @item group
40584 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40585 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40586 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40587 in @code{info registers}.
40588
40589 @end table
40590
40591 @node Predefined Target Types
40592 @section Predefined Target Types
40593 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40594
40595 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40596 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40597 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40598 types. The currently supported types are:
40599
40600 @table @code
40601
40602 @item int8
40603 @itemx int16
40604 @itemx int32
40605 @itemx int64
40606 @itemx int128
40607 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40608
40609 @item uint8
40610 @itemx uint16
40611 @itemx uint32
40612 @itemx uint64
40613 @itemx uint128
40614 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40615
40616 @item code_ptr
40617 @itemx data_ptr
40618 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40619 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40620 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40621 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40622 may be marked as data pointers.
40623
40624 @item ieee_single
40625 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40626
40627 @item ieee_double
40628 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40629
40630 @item arm_fpa_ext
40631 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40632
40633 @item i387_ext
40634 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40635
40636 @item i386_eflags
40637 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40638
40639 @item i386_mxcsr
40640 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40641
40642 @end table
40643
40644 @node Standard Target Features
40645 @section Standard Target Features
40646 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40647
40648 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40649 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40650 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40651 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40652 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40653 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40654 can recognize them.
40655
40656 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40657 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40658 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40659 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40660 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40661 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40662 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40663 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40664
40665 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40666 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40667 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40668
40669 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40670 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40671 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40672 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40673
40674 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40675 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40676 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40677
40678 @menu
40679 * AArch64 Features::
40680 * ARM Features::
40681 * i386 Features::
40682 * MicroBlaze Features::
40683 * MIPS Features::
40684 * M68K Features::
40685 * Nios II Features::
40686 * PowerPC Features::
40687 * S/390 and System z Features::
40688 * TIC6x Features::
40689 @end menu
40690
40691
40692 @node AArch64 Features
40693 @subsection AArch64 Features
40694 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40695
40696 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40697 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40698 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40699
40700 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40701 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40702 and @samp{fpcr}.
40703
40704 @node ARM Features
40705 @subsection ARM Features
40706 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40707
40708 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40709 ARM targets.
40710 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40711 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40712
40713 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40714 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40715 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40716 and @samp{xpsr}.
40717
40718 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40719 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40720
40721 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40722 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40723 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40724 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40725
40726 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40727 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40728 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40729 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40730 halves of the double-precision registers.
40731
40732 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40733 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40734 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40735 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40736 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40737 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40738
40739 @node i386 Features
40740 @subsection i386 Features
40741 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40742
40743 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40744 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40745
40746 @itemize @minus
40747 @item
40748 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40749 @item
40750 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40751 @item
40752 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40753 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40754 @item
40755 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40756 @item
40757 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40758 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40759 @end itemize
40760
40761 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40762
40763 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40764 describe registers:
40765
40766 @itemize @minus
40767 @item
40768 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40769 @item
40770 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40771 @item
40772 @samp{mxcsr}
40773 @end itemize
40774
40775 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40776 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40777 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40778
40779 @itemize @minus
40780 @item
40781 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40782 @item
40783 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40784 @end itemize
40785
40786 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
40787 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40788
40789 @itemize @minus
40790 @item
40791 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40792 @item
40793 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40794 @end itemize
40795
40796 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40797 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40798
40799 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40800 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40801 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40802
40803 @itemize @minus
40804 @item
40805 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40806 @end itemize
40807
40808 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40809
40810 @itemize @minus
40811 @item
40812 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40813 @end itemize
40814
40815 It should
40816 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40817
40818 @itemize @minus
40819 @item
40820 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40821 @item
40822 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40823 @end itemize
40824
40825 It should
40826 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40827
40828 @itemize @minus
40829 @item
40830 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40831 @end itemize
40832
40833 @node MicroBlaze Features
40834 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40835 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40836
40837 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40838 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40839 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40840 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40841 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40842
40843 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40844 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40845
40846 @node MIPS Features
40847 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40848 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40849
40850 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40851 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40852 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40853 on the target.
40854
40855 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40856 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40857 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40858
40859 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40860 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40861 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40862 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40863
40864 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40865 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40866 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40867 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40868
40869 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40870 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40871 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40872
40873 @node M68K Features
40874 @subsection M68K Features
40875 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40876
40877 @table @code
40878 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40879 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40880 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40881 One of those features must be always present.
40882 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40883 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40884 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40885 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40886
40887 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40888 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40889 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40890 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40891 @end table
40892
40893 @node Nios II Features
40894 @subsection Nios II Features
40895 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40896
40897 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40898 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40899 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40900 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40901 @samp{mpuacc}).
40902
40903 @node PowerPC Features
40904 @subsection PowerPC Features
40905 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40906
40907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40908 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40909 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40910 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40911
40912 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40913 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40914
40915 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40916 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40917 and @samp{vrsave}.
40918
40919 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40920 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40921 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40922 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40923 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40924 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40925
40926 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40927 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40928 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40929 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40930 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40931 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40932 user.
40933
40934 @node S/390 and System z Features
40935 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40936 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40937 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40938
40939 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40940 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40941 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40942 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40943 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40944 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40945 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40946 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40947 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40948
40949 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40950 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40951 @samp{fpc}.
40952
40953 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40954 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40955
40956 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40957 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40958 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40959 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40960 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40961 32-bit wide.
40962
40963 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40964 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40965 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40966
40967 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40968 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40969 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40970 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40971 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40972 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40973 @samp{v31}.
40974
40975 @node TIC6x Features
40976 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40977 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40978 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40979 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40980 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40981 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40982
40983 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40984 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40985 through @samp{B31}.
40986
40987 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40988 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40989
40990 @node Operating System Information
40991 @appendix Operating System Information
40992 @cindex operating system information
40993
40994 @menu
40995 * Process list::
40996 @end menu
40997
40998 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40999 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41000 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41001 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41002 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41003 on a different aspect of target.
41004
41005 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41006 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41007 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41008 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41009
41010 @node Process list
41011 @appendixsection Process list
41012 @cindex operating system information, process list
41013
41014 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41015 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41016 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41017 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41018
41019 An example document is:
41020
41021 @smallexample
41022 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41023 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41024 <osdata type="processes">
41025 <item>
41026 <column name="pid">1</column>
41027 <column name="user">root</column>
41028 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41029 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41030 </item>
41031 </osdata>
41032 @end smallexample
41033
41034 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41035 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41036 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41037 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41038 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41039 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41040 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41041
41042 @node Trace File Format
41043 @appendix Trace File Format
41044 @cindex trace file format
41045
41046 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41047 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41048
41049 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41050 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41051 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41052 in the future.
41053
41054 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41055 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41056 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41057 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41058 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41059 of this section.
41060
41061 @table @code
41062 @item R @var{size}
41063 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41064 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41065 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41066 a single trace file.
41067
41068 @item status @var{status}
41069 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41070 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41071 file.
41072
41073 @item tp @var{payload}
41074 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41075 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41076 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41077 reply packets.
41078
41079 @item tsv @var{payload}
41080 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41081 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41082 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41083 reply packets.
41084
41085 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41086 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41087 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41088 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41089 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41090 file. Includes are not allowed.
41091
41092 @end table
41093
41094 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41095 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41096 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41097 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41098 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41099 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41100 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41101 endianness.
41102
41103 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41104
41105 @table @code
41106 @item R @var{bytes}
41107 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41108 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41109 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41110
41111 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41112 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41113 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41114 @var{length} bytes.
41115
41116 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41117 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41118 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41119
41120 @end table
41121
41122 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41123 of blocks.
41124
41125 @node Index Section Format
41126 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41127 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41128 @cindex index section format
41129
41130 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41131 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41132 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41133 description.
41134
41135 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41136 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41137 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41138 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41139 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41140 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41141
41142 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41143
41144 @enumerate
41145 @item
41146 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41147 unless otherwise noted:
41148
41149 @enumerate
41150 @item
41151 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41152 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41153 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41154 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41155 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41156 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41157 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41158
41159 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41160 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41161 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41162 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41163
41164 @item
41165 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41166
41167 @item
41168 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41169 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41170 to the next offset.
41171
41172 @item
41173 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41174
41175 @item
41176 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41177
41178 @item
41179 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41180 @end enumerate
41181
41182 @item
41183 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41184 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41185 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41186 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41187 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41188 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41189 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41190 CU indices.
41191
41192 @item
41193 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41194 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41195 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41196 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41197
41198 @item
41199 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41200 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41201
41202 @enumerate
41203 @item
41204 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41205
41206 @item
41207 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41208 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41209
41210 @item
41211 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41212 @end enumerate
41213
41214 @item
41215 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41216 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41217
41218 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41219 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41220 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41221 constant pool.
41222
41223 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41224 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41225 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41226
41227 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41228 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41229 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41230 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41231 index version:
41232
41233 @table @asis
41234 @item Version 4
41235 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41236
41237 @item Versions 5 to 7
41238 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41239 @end table
41240
41241 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41242
41243 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41244 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41245 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41246 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41247 collision.
41248
41249 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41250 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41251 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41252 the code.
41253
41254 @item
41255 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41256 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41257 strings.
41258
41259 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41260 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41261 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41262 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41263 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41264 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41265
41266 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41267 @end enumerate
41268
41269 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41270 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41271 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41272
41273 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41274 (bit 0 = LSB):
41275
41276 @table @asis
41277
41278 @item Bits 0-23
41279 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41280 @item Bits 24-27
41281 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41282 @item Bits 28-30
41283 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41284
41285 @table @asis
41286 @item 0
41287 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41288 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41289 with previous versions of the index.
41290 @item 1
41291 The symbol is a type.
41292 @item 2
41293 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41294 @item 3
41295 The symbol is a function.
41296 @item 4
41297 Any other kind of symbol.
41298 @item 5,6,7
41299 These values are reserved.
41300 @end table
41301
41302 @item Bit 31
41303 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41304
41305 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41306 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41307 @value{GDBN} sources.
41308
41309 @end table
41310
41311 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41312 global/static attributes in the index.
41313
41314 @smallexample
41315 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41316 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41317 switch (die->tag)
41318 @{
41319 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41320 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41321 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41322 kind = TYPE;
41323 is_static = 1;
41324 break;
41325 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41326 kind = VARIABLE;
41327 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41328 break;
41329 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41330 kind = FUNCTION;
41331 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41332 break;
41333 case DW_TAG_constant:
41334 kind = VARIABLE;
41335 is_static = ! is_external;
41336 break;
41337 case DW_TAG_variable:
41338 kind = VARIABLE;
41339 is_static = ! is_external;
41340 break;
41341 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41342 kind = TYPE;
41343 is_static = 0;
41344 break;
41345 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41346 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41347 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41348 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41349 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41350 kind = TYPE;
41351 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41352 break;
41353 default:
41354 assert (0);
41355 @}
41356 @end smallexample
41357
41358 @node Man Pages
41359 @appendix Manual pages
41360 @cindex Man pages
41361
41362 @menu
41363 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41364 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41365 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41366 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41367 @end menu
41368
41369 @node gdb man
41370 @heading gdb man
41371
41372 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41373
41374 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41375 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41376 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41377 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41378 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41379 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41380 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41381 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41382 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41383 @c man end
41384
41385 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41386 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41387 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41388 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41389
41390 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41391 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41392
41393 @itemize @bullet
41394 @item
41395 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41396
41397 @item
41398 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41399
41400 @item
41401 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41402
41403 @item
41404 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41405 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41406 @end itemize
41407
41408 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41409 Modula-2.
41410
41411 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41412 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41413 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41414 by using the command @code{help}.
41415
41416 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41417 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41418 executable program as the argument:
41419
41420 @smallexample
41421 gdb program
41422 @end smallexample
41423
41424 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41425
41426 @smallexample
41427 gdb program core
41428 @end smallexample
41429
41430 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41431 to debug a running process:
41432
41433 @smallexample
41434 gdb program 1234
41435 gdb -p 1234
41436 @end smallexample
41437
41438 @noindent
41439 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41440 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41441 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41442
41443 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41444
41445 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41446 @table @env
41447 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
41448 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41449
41450 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41451 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41452
41453 @item bt
41454 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41455
41456 @item print @var{expr}
41457 Display the value of an expression.
41458
41459 @item c
41460 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41461
41462 @item next
41463 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41464 function calls in the line.
41465
41466 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41467 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41468
41469 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41470 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41471
41472 @item step
41473 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41474 function calls in the line.
41475
41476 @item help [@var{name}]
41477 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41478 about using @value{GDBN}.
41479
41480 @item quit
41481 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41482 @end table
41483
41484 @ifset man
41485 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41486 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41487 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41488 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41489 @end ifset
41490 @c man end
41491
41492 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41493 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41494 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41495 encountered with no
41496 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41497 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41498 Many options have
41499 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41500 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41501 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41502 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41503 more usual convention.)
41504
41505 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41506 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41507 option is used.
41508
41509 @table @env
41510 @item -help
41511 @itemx -h
41512 List all options, with brief explanations.
41513
41514 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41515 @itemx -s @var{file}
41516 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41517
41518 @item -write
41519 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41520
41521 @item -exec=@var{file}
41522 @itemx -e @var{file}
41523 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41524 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41525 dump.
41526
41527 @item -se=@var{file}
41528 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41529 file.
41530
41531 @item -core=@var{file}
41532 @itemx -c @var{file}
41533 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41534
41535 @item -command=@var{file}
41536 @itemx -x @var{file}
41537 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41538
41539 @item -ex @var{command}
41540 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41541
41542 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41543 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41544 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41545
41546 @item -nh
41547 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41548
41549 @item -nx
41550 @itemx -n
41551 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41552
41553 @item -quiet
41554 @itemx -q
41555 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41556 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41557
41558 @item -batch
41559 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41560 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41561 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41562 commands in the command files.
41563
41564 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41565 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41566 more useful, the message
41567
41568 @smallexample
41569 Program exited normally.
41570 @end smallexample
41571
41572 @noindent
41573 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41574 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41575
41576 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41577 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41578 instead of the current directory.
41579
41580 @item -fullname
41581 @itemx -f
41582 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41583 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41584 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41585 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41586 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41587 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41588 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41589 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41590
41591 @item -b @var{bps}
41592 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41593 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41594
41595 @item -tty=@var{device}
41596 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41597 @end table
41598 @c man end
41599
41600 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41601 @ifset man
41602 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41603 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41604 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41605
41606 @smallexample
41607 info gdb
41608 @end smallexample
41609
41610 @noindent
41611 should give you access to the complete manual.
41612
41613 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41614 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41615 @end ifset
41616 @c man end
41617
41618 @node gdbserver man
41619 @heading gdbserver man
41620
41621 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41622 @format
41623 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41624 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41625
41626 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41627
41628 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41629 @c man end
41630 @end format
41631
41632 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41633 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41634 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41635
41636 @ifclear man
41637 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41638 @end ifclear
41639 @ifset man
41640 Usage (server (target) side):
41641 @end ifset
41642
41643 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41644 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41645 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41646 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41647
41648 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41649 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41650 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41651
41652 @smallexample
41653 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41654 @end smallexample
41655
41656 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41657
41658 @smallexample
41659 @ifset man
41660 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41661 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41662 @end ifset
41663 @ifclear man
41664 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41665 @end ifclear
41666 @end smallexample
41667
41668 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41669 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41670 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41671
41672 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41673
41674 @smallexample
41675 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41676 @end smallexample
41677
41678 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41679 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41680 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41681 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41682 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41683 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41684 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41685 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41686 print an error message and exit.
41687
41688 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41689 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41690
41691 @smallexample
41692 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41693 @end smallexample
41694
41695 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41696 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41697
41698 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41699 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41700 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41701 the program you want to debug.
41702
41703 @smallexample
41704 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41705 @end smallexample
41706
41707 @ifclear man
41708 @subheading Usage (host side)
41709 @end ifclear
41710 @ifset man
41711 Usage (host side):
41712 @end ifset
41713
41714 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41715 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41716 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41717 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41718 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41719 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41720 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41721 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41722 descriptor. For example:
41723
41724 @smallexample
41725 @ifset man
41726 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41727 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41728 @end ifset
41729 @ifclear man
41730 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41731 @end ifclear
41732 @end smallexample
41733
41734 @noindent
41735 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41736
41737 @smallexample
41738 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41739 @end smallexample
41740
41741 @noindent
41742 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41743 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41744 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41745 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41746 `Connection refused'.
41747
41748 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41749 described in
41750 @ifset man
41751 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41752 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41753 @end ifset
41754 @ifclear man
41755 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41756 @end ifclear
41757 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41758
41759 @smallexample
41760 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41761 @end smallexample
41762
41763 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41764 case.
41765 @c man end
41766
41767 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41768 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41769
41770 @itemize @bullet
41771
41772 @item
41773 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41774
41775 @smallexample
41776 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41777 @end smallexample
41778
41779 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41780 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41781 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41782 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41783 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41784 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41785 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41786
41787 @item
41788 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41789 program:
41790
41791 @smallexample
41792 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41793 @end smallexample
41794
41795 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41796 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41797 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41798 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41799
41800 @item
41801 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41802
41803 @smallexample
41804 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41805 @end smallexample
41806
41807 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41808 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41809 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41810 debug several processes in the same session.
41811 @end itemize
41812
41813 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41814
41815 @table @env
41816
41817 @item --help
41818 List all options, with brief explanations.
41819
41820 @item --version
41821 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41822
41823 @item --attach
41824 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41825
41826 @smallexample
41827 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41828 @end smallexample
41829
41830 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41831 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41832
41833 @item --multi
41834 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41835 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41836 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41837 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41838
41839 @smallexample
41840 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41841 @end smallexample
41842
41843 @item --debug
41844 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41845 process.
41846 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41847 the developers.
41848
41849 @item --remote-debug
41850 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41851 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41852 the developers.
41853
41854 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41855 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41856 of debugging output.
41857 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41858
41859 @item --wrapper
41860 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41861 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41862 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41863 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41864
41865 @item --once
41866 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41867 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41868 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41869 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41870
41871 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41872
41873 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41874 @c QDisableRandomization.
41875
41876 @end table
41877 @c man end
41878
41879 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41880 @ifset man
41881 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41882 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41883 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41884
41885 @smallexample
41886 info gdb
41887 @end smallexample
41888
41889 should give you access to the complete manual.
41890
41891 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41892 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41893 @end ifset
41894 @c man end
41895
41896 @node gcore man
41897 @heading gcore
41898
41899 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41900
41901 @format
41902 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41903 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41904 @c man end
41905 @end format
41906
41907 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41908 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41909 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41910 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41911 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41912 running without any change.
41913 @c man end
41914
41915 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41916 @table @env
41917 @item -o @var{filename}
41918 The optional argument
41919 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41920 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41921 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41922 @end table
41923 @c man end
41924
41925 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41926 @ifset man
41927 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41928 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41929 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41930
41931 @smallexample
41932 info gdb
41933 @end smallexample
41934
41935 @noindent
41936 should give you access to the complete manual.
41937
41938 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41939 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41940 @end ifset
41941 @c man end
41942
41943 @node gdbinit man
41944 @heading gdbinit
41945
41946 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41947
41948 @format
41949 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41950 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41951 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41952 @end ifset
41953
41954 ~/.gdbinit
41955
41956 ./.gdbinit
41957 @c man end
41958 @end format
41959
41960 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41961 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41962 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41963 described in
41964 @ifset man
41965 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41966 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41967 @end ifset
41968 @ifclear man
41969 @ref{Sequences}.
41970 @end ifclear
41971
41972 Please read more in
41973 @ifset man
41974 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41975 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41976 @end ifset
41977 @ifclear man
41978 @ref{Startup}.
41979 @end ifclear
41980
41981 @table @env
41982 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41983 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41984 @end ifset
41985 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41986 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41987 @end ifclear
41988 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41989 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41990 See more in
41991 @ifset man
41992 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41993 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41994 @end ifset
41995 @ifclear man
41996 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41997 @end ifclear
41998
41999 @item ~/.gdbinit
42000 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42001 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42002
42003 @item ./.gdbinit
42004 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42005 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42006 See more in
42007 @ifset man
42008 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42009 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42010 @end ifset
42011 @ifclear man
42012 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42013 @end ifclear
42014 @end table
42015 @c man end
42016
42017 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42018 @ifset man
42019 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42020
42021 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42022 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42023 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42024
42025 @smallexample
42026 info gdb
42027 @end smallexample
42028
42029 should give you access to the complete manual.
42030
42031 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42032 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42033 @end ifset
42034 @c man end
42035
42036 @include gpl.texi
42037
42038 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42039 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42040 @include fdl.texi
42041
42042 @node Concept Index
42043 @unnumbered Concept Index
42044
42045 @printindex cp
42046
42047 @node Command and Variable Index
42048 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42049
42050 @printindex fn
42051
42052 @tex
42053 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42054 % meantime:
42055 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42056 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42057 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42058 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42059 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42060 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42061 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42062 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42063 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42064 \page\colophon
42065 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42066 @end tex
42067
42068 @bye
This page took 1.525931 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.